97-12201. Antidumping Duties; Countervailing Duties  

  • [Federal Register Volume 62, Number 96 (Monday, May 19, 1997)]
    [Rules and Regulations]
    [Pages 27296-27424]
    From the Federal Register Online via the Government Publishing Office [www.gpo.gov]
    [FR Doc No: 97-12201]
    
    
    
    [[Page 27295]]
    
    _______________________________________________________________________
    
    Part II
    
    
    
    
    
    Department of Commerce
    
    
    
    
    
    _______________________________________________________________________
    
    
    
    International Trade Administration
    
    
    
    _______________________________________________________________________
    
    
    
    19 CFR Part 351 et al.
    
    
    
    Antidumping Duties; Countervailing Duties; Final rule
    
    Federal Register / Vol. 62, No. 96 / Monday, May 19, 1997 / Rules and 
    Regulations
    
    [[Page 27296]]
    
    
    =======================================================================
    -----------------------------------------------------------------------
    
    
    DEPARTMENT OF COMMERCE
    
    International Trade Administration
    
    19 CFR Parts 351, 353, and 355
    
    [Docket No. 950306068-6361-04]
    RIN 0625-AA45
    
    
    Antidumping Duties; Countervailing Duties
    
    AGENCY: International Trade Administration, Commerce.
    
    ACTION: Final rule.
    
    -----------------------------------------------------------------------
    
    SUMMARY: The Department of Commerce (``the Department'') hereby revises 
    its regulations on antidumping and countervailing duty proceedings to 
    conform the Department's existing regulations to the Uruguay Round 
    Agreements Act, which implemented the results of the Uruguay Round 
    multilateral trade negotiations. In addition to conforming changes, in 
    these regulations the Department has sought to: where appropriate and 
    feasible, translate the principles of the implementing legislation into 
    specific and predictable rules, thereby facilitating the administration 
    of these laws and providing greater predictability for private parties 
    affected by these laws; simplify and streamline the Department's 
    administration of antidumping and countervailing duty proceedings in a 
    manner consistent with the purpose of the statute and the President's 
    regulatory principles; and codify certain administrative practices 
    determined to be appropriate under the new statute and under the 
    President's Regulatory Reform Initiative.
    
    DATES: The effective date of this final rule is June 18, 1997. See 
    Sec. 351.701 for applicability dates.
    
    FOR FURTHER INFORMATION CONTACT: Michael Rill (202) 482-3058. For 
    information concerning matters relating to the scope of orders or 
    changed circumstances reviews, contact the Office of Policy (202) 482-
    4412.
    
    SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION:
    
    Background
    
        The publication of this notice of final rules completes a 
    significant portion of the process of developing regulations under the 
    Uruguay Round Agreements Act (``URAA''). This process began when the 
    Department took the unusual step of requesting advance public comments 
    in order to ensure that, at the earliest possible stage, we could 
    consider and take into account the views of the private sector entities 
    that are affected by the antidumping (``AD'') and countervailing duty 
    (``CVD'') laws. On February 27, 1996, the Department published proposed 
    rules dealing with AD and CVD procedures and AD methodology (``AD 
    Proposed Regulations''). The Department received over five hundred 
    written public comments regarding the AD Proposed Regulations. On June 
    7, 1996, the Department held a public hearing, and, thereafter, 
    received over one hundred additional post-hearing written public 
    comments on the AD Proposed Regulations.1
    ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
    
        \1\ The prior notices published by the Department as part of its 
    URAA rulemaking activity are: (1) Advance Notice of Proposed 
    Rulemaking and Request for Public Comments (Antidumping Duties; 
    Countervailing Duties; Article 1904 of the North American Free Trade 
    Agreement), 60 FR 80 (Jan. 3, 1995); (2) Advance Notice of Proposed 
    Rulemaking: Extension of Comment Period (Antidumping Duties; 
    Countervailing Duties; Article 1904 of the North American Free Trade 
    Agreement), 60 FR 9802 (Feb. 22, 1995); (3) Interim Regulations; 
    Request for Comments (Antidumping and Countervailing Duties), 60 FR 
    25130 (May 11, 1995); (4) Proposed Rule; Request for Comments 
    (Antidumping and Countervailing Duty Proceedings; Administrative 
    Protective Order Procedures; Procedures for Imposing Sanctions for 
    Violation of a Protective Order), 61 FR 4826 (Feb. 8, 1996); (5) 
    Notice of Proposed Rulemaking and Request for Public Comments 
    (Antidumping Duties; Countervailing Duties), 61 FR 7308 (Feb. 27, 
    1996); (6) Extension of Deadline to File Public Comments on Proposed 
    Antidumping and Countervailing Duty Regulations and Announcement of 
    Public Hearing (Antidumping Duties; Countervailing Duties), 61 FR 
    18122 (April 24, 1996); (7) Announcement of Opportunity to File 
    Public Comments on the Public Hearing of Proposed Antidumping and 
    Countervailing Duty Regulations (Antidumping Duties; Countervailing 
    Duties), 61 FR 28821 (June 6, 1996); (8) Notice of Proposed 
    Rulemaking and Request for Public Comments (Countervailing Duties), 
    62 FR 8818 (Feb. 26, 1997); and (9) Extension of Deadline to File 
    Public Comments on Proposed Countervailing Duty Regulations 
    (Countervailing Duties), 62 FR 19719 (April 23, 1997).
    ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
    
        In drafting these final rules, the Department has carefully 
    reviewed and considered each of the hundreds of comments it received. 
    While we have not always adopted suggestions made by commenters, we 
    found the comments to be extremely useful in helping us to work our way 
    through the legal and policy thickets created by the massive rewriting 
    of our operating statute. Therefore, we are extremely grateful to those 
    who took the time and trouble to express their views regarding how the 
    Department should administer the AD and CVD laws in the future.
        In addition, in these final rules, the Department has continued to 
    be guided by the objectives described in the AD Proposed Regulations. 
    Specifically, these objectives are: (1) Conformity with the statutory 
    amendments made by the URAA; (2) the elaboration through regulation of 
    certain statements contained in the Statement of Administrative Action 
    (``SAA''); 2 and (3) consistency with President Clinton's 
    Regulatory Reform Initiative and his directive to identify and 
    eliminate obsolete and burdensome regulations.
    ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
    
        \2\ Statement of Administrative Action Accompanying H.R. 5110, 
    H.R. Doc. No. 316, Vol. 1, 103d Cong., 2d Sess. (1994).
    ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
    
    Explanation of the Final Rules
    
    General Background
    
    Consolidation of Antidumping and Countervailing Duty Regulations
        As described in the AD Proposed Regulations, in response to the 
    President's Regulatory Reform Initiative and to reduce the amount of 
    duplicative material in the regulations, the Department proposed to 
    consolidate the AD and CVD regulations into a new part 351, and to 
    remove parts 353 and 355. The Department did not receive any comments 
    concerning the consolidation of the regulations, and, upon further 
    review, we believe that the consolidation reduces duplication and makes 
    the AD/CVD regulations easier to use. Accordingly, we are promulgating 
    a single part 351, and are removing parts 353 and 355.
        The structure of part 351 is as follows. Subpart A (Scope and 
    Definitions) is based on former subpart A of parts 353 and 355. Among 
    other things, the regulations contained in subpart A deal with general 
    definitions applicable to AD/CVD proceedings, the record for such 
    proceedings, de minimis standards for countervailable subsidies and 
    dumping margins, and the rates to be applied in the case of 
    nonproducing exporters or AD proceedings involving nonmarket economy 
    countries.
        Subpart B (Antidumping and Countervailing Duty Procedures) is based 
    on former subpart B of parts 353 and 355. As indicated by the title, 
    subpart B deals with procedural aspects of AD and CVD proceedings. 
    Where the procedures for AD and CVD proceedings are different, the 
    regulations in subpart B so specify.
        Subpart C (Information and Argument) is based on former subpart C 
    of parts 353 and 355. Subpart C establishes rules for AD/CVD 
    proceedings regarding such matters as the submission of information, 
    the treatment of business proprietary information, the verification of 
    information, and determinations based on the facts available. Certain 
    portions of subpart C dealing with the treatment of business 
    proprietary information and administrative protective order procedures 
    were the subject of a separate notice of proposed rulemaking
    
    [[Page 27297]]
    
    and request for public comments on February 8, 1996. 61 FR 4826. A 
    separate notice of final regulations will be published for these 
    portions of subpart C.
        Subpart D (Calculation of Export Price, Constructed Export Price, 
    Fair Value, and Normal Value) is based on former subpart D of part 353. 
    Subpart D deals with methodologies for identifying and measuring 
    dumping.
        Subpart E is designated ``[Reserved].'' Proposed rules to be 
    included in subpart E were published in a separate notice of proposed 
    rulemaking and request for public comments on February 26, 1997. 62 FR 
    8818. The Department will publish a separate notice of final 
    regulations after reviewing and considering public comments submitted 
    in connection with proposed subpart E.
        Subpart F (Cheese Subject to In-Quota Rate of Duty) is based on 
    subpart D of former part 355, and implements section 702 of the Trade 
    Agreements Act of 1979, as amended by the URAA.
    Comments on Overall Drafting Approach
        The Department received a few comments regarding the overall 
    drafting approach used in the AD Proposed Regulations. One commenter 
    complimented the Department on its use of introductory paragraphs 
    before each regulation, but noted that in several instances the 
    language of the introductory paragraph did not accurately reflect the 
    content of the regulation itself. In addition, this same commenter 
    noted that in several instances, the Department's use of the citation 
    signal ``See'' to a particular statutory provision was ambiguous. We 
    have taken this commenter's suggestions to heart, and in drafting these 
    final regulations we have reviewed the introductory paragraphs and our 
    citation signals in order to improve the clarity and precision of these 
    regulations.
        A different commenter noted that in the AD Proposed Regulations, 
    when the Department referred to a particular section of the statute, it 
    referenced only the Tariff Act of 1930 (the ``Act'') itself, not the 
    section of the U.S. Code where the section is codified. This commenter 
    suggested that to make the regulations more ``user friendly,'' the 
    Department should refer to the relevant U.S. Code section of the Act or 
    to both the U.S. Code and the Act.
        While we appreciate the spirit in which this suggestion was made, 
    we have not adopted it in drafting these final regulations. For years, 
    the Department generally has referenced sections of the Act in its 
    regulations, and we are not aware of any objections having been raised 
    regarding this drafting practice (other than the instant comment). The 
    absence of objections to this practice, as well as the absence of any 
    other comments endorsing the use of U.S. Code citations, suggests to us 
    that those who use these laws are comfortable with our practice of 
    referencing sections of the Act. As for the suggestion that we 
    reference both the Act and U.S. Code sections, given the numerous 
    statutory references in these final regulations, the adoption of this 
    suggestion would add considerably to the overall length of the 
    regulations without, in our view, contributing significantly to their 
    ease of use.
    Explanation of Particular Provisions
        In drafting these final regulations, the Department carefully 
    considered each of the comments received. In addition, we conducted our 
    own independent review of those provisions of the AD Proposed 
    Regulations that were not the subject of public comments. The following 
    sections contain a summary of the comments we received and the 
    Department's responses to those comments. In addition, these sections 
    contain an explanation of any changes the Department has made to the AD 
    Proposed Regulations either in response to comments or on its own 
    initiative. The following sections do not contain a discussion of those 
    provisions that remain unchanged from the AD Proposed Regulations and 
    that were not the subject of any public comments.
    
    Subpart A--Scope and Definitions
    
        Subpart A of part 351 sets forth the scope of part 351, 
    definitions, and other general matters applicable to AD/CVD 
    proceedings.
    
    Section 351.102
    
        Section 351.102 sets forth definitions of terms that are used 
    throughout part 351. With respect to most of the definitions contained 
    in Sec. 351.102, we received no comments. Definitions that we have 
    added or revised, or on which we received comments, are discussed 
    below.
        We received one general comment suggesting that we number each of 
    the definitions contained in Sec. 351.102(b) as a separate numbered 
    paragraph. According to the commenter, the absence of subparagraph 
    numbering will make shorthand references to a particular definition 
    impossible and will render definitions difficult to locate.
        We have not adopted this suggestion, because we have followed the 
    guidelines set forth in the Document Drafting Handbook 1991 ed. (Office 
    of the Federal Register), which states, at page 21, that ``paragraph 
    designations are not required for the terms being defined, if the terms 
    are listed in alphabetical order,'' as is the case with respect to 
    Sec. 351.102(b). Because the definitions in Sec. 102(b) are listed in 
    alphabetical order, we do not believe that it will be difficult to 
    locate a particular definition. In addition, we do not believe that the 
    format we have used precludes shorthand references.
        Affiliated persons; affiliated parties: Many commenters claimed 
    that because the statute and the SAA do not provide sufficient guidance 
    as to when the Department will consider an affiliation to exist by 
    virtue of ``control,'' the Department should provide clearer guidance 
    in the regulations. In this regard, we received a number of specific 
    suggestions relating to the issue of ``control,'' many of which had 
    been submitted previously.
        As a general observation, the Department appreciates the desire for 
    additional detail regarding the concept of affiliation. To the extent 
    possible, we have attempted to provide additional guidance in this 
    explanatory material. However, we continue to believe that it would be 
    premature to codify much guidance in the form of a regulation. As 
    explained in the AD Proposed Regulations, 61 FR at 7310, we believe 
    that it is more appropriate to develop our practice regarding 
    affiliation through the adjudication of actual cases.
        Turning to specific suggestions, several commenters suggested that 
    the definition should state that in order for control to exist within 
    the meaning of section 771(33) of the Act, a relationship must affect 
    the subject merchandise or foreign like product. These commenters 
    argued that the purpose of such a requirement would be to winnow out 
    those relationships that, while unquestionably close enough to 
    constitute control in the abstract, do not affect the production or 
    sale of the product that the Department is examining. According to 
    these commenters, this approach is in line with the statement in the AD 
    Proposed Regulations, 61 FR at 7310, that the Department would look at 
    the ability to impact production, pricing, or cost, an analysis which, 
    they claimed, must be directed at the product under investigation or 
    review.
        In general we agree with the suggestion that we focus on 
    relationships that have the potential to impact decisions concerning 
    production, pricing or cost. This does not mean however, that proof is 
    required that a relationship in fact has
    
    [[Page 27298]]
    
    had such an impact. In this regard, section 771(33), which refers to a 
    person being ``in a position to exercise restraint or direction,'' 
    properly focuses the Department on the ability to exercise ``control'' 
    rather than the actuality of control over specific decisions. 
    Therefore, we will consider the full range of criteria identified in 
    the SAA, at 838, in determining whether ``control'' exists. Moreover, 
    we do not believe that we should ignore situations in which a control 
    relationship, while relating directly to another product or another 
    type of commercial activity, could affect decisions involving the 
    production, pricing or cost of the merchandise under consideration. 
    Therefore, in these types of situations, where a control relationship 
    exists, the respondent will have to demonstrate that the relationship 
    does not have the potential to affect the subject merchandise or 
    foreign like product.
        Several commenters suggested that the Department reconsider the 
    statement in the preamble to the AD Proposed Regulations, 61 FR at 
    7310, that ``temporary market power, created by variations in supply 
    and demand conditions, would not suffice [as evidence of control].'' 
    With respect to this comment, we continue to believe that temporary 
    market power generally would not constitute sufficient evidence of 
    control. However, where the issue arises, the Department will conduct a 
    case-by-case examination to determine whether market power is truly 
    ``temporary.''
        Another commenter suggested that the regulations state that in 
    analyzing control, the Department will focus on long-term, rather than 
    short-term, relationships. With respect to this suggestion, the 
    Department normally will not consider firms to be affiliated where the 
    evidence of ``control'' is limited, for example, to a two-month 
    contract. On the other hand, the Department cannot rule out the 
    possibility that a short-term relationship could result in control. 
    Therefore, the Department will consider the temporal aspect of a 
    relationship as one factor to consider in determining whether control 
    exists. In this regard, we also should note that we do not intend to 
    ignore a control relationship that happens to terminate at the 
    beginning (or comes into existence at the end) of a period of 
    investigation or review.
        A number of commenters asked that the Department refrain from 
    finding an affiliation in situations where the applicable national law 
    prevents one firm from exercising control over another. With respect to 
    this suggestion, the Department will take national laws into account in 
    examining the existence of control. However, the Department also will 
    consider whether, national laws notwithstanding, there is any de facto 
    control.
        Many commenters requested that the Department establish (1) 
    rebuttable presumptions for when control does or does not exist; (2) 
    bright-line thresholds establishing when control does not exist; and 
    (3) specific examples in the regulations of relationships that do or do 
    not constitute control. We have not adopted these suggestions, because 
    they require the type of fact-specific determinations that the 
    Department is not prepared to make at this time. As discussed above, 
    the Department intends to establish guidelines concerning affiliation 
    gradually as we gain experience through the resolution of issues in 
    actual cases.
        One commenter suggested that the Department should find control to 
    exist only if a relationship resulted in an impact on prices or other 
    significant terms of sale. The Department has not adopted this 
    suggestion, because we do not agree that it is appropriate to require 
    evidence regarding the actual impact of a relationship. Because section 
    771(33) refers to a person being ``in a position to exercise restraint 
    or direction,'' we are required to examine the ability to control, not 
    the actual exercise of control.
        Another commenter suggested that the Department should not consider 
    ``normal commercial relationships'' as giving rise to control. We have 
    not adopted this suggestion, because ``normal'' is a subjective term 
    that lacks any clear definition. In our view, a standard of 
    ``normality'' would be subject to substantial confusion, argument, and 
    litigation. More importantly, there is nothing in the statute or the 
    legislative history that suggests that ``normal commercial 
    relationships'' cannot give rise to control. To the contrary, the SAA 
    at 838 states: ``A company may be in a position to exercise restraint 
    or direction, for example, through corporate or family groupings, 
    franchises or joint venture agreements, debt financing, or close 
    supplier relationships in which the supplier or buyer becomes reliant 
    upon the other.'' Each of the relationships described in this passage 
    can be characterized as ``normal'' in the sense that they are 
    commercial relationships commonly entered into by firms. Nevertheless, 
    notwithstanding the ``normality'' of these commercial relationships, 
    the SAA indicates that they can give rise to control.
        One commenter suggested that the Department clarify that the 
    provision of a loan by one firm to another on terms consistent with 
    commercial considerations will not constitute control. The Department 
    has not adopted this suggestion, because we do not believe that the 
    fact that a loan is provided on terms consistent with commercial 
    considerations is necessarily dispositive with respect to the issue of 
    control. For example, in situations where the supply of credit is 
    limited, the availability of a loan, regardless of the loan's terms, 
    may allow the lender to exercise control over the recipient of the 
    loan.
        Several commenters suggested that the Department should define 
    legal or operational control as the ``enforceable ability to compel or 
    restrain commercial actions.'' As a further refinement of this 
    suggestion, one commenter suggested that the Department should find 
    control only if one firm is capable of forcing another firm to act 
    against its own interests.
        The Department has not adopted these suggestions, because we do not 
    believe that ``enforceability'' is a requisite factor under section 
    771(33). In addition, in the case of the second suggestion, we believe 
    that focusing on the speculative question of what is or is not in a 
    firm's interests would render our analysis of affiliation less, rather 
    than more, predictable.
        Aggregate basis: We received one comment concerning the definition 
    of the term ``aggregate basis,'' a term that describes CVD proceedings 
    in which the Department, under section 777A(e)(2)(B) of the Act, 
    determines a single country-wide subsidy rate applicable to all 
    exporters and producers. The commenter suggested that we substitute the 
    word ``principally'' for ``solely'' so that the definition would read: 
    `` `Aggregate basis' means the calculation of a country-wide subsidy 
    rate based principally on information provided by the foreign 
    government.'' According to the commenter, the purpose of the 
    modification would be to avoid confusion when the Department conducts a 
    CVD investigation or review on an aggregate basis, but one or more 
    producers request an individual review or exclusion.
        We have adopted this suggestion, although not for the reason 
    suggested. Although section 777A(e) of the Act establishes a preference 
    for individual countervailable subsidy rates, section 777A(e)(2) 
    provides for alternative methods where there are a large number of 
    exporters or producers involved in an investigation or review. Under 
    section 777A(e)(2)(B), one of these alternatives is to determine a 
    single country-wide subsidy rate. Should the Department
    
    [[Page 27299]]
    
    have to use the country-wide rate method of section 777A(e)(2)(B), the 
    Department will not review firms individually, although, where 
    practicable, the Department will consider requests for an individual 
    zero rate in an administrative review under Sec. 351.213(k). In 
    addition, while the Department will consider requests for exclusions 
    from firms that claim to have received no countervailable subsidies, 
    the Department will not calculate subsidy rates to be applied to 
    merchandise produced or exported by such firms. Instead, the Department 
    merely will determine whether or not a firm requesting exclusion 
    receives countervailable subsidies in more than de minimis amounts. If 
    the firm does not, the Department will exclude the firm. If the firm 
    does receive more than de minimis countervailable subsidies, the 
    Department will not exclude the firm, and will apply to that firm the 
    country-wide subsidy rate.
        Thus, the definition of ``aggregate basis'' is not inaccurate 
    insofar as it relates to the calculation of individual rates and the 
    granting of exclusions. On the other hand, the definition, as drafted, 
    fails to reflect the fact that even in a CVD proceeding in which the 
    Department calculates a single country-wide rate, it may have to obtain 
    information from one or more firms with respect to certain types of 
    subsidies, such as equity infusions. Therefore, we have substituted the 
    word ``principally'' for ``solely'' to reflect this fact.
        Country-wide subsidy rate: One commenter suggested that we add to 
    Sec. 351.102(b) a definition of ``country-wide subsidy rate.'' The 
    proposed definition included a statement that the Secretary shall use 
    ``the smallest applicable and feasible jurisdictional unit consistent 
    with'' the definition of ``country'' in section 771(3) of the Act. The 
    thrust of the comment was that the Department should calculate separate 
    ``country-wide subsidy rates'' for individual subnational 
    jurisdictions, such as provinces or states. A different commenter 
    opposed this suggestion.
        We have not adopted this suggestion, because the statute does not 
    require the Department to calculate state- or province-specific subsidy 
    rates. The Department rejected province-specific rates in Certain 
    Softwood Lumber Products from Canada, 57 FR 22570, 22578-80 (1992), and 
    the Department's position was sustained in Certain Softwood Lumber 
    Products from Canada, No. USA-92-1904-01, Slip op. 139-43 (FTA Panel 
    May 6, 1993). We do not believe that any of the statutory amendments 
    made by the URAA warrants a different outcome. Moreover, there is no 
    indication in the legislative history that Congress intended any change 
    to the Department's practice in this regard.
        Ordinary course of trade: We received several comments concerning 
    the Department's proposed definition of the term ``ordinary course of 
    trade.'' Some of these comments dealt with the definition in general, 
    while other comments focussed on particular aspects of the definition.
        The definition in general: One commenter stated that the definition 
    should establish a presumption that sales are in the ordinary course of 
    trade until a party demonstrates otherwise on a sale-by-sale basis 
    (with the exception of home-market sales at prices below cost of 
    production). This commenter also argued that the standards for making 
    such a claim should be exacting, and that no general unsupported 
    conclusions should suffice to exclude selected transactions. This 
    commenter also urged the Department to omit from the regulation 
    examples of sales that might be outside the ordinary course of trade, 
    stating that each case should turn on its facts.
        We have adopted this suggestion in part. We have not adopted the 
    suggestion regarding the establishment of a presumption, because we 
    believe that judicial precedent is sufficiently clear that the party 
    making the claim bears the burden of proving that sales are outside the 
    ordinary course of trade. See, e.g., Koyo Seiko Co., Ltd. v. United 
    States, Slip op. 96-101 (Ct. Int'l Trade June 19, 1996), pp. 22-25, and 
    cases cited therein. In addition, we have not adopted the suggestion 
    that we delete references to particular types of sales that might be 
    considered as outside the ordinary course of trade. Given the 
    illustrative examples of such sales in the SAA, we believe that it is 
    appropriate to provide guidance to parties by describing certain types 
    of transactions that, depending on the facts, might be deemed to be 
    outside the ordinary course of trade.
        However, we have modified the definition so as to emphasize the 
    fact-specific nature of ordinary course of trade analyses. As revised, 
    the definition states that, as required by judicial precedent, the 
    Secretary will evaluate ``all the circumstances particular to the sales 
    in question.''
        Another commenter expressed satisfaction with the proposed 
    definition, but suggested that the Department's placement of the closed 
    parenthesis in the definition was incorrect. We agree that we misplaced 
    the closed parenthesis. However, we have corrected the error by 
    restating the parenthetical as a separate sentence.
        Abnormally high profits: Several commenters objected to the 
    reference in the proposed definition to ``merchandise sold * * * with 
    abnormally high profits.'' According to one commenter, neither the 
    statute nor the SAA refers to ``abnormally high profits'' as a factor 
    in considering whether merchandise is sold in the ordinary course of 
    trade. In addition, this commenter asserted that the inclusion of this 
    factor in the definition would invite respondents to argue for the 
    exclusion of allegedly overly profitable sales.
        Another commenter acknowledged that the SAA does discuss sales with 
    ``abnormally high profits'' as being outside the ordinary course of 
    trade, but that it does so in the context of constructed value profit. 
    This same commenter also argued that the proposed definition is overtly 
    biased in favor of respondents, because it does not provide for the 
    exclusion of sales with abnormally ``low'' profits as being outside the 
    ordinary course of trade. A third commenter, also noting that the 
    proposed definition does not refer to sales with abnormally ``low'' 
    profits, requested that the Department either delete the reference to 
    abnormally high profits or revise the definition to refer to 
    ``merchandise sold at aberrational prices or profits.''
        We have not adopted these suggestions. With respect to the 
    propriety of including in the definition any reference to sales with 
    abnormally high profits, we believe that the SAA warrants such a 
    reference. As acknowledged by one of the commenters, the SAA at 839-40 
    does refer to sales with abnormally high profits as being outside the 
    ordinary course of trade. Although this reference is made in the 
    context of constructed value profit, we believe that it applies in 
    other contexts, as well. The SAA at 839 itself notes that ``constructed 
    value serves as a proxy for a sales price.'' Thus, where normal value 
    is based on constructed value, the constructed value is supposed to 
    approximate what a price-based normal value would be if there were 
    usable sales. Because, according to the SAA, a constructed value that 
    included a profit element based on sales with abnormally high prices 
    would not constitute an acceptable normal value, it follows that it 
    would be improper to use sales with abnormally high profits as a basis 
    for a price-based normal value.
        With respect to the suggestion that the Department will be 
    overwhelmed with arguments from respondents claiming
    
    [[Page 27300]]
    
    that particular sales have abnormally high profits, as discussed above, 
    the burden of establishing that a particular sale is outside the 
    ordinary course of trade rests on the party making the claim. Over 
    time, we believe that this evidentiary burden will ensure that only 
    serious claims are presented to the Department.
        Finally, we do not believe that the proposed definition favors 
    respondents. When one considers the proposed definition in light of the 
    entire statute and the SAA, it is apparent that the Department may 
    exclude sales with both abnormally low (i.e., negative) and abnormally 
    high profits from a dumping analysis. The only difference is that the 
    Department considers sales with abnormally low profits under the rubric 
    of ``sales below cost of production'' and section 773(b) of the Act. 
    However, as section 771(15)(A) of the Act makes clear, sales that are 
    disregarded under section 773(b)(1) as being below cost are considered 
    to be outside the ordinary course of trade.
        Off-quality merchandise: One commenter requested that the 
    Department delete the reference in the proposed definition to ``off-
    quality merchandise.'' According to this commenter, neither the statute 
    nor the SAA mentions ``off-quality merchandise,'' and such merchandise 
    may be in the ordinary course of trade in certain industries and 
    markets.
        We have not adopted this suggestion. Contrary to the comment, the 
    SAA at 839 does refer to ``off-quality merchandise,'' albeit in the 
    context of constructed value profit. For the reasons set forth above in 
    connection with the issue of ``abnormally high profits,'' we believe 
    that this reference is relevant to the general definition of ``ordinary 
    course of trade.'' As for the argument that sales of ``off-quality 
    merchandise'' may be in the ordinary course of trade in certain 
    industries and markets, the inclusion of the reference to ``off-quality 
    merchandise'' does not mean that sales of such merchandise are 
    automatically outside the ordinary course of trade. As discussed above, 
    and as the revised definition now makes clear, the Secretary will 
    conclude that particular sales are outside the ordinary course of trade 
    only after an evaluation of all of the circumstances.
        Samples and Prototypes: One commenter suggested that the Department 
    should consider sales of sample and prototype merchandise to be outside 
    the ordinary course of trade, and should exclude such sales from its 
    calculations of dumping margins. We have not adopted this suggestion 
    for several reasons. First, there needs to be some limit on the number 
    of items included in a non-exhaustive list of examples. While we do not 
    disagree that there may be instances in which the Department might 
    consider sales of samples or prototypes to be outside the ordinary 
    course of trade, the commenter acknowledged that such sales already may 
    be embraced by the regulatory reference to merchandise ``sold pursuant 
    to unusual terms of sale.'' Second, the commenter requested that sales 
    of samples or prototypes be excluded from the dumping margin 
    calculation altogether. However, as both the Department and the courts 
    have made clear on numerous occasions, the statutory exclusion for 
    sales outside the ordinary course of trade applies only to sales used 
    to determine foreign market value (now normal value), not sales used to 
    determine U.S. price (now export price or constructed export price). 
    Thus, the courts have sustained the inclusion of all United States 
    sales whether in or out of the ordinary course of trade. See, e.g., 
    Bowe Passat Reinigungs-Und Waschereitechnik GMBH v. United States, 926 
    F. Supp. 1138, 1147-49 (Ct. Int'l Trade 1996), and cases cited therein.
        Price adjustment: We have added to Sec. 351.102(b) a definition of 
    the term ``price adjustment.'' This term is intended to describe a 
    category of changes to a price, such as discounts, rebates and post-
    sale price adjustments, that affect the net outlay of funds by the 
    purchaser. As discussed in connection with Sec. 351.401, below, such 
    price changes are not ``expenses'' as the Department usually uses that 
    term, but rather are changes that the Department must take into account 
    in identifying the actual starting price. Numerous commenters requested 
    clarification on whether price adjustments would be treated as direct 
    or indirect expenses. As discussed more fully below, price adjustments 
    are neither direct nor indirect expenses, although they impact price as 
    additions or deductions.
        Sale or likely sale: The proposed definition of ``likely sale,'' 
    which was based on 19 CFR Secs. 353.2(t) and 355.2(p), defined this 
    term as meaning ``a person's irrevocable offer to sell.'' One commenter 
    suggested that the Department liberalize this definition to encompass 
    something less than an irrevocable offer to sell.
        Although the Department has not adopted this particular suggestion, 
    we have taken another look at the ``irrevocable offer'' standard. 
    Because most AD/CVD petitions are based on sales, rather than likely 
    sales, the Department rarely has applied this standard. However, in one 
    case where the use of the irrevocable offer standard was at issue, the 
    court criticized the standard. Kerr-McGee Chemical Corp. v. United 
    States, 765 F. Supp. 1576 (Ct. Int'l Trade 1991). Therefore, the 
    Department has decided to eliminate the definition of ``likely sale'' 
    in Sec. 351.102(b). Should the meaning of this term become an issue in 
    future cases, we will interpret the term in light of the statute and 
    the legislative history.
        Segment of the proceeding: One commenter suggested that paragraph 
    (2) of the definition of ``segment of the proceeding'' include a 
    reference to scope inquiries, because such inquiries are separately 
    reviewable under section 516A of the Act. We have adopted this 
    suggestion, and have revised paragraph (2) of the definition 
    accordingly.
        Another commenter did not object to the definition itself, but 
    stated that the Department should treat each whole review as a separate 
    proceeding, and should rely upon the record from each proceeding only 
    in connection with that particular proceeding. Because this commenter 
    did not propose any revisions to the definition, we have not made any 
    changes to the definition based on this comment.
        Suspension of liquidation: One commenter suggested that in order to 
    eliminate confusion created by ``suspensions'' ordered by agencies 
    other than the Department, such as the Customs Service, the Department 
    should add to Sec. 351.102 a definition of ``suspension of 
    liquidation.'' The commenter included a proposed definition that, in 
    general, defined ``suspension of liquidation'' as a suspension of 
    liquidation specifically ordered by the Department under the authority 
    of title VII or title X of the Tariff Act, or by the courts in 
    litigation involving antidumping or countervailing duties. No commenter 
    opposed this suggestion.
        We have adopted the suggestion, and have added to Sec. 351.102(b) a 
    definition of ``suspension of liquidation'' along the lines suggested 
    by the commenter. However, we have modified the language proposed by 
    the commenter in order to make the definition more accurate with 
    respect to suspensions of liquidation ordered by courts.
    
    Section 351.104
    
        Section 351.104 defines what constitutes the official and public 
    records of an AD/CVD proceeding, and prohibits the removal of a record 
    or any portion thereof unless ordered by the Secretary or required by 
    law.
        In connection with Sec. 351.104(a)(1) and its list of examples of 
    materials that will be included in the official record,
    
    [[Page 27301]]
    
    one commenter suggested that the Department add to this list ``changes 
    to the electronic database that are made by Commerce (or by 
    respondents)'' and ``computer programs.'' Although the material 
    described by the commenter is, as a matter of practice, included in the 
    official record, we have not adopted this suggestion. As the commenter 
    acknowledged, paragraph (a)(1) merely contains examples of material 
    that will be included in the record, and is not itself an exhaustive 
    list. The commenter did not indicate that the absence of a reference in 
    the former regulations to computer programs or changes to the 
    electronic database gave rise to difficulties in actual cases. In the 
    absence of such difficulties, we see no need to revise this regulation.
        One commenter supported Sec. 351.104(a)(2)(ii), which deals with 
    the inclusion in the official record of documents returned to the 
    submitter. The commenter requested that this provision remain 
    unchanged. The Department has not revised this provision.
    
    Section 351.105
    
        Section 351.105 defines the four categories of information 
    applicable to AD/CVD proceedings: public, business proprietary, 
    privileged, and classified. After a review of proposed Sec. 351.105 and 
    the comments submitted pertaining to that section, we have left 
    Sec. 351.105 unchanged, but for some stylistic changes involving the 
    substitution of ``that'' for ``which.''
        One commenter suggested that the proposed definition of ``public 
    information'' in Sec. 351.105(b) is too narrow, because it excludes 
    business information claimed by the submitter to be business 
    proprietary unless the submitter has published the information or 
    otherwise made it public. According to this commenter, the definition 
    should include all non-classified information that a party learns 
    through any lawful means outside the context of disclosure under an 
    administrative protective order (``APO''). The commenter cited, for 
    example, information acquired through market research that may not have 
    been published or made generally available to the public at large. In 
    addition, this commenter proposed that the definition of ``business 
    proprietary information'' contained in Sec. 351.105(c) expressly 
    exclude all ``public information'' as the commenter would define 
    ``public information.''
        For the following reasons, the Department has not adopted this 
    suggestion. The Department places a high priority on the safeguarding 
    of business proprietary information. The definition of ``public 
    information'' in Sec. 351.105(b) is identical to the definition of that 
    term in former 19 CFR Secs. 353.4(a) and 355.4(a). Absent some evidence 
    that the definition interferes with a party's ability to defend its 
    interests in an AD/CVD proceeding, we are reluctant to transform what 
    heretofore has been considered as business proprietary information into 
    public information. However, the commenter did not offer any evidence 
    that the Department's longstanding definition of ``public information'' 
    has had this effect. Instead, the commenter merely asserted that it is 
    not the Department's role ``to regulate lawfully acquired commercial 
    information.''
        The same commenter suggested that the Department should amend 
    Sec. 351.105(b) so as to add the following additional category of 
    information normally considered as public: ``descriptions of reporting 
    methodologies, such as allocation methods.'' We have not adopted this 
    suggestion, because here, too, there is no indication that the absence 
    of a reference in Sec. 351.105(b) to this type of information has 
    interfered with a party's ability to defend its interests in an AD/CVD 
    proceeding.
        We should note, however, that the former regulations did not, and 
    these regulations will not, preclude a party from arguing in a given 
    case that business proprietary treatment should not be accorded to 
    particular information. In this regard, Sec. 351.104(b)(3) continues to 
    treat as ``public information'' information ``that the Secretary 
    determines is not properly designated as business proprietary.'' 
    However, we should emphasize here that where a party seeks to challenge 
    the business proprietary status of certain information, it should take 
    care to ensure that in submitting its challenge to the Secretary, it 
    does not inadvertently disclose the information in dispute.
        Finally, we received two comments that essentially suggested that 
    the Department delete proposed Sec. 351.105(c)(10), which provides for 
    business proprietary treatment of the position of a domestic producer 
    or workers regarding a petition. According to one commenter, 
    Sec. 351.105(c)(10) would effectively preclude industrial users and 
    consumers from commenting on the issue of industry support for a 
    petition, because users and consumers would not be eligible to obtain 
    this information under APO. In addition, both commenters were skeptical 
    regarding the ability of the Department to grant APO access to this 
    information in a timely manner so that ``interested parties'' will be 
    able to comment on the issue of industry support within the 20-day 
    statutory deadline. A third commenter, however, opposed deleting 
    paragraph (c)(10), although it agreed that the Department should 
    expedite the APO process.
        We have not adopted this suggestion for several reasons. As we 
    stated in the AD Proposed Regulations, 61 FR at 7314, several 
    commenters indicated that, due to concerns regarding commercial 
    retaliation, business proprietary treatment may be necessary in order 
    to encourage domestic producers and workers to present their candid 
    views regarding a petition. The instant commenters did not challenge 
    the validity of these concerns. As for APO disclosure, the Department 
    is aware of the need for expedited disclosure with respect to 
    information concerning industry support, and is confident that it will 
    be able to process APO requests in a timely manner that allows 
    interested parties to exercise their right to comment on the existence 
    of industry support for a petition.
    
    Section 351.106
    
        Section 351.106 deals with the de minimis standard, and implements 
    section 703(b)(4) and section 733(b)(3) of the Act. After reviewing 
    proposed Sec. 351.106 and the comments pertaining to that section, we 
    have left Sec. 351.106 unchanged.
        One commenter objected to the fact that the de minimis standard for 
    reviews remained at 0.5 percent, and suggested that this was 
    inconsistent with the spirit, if not the letter, of the AD Agreement. 
    We have left the de minimis standard for reviews at 0.5 percent, 
    because, as stated in the AD Proposed Regulations, 61 FR at 7312, this 
    result is required by the statute and is consistent with both the AD 
    Agreement and the SCM Agreement.
        As discussed above in connection with Sec. 351.102(b), one 
    commenter suggested a definition of ``country-wide subsidy rate'' that 
    would have provided for the application of country-wide subsidy rates 
    on a state-or province-specific basis. This same commenter, assuming 
    the adoption of its prior suggestion, proposed that we add a paragraph 
    to Sec. 351.106 that would have applied the de minimis standard to 
    country-wide rates on a state-or province-specific basis. The same 
    commenter that opposed the prior suggestion also opposed the instant 
    suggestion concerning the de minimis standard. Because we have not 
    adopted the prior suggestion, we are not adopting the corresponding 
    suggestion regarding the de minimis standard; i.e.,
    
    [[Page 27302]]
    
    we will not apply the de minimis standard on a subnational level.
        We have left unchanged proposed Sec. 351.106(c)(2), which applies 
    the de minimis standard to the assessment of antidumping duties. 
    Applying the de minimis standard to assessments on an importer-specific 
    basis resolves the inconsistency between the treatment of cash deposits 
    and assessments. If a de minimis amount of estimated duties is not 
    worth collecting, then there is no reason to believe that a de minimis 
    level of definitively determined duties is worth assessing and 
    collecting either. Paragraph (c)(2) also avoids an inconsistency 
    between the administration of the AD and CVD laws, something that the 
    Department has expressed as one of its goals.
        One commenter contended that the Department should not apply the de 
    minimis standard to the assessment of antidumping duties, because such 
    a policy does not result in any reduction in the Department's 
    administrative burden, is contrary to the SAA, and is not allowed by 
    the statute. This commenter cited the statutory requirement that 
    antidumping duties be imposed ``in an amount equal to the amount by 
    which the normal value exceeds the export price (or the constructed 
    export price) for the merchandise'' for the proposition that the 
    Department never may decline to assess antidumping duties, regardless 
    of how small such duties may be. With regard to the SAA, this commenter 
    contended that the SAA expressly limits the application of the de 
    minimis standard to the collection of deposits only by stating: 
    ``Commerce will continue its present practice in reviews of waiving the 
    collection of estimated cash deposits if the deposit rate is below 0.5 
    percent ad valorem, the existing regulatory standard for de minimis.''
        As noted above, the Department will apply the de minimis standard 
    to the assessment of antidumping duties on an importer-specific basis. 
    Regarding the commenter's statutory arguments, we believe that the 
    statute is silent on the issue. Although the statutory provisions cited 
    provide that the Department must assess duties, as the courts have 
    recognized, these provisions do not specify any particular assessment 
    methodology. See, e.g., FAG Kugelfischer Georg Schafer KGaA v. United 
    States, Slip Op. 95-158, 1995 Ct. Int'l. Trade LEXIS 209 (1996), aff'd, 
    No. 96-1074 (Fed. Cir. May 20, 1996). Significantly, the statutory 
    provisions cited by the commenter do not address how the Department 
    should apply the de minimis standards in reviews. Instead, the only 
    mention of such standards applying in reviews is contained in the SAA. 
    However, the SAA statement cited by the commenter (that the Department 
    will continue its practice of waiving cash deposits below 0.5 percent 
    in reviews) does not address the assessment issue at all. Read in 
    context, the statement refers to the fact that the de minimis standard 
    in reviews will continue to be 0.5 percent, as opposed to the new 2 
    percent standard for AD investigations. This statement does not address 
    the issue of whether the application of the 0.5 percent standard is 
    limited to the collection of cash deposits of estimated duties. As the 
    Department noted in the AD Proposed Regulations, 61 FR at 7312, the 
    only statement addressing that issue in the SAA is the general 
    statement that ``de minimis margins are regarded as zero margins.'' The 
    commenter offers no policy arguments for adopting an approach that 
    would limit the application of the de minimis standard to the deposit 
    of estimated duties.
        Another commenter agreed with the Department's proposal to apply 
    the de minimis standard to the assessment of antidumping duties. In 
    addition, this commenter proposed that the Department clarify that 
    where an importer purchases from more than one exporter, the importer 
    will receive producer-specific assessment rates, and that no duties 
    will be assessed for individual de minimis rates.
        In general, we agree with this comment, although we do not believe 
    that revisions to the regulations are necessary. As discussed below, 
    under Sec. 351.212(b)(1), the Department, as it has in many previous 
    cases, will calculate importer-specific assessment rates for each 
    producer or exporter reviewed. Thus, if one importer purchases from 
    several producers or exporters, the Department will assign that 
    importer an assessment rate for each producer or exporter. The 
    Department will apply the de minimis standard to these individual 
    assessment rates.
        Proposed paragraph (c)(2) provided that the Secretary will instruct 
    the Customs Service to liquidate without regard to antidumping duties 
    all entries of subject merchandise for which the Secretary calculates 
    an assessment rate that is de minimis (i.e., less than 0.5 percent ad 
    valorem. Two commenters noted that the proposed regulations did not 
    indicate which entries will be subject to paragraph (c)(2) if it is 
    issued in final form. According to the commenters, paragraph (c)(2) 
    should apply to all entries that are unliquidated as of the date of 
    issuance of the final regulations.
        The Department recognizes the need for guidance on this issue, but 
    has not adopted the solution proposed. Instead, the Department will 
    apply paragraph (c)(2) to all liquidations done pursuant to final 
    results in reviews that the Department initiates after the effective 
    date of these regulations. This approach is consistent with the 
    applicability date set forth in Sec. 351.701. In addition, this 
    approach is necessary in order to avoid the extreme administrative 
    burden the Department would face if it applied paragraph (c)(2) 
    retroactively, in which case the Department would have to amend the 
    numerous liquidation instructions that it has sent to the Customs 
    Service over the years. Normally, the Customs Service liquidates 
    entries soon after the Department issues liquidation instructions. 
    However, the Department has no way to determine whether the Customs 
    Service has liquidated all entries subject to liquidation instructions, 
    because liquidation may have been delayed for reasons unrelated to the 
    existence of an AD order. Therefore, to implement the commenters' 
    proposal, the Department would have to amend all of its previously 
    issued liquidation instructions.
        One commenter expressed concern that the Department will apply 
    paragraph (c)(2) based upon de minimis weighted-average dumping 
    margins. With respect to this comment, we note that Department usually 
    uses the term ``weighted-average dumping margin'' to refer to an 
    exporter-or producer-specific margin that the Department uses for cash 
    deposit purposes. As discussed above, the Department normally will 
    apply paragraph (c)(2) on the basis of importer-specific assessment 
    rates. However, although the Department has been calculating importer-
    specific assessment rates for some time, there are some cases that are 
    held up in litigation. In these cases, we may not be able to calculate 
    importer-specific assessment rates, because the record does not contain 
    the necessary information. In such situations, where the Department 
    issues assessment instructions at the conclusion of the litigation, we 
    will apply the de minimis rule on the basis of the weighted-average 
    dumping margin calculated for the exporter or producer.
    
    Section 351.107
    
        We have added a new Sec. 351.107 that deals with (1) the 
    establishment of deposit rates in situations involving a nonproducing 
    exporter, (2) the selection of the appropriate deposit rate where entry 
    documents do not identify the
    
    [[Page 27303]]
    
    producer of subject merchandise, and (3) the calculation of rates in AD 
    proceedings involving nonmarket economy countries.
        Nonproducing exporters: In the AD Proposed Regulations, 61 FR at 
    7311, the Department requested additional public comment on the issue 
    of whether to promulgate special rules regarding the rates applicable 
    to exporters that are not also producers, such as trading companies. We 
    noted that one alternative would be to calculate a separate rate for 
    each exporter/producer combination.
        One commenter suggested that the Department should apply this 
    approach in all instances. Other commenters argued that the Department 
    should not codify an across-the-board rule, but instead should 
    establish rates for exporter/producer combinations on a case-by-case 
    basis. Another commented that it would be inappropriate to determine 
    rates solely on the basis of exporter/producer combinations, and that 
    normally the Department should base deposits of estimated duties on the 
    rate calculated for the producer.
        The Department agrees with the comments suggesting that it is 
    appropriate in some instances to establish rates for exporter/producer 
    combinations. Therefore, in paragraph (b)(1)(i), we have provided for 
    the establishment of such ``combination rates.''
        We believe that combination rates are appropriate, because, in an 
    AD proceeding, the Department usually investigates or reviews sales by 
    a nonproducing exporter only if that exporter's supplier sold the 
    subject merchandise to the exporter without knowledge that the 
    merchandise would be exported to the United States. While we agree with 
    one commenter that in these instances the producer's pricing is not at 
    issue, we are concerned about the proper application of any deposit 
    rate determined on the basis of the exporter's pricing. Establishing a 
    deposit rate for an exporter and, without regard to the identity of the 
    supplier, applying that rate to all future exports by that exporter 
    could lead to the application of that rate even if other suppliers sold 
    to the exporter with knowledge of exportation to the United States. 
    This would enable a producer with a relatively high deposit rate to 
    avoid the application of its own rate by selling to the United States 
    through an exporter with a low rate. Therefore, in order to ensure the 
    proper application of deposit rates, the Department believes that it 
    should establish, where appropriate, individual rates for nonproducing 
    exporters in combination with the particular supplier or suppliers from 
    whom the exporter purchased the subject merchandise.
        On the other hand, the Department believes that there are 
    situations where it may be inappropriate and/or impractical to 
    establish combination rates. For example, it may not be necessary to 
    establish combination rates when investigating or reviewing 
    nonproducing exporters that are not trading companies, such as original 
    equipment manufacturers. In addition, it may not be practicable to 
    establish combination rates when there are a large number of producers, 
    such as in certain agricultural cases. The Department will make such 
    exceptions to combination rates on a case-by-case basis.
        Another instance in which the Department assigns rates to exporters 
    is in AD investigations and reviews of imports from nonmarket economies 
    (NMEs). In those cases, if sales to the United States are made through 
    an NME trading company, we assign a noncombination rate to the trading 
    company regardless of whether the NME producer supplying the trading 
    company has knowledge of the destination of the merchandise. One 
    exception to this NME practice occurs where we find no dumping and 
    exclude an exporter from an AD order. Where exclusions are involved, we 
    publish a combination rate to address the same concerns described above 
    regarding redirection of exports through an excluded trading company. 
    Nothing in Sec. 351.107(b)(1) is intended to change our policy for 
    assigning rates in NME proceedings.
        The Department also believes it is not appropriate to establish 
    combination rates in an AD investigation or review of a producer; i.e., 
    where a producer sells to an exporter with knowledge of exportation to 
    the United States. In these situations, the establishment of separate 
    rates for a producer in combination with each of the exporters through 
    which it sells to the United States could lead to manipulation by the 
    producer. Furthermore, the Department recognizes that in many 
    industries it is not uncommon for a producer to sell some amount of 
    merchandise purchased from other producers. In such situations, the 
    Department generally intends to establish a single rate for such a 
    respondent based on its status as a producer, although unusual 
    circumstances may warrant the application of a combination rate.
        The Department also generally agrees with the comment that, in AD 
    cases, if an exporter changes its supplier, the supplier's rate should 
    be applied for deposit purposes rather than the ``all-others'' rate. 
    Therefore, paragraph (b)(2) provides that for purposes of deposits, the 
    Department will apply the producer's rate to entries if the Department 
    has not established previously a deposit rate for the particular 
    exporter/producer combination or the exporter alone. If the Department 
    has not calculated an individual rate for the producer, the Department 
    will apply the ``all-others'' rate. Again, nothing in this section is 
    intended to change our practice regarding the rates assigned to NME 
    exporters. In particular, an ``all-others'' rate may not be calculated 
    in an NME proceeding or, if it is, it may not apply to the new shippers 
    covered in this section.
        In the case of CVD proceedings, subject merchandise may be 
    subsidized by means of subsidies provided to both the producer and the 
    exporter. In the Department's view, all subsidies conferred on the 
    production of subject merchandise benefit that merchandise, even if it 
    is exported to the United States by a reseller rather than the producer 
    itself. Therefore, the Department calculates countervailable subsidy 
    rates on the basis of any subsidies provided to the producer, as well 
    as those provided to the exporter in any investigation or review 
    involving exports by a nonproducing exporter. As a result, rates 
    established for particular combinations of exporters and producers are 
    the most accurate rates. Moreover, as in an AD proceeding, combination 
    rates help to ensure the proper application of combination rates when 
    other producers sell through the same exporter.
        As in AD proceedings, in CVD proceedings there may be situations in 
    which it is not appropriate or practicable to establish combination 
    rates. In such situations, the Department will make exceptions to its 
    combination rate approach on a case-by-case basis. In addition, for a 
    new combination of exporter and producer, the Department believes that 
    it should apply the supplier's rate, rather than the ``all-others'' 
    rate, for deposit purposes. Therefore, under paragraph (b)(2), in a CVD 
    proceeding the Department intends to apply the producer's rate to 
    entries for deposit purposes if the Department has not established a 
    rate for the particular exporter/producer combination or the exporter 
    alone. If the producer's rate is applicable, but the Department has not 
    established a rate for that producer, the Department will apply the 
    ``all-others'' rate.
        In this regard, however, in a CVD proceeding, the Department 
    intends to establish a deposit rate for each
    
    [[Page 27304]]
    
    producer that it investigates or reviews, even if during the period of 
    investigation or review the producer happened to be selling to the 
    United States through a reseller. The purpose of this approach is to 
    ensure that if the producer subsequently begins to export to the United 
    States directly, the Department will be able to apply a deposit rate 
    based on the producer's own level of subsidization, as opposed to the 
    ``all-others'' rate.
        The proper application of rates to entries for deposit purposes 
    generally requires that the producer of the merchandise be identified. 
    Accordingly, under paragraph (c), if an entry does not identify the 
    producer (or the exporter's supplier if the exporter is not the 
    producer), the Department will instruct the Customs Service to use the 
    higher of: (1) the highest of any combination rate involving that 
    exporter, (2) the highest rate for any producer other than a producer 
    for which the Secretary has established a combination rate involving 
    the exporter in question, or (3) the ``all-others'' rate. The objective 
    of paragraph (c) is to prevent an exporter from obtaining a lower 
    deposit rate by means of withholding the identity of its supplier from 
    the Customs Service.
        As an example of how paragraph (c) would operate, assume that in an 
    AD proceeding the existing rates are: Exporter A/Producer 1--5 percent; 
    Exporter B/Producer 2--20 percent; Producer 1--18 percent; Producer 2--
    15 percent; and All Others--10 percent. If an entry did not identify 
    the producer of subject merchandise exported by Exporter A, the 
    Department would instruct the Customs Service to apply Producer 2's 
    deposit rate of 15 percent. 15 percent would be the appropriate rate if 
    Producer 2 were the supplier, and it also is the highest of the 
    possible rates applicable had the producer been identified (those rates 
    being 5, 10, and 15 percent in this example). Producer 1's rate of 18 
    percent would not be appropriate, because the Department already would 
    have established that, when Producer 1 exports through Exporter A, the 
    appropriate rate is 5 percent.
        Nonmarket economy cases: The second sentence of the definition of 
    ``rates'' in proposed Sec. 351.102(b) provided the Department with the 
    authority to apply a single AD margin to all producers and exporters 
    from a nonmarket economy (``NME'') country. We have moved that sentence 
    to paragraph (d) of Sec. 351.107.
        As explained in the AD Proposed Regulations, 61 FR at 7311, the 
    Department elected not to codify its current presumption that a single 
    rate will be applied in NME cases. We received several comments on this 
    issue.
        Four commenters suggested that the Department codify its current 
    presumption of a single rate. Three of these commenters viewed the 
    presumption as correct, because the fact that a country is an NME 
    carries with it an assumption that the government controls all 
    exporters. Moreover, these commenters asserted that NME governments, 
    due to their control, can funnel sales of the subject merchandise 
    through, or transfer production of the subject merchandise to, the 
    entity that receives the most favorable dumping margin. These 
    commenters further urged the Department to extend the presumption of 
    control beyond the central NME government to provincial and municipal 
    governments, as well. One commenter that urged the Department to codify 
    the presumption of a single rate also argued that the presumption is 
    consistent with the statute, because all NME companies are under common 
    ownership and, hence, comprise a single exporter. Consequently, in this 
    commenter's view, the Department should calculate a single dumping 
    margin just as it would calculate a single dumping margin in situations 
    where the Department ``collapses'' market economy producers under 
    common ownership. This same commenter urged the Department to make 
    clear that the NME-wide rate calculated as a consequence of the 
    presumption is different from the ``all-others'' rate described in 
    section 735(c)(1)(B)(i)(II) of the Act.
        One commenter opposed the presumption. In discussing the People's 
    Republic of China (``PRC''), this commenter pointed to the reforms that 
    have been instituted in the PRC economy, claiming that the underlying 
    premise of the presumption--that the central government controls 
    exporters--is erroneous. According to the commenter, the Department's 
    experience in administering the presumption confirms this conclusion, 
    because in virtually every case since the Department instituted the 
    presumption, individual PRC producers have been able to demonstrate 
    that they are entitled to their own rates. Consequently, this commenter 
    argued, the Department should abandon the presumption of a single NME-
    wide rate, and non-investigated exporters in an NME should receive an 
    all-others rate. Another commenter asked that even if the Department 
    does not codify the presumption, the Department should clarify that it 
    will continue to calculate separate rates in appropriate cases.
        Several commenters went on to make specific suggestions for 
    amending the so-called ``separate rates test''; i.e., the conditions 
    that must be met for rebutting the presumption. One commenter urged the 
    Department to incorporate into the separate rates test the affiliated 
    party criteria from section 771(33) of the Act and Secs. 351.102(b) and 
    351.401(f) of the regulations. In this commenter's view, the affiliated 
    party criteria provide appropriate guidance on when parties under 
    common ownership should be subject to a single AD rate. A second 
    commenter recommended amending the test to include an assessment of 
    possible central government influence in the future. Also, in this 
    commenter's view, the NME exporter seeking a separate rate should be 
    required to present affirmative evidence that the government is not 
    involved in the exporter's pricing decision. In other words, this 
    commenter claimed, an absence of evidence of control should not be 
    sufficient to rebut the presumption. Finally, this commenter suggested 
    that, because of the potential for circumvention, the Department should 
    calculate individual rates only for manufacturers, and not for export 
    trading companies.
        Another commenter pointed to the unfairness of having to prove the 
    negative; i.e., the absence of control. This commenter also suggested 
    that the Department should focus on events during the period of 
    investigation and not speculate about events that might occur in the 
    future. Two commenters urged the Department to provide an opportunity 
    for firms to receive separate rates in those situations where the 
    Department chooses not to investigate all exporters. In their view, 
    instead of using the punitive NME-wide rate, the Department should 
    assign these non-investigated exporters an average dumping margin 
    calculated on the basis of investigated firms receiving separate rates.
        As in the proposed regulations, we have refrained from codifying 
    the presumption of a single rate in NME AD cases. Nor have we adopted a 
    modified version of the presumption. We appreciate the many thoughtful 
    comments that we received on this topic. However, because of the 
    changing conditions in those NME countries most frequently subject to 
    AD proceedings, we do not believe it is appropriate to promulgate the 
    presumption or the separate rates test in these regulations. Instead, 
    we intend to continue developing our policy in this area, and the 
    comments that were submitted will help us in that process. We would 
    like
    
    [[Page 27305]]
    
    to clarify, however, that we do intend to grant separate rates in 
    appropriate circumstances, and that our decision not to codify the 
    presumption or the separate rates test should not be seen, as one 
    commenter suggested, as a decision not to grant separate rates. Also, 
    as discussed above in connection with Sec. 351.107(b)(1), we intend to 
    continue calculating AD rates for NME export trading companies, and not 
    the manufacturers supplying the trading companies.
    
    Subpart B--Antidumping Duty and Countervailing Duty Procedures
    
        Subpart B deals with AD/CVD procedures, and is based on subpart B 
    of part 353 and part 355 of the Department's former regulations.
    
    Section 351.202
    
        Section 351.202 deals with the contents of, and filing requirements 
    for, AD/CVD petitions. We received several comments regarding proposed 
    Sec. 351.202.
        Contents of petitions: Proposed Sec. 351.202(b), consistent with 
    the statute, provided that a petition must contain specified 
    information ``to the extent reasonably available to the petitioner.'' 
    One commenter suggested that the Department revise Sec. 351.202(b) so 
    as to make clear that the ``reasonably available'' standard is 
    flexible, and that, in particular, the Department expressly acknowledge 
    in the regulation that cost is a relevant consideration in determining 
    what is ``reasonably available.''
        We have not adopted this suggestion. While we do not disagree with 
    the proposition that the ``reasonably available'' standard is flexible, 
    we believe that the word ``reasonably'' makes this flexibility 
    manifest. In addition, while we also do not disagree with the notion 
    that cost to a petitioner is a factor in determining what is reasonably 
    available, it is only one of many possible factors. To identify in the 
    regulation one factor to the exclusion of others might result in undue 
    emphasis being placed on the factor of cost. The ``reasonably 
    available'' standard has been in the statute for many years, and we 
    believe that it provides sufficient guidance to petitioners as to the 
    efforts they must undertake in providing information to the Department.
        The same commenter objected to the requirement in proposed 
    Sec. 351.202(b)(3) that a petitioner provide production data for each 
    domestic producer identified by the petitioner. This commenter argued 
    that Article 5.2 of the AD Agreement and Article 11.2 of the SCM 
    Agreement merely require that a petitioner provide aggregate production 
    data for all known domestic producers. A second commenter supported 
    proposed Sec. 351.202(b)(3) as drafted, arguing that the SAA at 861 
    clearly requires producer-specific production data.
        We do not agree with the first commenter's interpretation of 
    articles 5.2 and 11.2. However, even if that interpretation were 
    correct, it is the U.S. statute that controls. The SAA clearly requires 
    that a petitioner provide producer-specific production data, subject, 
    of course, to the proviso that such information is reasonably available 
    to the petitioner. This information is necessary in order to enable the 
    Department to determine whether an adequate portion of domestic 
    producers support a petition, an inquiry which is based on production 
    volumes of domestic producers. Therefore, we have left 
    Sec. 351.202(b)(3) unchanged.
        Two commenters suggested that the Department coordinate with the 
    Commission with respect to regulations dealing with the contents of 
    petitions, and that the Department incorporate into Sec. 351.202(b) the 
    specific requirements contained in the Commission's corresponding 
    regulation. In addition, these commenters suggested that, in light of 
    the Commission's proposed Sec. 207.11(b)(2)(iv), the Department should 
    revise its own proposed Sec. 351.202(b)(8) so as to require volume and 
    value information regarding the subject merchandise for the most recent 
    three-year period, as opposed to a two-year period.
        We have adopted these suggestions in part. The Commission completed 
    its rulemaking activity and issued final rules on July 22, 1996. See 61 
    FR 3818. These final rules contain a revised 19 CFR Sec. 207.11 that 
    deals with the contents of AD/CVD petitions. We have incorporated 
    elements of the Commission's regulations into Sec. 351.202(b) where the 
    information identified in Sec. 207.11 is of the same general type as 
    that sought by the Department. With respect to the identity of 
    importers, we have revised proposed Sec. 351.202(b)(9) so as to require 
    telephone numbers for each importer identified, to the extent such 
    information is reasonably available to the petitioner. On the other 
    hand, we have not incorporated elements of Sec. 207.11 where the 
    information identified in that regulation is not of the same general 
    type as that sought by the Department. For example, we have not 
    included the requirement of Sec. 207.11(b)(2)(iv) that a petitioner 
    identify each product for which the petitioner requests the Commission 
    to seek pricing information in its questionnaires. Finally, we have 
    added a sentence to paragraph (a) that advises petitioners to refer to 
    the Commission's regulations concerning petition contents.
        With respect to the suggestion that we require three, rather than 
    two, years of volume and value information, as required by proposed 
    Sec. 207.11(b)(2)(iv), we note that the Commission deleted this 
    provision in its final rule. Therefore, we are not adopting this 
    suggestion for purposes of Sec. 351.202(b).
        Amendments to petitions: One commenter objected to the substitution 
    of ``may'' for ``will'' in proposed Sec. 351.202(e) (``The Secretary 
    may allow timely amendment of the petition''). The commenter argued 
    that the substitution is improper, because it confers on the Department 
    more discretion than is allowed by section 732(b)(1) of the Act. We 
    have retained the language of the proposed rule. In our view, the 
    statute, by permitting the Secretary to establish on a case-by-case 
    basis the timing and conditions for any amendments to a petition, 
    confers considerable discretion. We continue to believe that the word 
    ``may'' more accurately reflects this discretionary authority than does 
    the word ``will.''
        Pre-initiation communications: Commenting on proposed 
    Sec. 351.202(i), one commenter suggested that because the statutory 
    limitation on pre-initiation communications is limited to comments that 
    are unsolicited by the Department, the Department should revise 
    Sec. 351.202(i) so as to clarify that the Department retains the 
    discretion to ``solicit'' comments on its own initiative. According to 
    this commenter, the Department's interpretation of the SAA in the AD 
    Proposed Regulations is incorrect. See 61 FR at 7313. The commenter 
    argued that while the SAA limits the pre-initiation right of parties to 
    comment to the issue of industry support, Congress deliberately used 
    the word ``unsolicited'' in sections 702(b)(4)(B) and 732(b)(3)(B) of 
    the Act in order to provide the Department with the discretion to 
    solicit comments on any issue where necessary. Two other commenters 
    submitted similar comments.
        Three commenters, however, opposed the suggestion described in the 
    preceding paragraph. In addition, these commenters proposed that the 
    Department revise the proposed regulations so as to expressly state 
    that the Department will not solicit information from sources other 
    than domestic interested parties.
        We have not adopted either of these competing suggestions. As noted 
    above,
    
    [[Page 27306]]
    
    in drafting these regulations, the Department has sought to avoid 
    repeating the statute to the extent possible. Consistent with this 
    objective, in proposed Sec. 351.202(i), the Department sought to do no 
    more than clarify that the filing of a notice of appearance would not 
    constitute a ``communication'' within the meaning of the statute. The 
    Department referred in paragraph (i) to sections 702(b)(4)(B) and 
    732(b)(3)(B) merely to provide a context for this clarification. As for 
    the Department's discussion of the SAA mentioned by the first 
    commenter, this discussion was in response to suggestions that the 
    Department should solicit comments regarding a petition, an activity 
    clearly not contemplated by the statute or the SAA.
        Each group of commenters is asking the Department to place a 
    different gloss on the statute. At this time, we do not believe that 
    either gloss is necessary or appropriate. However, in view of the fact 
    that both groups of commenters apparently misinterpreted the 
    Department's intent in drafting proposed Sec. 351.202(i), we have 
    revised that paragraph to clarify that it deals only with the treatment 
    of notices of appearance.
        We should note that the Department has no intention of soliciting 
    comments concerning the adequacy and accuracy of a petition. In this 
    regard, the Department intends to follow the general rule articulated 
    by the Federal Circuit in United States v. Roses, Inc., 706 F.2d 1563 
    (1983), that, in order to determine whether a petition is adequate 
    under the law, the Department should look only within the four corners 
    of the petition. This general principle is now incorporated in sections 
    702(b)(4)(B) and 732(b)(3)(B) of the Act.
        The three exceptions to this rule are those specified in the Act 
    and the SAA: for comments concerning industry support for the petition; 
    for inquiries concerning the status of the Department's consideration 
    of the petition; and for government-to-government consultations in CVD 
    investigations. With respect to industry support, the statutory 
    exception is necessary in part because the issue of industry support 
    cannot be revisited after initiation. The SAA at 194 makes clear that 
    the Department is to construe this exception narrowly. The Department 
    may accept and answer inquiries concerning the status of the 
    Department's consideration of a petition, because such inquiries do not 
    constitute comments on the accuracy and adequacy of the petition 
    itself. In the case of CVD investigations, section 702(b)(4)(B) 
    expressly directs the Department to provide the government of the 
    exporting country with an opportunity for consultations on the 
    petition. This requirement implements Section 13.1 of the SCM 
    Agreement. The Department will determine what weight to give to any 
    information received during the course of such consultations on a case-
    by-case basis.
        Other comments: One commenter argued that it was improper for a 
    Department official to counsel a petitioner in preparing a petition and 
    then, after the petition is formally filed, participate in an analysis 
    of the adequacy of the petition. According to this commenter, such 
    activity gives rise to an appearance of impropriety and violates the 
    Department's own rules on ethical conduct. The commenter proposed a 
    revision to Sec. 351.202 which would have (1) required the Department 
    to disclose publicly the names of all Department personnel who assisted 
    in the preparation of a petition; and (2) precluded any such official 
    from participating in the relevant AD/CVD proceeding once the petition 
    was filed.
        We have not adopted this comment, and we disagree strongly with its 
    underlying premise. We do not believe that Department personnel lose 
    their objectivity or impartiality regarding the merits of a petition 
    when they have provided advice to a petitioner in the preparation of a 
    petition. In addition, we do not believe that there is an appearance of 
    impropriety or a violation of the Department's rules of ethical conduct 
    when such personnel participate in an AD/CVD proceeding triggered by 
    the filing of a petition with respect to which they may have offered 
    pre-filing advice.
        The same commenter also suggested that the Department revise 
    proposed Sec. 351.202(i)(2), which provides that, in the case of a CVD 
    petition, the Department will invite the government of the exporting 
    country involved for consultations under Article 13.1 of the SCM 
    Agreement. Consistent with other comments made by this commenter based 
    on its analysis of the statutory term ``country,'' the commenter 
    suggested that the Department modify paragraph (i)(2) to provide that 
    the Department also will invite for consultations the government of any 
    political subdivision of a named country.
        We have not adopted this suggestion. Although there certainly are 
    situations in which the statute treats political subdivisions as 
    ``countries,'' this is not one of those situations. Section 
    702(b)(4)(A)(ii) of the Act refers to consultations with a ``Subsidies 
    Agreement country.'' In our view, a state or provincial government does 
    not meet the definition of ``Subsidies Agreement country'' in section 
    702(b) of the Act.
        Moreover, under Article 13.1, the obligation of the United States 
    is to consult with ``Members'' of the WTO, a term that excludes 
    subnational governments, such as states and provinces. While the 
    central government of a WTO Member may choose to be accompanied at 
    consultations by representatives of subnational levels of government, 
    the Department will not embroil itself in the internal politics of 
    another country by inviting such representatives to participate in 
    Article 13.1 consultations.
        Finally, one commenter proposed that the following sentence be 
    added to proposed Sec. 351.202(c): ``Other filing requirements are set 
    forth in Sec. 351.303.'' The purpose of this addition would be to put 
    petitioners on notice as to the existence and location of distinct 
    filing requirements. The Department agrees with this suggestion, and we 
    have revised paragraph (c) accordingly.
        Other changes: In light of the recent reorganization of Import 
    Administration, we have revised Sec. 351.202(h)(2) to provide that 
    persons seeking information concerning petitions should contact Import 
    Administration's Director for Policy and Analysis.
    
    Section 351.203
    
        Section 351.203 deals with determinations regarding the sufficiency 
    of an AD or CVD petition, and implements sections 702(c) and 732(c) of 
    the Act. We received several comments regarding Sec. 351.203.
        Adequacy of allegations: Three commenters made suggestions relating 
    to proposed Sec. 351.203(b)(1), which provides that ``the Secretary, on 
    the basis of sources readily available to the Secretary, will examine 
    the accuracy and adequacy of the evidence provided in the petition and 
    determine whether to initiate an investigation.'' While these 
    commenters agreed that proposed Sec. 351.203(b)(1) was consistent with 
    the statute, they were concerned that the Department's commentary in 
    the AD Proposed Regulations and/or the Department's practice was not. 
    In the commentary, we described our prior practice in reviewing a 
    petition and stated that this practice was consistent with the type of 
    review contemplated by the new statute. In particular, we noted that it 
    was the Department's practice to seek additional information when a 
    particular allegation lacked sufficient support or appeared 
    aberrational, even though the allegation was supported by some 
    documentation. 61 FR at 7313.
    
    [[Page 27307]]
    
        One of the three commenters, however, stated that the practice 
    described amounted to the weighing of evidence, and that this practice 
    is inconsistent with the legislative history of the Trade Agreements 
    Act of 1979, a legislative history that the SAA endorsed. This 
    commenter proposed that the 1979 legislative history be incorporated 
    into Sec. 351.203(b)(1).
        The second of the three commenters also complained that the 
    Department's commentary suggested the weighing of evidence, and 
    disagreed that the Department's proposal was consistent with past 
    practice. Asserting that the statute and legislative history do not 
    envision an adversarial pre-initiation proceeding, this commenter 
    proposed that the Department clarify that (1) it will not allow 
    respondents to bring public information to the Department's attention 
    for purposes of assessing the sufficiency of a petition; and (2) that 
    the new regulations are not intended to increase the burden on 
    petitioners for initiating investigations.
        The third of the three commenters agreed with proposed 
    Sec. 351.203(b)(1) and the accompanying commentary, but alleged that 
    over time, the Department has been subjecting petitioners to 
    substantially increased demands for additional factual support. 
    Therefore, while not suggesting any changes to Sec. 351.203(b)(1) or 
    the commentary, this commenter suggested that the Department review its 
    practice to ensure that that practice is consistent with the regulation 
    and the commentary.
        We agree that the pre-initiation process should not become an 
    adversarial process between the petitioner and potential respondents. 
    On the other hand, however, the Department has a statutory obligation 
    to examine the accuracy and adequacy of the evidence provided in the 
    petition, an exercise which necessarily entails making some judgments 
    regarding the quantity and quality of the information contained in a 
    petition. Whether or not such an examination constitutes the ``weighing 
    of evidence'' is, in our view, largely a question of semantics. 
    However, we believe that the practice described in the commentary 
    accompanying proposed Sec. 351.203(b)(1) does not result in an 
    adversarial process and that this practice is consistent with the 
    legislative history of the 1979 Act. That legislative history states, 
    inter alia, that a petition must be ``reasonably supported by the facts 
    alleged.'' H.R. Rep. No. 317, 96th Cong., 1st Sess. 51 (1979) (emphasis 
    added). In our view, this means that the mere provision of any 
    documentation is not necessarily sufficient, and the Department, where 
    appropriate, should be able to seek additional information where 
    support for a particular allegation is weak or information appears 
    aberrational.
        Therefore, we have not changed proposed Sec. 351.203(b)(1) in light 
    of these comments. However, we wish to reiterate what we said in the 
    commentary accompanying proposed Sec. 351.203(b)(1); namely, that we do 
    ``not believe that the new statutory standard constitutes a significant 
    departure from past Department practice.'' 61 FR at 7313.
        Sources readily available: Commenting on proposed 
    Sec. 351.203(b)(1), one commenter suggested that the regulations make 
    clear that ``sources readily available'' to the Department include any 
    information that is relevant to its evaluation of a petition and that 
    is submitted by an interested person further to the Department's 
    request. We have not adopted this suggestion, because we prefer to 
    develop our interpretation of this new statutory term on a case-by-case 
    basis.
        The same commenter urged the Department to refrain from allowing a 
    petitioner to comment on any pre-initiation submissions that a 
    respondent interested party makes in response to a Department request. 
    Presumably, this commenter was referring to the following statement in 
    the preamble to the AD Proposed Regulations: ``The Department will give 
    the petitioner an opportunity to comment on any such information 
    acquired by the Department.'' 61 FR at 7313. We have not adopted this 
    suggestion either, because we continue to believe that it is 
    appropriate to provide a petitioner with an opportunity to comment on 
    information collected during the pre-initiation process.
        Also in connection with proposed Sec. 351.203(b)(1), another 
    commenter proposed that after the phrase ``sources readily available to 
    the Secretary,'' the Department should add the following clause: 
    ``including information provided to the Department by foreign 
    governments during the consultations required under 19 U.S.C. 
    Sec. 1671a(b)(4)(A)(ii). * * *'' This commenter was referring to the 
    pre-initiation consultations provided for in Article 13.1 of the SCM 
    Agreement and referred to in section 702(b)(4)(A)(ii) of the Act. 
    According to the commenter, the ``right to consult is meaningless if 
    the Department were not to consider information provided in the 
    consultations in making its decision whether to initiate an 
    investigation and, if so, on what programs.'' Another commenter, 
    however, opposed this suggestion, arguing that neither the statute nor 
    the Department's practice concerning CVD petitions allows the 
    Department to transform Article 13.1 consultations into pre-initiation 
    litigation.
        While we have not adopted the suggestion, we do not disagree with 
    the thrust of the first commenter's position. Under Article 13.1 of the 
    SCM Agreement, foreign governments have a right to consultations prior 
    to the initiation of an investigation. The purpose of these 
    consultations is to clarify the matters referred to in a petition. The 
    right to consultations is specifically provided for in 
    Sec. 702(b)(4)(A)(ii) of the Act. We note that under Sec. 702(b)(4)(B), 
    the Department is prohibited from accepting any unsolicited oral or 
    written communication from potential respondents, except as provided 
    for under the aforementioned provision of the Act requiring that 
    foreign governments be given an opportunity for consultations. 
    Therefore, we believe that the Department may consider relevant 
    information provided by a foreign government prior to the initiation of 
    an investigation. The use of such information and the weight given to 
    it, either prior to the initiation decision or during an investigation, 
    will be determined by the Department on a case-by-case basis.
        Industry support: Commenting on proposed Sec. 351.203(e)(1), one 
    commenter suggested that when measuring domestic production as an index 
    of industry support for a petition, the Department (1) never should 
    measure production over a period of less than twelve months; and (2) 
    should retain the flexibility to examine a period greater than twelve 
    months in appropriate circumstances. A second commenter endorsed 
    proposed Sec. 351.203(e)(1), arguing that the use of the word 
    ``normally'' in that provision provided the Department with the 
    necessary flexibility to use periods greater or lesser than twelve 
    months when appropriate.
        We have left Sec. 351.203(e)(1) unchanged. Because the statutory 
    standard for determining industry support is new, we are reluctant to 
    adopt a regulation that would preclude, in all cases, the use of a 
    period shorter than twelve months. As observed by the second commenter, 
    there may well be industries for which use of a shorter period is 
    appropriate. While we expect that in most cases the Department will use 
    a twelve-month period, use of the word ``normally'' provides us with 
    sufficient flexibility to use longer or shorter periods when 
    appropriate.
    
    [[Page 27308]]
    
        One commenter suggested that the Department revise proposed 
    Sec. 351.203(e)(3) to provide that: (1) the Department may base the 
    position of workers on a statistically valid sampling of the views of 
    individual workers; and (2) the views of workers and management be 
    recorded in writing and certified in accordance with Sec. 351.303(g). A 
    second commenter objected to these suggestions, arguing that (1) the 
    first commenter's notion of sampling effectively would rewrite the 
    statute; and (2) a separate certification requirement is unnecessary, 
    because Sec. 351.303(g) already requires certification of submissions 
    containing factual information.
        We have not adopted the first commenter's suggestions. With respect 
    to sampling of individual workers, this suggestion would require a 
    level of regulatory detail greater than what we consider to be 
    appropriate at this time. The statute does provide for the use of 
    statistically valid sampling methods to determine industry support, but 
    only when there are a large number of producers in the relevant 
    industry. In the AD Proposed Regulations, we deliberately refrained 
    from elaborating on what is, for the Department, a new and untried 
    method for determining industry support. For purposes of these final 
    regulations, we continue to believe that we should develop this method 
    on a case-by-case basis. With respect to the first commenter's 
    suggestion regarding filing requirements for industry positions, we 
    agree with the second commenter that the changes proposed are redundant 
    and unnecessary.
        Another commenter sought clarification with respect to proposed 
    Sec. 351.203(e)(3), a provision that states that the Secretary will 
    accord equal weight to the positions of management and workers 
    regarding a petition. The commenter stated that the 25 percent 
    threshold for determining industry support should not be subject to 
    Sec. 351.203(e)(3), apparently based on the commenter's belief that 
    this provision somehow undermines the 25 percent threshold. A second 
    commenter offered an interpretation of the first commenter's comment, 
    and suggested, based on its interpretation, that the commenter's 
    ``complaint should be dismissed.''
        The first commenter did not seek a change to the regulation, and we 
    do not believe that a change is necessary. However, the Department 
    wishes to confirm that in situations where the views of the management 
    and workers of a firm negate each other, the production of the firm in 
    question will be included as part of the total production of the 
    domestic like product for purposes of applying the 25 percent threshold 
    in sections 702(c)(4)(A)(i) and 732(c)(4)(A)(i) of the Act.
        The same commenter also sought clarification that all interested 
    parties would be given access to non-confidential information related 
    to the positions of domestic producers and workers. With respect to 
    this comment, the Department can confirm that public information (e.g., 
    non-business proprietary information) concerning the positions of 
    producers and workers will be included in the public record of an AD/
    CVD proceeding. Under Sec. 351.104(b), the public record will be 
    available to the public, including interested parties, for inspection 
    and copying in Import Administration's Central Records Unit.
        Another commenter made some suggestions regarding proposed 
    Sec. 351.203(e)(5), which deals with determinations of industry support 
    in cases where the petitioner alleges the existence of a regional 
    industry. This commenter proposed that in regional industry cases, the 
    Department should (1) determine the position of all members of the 
    national industry regarding the petition, initiate based upon support 
    within the alleged region, but terminate the investigation for lack of 
    interest if there is insufficient support from producers within the 
    region or nation, as determined by the Commission in its preliminary 
    determination; and (2) consult extensively with the Commission prior to 
    initiation regarding the adequacy of the regional industry allegation 
    and, if the Commission's advice is that the alleged region is 
    questionable, advise the petitioner to withdraw the petition and refile 
    it as a national case or with a more properly defined region. According 
    to the commenter, such an approach is necessary (1) to address the 
    ``anomaly'' in the statute that arises when the Commission rejects a 
    regional industry alleged in a petition; and (2) to ensure that 
    allegations of regional industry in a petition are not used to 
    circumvent the industry support requirements.
        A second commenter opposed these suggestions. First, this commenter 
    noted, the statute addresses this very situation, because the statute 
    expressly states that (1) the Department shall determine industry 
    support based on production in the region alleged in the petition, and 
    (2) the Department shall not reconsider a determination of industry 
    support once it is made. Second, there is no ``anomaly'' limited to 
    regional industry cases, because in any case, including a case in which 
    the petitioner alleges a national industry, the Commission may define 
    the relevant product in such a way that the scope of the relevant 
    industry analyzed for injury purposes differs from the scope of the 
    industry analyzed for purposes of determining industry support. Third, 
    there is no basis for the Department to revisit its industry support 
    determination based on the Commission's preliminary determination, 
    because in its final determination the Commission may change the 
    definition of the industry at issue yet again, or even revert back to 
    the definition originally alleged in the petition. Finally, the second 
    commenter suggested that the first commenter's concerns about 
    circumvention were overblown, stating that the first commenter did not 
    understand the difficulties involved in bringing a regional industry 
    case.
        In light of these comments, and because the SAA is clear on this 
    point, we have deleted paragraph (e)(5).
        Other comments: One commenter submitted a comment concerning 
    proposed Sec. 351.203(c)(2), which requires that, after initiation of 
    an investigation, the Secretary provide a public version of the 
    petition to all known exporters who sell for export to the United 
    States. Section 351.203(c)(2) makes an exception for situations where 
    the number of exporters is ``particularly large.'' The commenter 
    suggested that the Department should invoke the exception only in 
    situations where the number of exporters is ``exceptionally large.'' We 
    have not adopted this suggestion, because the phrase ``particularly 
    large'' tracks the language of the SAA and the relevant provisions of 
    the AD Agreement and the SCM Agreement.
        The same commenter also suggested that Sec. 351.203(c)(2) provide 
    that, upon request, any exporter, producer, or importer of subject 
    merchandise be provided, free of charge, with a public version of the 
    petition. We have not adopted this suggestion, because Sec. 351.104(b) 
    adequately deals with matters relating to access to the public record, 
    including the public version of a petition.
    
    Section 351.204
    
        Section 351.204 deals with issues relating to the time period and 
    persons to be examined in an investigation, voluntary respondents, and 
    exclusions. In the section title, we have substituted ``Time periods'' 
    for ``Transactions'' to reflect more accurately the contents of 
    Sec. 351.204.
        Period of investigation in AD investigations: In proposed
    
    [[Page 27309]]
    
    Sec. 351.204(b)(1), the Department revised the period of investigation 
    (``POI'') for antidumping investigations. In the past, the Department 
    normally used a six-month POI that ended with the month in which the 
    petition was filed. 19 CFR Sec. 353.42(b)(1) (1995). In 
    Sec. 351.204(b)(1), the Department expanded the POI from six months to 
    four fiscal quarters (twelve months), with the exception of nonmarket 
    economy cases. In addition, the Department provided that the POI would 
    consist of the four most recently completed fiscal quarters as of the 
    month preceding, instead of including, the month in which the petition 
    was filed or in which the Secretary self-initiated an investigation. 
    Finally, the Department preserved its discretion to use a different POI 
    in appropriate circumstances.
        We received several comments concerning this change in the standard 
    AD POI. One commenter, while approving the expansion of the POI to 
    twelve months, objected to reliance upon fiscal quarters completed as 
    of the month preceding the month in which a petition was filed. 
    According to this commenter, domestic industries are badly buffeted by 
    dumped imports at least up to the date of the filing of a petition. If 
    the Department relied on completed fiscal quarters, however, it would 
    ignore at least two months worth of dumping activity, activity that was 
    automatically covered by the Department's former POI. In addition, this 
    commenter asserted, the use of months, rather than fiscal quarters, 
    ``has worked well generally in the past and has not demonstrably been 
    an impediment to verification.'' Therefore, this commenter proposed 
    that the standard AD POI be the twelve-month period ending in the month 
    of filing or self-initiation, and that respondents should have the 
    burden of proving that a different POI is appropriate.
        A second commenter, on the other hand, generally supported the use 
    of fiscal quarters, but believed that the Department should rely on 
    completed quarters as of the end of the month of filing or self-
    initiation. In addition, this commenter objected to the expansion of 
    the POI from six months to twelve months, arguing that the Department 
    had not explained the reasons for this expansion and that it appeared 
    to be inconsistent with the Department's stated goal of easing 
    reporting requirements and permitting more efficient verification.
        With respect to the expansion of the POI to twelve months, we 
    believe that this expansion is required by Article 2.2.1, note 4 of the 
    AD Agreement. Note 4 states: ``The extended period of time should 
    normally be one year but shall in no case be less than six months.'' 
    Although this statement is made in the context of analyzing sales below 
    the cost of production, implicit in the statement is the assumption 
    that the POI in an AD investigation normally will be one year. 
    Therefore, we have not adopted the suggestion of the second commenter 
    that we revert to a normal POI of six months.
        With respect to the use of completed fiscal quarters rather than 
    months, while we do not dispute the first commenter's assertion that 
    domestic industries may be buffeted by dumped imports in the months 
    immediately preceding the filing of a petition, these imports would not 
    be subject to antidumping duties, regardless of whether they were 
    covered by the POI. Moreover, the timing of a petition filing often can 
    address such concerns. In addition, we continue to believe that 
    defining the POI in terms of completed fiscal quarters, rather than 
    calendar months running from the date of filing, will generate 
    considerable savings in time and money for both the Department and the 
    parties involved in AD proceedings. Our experience is that a 
    considerable amount of time is spent in reconciling AD submissions 
    (that until now have been based on calendar months) to a firm's 
    accounting records (that typically are based on fiscal quarters). 
    However, we should emphasize that Sec. 204(b)(1) refers to the POI that 
    the Secretary ``normally'' will use. Therefore, the Department retains 
    the discretion to depart from its standard POI where warranted by the 
    circumstances of a case.
        Finally, we are not adopting the suggestion that we base our POI on 
    completed fiscal quarters as of the end of the month of filing or self-
    initiation. In general, we believe that it is more appropriate to 
    investigate only sales made prior to the filing of a petition to 
    alleviate concerns about the effect of the petition on pricing 
    practices.
        Period of investigation in CVD investigations: One commenter 
    suggested that we retain the modifier ``normally'' in the second 
    sentence of proposed Sec. 351.204(b)(2). According to this commenter, 
    the Department should retain the flexibility to adopt as the POI the 
    fiscal year of the foreign government or the main responding company.
        We have retained the word ``normally'' in the second sentence. 
    However, we have changed the second sentence of Sec. 351.204(b)(2). 
    Originally, this sentence would have required the Secretary to set the 
    POI as the most recently completed calendar year, if the fiscal years 
    of the government and the exporters or producers differed. This 
    language did not correctly reflect our past practice, a practice that 
    we do not wish to change. The new language simply deletes the reference 
    to the government's fiscal year. Thus, the Department normally will set 
    the POI according to the fiscal year of the individual exporters or 
    producers. Only if the fiscal years of the exporters or producers 
    differ, will the POI be the most recently completed calendar year. In 
    the case of investigations conducted on an aggregate basis, the 
    Department's normal POI will continue to be based on the most recently 
    completed fiscal year for the government in question.
        Acceptance of voluntary respondents: Two commenters submitted 
    virtually identical comments objecting to the requirement in proposed 
    Sec. 351.204(d)(2) that a voluntary respondent submit a questionnaire 
    response before the Department decides whether to examine the voluntary 
    respondent individually. Citing the Department's AD investigation on 
    Pasta from Italy, these commenters claimed that an exporter will not be 
    willing to expend the time and financial resources required to prepare 
    a questionnaire response without some prior assurance by the Department 
    that it will conduct an individual examination of the firm. Therefore, 
    they concluded, this requirement discourages voluntary responses and, 
    thus, violates Article 6.10.2 of the AD Agreement.
        To remedy this alleged violation of international law, the 
    commenters proposed that the Department require only that any exporter 
    not selected as a mandatory respondent submit a letter if it is 
    interested in submitting a voluntary response. Based on these letters, 
    the Department would decide which, if any, voluntary respondents it 
    would examine. Only after being selected would voluntary respondents be 
    required to submit questionnaire responses.
        We have not adopted this suggestion, because the approach that the 
    commenters objected to is made necessary by the requirements of 
    sections 777A(c)(2)(B) and 782(a) of the Act. Where the Department does 
    not examine all known producers and exporters, it often selects for 
    examination all producers or exporters ``that can be reasonably 
    examined'' in accordance with the requirements of section 777A(c)(2)(B) 
    of the Act. The selected producers and exporters in this group normally 
    represent the largest number of respondents the Department believes it 
    can examine at that time. The Department normally will decide the 
    number of selected respondents very early in the proceeding; i.e., 
    before it
    
    [[Page 27310]]
    
    issues questionnaires to the selected respondents. Therefore, it 
    frequently is the case that the Department cannot make a determination 
    as to whether additional voluntary respondents can be reasonably 
    examined until after the deadline for questionnaire responses has 
    passed (e.g., one or more selected respondents have not responded). If 
    the additional voluntary respondents did not begin to prepare their 
    questionnaire responses until after the Department received 
    questionnaire responses from the selected respondents, the Department 
    would not be able to complete the investigation or review within the 
    statutory deadlines. Therefore, additional voluntary respondents must 
    submit the complete questionnaire response by the deadlines in 
    accordance with section 782(a) of the Act. In addition, we do not 
    believe that section 782(a) ``discourages'' voluntary responses within 
    the meaning of Article 6.10.2. Instead, it simply recognizes the 
    constraints on the Department's resources that must be taken into 
    account in determining whether we can accept a voluntary response. In 
    order to help potential voluntary respondents decide, prior to 
    acceptance as a respondent, whether to submit a questionnaire response, 
    we intend to accept voluntary responses based on the order in which 
    written requests to be accepted as voluntary respondents are submitted. 
    In those instances where we can make earlier determinations to accept 
    voluntary responses, we will do so.
        One commenter submitted a comment suggesting that Sec. 351.204 be 
    amended to incorporate requests by voluntary respondents to be included 
    in the pool of companies investigated in cases conducted on an 
    ``aggregate'' basis. We have not adopted this suggestion, because under 
    the statute, only CVD investigations are to be conducted on an 
    ``aggregate basis,'' and it is clear from the comment that the 
    commenter was addressing AD investigations.
        Voluntary respondents and the all-others rate: Proposed 
    Sec. 351.204(d)(3) provided that in calculating an all-others rate, the 
    Secretary will exclude weighted-average dumping margins or 
    countervailable subsidy rates calculated for voluntary respondents. In 
    the preamble to the AD Proposed Regulations, the Department explained 
    that the purpose of this provision was to prevent manipulation and to 
    maintain the integrity of the all-others rate. One commenter argued 
    that this provision is inconsistent with the statute and should be 
    deleted.
        We do not agree with this comment, and have retained the rule as 
    drafted. The statute does not define the term ``investigated'' and does 
    not directly address the question of whether voluntary respondents 
    should be considered to be part of the Department's investigation. 
    Because the statute does not resolve the issue, we look to the AD 
    Agreement for guidance as to the best interpretation of the Act, in 
    keeping with the requirement that, to the extent possible, a statute be 
    interpreted in a manner consistent with the international obligations 
    of the United States.
        Article 9.4 of the AD Agreement provides that the duties applied to 
    ``exporters or producers not included in the examination'' (i.e., 
    ``all-others'') may not exceed the weighted-average margin for the 
    ``selected exporters or producers.'' This implies that those exporters 
    or producers not ``selected'' are not considered to be included in the 
    ``examination.'' Therefore, the better interpretation of section 
    735(c)(5) is that producers who are not ``selected'' by the Department 
    (i.e., voluntary respondents) are not considered to have been 
    ``examined'' (i.e., investigated), so that their margins should not 
    contribute to the ``all-others'' rate. In effect, the Department 
    conducts parallel proceedings for voluntary respondents.
        As we noted in the preamble to the AD Proposed Regulations, 
    exclusion of voluntary respondents from the determination of the all-
    others rate serves the obvious purpose of preventing distortion or 
    outright manipulation of the all-others rate. The producers or 
    exporters most likely to submit voluntary responses are those with 
    reason to believe that they will obtain a lower margin by volunteering 
    than they would obtain by being subject to the all-others rate. 
    Inclusion of rates determined for voluntary respondents thus would be 
    expected to distort the weighted-average for the respondents selected 
    by the Department on a neutral basis.
        Exclusions: In the AD Proposed Regulations, 61 FR at 7315, the 
    Department requested additional public comment on the issue of whether 
    there should be special exclusion rules for firms, such as trading 
    companies, that export, but do not produce, subject merchandise. We 
    noted that one alternative would be to limit the exclusion of a 
    nonproducing exporter to the subject merchandise produced by those 
    producers that supplied the exporter during the period of 
    investigation. Several commenters supported this approach, citing the 
    potential for other producers to avoid the imposition of duties by 
    selling through an excluded exporter. Other commenters argued that if 
    an exporter is excluded, the exclusion should apply to all exports by 
    that exporter, regardless of the producer.
        The Department agrees with the first group of commenters that 
    normally the exclusion of a nonproducing exporter should be limited. 
    Therefore, we have added a new paragraph (e)(3) to provide that the 
    exclusion of a nonproducing exporter normally will be limited to 
    subject merchandise produced or supplied by those companies that 
    supplied the exporter during the period of investigation.
        In an AD investigation, the Secretary may grant an exclusion to a 
    nonproducing exporter if the Secretary investigates the exporter's 
    sales and determines that the dumping margins on those sales are not 
    greater than de minimis. However, to prevent other producers from 
    selling through an excluded exporter in order to avoid the imposition 
    of duties, the Secretary normally will apply the exclusion only to the 
    exporter's exports of subject merchandise purchased from those 
    producer(s) found by the Secretary to lack knowledge of the exportation 
    of the merchandise to the United States. This limitation is 
    appropriate, because the lack of knowledge by these producers provided 
    the basis for investigating and establishing a rate for the exporter.
        In a CVD investigation, the basis for the exclusion of a 
    nonproducing exporter is that neither the exporter nor the producers or 
    suppliers of subject merchandise sold by the exporter received more 
    than de minimis net countervailable subsidies. Therefore, it is 
    appropriate to limit the exclusion to merchandise purchased from the 
    same suppliers and producers.
        With respect to requests for exclusion in a CVD investigation 
    conducted on an aggregate basis, we have renumbered paragraph (e)(3) as 
    paragraph (e)(4), and we have revised paragraph (e)(4)(iv) to clarify 
    that in the case of a non-producing exporter, the foreign government 
    must certify that neither the exporter nor the exporter's supplier 
    received more than de minimis countervailable subsidies during the 
    review period.
        One commenter proposed that (1) the regulations make clear that the 
    Department has the authority to ``bring back'' under an order an 
    excluded company if the Department subsequently finds in a review that 
    the company is dumping, and (2) the regulations retain the requirements 
    of Secs. 353.14 and 355.14 of the Department's prior regulations. 
    According to the commenter, the Department required a company with a
    
    [[Page 27311]]
    
    zero or de minimis dumping margin or CVD rate to certify that the 
    company would not dump or receive countervailable subsidies in the 
    future. The commenter contended that this certification authorized the 
    Department to review excluded firms to confirm that they were acting in 
    a manner consistent with the certification. In addition, this commenter 
    claimed that because AD/CVD orders apply to countries, rather than to 
    individual companies, the Department has the authority to review 
    excluded companies.
        We have not adopted these suggestions. With respect to the notion 
    of ``bringing back'' excluded companies, as a matter of administrative 
    practice, the Department never has reviewed sales of excluded 
    companies, with the exception of situations in which nonexcluded 
    companies attempt to funnel their ``non-excluded'' merchandise through 
    an excluded company. There is no indication in either the statute or 
    the SAA that Congress intended the Department to make such a radical 
    departure from its prior practice concerning exclusions. Moreover, we 
    believe that the ``inclusion'' of an excluded company would be 
    inconsistent with Article 5.8 of the AD Agreement and Article 11.9 of 
    the SCM Agreement (both of which require termination where the amount 
    of dumping or subsidization is de minimis).
        As for former Secs. 353.14 and 355.14, with the exception of CVD 
    investigations conducted on an aggregate basis, these provisions are no 
    longer necessary in light of the amendments to the statute made by the 
    URAA, and, in any event, never functioned in the manner suggested by 
    the commenter. These provisions, notwithstanding their titles, 
    functioned as a mechanism for considering requests by voluntary 
    respondents to be investigated. As stated by the Department when it 
    adopted Sec. 351.14:
    
        If the Department includes a producer or reseller in its 
    investigation and determines that the producer or reseller had no 
    dumping margin during the period of investigation, the Department 
    would automatically exclude that producer or reseller from the 
    antidumping duty order, even if the producer or reseller did not 
    request exclusion under the procedures described in [Sec. 353.14]. 
    The purpose of this section merely is to provide an opportunity for 
    producers and resellers that the Department might not otherwise 
    include in its investigation to request that the Department 
    specifically include and investigate them.
    
    Final Rule (Antidumping Duties), 54 FR 12742, 12748 (1989). The 
    Department made a virtually identical statement with respect to 
    Sec. 355.14. Final Rule (Countervailing Duties), 53 FR 53206, 52316 
    (1988).
        Given their original purpose, Secs. 353.14 and 355.14 have become 
    superfluous in light of section 782(a) of the Act and Sec. 351.204(d) 
    (which establish new procedures for dealing with voluntary respondents) 
    and Sec. 351.204(e)(3) (which deals with exclusion requests in CVD 
    investigations conducted on an aggregate basis). Under these 
    provisions, decisions on exclusions will be based on a firm's actual 
    behavior, as opposed to assertions regarding its possible future 
    behavior.
        Other comments: One commenter suggested that Sec. 351.204 be 
    modified to state explicitly that the Department retains the right to 
    seek and obtain information from importers in the United States of 
    subject merchandise. We have not adopted this suggestion. While we do 
    not disagree with the proposition that the Department may seek 
    information from importers, we also do not believe that there is any 
    doubt concerning the Department's authority to seek such information. 
    Therefore, we do not feel that the suggested modification is necessary.
    
    Section 351.205
    
        Section 351.205 deals with preliminary AD and CVD determinations. 
    Two commenters noted that, in connection with proposed Sec. 351.205(c), 
    the Department deleted (1) the requirement that a preliminary 
    determination include the factual and legal conclusions for the 
    Department's determination, and (2) the requirement that the Department 
    notify the parties to the proceeding. They suggested that paragraph (c) 
    be revised so as to include these requirements.
        While we do not disagree with the substance of the comments, we do 
    not believe that a revision to paragraph (c) is appropriate. Section 
    777(i) of the Act requires the Department to include its factual and 
    legal conclusions in a preliminary determination, and sections 703(f) 
    and 733(f) of the Act require the Department to notify the petitioner 
    and other parties to an investigation. Therefore, given our overall 
    approach of avoiding repetitions of the statute, we have not made the 
    revisions suggested.
    
    Section 351.206
    
        Section 351.206 deals with critical circumstances findings. In 
    connection with Sec. 351.206, one commenter sought clarification that 
    provisional measures would not be imposed on merchandise imported prior 
    to the date of initiation of an AD or CVD investigation. We can confirm 
    that provisional measures will not be imposed on merchandise entered 
    prior to the date of initiation. Section 351.206(d), which deals with 
    retroactive suspension of liquidation, refers to sections 703(e)(2) and 
    733(e)(2) of the Act. These sections provide that suspension of 
    liquidation may not apply to merchandise entered prior to the date on 
    which notice of the determination to initiate is published in the 
    Federal Register. See also SAA at 878.
    
    Section 351.207
    
        Section 351.207 deals with the termination of investigations. We 
    received several comments regarding Sec. 351.207 from one commenter.
        First, the commenter objected to the proviso in Sec. 351.207(b)(1) 
    that the Secretary may terminate an investigation if ``the Secretary 
    concludes that termination is in the public interest.'' The commenter 
    argued that because the relevant provisions of the statute do not 
    require a public interest finding, the regulations should not enlarge 
    upon the statutory criteria.
        We have not adopted this suggestion, because the legislative 
    history of the Trade Agreements Act of 1979 indicates that Congress 
    intended that the Secretary make a public interest finding before 
    terminating a self-initiated investigation or an investigation in which 
    a petition is withdrawn. See, e.g., Trade Agreements Act of 1979 
    Statements of Administrative Action, H.R. Doc. No. 153, Pt. II, 96th 
    Cong., 1st Sess. 400, 418 (1979); and S. Rep. No. 249, 96th Cong., 1st 
    Sess. 54, 70-71 (1979). We believe that this legislative history 
    remains relevant in interpreting the post-URAA version of the Act. 
    Moreover, there is no indication in the legislative history of the URAA 
    that Congress intended that the Department abandon the requirement of a 
    public interest finding.
        Second, in connection with Sec. 351.207(c), the commenter suggested 
    that the Department clarify that its authority to terminate an 
    investigation due to lack of interest is unaffected by those statutory 
    provisions prohibiting the post-initiation reconsideration of industry 
    support for a petition. We have not adopted this suggestion, because, 
    as the Department stated in the AD Proposed Regulations, 61 FR at 7315, 
    the SAA is clear on this point.
        Finally, in connection with Sec. 351.207(b)(2), the commenter 
    suggested that in light of the prohibition against voluntary export 
    restraints found in the WTO Agreement on Safeguards, the Department 
    should exercise sparingly its discretion to terminate an investigation 
    based on a
    
    [[Page 27312]]
    
    foreign government's agreement to limit the volume of imports of 
    subject merchandise into the United States. The commenter did not 
    suggest any modifications to Sec. 351.207(b)(2), and we have left that 
    provision unchanged.
    
    Section 351.208
    
        Section 351.208 deals with suspension agreements and suspended 
    investigations. Most of the comments we received regarding Sec. 351.208 
    dealt with our proposed deadlines for initialing and signing suspension 
    agreements.
        Deadlines: In proposed Sec. 351.208(f)(1)(i), we advanced the 
    deadline for submitting a proposed suspension agreement to 15 days 
    after a preliminary determination in an AD investigation and 5 days 
    after a preliminary determination in a CVD investigation. As explained 
    in the AD Proposed Regulations, the purpose of this change was to 
    reduce burdens on all parties and Department staff. 61 FR at 7316. 
    Public reaction to this change in deadlines was mixed, cutting across 
    respondent/domestic industry lines.
        On the domestic industry side, one commenter strongly supported the 
    change, while another commenter thought the AD deadline too short. On 
    the respondent side, one commenter supported the change, but three 
    commenters considered the revised deadline to be too short.
        After careful consideration of these comments, we have left the 
    deadlines as set forth in proposed Sec. 351.208(f)(1)(i). Several of 
    the commenters seeking a longer deadline argued that exporters are not 
    in a position to consider whether or not they desire to propose a 
    suspension agreement until the preliminary determination has been 
    issued. We can understand why respondent interested parties might wish 
    to see the results of a preliminary determination before formally 
    submitting a proposed suspension agreement. However, in our view, a 
    respondent interested party that is entertaining a suspension agreement 
    as an option may begin its deliberations as soon as the Department 
    initiates an investigation instead of waiting until the Department 
    issues a preliminary determination. If a respondent interested party 
    begins its deliberations early, we believe that the deadlines set forth 
    in Sec. 351.208(f)(1)(i) provide sufficient time in which to digest the 
    results of a preliminary determination.
        We received other comments regarding deadlines, in addition to 
    those described above. One commenter suggested that the Department give 
    itself authority to extend the deadlines where necessary. We agree with 
    this suggestion, but note that it already is addressed by 
    Sec. 351.302(b), which provides the Secretary with authority to extend, 
    for good cause, any time limit established by part 351.
        Another commenter suggested that in order to provide the Department 
    with more flexibility, the deadlines should run from the date of 
    publication of a preliminary determination instead of the date of 
    issuance. We have not adopted this suggestion. In order to accomplish 
    our objective of reducing burdens, we deliberately chose the date of 
    issuance, because one week can elapse between the date of issuance and 
    the date of publication in the Federal Register. However, we believe 
    that Sec. 351.302(b), discussed in the preceding paragraph, addresses 
    the commenter's concerns, because it permits the Secretary to extend a 
    deadline for good cause.
        Another commenter suggested that if the deadline for submitting 
    proposed suspension agreements in CVD investigations remains at 5 days 
    from the preliminary determination, the timeframe should be modified to 
    5 business days, excluding applicable foreign holidays. We have adopted 
    this suggestion in part by changing the deadline from 5 days to 7 days. 
    However, we have not adopted the suggestion concerning the exclusion of 
    foreign holidays. If, in a particular case, the occurrence of a foreign 
    holiday should make this deadline unworkable, this is something that 
    the Secretary could consider under the extension authority of 
    Sec. 351.302(b).
        Suspension agreement procedures: We received several comments 
    concerning the procedures to be followed in entering into a suspension 
    agreement. One commenter, arguing that current procedures deprive 
    petitioners of meaningful input, suggested that the Department amend 
    Sec. 351.208(f)(1) to: (1) require the foreign exporters or foreign 
    government to serve a copy of the proposed suspension agreement on the 
    petitioner at the same time that it is submitted to the Department; (2) 
    require the Department thereafter to consult with all parties and to 
    request written comments from all parties regarding the terms of the 
    agreement and whether the agreement is in the public interest; and (3) 
    require the Department to consider domestic industry opposition to a 
    suspension agreement as a strong indicator that the agreement is not in 
    the public interest.
        Before addressing the specific suggestions, we should note at the 
    outset that, in our view, the Department's existing procedures have not 
    denied petitioners meaningful input regarding decisions to enter into 
    suspension agreements. Department precedents offer numerous examples of 
    revisions to proposed suspension agreements that the Department has 
    made in response to petitioners' comments. While the Department may not 
    always agree with all of a petitioner's comments, this does not mean 
    that the Department has not carefully considered those comments.
        As for the specific suggestions, we have not adopted them for the 
    following reasons. With respect to the suggestion that the party 
    proposing a suspension agreement serve a copy on the petitioner, we 
    note that sections 704(e) and 734(e) of the Act contemplate that the 
    Department will notify the petitioner of a proposed suspension 
    agreement and provide the petitioner with a copy of the proposed 
    agreement at the time of notification. In our experience, this process 
    has worked well in the past and there is no need to change it at this 
    time. With respect to the suggestion that the Department consult with, 
    and request written comments from, all parties, sections 704(e)(1) and 
    734(e)(1) require the Department to consult only with the petitioner, a 
    requirement reflected in Sec. 351.208(f)(2)(iii). Other parties have a 
    right to comment on a proposed suspension agreement, however, and we do 
    not believe it is necessary or appropriate to impose an additional 
    consultation requirement on Department staff. With respect to written 
    comments, sections 704(e)(3) and 734(e)(3) permit all interested 
    parties to submit comments and information, a right that is already 
    reflected in Sec. 351.208(f)(3). Finally, with respect to the 
    suggestion concerning the significance of domestic industry opposition, 
    this is something to which the Department would accord considerable 
    weight when assessing the public interest. However, the Department must 
    assess the public interest based on all the facts, and we do not 
    believe it appropriate to issue a regulation that singles out one 
    factor to the exclusion of others.
        Another commenter suggested that before entering into a suspension 
    agreement, the Department should consult potentially affected consuming 
    industries and potentially affected producers and workers in the 
    domestic industry, including producers and workers not party to the 
    investigation. As discussed above, we do not believe it is necessary or 
    appropriate to expand the consultation requirements beyond those set 
    forth in the statute. However, we have revised paragraph (f)(3) so as 
    to
    
    [[Page 27313]]
    
    expressly permit industrial users and consumers to submit written 
    argument and factual information concerning a proposed suspension 
    agreement.
        Regional industry cases: One commenter stated that the Department 
    should clarify Sec. 351.208, in accordance with the new statutory 
    language, to make it clear that (1) it is not easier for respondents to 
    obtain a suspension agreement in a regional industry investigation, and 
    (2) the Department has no more obligation to accept a suspension 
    agreement in a regional industry investigation than in any other 
    investigation. We agree that a suspension agreement in a regional 
    industry investigation is subject to the same requirements as a 
    suspension agreement in a national industry investigation (including 
    the public interest requirement), and that the Department need not 
    accept an agreement in a regional industry investigation if those 
    requirements are not met. However, because the SAA at 859 makes this 
    clear, we do not think that additional clarification is necessary.
        Revision to paragraph (f)(1): Although not the subject of public 
    comments, we have made certain stylistic revisions to paragraph (f)(1) 
    in order to make this provision accurate and more readable.
    
    Section 351.209
    
        Section 351.209 deals with the violation of suspension agreements. 
    Of the comments we received regarding this section, most related to 
    proposed Sec. 351.209(b)(2), which deals with the resumption of 
    suspended investigations that had not been completed under sections 
    704(g) or 734(g) of the Act. Proposed Sec. 351.209(b)(2) provided that 
    the Secretary may ``update previously submitted information where the 
    Secretary deems it appropriate to do so.''
        Although one commenter supported the use of updated information, 
    three commenters opposed the use of updated information. Each of the 
    latter commenters argued that the use of updated information 
    constitutes poor policy, because it effectively rewards parties that 
    violate or take advantage of a suspension agreement. In addition, two 
    of the commenters referred to sections 704(j) and 734(j) of the Act, 
    which provide that in making a final determination the Secretary 
    ``shall consider all of the subject merchandise, without regard to the 
    effect of any [suspension] agreement. . . .'' According to one of the 
    two commenters, these two statutory provisions preclude the use of 
    updated information. According to the second of the two commenters, 
    these provisions preclude the use of updated information except in the 
    unusual case where the Department is able to account for the effect of 
    the terminated suspension agreement.
        While we do not believe that sections 704(j) and 734(j) necessarily 
    preclude the use of updated information, we have concluded that, in 
    light of the Department's limited experience with resumed 
    investigations, it would be premature at this time to resolve this 
    issue in the regulations. Therefore, we have revised paragraph (b)(2) 
    by deleting the phrase dealing with updated information.
        One commenter also questioned whether Sec. 351.209(b) was intended 
    to broaden the circumstances under which it can be determined that a 
    suspension agreement has been violated. In this regard, our intent was 
    neither to broaden nor to narrow these circumstances.
    
    Section 351.210
    
        We received two comments concerning Sec. 351.210, which deals with 
    final determinations in investigations. As it did with respect to 
    proposed Sec. 351.205(c), one commenter objected to the deletion of (1) 
    the requirement that the Department include in a final determination 
    its factual and legal conclusions; and (2) the requirement that the 
    Department notify parties of a final determination. As we stated above 
    in connection with Sec. 351.205(c), because the Act clearly imposes 
    these requirements on the Department, these requirements need not be 
    reiterated in the regulations.
        Another commenter suggested that the Department codify its practice 
    of treating a request for a postponement of a final determination as a 
    request for the extension of provisional measures. We agree with this 
    suggestion. However, instead of assuming that a request for 
    postponement includes an implied request for an extension of 
    provisional measures, we prefer to rely on the Department's 
    discretionary authority to deny requests for postponements of final 
    determinations. More specifically, the absence of a request to extend 
    provisional measures would constitute a compelling reason, within the 
    meaning of Sec. 351.210(e)(1), for denying a request to postpone a 
    final determination. Therefore, we have revised Sec. 351.210(e) so as 
    to provide that in the case of a request for postponement made by 
    exporters, the Secretary will not grant the request unless it is 
    accompanied by a request for an extension of provisional measures to 
    not more than 6 months.
    
    Section 351.211
    
        Section 351.211 deals with the issuance of AD and CVD orders. We 
    received several suggestions concerning proposed Sec. 351.211(c), which 
    established special procedures concerning the assessment of duties in 
    proceedings in which the Commission identified a regional industry. 
    Based on our own review of paragraph (c) and these suggestions, we have 
    deleted paragraph (c) and substituted in its place a new 
    Sec. 351.212(f). A discussion of the suggestions and this new provision 
    appears below under ``Section 351.212.''
    
    Section 351.212
    
        Section 351.212 deals with matters related to the assessment of 
    antidumping and countervailing duties. We received several comments 
    relating to automatic assessment of duties and the calculation of 
    assessment rates.
        Automatic assessment: Under the former regulations, if the 
    Department did not receive a request for the review of particular 
    entries of subject merchandise, the Department would instruct the 
    Customs Service to liquidate those entries and assess duties at the 
    cash deposit rate applied to those entries at the time of entry. In 
    proposed Sec. 351.212(c), the Department proposed to assess duties on 
    entries for which there was no review request ``at rates equal to the 
    rates determined in the most recently completed segment of the 
    proceeding. . . .'' The Department believed that by relying on more 
    current rates as the basis for the assessment of duties, the number of 
    requests for reviews would decline.
        Several commenters opposed this change, some describing their 
    opposition as ``strong.'' They argued that the proposed change would 
    create an undue element of uncertainty, because at the time when a 
    party would have to decide whether to request a review, it would not 
    know the rate that would be applied to its entries if it did not 
    request a review. This would force parties to request reviews solely to 
    protect their interests, thereby defeating the purpose of the proposal. 
    They also argued that the proposal would result in more work for the 
    Customs Service, a point the Department recognized in 1989. Finally, 
    even those who did not oppose the change argued that proposed 
    Sec. 351.212(c) needed additional refinements in order to provide some 
    minimum degree of certainty.
        In light of the comments received, the Department has decided to 
    continue its current practice with respect to automatic assessment; 
    i.e., if an entry is
    
    [[Page 27314]]
    
    not subject to a request for a review, the Department will instruct the 
    Customs Service to liquidate that entry and assess duties at the rate 
    in effect at the time of entry. We have made the appropriate revisions 
    to paragraph (c).
        Antidumping duty assessment rates: Proposed Sec. 351.212(b)(1) 
    dealt with the method that the Department will use to assess 
    antidumping duties upon completion of a review. In proposed paragraph 
    (b)(1), the Department provided that it normally will calculate an 
    ``assessment rate'' for each importer by dividing the absolute dumping 
    margin found on merchandise reviewed by the entered value of that 
    merchandise. As such, paragraph (b)(1) merely codified an assessment 
    method that the Department has come to use more and more frequently in 
    recent years.
        Historically, the Department (and, before it, the Department of the 
    Treasury) used the so-called ``master list'' (entry-by-entry) 
    assessment method. Under the master list method, the Department would 
    list the appropriate amount of duties to assess for each entry of 
    subject merchandise separately in its instructions to the Customs 
    Service. However, in recent years, the master list method has fallen 
    into disuse for two principal reasons. First, in most cases, 
    respondents have not been able to link specific entries to specific 
    sales, particularly in CEP situations in which there is a delay between 
    the importation of merchandise and its resale to an unaffiliated 
    customers. Absent an ability to link entries to sales, the Department 
    cannot apply the master list method. Second, even when respondents are 
    able to link entries to sales, there are practical difficulties in 
    creating and using a master list if the number of entries covered by a 
    review is large. Preparing a master list that covers hundreds or 
    thousands of entries is a time-consuming process, and one that is prone 
    to errors by Department and/or Customs Service staff. Therefore, as the 
    Department explained in the AD Proposed Regulations, 61 FR at 7317, the 
    Department would consider using the master list method of assessment 
    only in situations where there are few entries during a review period 
    and the Department can tie those entries to particular sales.
        Several commenters suggested that the Department clarify that it 
    will apply the master list method if the importer can demonstrate that 
    the assessment rate approach would distort the amount of duty assessed 
    as compared to the amount assessed under the master list method. In 
    addition, one of these commenters urged the Department to clarify that, 
    regardless of the assessment method used, the Department will not 
    consider merchandise entered prior to the suspension of liquidation to 
    be ``subject merchandise'' under section 771(25) of the Act. Finally, 
    one commenter supported proposed paragraph (b)(1), and urged the 
    Department to apply the assessment rate method to all outstanding 
    unliquidated entries, regardless of whether the Department conducted 
    the applicable review under the pre-or post-URAA version of the Act.
        The Department has adopted proposed paragraph (b)(1) without 
    change. As noted above, and as recognized by most of the commenters, to 
    a large extent, paragraph (b)(1) simply codifies the Department's 
    current practice.
        With respect to the suggestions that the Department continue to 
    apply the master list method on a case-by-case basis, in our view, the 
    fact that a respondent is able to link its sales to entries, in itself, 
    constitutes an insufficient basis for using the master list method. As 
    discussed above, there are practical problems inherent in the use of 
    the master list method wholly apart from the linkage problem.
        Thus, based on the results of each review, the Department generally 
    will assess duties on entries made during the review period and will 
    use assessment rates to effect those assessments. However, on a case-
    by-case basis, the Department may consider whether the ability to link 
    sales with entries should cause the Department to base a review on 
    sales of merchandise entered during the period of review, rather than 
    on sales that occurred during the period of review. These two 
    approaches differ, because, in the case of CEP sales, the delay between 
    importation and resale to an unaffiliated customer means that 
    merchandise entered during the review period often is different from 
    the merchandise sold during that period. Because of the inability to 
    tie entries to sales, the Department normally must base its review on 
    sales made during the period of review. Where a respondent can tie its 
    entries to its sales, we potentially can trace each entry of subject 
    merchandise made during a review period to the particular sale or sales 
    of that same merchandise to unaffiliated customers, and we conduct the 
    review on that basis. However, the determination of whether to a review 
    sales of merchandise entered during the period of review hinges on such 
    case-specific factors as whether certain sales of subject merchandise 
    may be missed because, for example, the preceding review covered sales 
    made during that review period or sales may not have occurred in time 
    to be captured by the review. Additionally, the Department must 
    consider whether a respondent has been able to link sales and entries 
    previously for prior review periods and whether it appears likely that 
    the respondent will continue to be able to link sales and entries in 
    future reviews. The Department must consider these factors because of 
    the distortions that could arise by switching from one method to 
    another in different review periods. Also, in cases in which the 
    Department is sampling sales under section 777A of the Act, other 
    complicating factors mitigate against using entries during the POR as 
    the basis for the review.
        Finally, the fact that the amount of duties assessed may differ 
    depending on the method used is not necessarily grounds to conclude 
    that the assessment rate method is distortive, because neither the Act 
    nor the AD Agreement specifies whether sales or entries are to be 
    reviewed, nor do they specify how the Department must calculate the 
    amount of duties to be assessed. See, Torrington Co. v. United States, 
    44 F.3d 1572, 1578 (Fed. Cir. 1995). Moreover, as the Court of 
    International Trade has recognized in upholding the Department's 
    assessment rate method, a review of sales, rather than entries, 
    ``appears not to be biased in favor of, or against, respondents.'' FAG 
    Kugelfischer Georg Schafer KgaA v. United States, 1995 Ct. Int'l. Trade 
    LEXIS 209, *10 (1995), aff'd, 1996 U.S. App. LEXIS 11544 (Fed. Cir 
    1996).
        With respect to the issue of whether merchandise entered prior to 
    suspension of liquidation is ``subject merchandise,'' the Department 
    addressed this issue in Stainless Steel Wire Rod from France, 61 FR 
    47874, 47875 (Sept. 11, 1996), in which the Department stated:
    
        Sales of merchandise that can be demonstrably linked with 
    entries prior to the suspension of liquidation are not subject 
    merchandise and therefore are not subject to review by the 
    Department. Merchandise that entered the United States prior to the 
    suspension of liquidation (and in the absence of an affirmative 
    critical circumstances finding) is not subject merchandise within 
    the meaning of section 771(25) of the Act.
    
        Finally, with respect to the effective date of paragraph (b)(1), in 
    many cases the Department currently is applying the assessment rate 
    method. However, the Department cannot apply this method to all 
    unliquidated entries. Because liquidation of entries may have been 
    delayed by the Customs Service for reasons unrelated to the collection 
    of
    
    [[Page 27315]]
    
    antidumping duties, applying this method to all unliquidated entries 
    would require the amendment all of our prior liquidation instructions. 
    Not only would this place an enormous burden on the Department and the 
    Customs Service, it also would cause uncertainty for the importing 
    community.
        For these reasons, the Department will apply paragraph (b)(1) only 
    to assessment instructions issued on the basis of final results in 
    reviews initiated after the effective date of these regulations. As 
    noted previously, however, because this regulation merely codifies a 
    past practice, the Department will apply the assessment rate method in 
    those cases that are not technically subject to the regulation. 
    However, the Department will do so as a matter of practice, and not as 
    a regulatory requirement. The purpose of having an effective date is to 
    ensure that the Department is not required to amend old assessment 
    instructions based on reviews in which the Department did not collect 
    the necessary information.
        Regional industry cases: As noted above, we received suggestions 
    from one commenter regarding proposed Sec. 351.211(c), which 
    established special procedures for proceedings in which the Commission 
    identified a regional industry. Under paragraph (c), which was designed 
    to implement sections 706(c) and 736(d) of the Act, the Secretary could 
    except from the assessment of duties merchandise of an exporter or 
    producer that did not supply the region during the POI.
        While the commenter generally supported the procedures set forth in 
    Sec. 351.211(c), it suggested several improvements. First, it suggested 
    that the Department clarify that a petitioner has a right to respond to 
    certifications submitted by an exporter or producer. In its post-
    hearing comments, this commenter further refined this suggestion by 
    proposing that the Department require certifications from foreign 
    exporters and producers to be submitted early in the investigation, 
    rather than at its end.
        Second, for purposes of certifying and establishing whether an 
    exporter or producer exported subject merchandise for sale in the 
    region concerned during the POI, the commenter suggested that the 
    relevant POI be the ITC's POI. According to the commenter, the 
    Department's normal one-year POI is too short, and the Commission's 
    normal three-year POI is preferable.
        Third, the commenter suggested that U.S. importers should be 
    required to certify to the Customs Service, upon entry into the United 
    States of merchandise from an exporter or producer whose merchandise 
    has been excepted from assessment, whether that merchandise will be 
    sold in the region concerned. If an importer certified that merchandise 
    would be sold in the region, the importer would be required to notify 
    the Department directly so that the Department could direct that 
    merchandise of the exporter or producer in question would be subject to 
    the assessment of duties.
        Finally, in its post-hearing comments, the commenter suggested that 
    the certifications of exporters and producers should include the period 
    after the POI. In this regard, it noted that paragraph (c), as drafted, 
    required that the certifications of U.S. importers cover the period 
    after the POI.
        We believe these suggestions have considerable merit, and with, 
    certain exceptions, we have incorporated them into these final 
    regulations. However, after reviewing the commenter's suggestions and 
    proposed Sec. 351.211(c), we came to the conclusion that instead of 
    creating an entirely new procedure, it would be more administrable for 
    the Department to consider requests for an exception from the 
    assessment of duties in the context of an existing procedural 
    mechanism. Among other things, this would ensure that domestic 
    interested parties have ample opportunity to comment on requests for an 
    exception, something which was one of the primary concerns of the 
    commenter. Entries of subject merchandise from an exporter or producer 
    that did not supply the region concerned during the original POI would 
    be subject to cash deposit requirements. However, because final duties 
    would not be levied if, in a review, the exporter or producer 
    established its eligibility for an exception from assessment, this 
    procedure is consistent with Article 4.2 of the AD Agreement and 
    Article 16.3 of the SCM Agreement.
        Therefore, we have added a new paragraph (f) to Sec. 351.212 to 
    deal with requests for an exception from the assessment of duties in 
    regional industry cases. The procedures for obtaining an exception 
    would work as follows. First, paragraph (f)(1) sets forth the basic 
    standard for obtaining an exception, and incorporates some of the 
    suggestions of the commenter.
        Paragraph (f)(2) provides that requests for an exception from 
    assessment will be considered in the context of an administrative 
    review or a new shipper review. Paragraph (f)(2)(i) provides that an 
    exporter or producer seeking an exception from assessment must request 
    an administrative review or a new shipper review under Sec. 351.213 or 
    Sec. 351.214, respectively. The request for review must be accompanied 
    by a request that the Secretary determine whether subject merchandise 
    of the exporter or producer satisfies the requirements of paragraph 
    (f)(1) and should be excepted from the assessment of duties. The 
    exporter or producer may request that the Secretary limit the review to 
    a determination as to whether an exception should be granted. In 
    addition, a request for review and exception from assessment must be 
    accompanied by the certifications described in paragraphs (f)(2)(i) (A) 
    and (B).
        If the requirements of paragraph (f)(2)(i) and Sec. 351.213 or 
    Sec. 351.214, as the case may be, are satisfied, the Secretary will 
    initiate an administrative review or a new shipper review. The 
    Secretary will conduct the review in accordance with Sec. 351.221. 
    However, under paragraph (f)(2)(ii), the Secretary may limit the review 
    to a determination as to whether an exception from assessment should be 
    granted if requested to do so by the exporter or producer under 
    paragraph (f)(2)(i). Notwithstanding the submission of such a request, 
    the Secretary could decline to conduct a limited review if, for 
    example, a domestic interested party had requested an administrative 
    review of the particular exporter or producer.
        Under paragraph (f)(3), if the Secretary determines that the 
    exporter or producer satisfies the requirements for an exception from 
    assessment, the Secretary will instruct the Customs Service to 
    liquidate entries without regard to antidumping or countervailing 
    duties. These instructions would apply only to entries of subject 
    merchandise of the exporter or producer concerned that were covered by 
    the review. Future entries of subject merchandise would remain subject 
    to cash deposit requirements for estimated duties, although the 
    exporter or producer could seek an exception from assessment for future 
    entries in a subsequent review.
        Paragraph (f)(4) describes the actions that the Secretary will take 
    if the Secretary does not grant an exception from assessment. Under 
    paragraph (f)(4)(i), if the review was not limited to the question of 
    an exception from assessment, the Secretary will instruct the Customs 
    Service to assess duties in accordance with Sec. 351.212(b); i.e., to 
    assess duties in accordance with the results of the review. Under 
    paragraph (f)(4)(ii), however, if the review was limited to the 
    question of an exception from assessment, the Secretary will apply the 
    automatic assessment provisions of Sec. 351.212(c).
        Returning to the commenter's suggestions, because we now have opted
    
    [[Page 27316]]
    
    to deal with requests for exception from assessment in the context of 
    reviews, we have not adopted the suggestion concerning the early 
    submission of certifications in an investigation. By dealing with 
    requests for an exception in the context of a review, domestic 
    interested parties should have ample opportunity to scrutinize, and 
    comment on, the certifications submitted by an exporter or producer.
        In addition, we have not adopted the suggestion that we use the 
    Commission's POI. Neither section 703(c) nor section 706(d) expressly 
    state whether the relevant POI is the Department's or the ITC's. 
    However, we think that section 751(a)(2)(B) of the Act provides 
    guidance as to what Congress intended. Section 751(a)(2)(B), which 
    deals with new shipper reviews, refers to an
    
    exporter or producer [that] did not export the merchandise * * * to 
    the United States (or, in the case of a regional industry, did not 
    export the subject merchandise for sale in the region concerned) 
    during the period of investigation. * * *
    
        The Department interprets this section as referring to the 
    Department's period of investigation, because the section is directed 
    to the Department. If Congress had intended that the Department use the 
    Commission's POI for purposes of determining whether an exporter was a 
    new shipper under section 751(a)(2)(B), it would have said so 
    explicitly. Given the obvious interrelationship between section 
    751(a)(2)(B) and sections 706(c) and 736(d), the more reasonable 
    interpretation is that ``period of investigation,'' as used in the 
    latter two sections, means the Department's POI.
        Provisional measures deposit cap: Although we have not revised 
    proposed paragraph (d) in these final regulations, the Department is 
    using this opportunity to clarify that the provisional measures deposit 
    cap contained in paragraph (d) will apply to entries subject to an AD 
    order secured by bonds as well as cash deposits, as stated in that 
    paragraph.
        On July 29, 1991, the Court of International Trade (the CIT) 
    invalidated the Department's AD regulation on the provisional measures 
    deposit cap (19 CFR Sec. 353.23) in a case on televisions from Taiwan. 
    Zenith Electronics v. United States, 770 F. Supp. 648. The CIT followed 
    this precedent on July 28, 1992, in a challenge to a review of 
    televisions from Korea. Daewoo Electronics v. United States, 794 F. 
    Supp. 389 (Daewoo I). On September 30, 1993, the Court of Appeals for 
    the Federal Circuit reversed the CIT's decision in the Korean 
    television case, and upheld the regulation. Daewoo Electronics v. 
    United States, 6 Fed. 3d 1511 (Daewoo II). As a result of the Federal 
    Circuit's decision, the CIT subsequently vacated its July 29, 1991, 
    order in Taiwan televisions. The Department never amended its 
    regulation, and the original regulation (now replicated in paragraph 
    (d)) remains valid. For this and other reasons discussed below, 
    paragraph (d) and its predecessor provision should be applied to all 
    entries as though the CIT never invalidated it.
        Section 733(d)(2) of the Act provides that an importer of 
    merchandise subject to an AD investigation must post bonds, cash 
    deposits, or other security for entries of the subject merchandise 
    between the Department's affirmative preliminary determination of sales 
    at less than fair value and the Commission's final injury 
    determination.
        Assuming an AD order is imposed, a manufacturer or importer may 
    request an administrative review under section 751(a) of the Act to 
    determine the actual amount of antidumping duties due on the sales 
    during this period. Section 737(a)(1) of the Act provides that, if the 
    amount of a cash deposit collected as security for an estimated 
    antidumping duty is different from the amount of the antidumping duty 
    determined in the first section 751 administrative review, then the 
    difference shall be disregarded, to the extent that the cash deposit 
    collected is lower than the duty determined to be due under a section 
    751 administrative review. This is called the provisional measures 
    deposit cap, and applies to entries between publication of the 
    Department's preliminary determination and the Commission's final 
    determination of injury.
        The provisional measures deposit cap for countervailing duties 
    (section 707 of the Act), on the other hand, explicitly provides that 
    the cap applies whether the entry is secured by a cash deposit or by a 
    bond or other security. That is, the Act at first glance appears to 
    apply the cap to entries secured both by cash deposits and by bonds in 
    CVD cases, but only by entries secured cash deposits in AD cases.
        Since 1980, the Department, by regulation, took the position that 
    the difference between the AD and CVD provisions in the statute was an 
    oversight, and the agency thus applied the provisional cap to entries 
    secured both by bonds and by cash deposits in both AD and CVD cases. 19 
    C.F.R. Sec. 353.50 in pre-1989 regulations; 19 CFR Sec. 353.23 in the 
    post-1989 regulations.
        On July 29, 1991, in a case involving televisions from Taiwan, the 
    CIT rejected the Department's interpretation that the statutory 
    differences between the AD and CVD provisions were an oversight, based 
    on its analysis of the statute and the Tokyo Round AD Code. It ruled 
    that, in AD cases, the provisional measures deposit cap applied only to 
    entries secured by cash deposits. Zenith.
        The Department decided it would not appeal the decision when it 
    became final, and published notice of its acquiescence in the Federal 
    Register. 57 FR 45769 (1992). It also announced that, from the date of 
    the decision, it would apply the cap only to entries secured by cash 
    deposits in AD cases. However, the Department never amended its 
    regulations to be consistent with this position.
        In 1992, the CIT followed its Taiwan television decision on the cap 
    in a case involving televisions from Korea. (Daewoo I) Respondents 
    appealed the decision on this issue to the Federal Circuit.
        Although not directly before it, the Federal Circuit reviewed the 
    reasoning in the Zenith decision while deciding Daewoo II. The Federal 
    Circuit disagreed with the Zenith reasoning. It found that the statute 
    does not prohibit the application of the cap to bonds, that the 
    Department's interpretation was reasonable, and it overruled the CIT's 
    decision. On September 30, 1994, the Federal Circuit held that the 
    Department's regulation was valid, and that the cap can apply where 
    duties are secured by bonds as well as cash deposits. In footnote 17 of 
    its decision, the Federal Circuit noted with respect to the 
    Department's Federal Register notice:
    
        After the Court of International Trade issued its opinion in 
    Zenith II [in 1991], Commerce indicated that it would follow that 
    holding, but prospectively only. The court here rejected that 
    limitation [to cash deposits]. In view of our resolution of this 
    issue, the changed regulation may have prospective application only 
    [from October 5, 1992 forward].
    
        Thus, the Federal Circuit, erroneously treating our public notice 
    as an amendment to the Department's regulations, held that the 
    ``amended regulation'' could only be applied prospectively from the 
    date it was adopted, October 5, 1992. It was not valid during the time 
    between the CIT decision in Zenith and the date of the Federal Register 
    notice. The Department's Federal Register notice, however, did not 
    amend its original regulation; it only stated that it did not intend to 
    appeal the Zenith decision and
    
    [[Page 27317]]
    
    would change its practice. Therefore, the original regulation remained 
    valid from the date the CIT overturned it to the present.
        In addition, on October 21, 1994, when the Zenith decision became 
    final, the CIT vacated its original 1991 decision in Korean televisions 
    with regards to the cap. Zenith, Slip Op. 94-170.
    
    Section 351.213
    
        Section 351.213 deals with administrative reviews under section 
    751(a)(1) of the Act. We received a few comments concerning 
    Sec. 351.213.
        Publication of preliminary dumping margins: One commenter suggested 
    that the Department refrain from including individual, company-specific 
    preliminary dumping margins in its published notices of preliminary 
    results of review. We have not adopted this suggestion, because, in our 
    view, section 777(i)(2)(A)(iii)(II) of the Act requires that individual 
    margins be included in the published notice of preliminary results.
        Deferral of administrative reviews: To reduce burdens on parties 
    and the Department, in proposed Sec. 351.213(c) the Department 
    established a procedure by which the Secretary could defer the 
    initiation of an administrative review for one year if (i) the request 
    for review was accompanied by a request that the Secretary defer the 
    review; and (ii) no relevant party to the proceeding objected. One 
    commenter strongly supported this proposal, but two commenters opposed 
    it. According to the two opponents, deferral of reviews lacks a 
    statutory basis, is inconsistent with legislative intent, and may not 
    result in a reduction of burdens. In addition, the opposing commenters 
    argued that the requirement that no party object to deferral is an 
    inadequate procedural safeguard. They claim that the Department may 
    apply pressure on petitioners to acquiesce in requests for deferrals, 
    citing instances in which petitioners have requested postponements of 
    final determinations as an accommodation to the Department.
        After considering the comments, we have left Sec. 351.213(c) 
    unchanged, except for (1) minor revisions to paragraph (c)(1)(ii) aimed 
    at improving the clarity of that provision; and (2) an addition to 
    paragraph (c)(3) that extends the deadline in Sec. 351.301(b)(2) for 
    submitting factual information. As stated by the commenter supporting 
    the change, we believe that the deferral process will save ``time and 
    money, for both the Department and the parties.'' In addition, we do 
    not think that it is inconsistent with the statute or legislative 
    intent to defer a review for one year where all parties consent. As for 
    the claim that the ``no objection'' requirement is an inadequate 
    safeguard, while it is true that the Department, at times, may take the 
    initiative in suggesting that parties request postponements or 
    extensions, the Department does not ``pressure'' parties into 
    submitting such requests. In the case of a request for a deferral, if a 
    deferral is not in the interests of a particular party, that party will 
    be free to object without risk of any adverse consequences.
        Rescissions of administrative reviews: Commenting on proposed 
    Sec. 351.213(d)(1) and its 90-day limit on withdrawals of a request for 
    a review, one commenter suggested that the provision be modified so as 
    to allow the Department to rescind an administrative review after the 
    90-day period has expired if (1) the party that initially requested the 
    review withdraws its request, and (2) no other party objects to the 
    rescission within a reasonable period of time. According to the 
    commenter, such a rule would avoid the burden and expense of completing 
    reviews that none of the parties want.
        We agree that the 90-day limitation may be too rigid. However, we 
    believe that the Department must have the final say concerning 
    rescissions of reviews requested after 90 days in order to prevent 
    abuse of the procedures for requesting and withdrawing a review. For 
    example, we are concerned with the situation in which a party requests 
    a review, the Department devotes considerable time and resources to the 
    review, and then the party withdraws its requests once it ascertains 
    that the results of the review are not likely to be in its favor. To 
    discourage this behavior, the Department must have the ability to deny 
    withdrawals of requests for review, even in situations where no party 
    objects.
        Therefore, in Sec. 351.213(d)(1), we have retained the 90-day 
    requirement. In addition we have added a new sentence, taken from 19 
    CFR Secs. 353.22(a)(5) and 355.22(a)(3), that essentially provides that 
    if a request for rescission is made after the expiration of the 90-day 
    deadline, the decision to rescind a review will be at the Secretary's 
    discretion.
        Extension of review period: One commenter suggested that if the 
    Department has the authority to defer the initiation of an 
    administrative review, it follows that it has the authority to begin an 
    administrative review early, or to extend the period of a particular 
    review beyond one year. This commenter stated that in certain 
    industries where prices change rapidly, it is important to have duty 
    deposit rates that are as current as possible. The commenter suggested 
    a revision to proposed Sec. 351.213(e)(1) that would permit the 
    Secretary to extend the period of an administrative review, for good 
    cause shown, up to the date on which questionnaire responses are due.
        We believe that the regulation, as drafted, is sufficiently 
    flexible to address these concerns in extraordinary circumstances. 
    Section 351.213(e)(1)(i) states that the period of review ``normally'' 
    will be linked to the anniversary month of the order. The use of 
    ``normally'' indicates that the Secretary has the discretion to use 
    some other period in appropriate circumstances, but the Department will 
    exercise this discretion only in very unusual circumstances.
        Duty absorption: Proposed paragraph (j) established administrative 
    review procedures for analyzing antidumping duty absorption. We have 
    made several changes to paragraph (j) in response to the comments 
    received.
        Timing of the absorption inquiry: Three commenters argued that 
    proposed paragraph (j)(1) was unlawful to the extent that it allowed 
    for absorption inquiries during reviews other than those occurring in 
    the second and fourth years following the publication of an AD order. 
    In response, two other commenters argued that section 751(a)(4) of the 
    Act does not preclude parties from requesting, or the Department from 
    conducting, a duty absorption inquiry during administrative reviews 
    other than the second and fourth. One of these two commenters further 
    argued that the retention of the authority to conduct absorption 
    inquiries in any review would prevent automatic filings of requests by 
    petitioners in the second and fourth reviews.
        A sixth commenter asserted that for orders entered in 1993, section 
    751(a)(4) provides for duty absorption determinations in reviews 
    commenced in 1995 and 1997. Therefore, in the view of this commenter, 
    proposed paragraph (j)(1) is inconsistent with the statute to the 
    extent that it provides for absorption inquiries in reviews commencing 
    in 1996 and 1998.
        We have not revised paragraph (j)(1) in light of these comments. 
    Paragraph (j)(1), in accordance with section 751(a)(4), provides for 
    the conduct, upon request, of absorption inquiries in reviews initiated 
    two and four years after the publication of an AD order. As noted by 
    the commenters, paragraph (j)(1) also provides for such inquiries in
    
    [[Page 27318]]
    
    reviews initiated in the second and fourth years following the 
    continuation of an AD order as the result of a sunset review under 
    section 751(c) of the Act. The reason for this schedule is that (1) 
    duty absorption findings are intended for use in the five-year sunset 
    reviews conducted by the Department and the Commission (see SAA at 
    885), and (2) there will be subsequent sunset reviews of AD orders that 
    remain in place following the completion of an initial sunset review 
    (see section 751(a)(c)(1)(C) of the Act). Moreover, section 751(a)(4) 
    does not preclude the Department from conducting absorption inquiries 
    in reviews initiated in the second and fourth years after continuation.
        With respect to the comment concerning AD orders published in 1993, 
    under section 751(c)(6)(C) of the Act, these orders constitute 
    ``transition orders'' because they were in effect on January 1, 1995, 
    the date on which the WTO Agreement became effective with respect to 
    the United States. Under section 751(c)(6)(D) of the Act, the 
    Department is to treat transition orders, such as the 1993 orders in 
    question, as being issued on January 1, 1995. Therefore, paragraph 
    (j)(2) properly permits absorption inquiries for transition orders to 
    be requested in any administrative review initiated in 1996 or 1998, 
    because these are the second and fourth years after the date on which 
    transition orders are deemed to be issued.
        Who can request an absorption inquiry: We have modified paragraph 
    (j)(1) to clarify that only domestic interested parties may request a 
    duty absorption inquiry. This is consistent with the Department's view 
    that one exporter or producer may not request an administrative review 
    of another exporter or producer.
        Deadline and content of request: Two commenters supported as 
    reasonable the Department's proposal to impose a deadline of 30 days 
    after initiation on requests for absorption inquiries. One of these 
    commenters also suggested that the Department require requests for 
    absorption inquiries to be made on a respondent-specific basis.
        Two other commenters argued that the Department should eliminate 
    the 30-day deadline. One of these two commenters argued that the 30-day 
    requirement was not reasonable in cases in which the necessary evidence 
    of absorption is already before the Department. The other commenter 
    stated that, because a respondent's questionnaire response would not be 
    available to a domestic interested party within the first 30 days of an 
    administrative review, the Department should extend the request period 
    until after the date on which questionnaire responses are filed.
        A fifth commenter suggested that requests for duty absorption 
    inquiries should contain legitimate and substantial evidence of duty 
    absorption. In response, two other commenters argued that the 
    Department should not impose any special burden on a party requesting 
    an absorption inquiry, and that any such burden would be contrary to 
    section 751(a)(4).
        With respect to these comments, we agree with the commenters who 
    stated that the 30-day deadline is reasonable. No change in the 
    deadline is necessary, because any domestic interested party requesting 
    an absorption inquiry will not have to supply any information to the 
    Department other than the name(s) of the respondent(s) to be examined 
    for duty absorption.
        We also agree with the suggestion that absorption inquiry requests 
    be respondent-specific, and we have made appropriate revisions to 
    paragraph (j)(1). In the Department's view, a requirement that the 
    request identify the respondents to be examined is not unreasonable, 
    and such a requirement will spare the Department the burden of 
    conducting an absorption inquiry of respondents in which the domestic 
    industry is not interested.
        Finally, we have not adopted the suggestion that requests for duty 
    absorption inquiries must be accompanied by evidence of duty 
    absorption. In our view, any such requirement would be contrary to 
    section 751(a)(4).
        Substantive criteria: One commenter argued that the Department 
    should set forth in the regulations substantive criteria regarding duty 
    absorption. This commenter further proposed that as part of these 
    criteria, the Department should give an exporter or producer credit for 
    negative dumping margins.
        A second commenter agreed with the need for substantive criteria, 
    and argued that the Department should find duty absorption whenever an 
    affiliated entity pays either estimated or final antidumping duties. 
    This commenter also asserted that the regulations should state 
    expressly that a finding of absorption does not result in the treatment 
    of the absorbed duties as a cost in the Department's calculations of 
    dumping margins.
        A third commenter, also supporting the promulgation of substantive 
    criteria, suggested that the Department must develop a ``bright-line'' 
    test to review and examine intracompany transfers of capital. This 
    commenter also asserted that the Department should make clear that the 
    duty absorption provision applies only to final, assessed antidumping 
    duties, not to estimated antidumping duty deposits.
        We have not adopted the suggestions that we promulgate substantive 
    duty absorption criteria. The Department will need experience with 
    absorption inquiries before it is able to promulgate such criteria. 
    However, we have added a new paragraph (j)(3) that clarifies that the 
    Department will limit the absorption inquiry to information pertaining 
    to antidumping duties determined in the administrative review in which 
    the absorption inquiry is requested. In our view, this limitation flows 
    directly from the objective of section 751(a)(4), which is to identify 
    producers or exporters that have affiliated importers and that continue 
    to dump while the affiliated importer pays the antidumping duties. See, 
    S. Rep. No. 412, 103d Cong., 2d Sess. 44 (1994). Limiting the inquiry 
    in this manner precludes any approach to duty absorption that attempts 
    to measure the degree to which the duties determined in a prior review 
    period were passed on to unaffiliated purchasers, and precludes basing 
    absorption on estimated antidumping duty deposits.
        Exception from assessment of duties in regional industry cases: In 
    light of the revised procedure for obtaining an exception from the 
    assessment of duties in regional industry cases, discussed above in 
    connection with Sec. 351.212, we have added a new paragraph (l) that 
    cross-references Sec. 351.212(f).
        Administrative reviews of CVD orders conducted on an aggregate 
    basis: With respect to requests for zero rates in administrative review 
    of CVD orders that are conducted on an aggregate basis, we revised 
    paragraph (k)(1)(iv) to clarify that in the case of a non-producing 
    exporter, the foreign government must certify that neither the exporter 
    nor the exporter's supplier received more than de minimis subsidies 
    during the review period.
    
    Section 351.214
    
        Proposed Sec. 351.214 established procedures for conducting new 
    shipper reviews, a new type of review provided for in section 
    751(a)(2)(B) of the Act. We received several comments concerning new 
    shipper reviews, some of which related to Sec. 351.214 and some of 
    which related to other sections. For ease of discussion, we will 
    address here those comments concerning other sections.
        Initiation of a new shipper review: Three commenters suggested that 
    the regulations clarify that the Department may initiate a new shipper 
    review based
    
    [[Page 27319]]
    
    on an irrevocable offer for sale. They argue that if an irrevocable 
    offer is considered sufficient for purposes of initiating an 
    investigation, it should be considered sufficient for purposes of 
    initiating a new shipper review. In addition, they argued that the 
    statute does not preclude this approach, and they cited to one instance 
    in which the Department allegedly initiated a new shipper review based 
    on an irrevocable offer. Another commenter, however, argued in response 
    that the statute precludes the initiation of a new shipper review in 
    the absence of a sale or entry during the relevant review period, 
    although the commenter did not cite the particular provision of the 
    statute containing this preclusion. Yet another commenter suggested 
    that the Department clarify that a person can request a new shipper 
    review as long as there is a bona fide sale of subject merchandise to 
    the United States, even if that merchandise has not yet been shipped to 
    or entered the United States.
        We agree that the Department should clarify the basis on which an 
    exporter or producer may request a new shipper review. Therefore, in 
    paragraph (b), we have added a new paragraph (b)(1) and have renumbered 
    the remainder of paragraph (b) accordingly. Under paragraph (b)(1), an 
    exporter or producer may request a new shipper review if it has 
    exported subject merchandise to the United States or if it has sold 
    subject merchandise for export to the United States. Thus, an exporter 
    or producer may request a new shipper review prior to the entry of 
    subject merchandise.
        We have not adopted the suggestion that an irrevocable offer for 
    sale would suffice for purposes of initiating a new shipper review. 
    First, as discussed above in connection with Sec. 351.102(b) and the 
    definition of ``likely sale,'' we have deleted the irrevocable offer 
    standard from the regulations. More generally, however, we do not 
    believe it appropriate to base a new shipper review on anything short 
    of a sale. The initiation of new shipper reviews and the issuance of 
    questionnaires requires an expenditure of administrative resources by 
    the Department that is not inconsiderable when cumulated across all AD/
    CVD proceedings. In our view, the Department should not expend these 
    resources unless there is a reasonable likelihood that there ultimately 
    will be a transaction for the Department to review; namely, as 
    discussed below, an entry and sale to an unaffiliated purchaser. In the 
    case of an offer, because the offer may or may not result in a sale, we 
    do not believe that there is a sufficient likelihood of an eventual 
    entry and sale to warrant the expenditure of resources on the 
    initiation of a new shipper review.
        The same commenter requested that the regulations clarify that one 
    shipment or sale is sufficient for a new shipper to be entitled to a 
    review, assuming that the other requirements of Sec. 351.214(b) are 
    satisfied. While we do not disagree with the proposition that a new 
    shipper review may be initiated based on a single transaction, we 
    believe that the regulation, as proposed, makes this clear. As 
    discussed below, we have revised Sec. 351.214(f)(2) to provide that the 
    Secretary may rescind a new shipper review if there ``has not been an 
    entry and sale.'' In our view, the use of the singular indicates that a 
    single transaction is sufficient for purposes of initiating and 
    completing a new shipper review.
        Citing the possibility of meritless claims for new shipper reviews, 
    one commenter, referring to proposed paragraph (b) (now paragraph 
    (b)(2)), suggested that the Department require additional documentation 
    from an exporter claiming to be a new shipper. Specifically, this 
    commenter stated that the Department should require: (1) Documentation 
    concerning the exporter's offers to sell merchandise in the United 
    States; (2) documentation identifying the exporter's sales activities 
    in the United States; (3) an identification of the complete 
    circumstances surrounding the exporter's sales to the United States, as 
    well as any home market or third country sales; (4) in the case of a 
    non-producing exporter, an explanation of the exporter's relationship 
    with its producer/supplier; (5) an identification of the exporter's 
    relationship to the first unrelated U.S. purchaser; and (6) a 
    certification from the purchaser that it did not purchase the subject 
    merchandise from the exporter during the POI of the original 
    investigation. Another commenter opposed this suggestion.
        While the Department has no interest in dealing with meritless 
    claims for new shipper reviews, by the same token, we do not want to 
    discourage meritorious claims. The information requirements that this 
    commenter would impose might discourage legitimate new shippers from 
    requesting new shipper reviews. Moreover, some of the information 
    sought (e.g., the complete circumstances surrounding an exporter's home 
    market or third country sales) appears to be of little relevance in 
    determining whether an exporter is a new shipper to the United States. 
    Therefore, we have not adopted this suggestion.
        Another commenter questioned the implication, in the case of a CVD 
    proceeding, that the foreign government will be required to provide a 
    full response to a Department questionnaire. Presumably, the commenter 
    was referring to proposed Sec. 351.214(b)(5) and the requirement that a 
    person requesting a new shipper review certify that it ``has informed 
    the government of the exporting country that the government will be 
    required to provide a full response to the Department's 
    questionnaire.'' According to the commenter, if the foreign government 
    cooperated during the original CVD investigation and provided a full 
    response to the Department's questionnaire, another questionnaire 
    response would not be necessary.
        We have not revised Sec. 351.214(b)(5) in light of this comment, 
    because it overlooks the fact that the period of review in a new 
    shipper review will be different from the POI of the original CVD 
    investigation. Therefore, just as in the case of an administrative 
    review, the Department will require information from the foreign 
    government concerning any countervailable subsidies conferred during 
    the period of review. In addition, as stated in the AD Proposed 
    Regulations, the purpose of this particular certification requirement 
    is ``to minimize situations in which [the Department] will be forced to 
    rely upon the facts available.'' 61 FR at 7318.
        Completion of a new shipper review: One commenter suggested that 
    the Department clarify that a sale to an unaffiliated person along with 
    an entry during the review period should be a prerequisite for 
    completing a new shipper review. This commenter interpreted the 
    references in proposed Sec. 351.214(f)(2) to ``entries, exports, or 
    sales'' as indicating that the Department might complete a new shipper 
    review even in the absence of an entry and sale to an unaffiliated 
    person during the review period.
        In drafting proposed Sec. 351.214, our intent was that the 
    Department would complete a new shipper review only if there were an 
    entry during the review period and a sale to an unaffiliated person. 
    However, we appreciate that proposed Sec. 351.214(f)(2), as drafted, 
    does not accurately reflect this intent. Therefore, we have revised 
    Sec. 351.214(f)(2) to clarify this particular point.
        Another commenter suggested that the Department modify proposed 
    Sec. 351.214(f)(2) to allow a review to continue if there were no 
    entries during the review period but an entry occurred within 30 days 
    after initiation. We have not adopted this suggestion. The
    
    [[Page 27320]]
    
    Department does not disagree with the notion that the Secretary should 
    have the discretion to expand the review period in appropriate cases. 
    However, given our lack of experience with this new procedure, we are 
    reluctant to select 30 days as the relevant cut-off point for all 
    cases. There may be cases in which the cut-off point should be greater 
    or lesser than 30 days. In our view, Sec. 351.214(f)(2)(ii) 
    appropriately provides the Department with a more flexible approach for 
    dealing with the types of problems envisioned by the commenter.
        Conduct of new shipper reviews: One commenter also suggested that 
    the regulations should provide that, in each new shipper review, the 
    Department will send a questionnaire to the U.S. customer seeking 
    information concerning the bona fide nature of the new shipper 
    transaction. According to the commenter, such an approach would 
    safeguard against new shippers conspiring with an unaffiliated U.S. 
    customer to engage in a single transaction at a high price that would 
    generate a dumping margin and deposit and assessment rates of zero. 
    Again, another commenter opposed this suggestion.
        We have not adopted this suggestion, because we believe that the 
    statutory and regulatory schemes provide adequate safeguards against 
    such manipulation, should it actually occur. It bears emphasis that in 
    the scenario described by the commenter, a new shipper obtaining a 
    dumping margin of zero would not be excluded from the order. Instead, 
    its merchandise would remain subject to the AD order, and if the new 
    shipper later began to sell at dumped prices, antidumping duties could 
    be assessed with interest for any underpayment of estimated duties.
        The same commenter made a suggestion regarding proposed 
    Secs. 351.221(b)(3) and 351.307(b)(iv), which together provide that the 
    Department will conduct a verification in a new shipper review if the 
    Secretary determines that good cause for verification exists. The 
    commenter suggested that the regulations clarify that it will be the 
    Department's normal practice to conduction a verification in a new 
    shipper review.
        We have not adopted this suggestion. While new shipper reviews 
    constitute a new procedure, new shippers themselves are not a new 
    phenomenon. Under the former statutory and regulatory scheme, the 
    Department reviewed new shippers and assigned them their own rates in 
    the context of reviews under section 751(a)(1) of the Act (now defined 
    in Sec. 351.102(b) as ``administrative reviews''). Under this scheme, 
    the Department would not automatically conduct a verification in any 
    review that involved a new shipper. We do not believe that the creation 
    of a separate review mechanism for new shippers, in and of itself, 
    warrants a departure from this practice. In addition, making 
    verification the norm in all new shipper reviews would impose a 
    considerable administrative burden on the Department. For these 
    reasons, therefore, we have not adopted the suggestion.
        A different commenter suggested that the regulations provide that 
    the new shipper review period always will encompass all shipments of 
    the subject merchandise made by the new shipper during the period 
    preceding initiation of the review. This commenter cited the situation 
    in which, in an AD proceeding, a new shipper waits until the end of the 
    year following its first shipment to request a review. Because, 
    according to the commenter, the period of review in an AD new shipper 
    review may be the six-month period immediately preceding the 
    anniversary or semiannual anniversary month, the review would not 
    capture shipments, including the first shipment, made in the first six 
    months. In addition, the commenter argued that in a CVD proceeding, 
    because, under proposed Sec. 351.214(g)(2), the normal new shipper 
    review period would be the most recently completed calendar year, a 
    shipment made before initiation but outside the calendar year would not 
    be captured in the review period.
        We have not adopted this suggestion, because we do not believe it 
    is necessary. In the case of AD proceedings, while Sec. 351.214(c) 
    permits a new shipper to wait one year before requesting a review, it 
    does not require a new shipper to do so. A new shipper can ensure that 
    its first shipment is covered by submitting a request for a review at 
    the earliest possible date. Moreover, in the case of new shipper 
    reviews initiated after the anniversary month of an order, the period 
    of review normally will be twelve, not six, months.
        In the case of CVD proceedings, while it is possible that a review 
    period based on the most recently completed calendar year may not 
    capture a new shipper's first shipment because that shipment occurs 
    after the calendar year in question, we believe that 
    Sec. 351.213(e)(2), which is cross-referenced in Sec. 351.214(g)(2), 
    and Sec. 351.214(f)(2)(ii) provide the Department with sufficient 
    flexibility to resolve any problems that may arise by modifying the 
    standard review period.
        This commenter also claimed that proposed paragraph (g) creates an 
    anomaly by providing for different review periods for AD and CVD 
    proceedings. The commenter suggested that the Department revise 
    paragraph (g) so that the review periods for both AD and CVD new 
    shipper reviews coincide.
        The Department does not see any ``anomaly,'' because the POI and 
    POR for AD and CVD investigations and reviews normally are different. 
    See Secs. 351.204(b) and 351.213(e). Moreover, the commenter did not 
    offer any explanation as to why they should be identical. Therefore, we 
    have not adopted this suggestion.
        Deadlines for completing new shipper reviews: Another commenter, 
    apparently referring to proposed Sec. 351.214(d), contended that the 
    timing of initiation of new shipper reviews was not consistent with the 
    intent that new shippers be accorded expedited reviews. This commenter 
    urged the Department to treat new shipper reviews more expeditiously, 
    and alleged that the AD Agreement provides for such reviews at any time 
    after an order is issued.
        We have not adopted this suggestion, because, in our view, 
    Sec. 351.214(d) is consistent with section 751(a)(2)(B)(ii) of the Act, 
    which, in turn, is consistent with Article 9.5 of the AD Agreement. 
    Article 9.5 does not prescribe exactly when an authority must commence 
    a new shipper review, but simply requires that such a review be 
    ``initiated * * * on an accelerated basis, compared to normal duty 
    assessment and review proceedings in the importing Member.'' This is 
    precisely what section 751(a)(2)(B)(ii) and Sec. 351.214(d) accomplish, 
    because they provide for initiation on an accelerated basis as compared 
    to an administrative review.
        A different commenter suggested that to ensure that the Department 
    completes new shipper reviews within the statutory deadlines, the 
    regulations should provide that a new shipper would no longer have to 
    post a bond or make a cash deposit for subject merchandise if a new 
    shipper review extends beyond 270 days. According to the commenter, 
    such a provision is necessary because a new shipper allegedly has no 
    effective judicial remedy if a review extends beyond the 270-day 
    period. We have not adopted this suggestion, because we do not believe 
    that the Department has the authority (and the commenter does not cite 
    to any authority) to do what the commenter suggests.
        Bonding requirements: One commenter, presumably referring to 
    proposed Sec. 351.214(e), suggested that instead of permitting the 
    posting of
    
    [[Page 27321]]
    
    bonds (in lieu of cash deposits) only when the Secretary initiates a 
    new shipper review, the Department should permit the posting of bonds 
    to be suspended immediately upon acceptance of a request for a new 
    shipper review. We have not adopted this suggestion, because section 
    751(a)(2)(B)(iii) of the Act provides that the Secretary may direct the 
    Customs Service to allow the posting of a bond ``at the time a review * 
    * * is initiated. * * *''
        Another commenter suggested that upon the initiation of a new 
    shipper review, the new shipper should have the option of replacing its 
    estimated duty deposits with a bond or other security. Specifically, 
    this commenter suggested that in the case of merchandise entered prior 
    to the initiation of the new shipper review, the Department should 
    direct the Customs Service to refund all estimated duty deposits with 
    interest, provided that the new shipper replaces those deposits with a 
    bond or other security. We have not adopted this suggestion, because it 
    is required by neither the statute nor the AD Agreement, and its 
    implementation would result in a considerable administrative burden for 
    the Department and the Customs Service.
        Citing to proposed Sec. 351.214(e) and the importer's option to 
    post a bond in lieu of a cash deposit, one commenter suggested that the 
    regulations provide for the payment of interest on liquidation, even 
    where the importer has opted to post bond in lieu of cash deposits. We 
    have not adopted this suggestion, because it would be inconsistent with 
    the Department's general approach that interest may not be imposed 
    where an importer has posted a bond or other security in lieu of a cash 
    deposit. The Federal Circuit sustained this approach in The Timken Co. 
    v. United States, 37 F.3d 1470 (1994), and the commenter did not offer 
    any justification for applying a different approach in the context of 
    new shipper reviews.
        Duty assessments: One commenter suggested that the Department 
    revise Sec. 351.214 so as to ensure that the rate determined in a new 
    shipper review will apply to any entries that occurred before the new 
    shipper review period. The commenter proposed changes to paragraphs (b) 
    and (g).
        We have not adopted this suggestion, because we do not believe that 
    it is necessary. Although Sec. 351.214 gives a new shipper the option 
    of waiting for up to one year before requesting a new shipper review, 
    it does not require a new shipper to do so. A new shipper can ensure 
    that its initial shipments are covered by the rates determined in a new 
    shipper review by promptly requesting a new shipper review at a 
    sufficiently early date.
        Multiple reviews: One commenter objected to proposed 
    Sec. 351.214(j), which deals with situations where there are multiple 
    reviews (or requests for review) of merchandise from a particular 
    exporter or producer. According to the commenter, a new shipper should 
    be guaranteed a new shipper review when multiple reviews covering the 
    same merchandise are requested. The commenter cited Article 9.5 of the 
    AD Agreement and the requirement that new shippers must have an 
    opportunity for a review ``on an accelerated basis, compared to normal 
    duty assessment and review proceedings in the importing Member.'' The 
    commenter argued that the objective of Article 9.5 would be thwarted if 
    the Department chose to terminate or not initiate a new shipper review 
    in favor of a more protracted administrative review. The commenter 
    proposed revised language that would have guaranteed a new shipper 
    review if the request for review was made within six months of the 
    first shipment. If the request was made later than six months and the 
    merchandise already was the subject of a different type of review, the 
    Secretary could decline to initiate a new shipper review.
        With respect to this suggestion, we are mindful of the requirements 
    of Article 9.5. In drafting a solution to the problem of multiple 
    reviews, our intent was to provide the Secretary with sufficient 
    flexibility so that the Secretary could opt to use the review mechanism 
    that, in light of the facts, would be most likely to provide a new 
    shipper with its own rate at the earliest possible date. Therefore, we 
    believe that our objective was not inconsistent with that of the 
    commenter.
        On the other hand, as noted previously, new shipper reviews are a 
    new procedure with which we have little experience. In our view, the 
    proposal suggested by the commenter may be too rigid to accommodate all 
    of the possible permutations that may arise in actual cases. Therefore, 
    we have not adopted the suggestion, and have left Sec. 351.214(j) 
    somewhat open-ended in terms of the Secretary's discretion. We should 
    emphasize again, however, that our intent is that the Secretary will 
    exercise this discretion in a manner that provides a new shipper with 
    its own individual rate at the earliest possible date.
        Expedited reviews in CVD proceedings for noninvestigated exporters: 
    In proposed paragraph (k), the Department established procedures for 
    expedited reviews in CVD proceedings of exporters that the Department 
    did not individually examine in the original CVD investigation. Upon 
    further review, we have made several revisions to paragraph (k).
        First, we have consolidated proposed paragraphs (k)(1) and (k)(2) 
    into a single paragraph (k)(1). Paragraph (k)(1) continues to require 
    that a request for review be submitted within 30 days of the date of 
    publication in the Federal Register of the countervailing duty order. 
    In addition, instead of providing for the initiation of paragraph (k) 
    reviews in the semi-annual anniversary month or the anniversary month, 
    in a revised paragraph (k)(2) we have provided that the Secretary will 
    initiate a review in the month following the month in which a request 
    for review is due.
        Second, we have made certain changes to paragraph (k)(3) to better 
    reflect the distinctions between a paragraph (k) review and a new 
    shipper review. Under paragraph (k)(3)(i), the period of review will be 
    the period of investigation used by the Secretary in the investigation 
    that gave rise to the CVD order. This change will enable the Department 
    to use government data from the original investigation, thereby 
    enabling the Department to truly expedite the review. The objective is 
    to provide a noninvestigated exporter with its own cash deposit rate 
    prior to the arrival of the first anniversary month of the order, at 
    which point the exporter may request an administrative review. In this 
    regard, in paragraph (k)(3)(iii) we have clarified that the final 
    results of a paragraph (k) review will not be the basis for the 
    assessment of countervailing duties, except, of course, under the 
    automatic assessment provisions of Sec. 351.212(c).
        Finally, because the Department will be reviewing the original 
    period of investigation, we have provided in paragraph (k)(3)(iv) for 
    the exclusion from a CVD order of a firm for which the Secretary 
    determines an individual countervailable subsidy rate of zero or de 
    minimis. However, the Secretary will not exclude an exporter unless the 
    information on which the exclusion is based has been verified.
        One commenter made two comments concerning proposed 
    Sec. 351.214(k). First, the commenter questioned the basis for not 
    extending the opportunity to post bonds to reviews conducted under 
    Sec. 351.214(k). Second, the commenter questioned the implication that 
    the foreign government will be required to provide a full response to 
    the Department's questionnaire.
    
    [[Page 27322]]
    
        With respect to the first comment, we have not extended the 
    opportunity to post a bond to these types of reviews because this 
    option is not required by either the statute or the SCM Agreement. With 
    respect to the second comment, for the reasons discussed in the 
    preceding paragraph, we do not agree with the comment. However, the 
    comment has identified a lack of precision in proposed (k)(1) regarding 
    the information to be provided by an exporter requesting a review of 
    this type. Therefore, we have added a new paragraph (k)(1)(iii) to 
    clarify that an exporter must certify that it has informed the 
    government of the exporting country that it will be required to provide 
    a full questionnaire response.
        One commenter argued that paragraph (k) should be extended to 
    permit expedited reviews of exporters that were not investigated in an 
    antidumping investigation. With respect to this comment, as stated in 
    the AD Proposed Regulations, paragraph (k) implements Article 19.3 of 
    the SCM Agreement. 61 FR at 7318. Article 19.3 requires expedited 
    reviews for exporters that were not ``actually investigated'' in a CVD 
    investigation. Because the AD Agreement does not contain a similar 
    requirement, we have continued to limit paragraph (k) to CVD 
    proceedings.
        Exception from assessment of duties in regional industry cases: In 
    light of the revised procedure for obtaining an exception from the 
    assessment of duties in regional industry cases, discussed above in 
    connection with Sec. 351.212, we have added a new paragraph (l) that 
    cross-references Sec. 351.212(f).
    
    Section 351.216
    
        Section 351.216 deals with changed circumstances reviews under 
    section 751(b) of the Act. In connection with Sec. 351.216, one 
    commenter suggested that the Department should adopt objective criteria 
    for determining changed circumstances that would take into account the 
    best interests of the current American industry rather than merely the 
    interests of the petitioner. The commenter then described a series of 
    scenarios for which, the commenter claimed, the regulations do not 
    provide express answers. The commenter appeared to be focusing on so-
    called ``no-interest revocations.'' According to the commenter, the 
    regulations, as drafted, provide a petitioner with a veto.
        We have not revised the regulations in light of this comment, 
    because we believe that the proposed regulations adequately take into 
    account the interests of domestic producers other than the petitioner. 
    First, Sec. 351.216(b) provides that any interested party may request a 
    changed circumstances review. Therefore, U.S. producers other than the 
    petitioner may request such a review. Second, insofar as no-interest 
    revocations are concerned, Sec. 351.222(g)(1)(i) states that the lack 
    of interest must be expressed by ``[p]roducers accounting for 
    substantially all of the production of the domestic like product to 
    which the order (or the part of the order to be revoked) or suspended 
    investigation pertains.* * *'' Thus, a petitioner does not acquire a 
    ``veto'' due to its status as petitioner.
        Another commenter suggested that Sec. 351.216 be revised so as to 
    provide for a determination as to whether the domestic industry 
    supports the continuation of an order. We have not adopted this 
    suggestion, because it is inconsistent with legislative intent to 
    preclude reconsideration of support for a petition after the initiation 
    of an investigation. See sections 702(c)(4)(E) and 732(c)(4)(E) of the 
    Act; SAA at 863.
        Several commenters argued that the Department's existing regulatory 
    procedures inadequately deal with situations of short supply. These 
    commenters proposed a number of substantive and procedural changes in 
    the areas of revocation, changed circumstances reviews, and temporary 
    relief. Other commenters opposed the creation of a regulatory short 
    supply provision. The commenters expressed concern that such a 
    provision would undermine the AD/CVD law by creating a huge loophole, 
    raising the cost of AD/CVD procedures, and interfering with the 
    economic impact of an order. These commenters argued that a short 
    supply provision would allow unfair low prices to continue and thereby 
    thwart U.S. companies from renewing production in those products. The 
    commenters also argued that no statutory authority exists in U.S. law 
    to create a short supply provision.
        With respect to revocation, several commenters suggested that the 
    Department codify in the regulations its authority to revoke an order 
    (or terminate a suspended investigation) in part with respect to 
    particular products included within the scope of an order or suspended 
    investigation. Another commenter proposed that demonstration of a lack 
    of domestic availability would create a rebuttable presumption that the 
    continued inclusion of the product within an order does not serve the 
    purpose for which AD/CVD relief is granted, and, unless the petitioning 
    industry rebutted the presumption, the Department would revoke the 
    order with respect to the particular product. The commenter proposed 
    also that the regulations set forth specific standards and procedures 
    that would allow parties to demonstrate that a product covered by an 
    order is not available domestically.
        With respect to changed circumstances reviews, several commenters 
    proposed that the regulations be amended to provide that lack of 
    domestic availability of a product constitutes a ``changed 
    circumstance'' sufficient to warrant a changed circumstance review. 
    Other commenters proposed that the regulations provide that the mere 
    allegation of lack of domestic availability is sufficient to trigger a 
    changed circumstances review. Commenters also proposed that lack of 
    domestic availability or, alternatively, an allegation of lack of 
    domestic availability, should constitute ``good cause'' under section 
    751(b)(4) of the Act to initiate a changed circumstances review less 
    than two years after the issuance of an order or the suspension of an 
    investigation.
        Several commenters specifically objected to the proposal that lack 
    of domestic availability alone would trigger the initiation of a 
    changed circumstances review. These commenters argued that a lack of 
    interest or consent by the petitioning industry should be the only 
    factor relevant to the decision to initiate a changed circumstances 
    review of products alleged to be unavailable domestically. Other 
    commenters argued that an express lack of interest in continuing the 
    order is required to show ``good cause.'' They argued that, especially 
    in the first two years after issuance of an order, industries that had 
    been injured by dumped imports would be unable to begin or renew 
    production if they continued to confront dumped goods.
        Additionally, with respect to changed circumstances reviews, 
    several commenters proposed specific regulatory deadlines governing the 
    initiation and completion of changed circumstances reviews in cases 
    based on lack of domestic availability. Another commenter also 
    suggested that the Department adopt internal deadlines now and consider 
    regulatory deadlines at a later date. Certain commenters also suggested 
    that the Department revise its regulations to allow industrial users or 
    consumers to file requests for changed circumstances reviews with 
    respect to particular products covered by an order or suspended 
    investigation.
        With respect to temporary relief, several commenters proposed that 
    the Department establish procedures that
    
    [[Page 27323]]
    
    provide for temporary relief in appropriate cases. In a similar vein, 
    one commenter suggested that in the case of a suspension agreement 
    based on quantitative restraints, the regulations should require the 
    inclusion of a provision in the agreement that would permit the 
    Department to suspend temporarily quantitative restrictions on the 
    import of particular products that are not available domestically.
        As is clear from these comments, the issues raised under the rubric 
    of ``domestic availability'' represent the positions of parties with 
    conflicting interests. The Department believes, however, that it is 
    possible to provide relief to industries from unfair trade practices 
    while also ensuring that products in which the affected industry has no 
    interest are properly removed from, or not included in the scope of an 
    order. As discussed in more detail below, through administrative 
    practice, the Department has developed procedures that, in our view, 
    adequately address the interests of both domestic producers and 
    domestic users. In these regulations, we have modified some of these 
    procedures in light of the comments received. In addition, we have 
    created two new procedures specifically to address parties' concerns. 
    Both the new and modified procedures are designed to ensure that 
    products in which the affected industry has no interest are removed 
    from, or not included in the scope of an order, without undermining the 
    Department's ability to effectively enforce the AD/CVD law.
        Two important new procedures we will implement are intended to 
    avoid, in the first instance, situations where products in which the 
    domestic industry has no interest are included in the scope of an 
    order. These new procedures will, at the outset of a proceeding, focus 
    on the proposed scope of an investigation. The Department believes that 
    early attention to product coverage issues will alleviate the need to 
    revisit these issues in the future.
        First, we will include in our checklist of items raised to 
    petitioners during pre-filing consultations, whether the proposed scope 
    of a proceeding is an accurate reflection of the product for which the 
    domestic industry is seeking relief. The Department's experience, in 
    some cases, has been that proposed product coverage may be 
    unintentionally over inclusive. This situation typically arises in 
    cases where the proposed scope of an investigation is worded broadly or 
    covers numerous HTS classification subheadings including subject and 
    nonsubject merchandise. Raising these types of coverage issues during 
    the pre-filing consultation period will give petitioners the 
    opportunity to focus the scope on those products causing injury to the 
    domestic industry. The resulting refined scope will contain a more 
    accurate reflection of intended product coverage. In addition, the 
    Department believes that beginning an investigation with more carefully 
    defined scope language and tariff classifications will reduce the need 
    to address product coverage issues later during the course of the 
    proceeding.
        Even after reconsideration of product coverage based on pre-filing 
    consultations, petitioners may not be aware that the scope is over 
    inclusive until U.S. purchasers have an opportunity to review the scope 
    language and tariff classifications. As a result, as a second new 
    procedure, we also will set aside a specific period early in an 
    investigation for issues regarding product coverage to be raised. This 
    new specific comment period will provide parties with ample opportunity 
    to address product coverage issues. Petitioners will then have the 
    opportunity to reconsider product coverage and the Department can amend 
    the scope of the investigation if warranted. Given the timing of any 
    amendments, the ITC may be able to take the refined scope into account 
    in defining the domestic like product for injury purposes. In addition, 
    early amendment will partially alleviate the reporting burden on 
    respondents and avoid suspension of liquidation and posting of bonds or 
    cash deposits on products of no interest to petitioners.
        No regulations are needed to implement these two new procedures. We 
    believe that affirmatively addressing product coverage, both pre-filing 
    and early in an investigation, is the single most effective means to 
    address the parties' concerns. This approach results in less ambiguity 
    over coverage and avoids problems inherent in later clarifications and 
    modifications to an order. In addition, resolution of product coverage 
    issues early in a proceeding reduces costs for all parties by 
    diminishing the necessity for later changed circumstances reviews or 
    scope inquiries.
        With respect to revocation, we believe that, as a matter of 
    administrative practice, the Department's authority to issue such 
    partial revocations or terminations already is well-established. For 
    example, in New Steel Rail, Except Light Rail, from Canada, 61 FR 11607 
    (March 21, 1996), the Department issued a partial revocation with 
    respect to certain 100 lb. rail. Similarly, in Certain Cut-to-Length 
    Carbon Steel Plate from Canada, 61 FR 7471 (Feb. 28, 1996), the 
    Department issued a partial revocation with respect to certain cobalt 
    60-free steel. To make clear the Department's commitment to the use of 
    this established authority, we have codified this practice in section 
    351.222 (g). The Department, however, has not adopted the commenters' 
    suggestions with respect to temporary relief because we believe that 
    prompt and permanent revocation (or termination), where warranted by 
    the facts, has been an adequate mechanism and is one which provides 
    greater predictability for all parties. We will continue to consider 
    the efficacy of our approach as this issue arises in individual cases.
        We have not adopted the proposal that demonstration of lack of 
    domestic availability creates a rebuttable presumption that, unless 
    rebutted by the petitioning industry, would lead to automatic 
    revocation of the order with respect to a particular product. Shifting 
    the burden of proof would constitute a dramatic change from the 
    Department's current practice.
        We also have not adopted the proposal that lack of domestic 
    availability, or an allegation thereof, constitutes a ``changed 
    circumstance'' sufficient to warrant a changed circumstances review. 
    Nor have we adopted the proposal that lack of, or the alleged lack of 
    domestic availability automatically constitutes ``good cause'' to 
    initiate an expedited changed circumstances review. The Department has 
    an established practice of partially revoking an order after a changed 
    circumstances review in certain situations where an interested party 
    has alleged that a product should not be subject to an order and the 
    petitioner or the domestic industry expresses a lack of interest in 
    continuing the order with respect to the particular product. 
    Furthermore, the Department has, in appropriate circumstances, 
    initiated a changed circumstances review less than two years after the 
    issuance of an order where the petitioners agreed there was ``good 
    cause'' to conduct a review with respect to a particular product. See 
    Flat Panel Displays from Japan, 57 FR 58791 (1992). We believe that 
    Department practice, therefore, can adequately meet the needs of both 
    the domestic industry and the domestic users of the particular product.
        With respect to the suggestion that the Department adopt specific 
    regulatory deadlines for changed circumstances reviews in cases where 
    an interested party has alleged that a particular product should not be 
    subject to an order, we agree that a deadline for
    
    [[Page 27324]]
    
    initiation is appropriate, and we have revised Sec. 351.216(b) to 
    provide for a 45-day deadline for initiation decisions. In addition, we 
    recognize that the Department can complete changed circumstances 
    reviews more quickly in cases in which there is agreement on the 
    issues. Therefore, we have revised Sec. 351.216(e) to require the 
    Secretary, in such cases, to issue final results of review within 45 
    days after initiation. As revised, these regulations would permit the 
    Secretary to issue final results within, roughly, 90 days of the 
    receipt of a request for review. However, because changed circumstances 
    reviews, by their nature, are fact-specific and often involve unique 
    issues, we continue to believe that in situations where there is no 
    agreement on the issues, a deadline of 270 days is appropriate for the 
    completion of a changed circumstances review.
        Finally, the Department has not adopted the suggestion that 
    industrial users or consumers be allowed to file requests for changed 
    circumstances reviews because we believe that it would conflict with 
    the statutory scheme contemplated by Congress. Section 751(b)(1) of the 
    Act refers only to requests for a changed circumstances review from an 
    ``interested party.'' In addition, the Act and the SAA make a clear 
    distinction between ``interested parties'' and other participants in an 
    AD/CVD proceeding. On the other hand, section 751(b)(1) of the Act 
    permits the Department to self-initiate a changed circumstances review 
    when it ``receives information * * * which shows changed circumstances 
    sufficient to warrant a review. * * * '' Nothing in these regulations 
    alters the Department's authority under that provision. Despite 
    statements that section 751(b) of the Act puts industrial users at a 
    disadvantage with regard to supply concerns, the Department's 
    experience has been that the requirements of the section have not 
    prevented requests for changed circumstance reviews.
    
    Section 351.218
    
        Section 351.218 deals with sunset reviews under section 751(c) of 
    the Act. We received a few comments concerning different aspects of 
    Sec. 351.218.
        Initiation of sunset reviews: One commenter noted that proposed 
    Sec. 351.218(c) fails to account for sunset reviews other than the 
    first sunset review. We agree that this oversight should be corrected, 
    and we have revised paragraph (c) accordingly. In addition, we also 
    have added a reference in paragraph (c) to the statutory provisions 
    governing the initiation of sunset reviews of transition orders.
        Another commenter suggested that the Department amend paragraph (c) 
    to ensure that the intent of initiating a sunset review prior to the 
    start of the last year of an order is made clearer. We have not revised 
    paragraph (c) in light of this comment, because, in our view, the 
    regulation already is clear that the Secretary, in certain 
    circumstances, may issue an early initiation of a sunset review.
        Sunset review procedures: One commenter argued that there should be 
    no routine issuance of questionnaires in sunset reviews, and noted that 
    the proposed regulations were ambiguous on this point. The commenter 
    observed that proposed Sec. 351.221(b)(2), which applies to reviews 
    generally, calls for the issuance of questionnaires in every case. On 
    the other hand, proposed Sec. 351.221(c)(5)(i), which deals with sunset 
    reviews in particular, provides that the notice of initiation of a 
    sunset review will contain a request for information described in 
    section 751(c)(2) of the Act. According to the commenter, these 
    information requests may obviate the need for the Department to issue 
    questionnaires.
        Although we have yet to conduct an actual sunset review, we agree 
    with the commenter that it may not be necessary to issue questionnaires 
    in every sunset review. Accordingly, we have revised Sec. 351.221(c)(5) 
    by adding a new paragraph (iii) which permits the Secretary to refrain 
    from issuing the questionnaires called for by Sec. 351.221(b)(2). Of 
    course, the Secretary would retain the discretion to issue 
    questionnaires in sunset reviews in appropriate situations.
        The same commenter also argued that because it is not anticipated 
    that parties will have to submit much additional factual information in 
    a sunset review, there should be no need for the Department to conduct 
    verifications in sunset reviews. However, the commenter noted, proposed 
    Sec. 351.307(b)(1)(iii) requires a verification if the Department 
    determines to revoke an order as the result of a sunset review. The 
    commenter argued that verification should occur only for good cause, 
    and that Sec. 351.307(b)(1)(iii) should be revised to refer only to 
    revocations under section 751(d)(1) of the Act, and not to revocations 
    under section 751(d)(2) resulting from a sunset review.
        We have not adopted this suggestion, because section 782(i)(2) of 
    the Act provides that the Department will verify all information relied 
    upon in making ``a revocation under section 751(d) of the Act'' 
    (emphasis added). Thus, section 782(i)(2) does not distinguish between 
    revocations under section 751(d)(1) and revocations under section 
    751(d)(2).
        Finally, this commenter suggested that the Department amend 
    proposed Sec. 351.218(e)(2) to set forth specifically the time limits 
    for transition orders. We have not adopted this suggestion. Because the 
    schedule in section 751(c)(6) of the Act for conducting sunset reviews 
    of transition orders refers to the completion of activity by both the 
    Department and the Commission, we believe it more appropriate to simply 
    include in paragraph (e)(2) a reference to the relevant provisions of 
    the statute.
        Substantive guidelines: Three commenters suggested that 
    Sec. 351.218 should include standards and guidelines for determining 
    the likelihood of dumping in a sunset review. (One of these commenters 
    actually submitted its comment in connection with Sec. 351.222(i)). One 
    commenter simply noted the absence of standards and guidelines. 
    However, the other commenter, proceeding from the premise that there is 
    an internationally agreed preference for the revocation of old orders, 
    made specific suggestions concerning the contents of standards and 
    guidelines. At a minimum, this commenter suggested, the regulations 
    should incorporate the relevant discussion from the SAA. A third 
    commenter essentially suggested that the regulations should put the 
    burden of proof on the domestic industry, and that the Department 
    should consider arguments from petitioners valid only if the 
    preponderance of the evidence supports their claim.
        We have not adopted these suggestions. Due to our lack of 
    experience with sunset reviews, we do not believe it appropriate at 
    this time to elaborate in regulations on the substantive standards to 
    be applied in determining whether dumping would be likely to continue 
    or resume if an order were revoked. As for the suggestion that we 
    incorporate into the regulations relevant language from the SAA, as 
    noted previously, we generally have refrained from repeating in these 
    regulations the language of the statute or the SAA.
        We should note, however, that we do not agree with the statement by 
    the one commenter that there is an internationally agreed preference 
    for the revocation of old orders. The commenter does not elaborate on 
    the precise source of this preference, and we do not find one in either 
    the AD Agreement or the SCM Agreement. All that these agreements 
    require is that
    
    [[Page 27325]]
    
    national authorities periodically review an order or suspended 
    investigations to determine whether the maintenance of the order or 
    suspended investigation is necessary to remedy injurious dumping or 
    countervailable subsidization. In addition, we find no basis in either 
    the statute or the agreements for placing the burden of proof on the 
    domestic industry.
    
    Section 351.221
    
        Section 351.221 deals with review procedures. In paragraph 
    (c)(7)(i) of this section, we moved the word ``will'' from that 
    paragraph to the beginning of paragraph (c)(7).
        We received one comment concerning Sec. 351.221(b), in which the 
    commenter stated that the regulation should provide that the results of 
    a review include the Department's factual and legal bases for the 
    determination. As noted previously in connection with a related 
    comment, we have not included this requirement in the regulations 
    because it already is clearly provided for in section 777(i) of the 
    Act.
        One commenter suggested that proposed Sec. 351.221(c)(4) should be 
    revised so as to provide for the issuance of preliminary results of 
    review in the case of Article 8 Violation and Article 4/Article 7 
    reviews under section 751(g) of the Act and Sec. 351.217. According to 
    the commenter, while the Department should conduct these special 
    reviews on an expedited basis, this objective can be preserved without 
    eliminating an ``essential step'' in the review process.
        We have not adopted this suggestion. In the case of an Article 8 
    Violation review, the review will be premised on a WTO ruling that the 
    foreign government in question has violated its international 
    obligations concerning the notification and use of so-called ``green 
    light'' subsidies. In our view, in this situation, it is important to 
    act as quickly as possible in order to provide the relevant domestic 
    industry the relief to which it is entitled.
        In the case of Article 4/Article 7 reviews, we also believe that 
    swift action is essential to ensure that the United States promptly 
    implements its international obligations in situations where the United 
    States has prevailed in a dispute under Article 4 or Article 7 of the 
    SCM Agreement. Moreover, we believe that Article 4/Article 7 reviews 
    will be sufficiently straightforward so as to obviate the need for the 
    issuance of preliminary results.
    
    Section 351.222
    
        Section 351.222 deals with the revocation of orders and the 
    termination of suspended investigations. We received several comments 
    relating to certain aspects of Sec. 351.222.
        Intervening periods: In proposed Sec. 351.222 (b) and (c), the 
    Department retained the requirement of the former regulations that an 
    order or suspended investigation may be revoked or terminated based on 
    the absence of dumping for three consecutive years or the absence of 
    countervailable subsidization for three (or in some cases five) 
    consecutive years. However, in proposed Sec. 351.222(d), the Department 
    established a new procedure under which a review of an ``intervening 
    year'' would not be necessary if (1) the Department conducted a review 
    of the first and third (or fifth) years and found no dumping or 
    countervailable subsidization for those time periods; and (2) the 
    Secretary is satisfied that during the unreviewed intervening years 
    there were exports to the United States in commercial quantities of 
    subject merchandise. As the Department explained, the purpose of 
    paragraph (d) was to reduce the Department's workload by removing the 
    incentive for companies to request reviews that they otherwise might 
    not request.
        Several commenters supported paragraph (d), while others opposed 
    it. All of the commenters opposing paragraph (d) argued that it would 
    not reduce the Department's workload, because if the first 
    administrative review of an order or suspended investigation resulted 
    in a rate of zero, the domestic industry likely would request a review 
    in the second period to ensure that there was no dumping or 
    subsidization during intervening years. In addition, one opposing 
    commenter argued that paragraph (d) would allow a respondent to engage 
    in significant dumping and still secure revocation. Another commenter 
    suggested that a domestic interested party might not be in a position 
    to know whether a particular producer is selling in commercial 
    quantities. Yet another commenter argued that in cases where the 
    Department relied on sampling and applied sample rates to non-sampled 
    companies, there would be no basis for assuming that the non-sampled 
    companies were not dumping in the beginning and ending years, or in the 
    intervening years.
        Having considered these comments carefully, we have retained 
    paragraph (d). While it may be true that in many instances a domestic 
    industry will request a review of an intervening year to ensure that 
    dumping margins or countervailable subsidy rates did, in fact, remain 
    at zero, we believe that there also will be cases where the domestic 
    industry, based on its own knowledge of what is going on in the 
    marketplace, will refrain from requesting a review because it is 
    satisfied that dumping or countervailable subsidization has ceased. In 
    terms of the Department's workload, this constitutes an improvement 
    over the existing situation, in which a respondent must request a 
    review for each year in order to obtain a revocation or termination.
        As for the argument that a respondent might engage in significant 
    dumping during an intervening year, one of the opponents of paragraph 
    (d) admits that a domestic interested party could request a review if 
    it believed that this was taking place. Similarly, while a domestic 
    interested party may not know the precise volumes sold by a particular 
    company, we believe, based on our experience, that domestic interested 
    parties generally are sufficiently aware of marketplace developments so 
    as to know whether a company is selling in commercial quantities. 
    Finally, with respect to the comment concerning sampling, any sample 
    used by the Department must be statistically valid. Therefore, we do 
    not believe that it is illogical to extrapolate the results of sampling 
    in the beginning and ending years to intervening years.
        One commenter suggested that if paragraph (d) is retained, the 
    Department should revise various paragraphs in Sec. 351.222(e) so as to 
    require, in addition to the certifications already required, that a 
    request for revocation be accompanied by information concerning the 
    volume and value of exports of subject merchandise during the initial 
    period of investigation and each of the last three (or five) 
    consecutive years. We have not adopted this suggestion, because we do 
    not believe that this information needs to be provided at the same time 
    as the request for revocation is submitted. However, the Department 
    intends to request this type of information in the course of its review 
    of the ending year in the three-or five-year period. Such information 
    would be necessary to fulfill the requirement of Sec. 351.222(d)(1) 
    that the Secretary ``must be satisfied that, during each of the three 
    (or five) years, there were exports to the United States in commercial 
    quantities of the subject merchandise to which a revocation or 
    termination will apply.''
        Turning to supporters of paragraph (d), one supporter suggested 
    certain amendments. First, the commenter suggested that the Department 
    eliminate the requirement of commercial shipments during intervening 
    years. According to the commenter, the presence of shipments during the
    
    [[Page 27326]]
    
    intervening years is irrelevant because the U.S. industry would not 
    have been the victim of dumped or subsidized imports, and the available 
    evidence from the first and last reviews would indicate that AD or CVD 
    rates were not a factor in the absence of imports and that dumping or 
    subsidization had ceased.
        We have not adopted this suggestion, because we do not accept the 
    premise that the absence of shipments in the intervening years is 
    irrelevant. The underlying assumption behind a revocation based on the 
    absence of dumping or countervailable subsidization is that a 
    respondent, by engaging in fair trade for a specified period of time, 
    has demonstrated that it will not resume its unfair trade practice 
    following the revocation of an order. If the respondent is not selling 
    in commercial quantities characteristic of that company or industry for 
    the duration of the specified period, this assumption becomes weaker.
        Moreover, we believe that it is reasonable to presume that if 
    subject merchandise, shipped in commercial quantities, is being dumped 
    or subsidized, domestic interested parties will react by requesting an 
    administrative review to ensure that duties are assessed and that cash 
    deposit rates are revised upward from zero. If domestic interested 
    parties do not request a review, presumably it is because they 
    acknowledge that the subject merchandise continues to be fairly traded. 
    However, neither presumption can be made when merchandise is not being 
    shipped in commercial quantities.
        This same commenter also suggested that paragraph (d) be revised so 
    as to permit more than one intervening unreviewed year in an AD 
    proceeding or more than three unreviewed years in a CVD proceeding. 
    According to the commenter, there may be reasons why a respondent might 
    not request revocation at the earliest possible opportunity, such as 
    cash flow difficulties that would preclude the respondent from 
    incurring the expense of a review, or the respondent simply might miss 
    the deadline for requesting a review. The Department agrees with this 
    suggestion and has revised paragraphs (d)(2), (e)(1)(iii), 
    (e)(2)(ii)(C), and (e)(2)(iii)(C) accordingly.
        Revocation based on absence of review requests: In the AD Proposed 
    Regulations, the Department eliminated its prior ``sunset revocation'' 
    procedures based on the absence of requests for administrative reviews. 
    These procedures previously were set forth in 19 CFR Secs. 353.25(d)(4) 
    and 355.25(d)(4). One commenter asked that the Department reconsider 
    its elimination of these types of revocations.
        The Department has reconsidered this matter, but continues to 
    believe that these types of revocations should be eliminated. The 
    procedures called for by Secs. 353.25(d)(4) and 355.25(d)(4) result in 
    a considerable administrative burden on Department staff, a burden that 
    is unnecessary in light of the new sunset review procedure contained in 
    section 751(c) of the Act and Sec. 351.218 of these regulations.
        Nonproducing exporters: As in the case of exclusions, in the AD 
    Proposed Regulations, 61 FR at 7319, the Department requested 
    additional public comment on the issue of whether there should be 
    special revocation rules for firms, such as trading companies, that 
    export, but do not produce, subject merchandise. We noted that one 
    alternative would be to limit any revocation of a nonproducing exporter 
    to the subject merchandise produced by those producers that supplied 
    the exporter prior to revocation. The comments we received on this 
    issue mirrored those concerning special exclusion rules for 
    nonproducing exporters. For the same reasons discussed above with 
    respect to exclusions, the Department believes it is appropriate to 
    normally limit the revocation of a nonproducing exporter to that 
    exporter's exports of subject merchandise produced by those producers 
    that supplied the exporter during the years that formed the basis for 
    the revocation. Therefore, we have added paragraphs (b)(3) and (c)(4) 
    to provide that the partial revocation of an order with respect to a 
    nonproducing exporter will be limited to that exporter's exports of 
    subject merchandise produced or supplied by those companies that 
    supplied the exporter during the time period that formed the basis for 
    the revocation.
        Other changes: In paragraph (g)(3)(vii), we corrected a 
    typographical error. Also, we revised the structure of paragraph (j) to 
    conform to Federal Register drafting guidelines.
    
    Section 351.224
    
        Section 351.224 deals with the disclosure of calculations and 
    procedures for the correction of ministerial errors.
        Section 351.224(b) provides for automatic disclosure normally 
    within five days after the date of public announcement of the 
    preliminary or final determination or final results of review. One 
    commenter proposed that the regulations provide for release of 
    disclosure materials on the same day that the Department releases its 
    determination or results, and that comments on clerical errors be due 
    10 days thereafter. Another commenter proposed that the regulations 
    permit disclosure of draft preliminary determinations and draft final 
    determinations and results of review, and provide for filing of 
    comments identifying ministerial errors, prior to their public 
    announcement. A third commenter proposed that the regulations permit 
    disclosure and correction of ministerial errors before publication of 
    the Department's determination or results of review because an 
    interested party may file an appeal immediately upon publication of the 
    final, effectively removing jurisdiction from the Department and hence 
    requiring litigation and court approval for correction of ministerial 
    errors.
        We have not adopted these proposals. In response to concerns about 
    needless litigation arising out of lengthy review of ministerial error 
    allegations, the Department has streamlined the disclosure and 
    ministerial error correction process by providing a 30-day time frame 
    for response to ministerial error allegations. While nothing prevents 
    the Department from, for example, releasing disclosure materials on the 
    day of public announcement, it is unlikely given the amount of work 
    necessary to prepare the Federal Register notice, draft decision 
    memoranda, finalize the computer programs, assemble the disclosure 
    materials, etc., that the Department would be able to shorten the 
    timing of disclosure even further.
        Section 351.224(c) provides for filing of comments regarding 
    ministerial errors. Paragraph (c)(1) indicates that the Department will 
    not consider comments concerning ministerial errors made in the 
    preliminary results of review. One commenter proposed that the 
    regulations clarify that while the Department will not amend 
    preliminary results to correct ministerial errors, it will consider 
    comments concerning ministerial errors made in preliminary results in 
    parties' case briefs. The commenter is concerned that the language in 
    the proposed regulation suggests that the Department is prohibited from 
    considering comments concerning ministerial errors until after the 
    final results have been issued. The Department agrees that the language 
    in the proposed regulation could be misconstrued. It was not our 
    intention to suggest that the Department would not consider comments 
    concerning ministerial errors made in preliminary results of review 
    during the course of
    
    [[Page 27327]]
    
    the review. Rather, we meant only to indicate that the Department will 
    not issue amended preliminary results to correct ministerial errors. 
    Therefore, we have adopted the commenter's proposal and have amended 
    the regulation to clarify that we will consider comments concerning 
    ministerial errors made in a preliminary results of a review in a 
    party's case brief. The alleged errors, therefore, will be addressed in 
    the final results of review.
        Two commenters proposed that the proposed regulations be amended to 
    provide for correction of ministerial errors in preliminary results 
    calculations because of ``significant commercial harm'' caused by 
    publication of erroneous preliminary dumping margins in administrative 
    reviews. We have not adopted this proposal. As the Department explained 
    in the preamble to the proposed regulations, unlike a preliminary 
    determination in an investigation, which may result in the suspension 
    of liquidation and the imposition of provisional measures, a 
    preliminary results of review has no immediate legal consequences. See 
    61 FR at 7321. As a result, a more judicious use of Department 
    resources is to correct any ministerial errors made in a preliminary 
    results of review in the final results. The Department is unable to 
    comment on the commenters' concern that not correcting ministerial 
    errors in preliminary results of review results in ``significant 
    commercial harm'' because the commenters offered no examples or further 
    explanation as to what they meant.
        Section 351.224(c)(3) establishes the time limits for filing 
    replies to comments. One commenter proposed that the regulations permit 
    the filing of responses to allegations of ministerial errors in the 
    context of preliminary determinations because the proposed timetable 
    provides sufficient time for the Department to analyze such responses 
    in addition to the original submissions. We have not adopted this 
    proposal. Paragraph (c)(3) provides that replies to comments must be 
    filed not later than five days after the date on which such comments 
    are filed. There is an exception for replies to comments in connection 
    with a significant ministerial error in a preliminary determination. As 
    the Department explained in the preamble to the proposed regulations, 
    because of greater time constraints due, in part, to the fact that 
    Department personnel conduct verification soon after the announcement 
    of a preliminary determination, the Department will not consider 
    replies to comments in a preliminary determination. See 61 FR at 7321. 
    Given the short time between public announcement of a preliminary 
    determination and departure for verification, the Department disagrees 
    with the commenter's suggestion that the proposed timetable provides 
    sufficient time for the Department to analyze replies to comments in a 
    preliminary determination. Any reply that a party wishes to make 
    should, therefore, be included in that party's case brief so that the 
    Department may address the reply in its final determination.
        Section 351.224(e) provides for the analysis of any comments 
    received and the announcement of the issuance of a correction notice 
    normally not later than 30 days after the date of public announcement 
    of the Department's preliminary or final determination or final results 
    of review. One commenter proposed that the proposed regulations be 
    modified to provide for announcement of the Department's decision on 
    ministerial error allegations no later than 25 days after publication 
    of the final in the Federal Register. Another commenter expressed 
    strong support for the 30-day time frame set forth in the proposed 
    regulations. The Department has not made any changes to the provision. 
    A period of 30 days after the date of public announcement (the 
    Department's regulation) or 25 days after publication in the Federal 
    Register (the commenter's proposal) is roughly the same because there 
    are typically three to seven days between the date of public 
    announcement of a Department decision and the date of publication of 
    that decision in the Federal Register. We have chosen to tie the 
    deadline for issuance of a correction notice to the date of public 
    announcement because the other deadlines in the ministerial regulation 
    are also tied to the date of public announcement.
        Sections 351.224(g) and (f) define ministerial error and 
    significant ministerial error, respectively. One commenter proposes 
    that the regulations clarify that ministerial errors do not include 
    ``substantive'' errors, i.e., errors which call a data submission into 
    question in terms of basic accuracy or credibility. The commenter also 
    proposed that the regulations state explicitly that parties are not 
    allowed to submit new evidence beyond the time frame for submitting 
    information to show or deny the existence of an error.
        The Department has not adopted these proposals. The provisions of 
    Sec. 351.224--covering disclosure of the Department's calculations and 
    procedures for correction of ministerial errors--only apply to 
    ministerial errors, as defined in paragraphs (f) and (g), and, hence, 
    only to errors made by the Department. Errors made by respondents in 
    their submissions to the Department, such as transposing digits as a 
    result of a data input error or other computer errors resulting in the 
    omission of data cited as examples by the commenter, are not governed 
    by the provisions of Sec. 351.224. Prior to the deadline for submission 
    of factual information, the Department's practice normally is to accept 
    a respondent's correction of an error in its own data because the 
    Department has time to review, analyze, and where applicable, verify 
    the corrected data. Where a respondent alleges an error in its own data 
    only after the deadline for submission of factual information, 
    frequently after the preliminary determination or results of review, 
    the Department's longstanding practice has been to correct the 
    respondent's own clerical errors only if the Department can assess from 
    information already on the record that an error has been made, that the 
    error is obvious from the record, and that the correction is accurate. 
    See, e.g., Industrial Belts and Components and Parts Thereof, Whether 
    Cured or Uncured, From Italy, 57 FR 8295, 8297 (1992). In light of the 
    Federal Circuit's decision in NTN Bearing Corp. v. United States, Slip 
    Op. 94-1186 (1996), however, the Department is in the process of 
    reevaluating its policy for correcting clerical errors of respondents. 
    We believe that it is appropriate to develop such a policy through 
    practice. See Certain Fresh Cut Flowers From Colombia, 61 FR 42833, 
    42833-34 (August 19, 1996) (proposing a number of conditions under 
    which we would accept corrections of a respondent's own clerical 
    error). As a result, we do not believe that a regulation on this issue 
    would be appropriate at this time.
    
    Section 351.225
    
        Section 351.225 details the procedural and substantive rules for 
    scope rulings, including rulings involving the anticircumvention 
    provisions of section 781 of the Act. We have noted below the few 
    changes made from the AD Proposed Regulations.
        Suspension of liquidation: In connection with proposed paragraph 
    (l), a number of commenters urged that, contrary to previous practice 
    and the proposed regulation, the Department should suspend liquidation 
    of possibly affected entries at the time of the formal initiation of a 
    scope inquiry, and that this suspension should continue unless and 
    until the Department makes a final negative ruling. These commenters 
    argued that proposed paragraph (l) is
    
    [[Page 27328]]
    
    contrary to the purpose of the statute, which is designed to provide 
    relief from imports of merchandise that, in the context of a scope 
    inquiry, the Department already has determined to have been dumped. 
    They noted that because scope rulings only clarify, and do not expand, 
    the scope of an order, the Department must view any merchandise that it 
    determines to be within the scope of an order as always having been 
    within the scope. Therefore, they asserted, the Department should 
    suspend liquidation when it initiates a formal scope inquiry (if 
    liquidation is not already suspended), and this suspension should apply 
    to all unliquidated entries. Finally, these commenters argued that the 
    Department should terminate suspension of liquidation only upon the 
    issuance of a negative final determination.
        Another commenter suggested that to help address the problem of 
    imports escaping the assessment of duties, the Department should impose 
    a deadline on the formal initiation of scope inquiries following the 
    receipt of a request for a scope ruling or an anticircumvention 
    inquiry. In addition, one commenter asked the Department to specify 
    that the suspension of liquidation and the imposition of a cash deposit 
    requirement will apply prospectively from the date of an affirmative 
    scope ruling. Other commenters supported the suspension of liquidation 
    provisions in proposed paragraph (l).
        The Department believes that, for the most part, the suspension of 
    liquidation rules in paragraph (l) are appropriate and has not changed 
    them. Suspension of liquidation is an action with a potentially 
    significant impact on the business of U.S. importers and foreign 
    exporters and producers. The Department should not exercise this 
    governmental authority before it has first given all parties a 
    meaningful opportunity to present relevant information and defend their 
    interests, and before the Department gives a reasoned explanation for 
    its action. Formal initiation of a scope inquiry by the Department 
    represents nothing more than a finding by the Department that it cannot 
    resolve the issue on the basis of the plain language of the scope 
    description or the clear history of the original investigation. It 
    would be extremely unfair to importers and exporters to subject entries 
    not already suspended to suspension of liquidation and possible duty 
    assessment with no prior notice and based on nothing more than a 
    domestic interested party's allegation. Because, when liquidation has 
    not been suspended, Customs, at least, and perhaps the Department as 
    well, have viewed the merchandise as not being within the scope of an 
    order, importers are justified in relying upon that view, at least 
    until the Department rules otherwise. Therefore, the Department will 
    not order the suspension of liquidation until it makes either a 
    preliminary or final affirmative scope ruling, whichever occurs first.
        Nonetheless, the Department is cognizant of the concerns expressed 
    on this issue by representatives of domestic interested parties. In 
    particular, the Department is concerned that significant delays in 
    initiating scope inquiries can be harmful. Accordingly, we have amended 
    paragraph (c), in accordance with a suggestion made by one commenter, 
    to impose a time limit of 45 days, from the date of receipt of a 
    request for a scope ruling, on the determination whether to initiate a 
    formal scope inquiry under Sec. 351.225. This deadline will apply to 
    all scope requests, including requests relating to circumvention. 
    Although the Department will continue to resolve scope questions, where 
    it can, on the basis of the plain language of the scope description and 
    the clear history of the original investigation without initiating a 
    formal inquiry, the Department will do so in 45 days or less.
        In further recognition of the concerns expressed by domestic 
    interested parties, the Department also has revised paragraph (l) to 
    make a suspension of liquidation, when ordered in conjunction with a 
    preliminary or final affirmative ruling, effective as to entries of all 
    affected merchandise that are made on or after the date of initiation 
    of the scope inquiry and that remain unliquidated as of the date of 
    publication of the affirmative ruling.
        Anticircumvention/Major input rule: Several commenters noted a 
    discrepancy between proposed paragraphs (g) and (h) relating to the 
    application of the ``major input'' rule under section 773(f)(3) of the 
    Act. Under proposed paragraph (g), which deals with products completed 
    or assembled in the United States, the application of the major input 
    rule was discretionary when valuing parts or components acquired from 
    an affiliated person. Under proposed paragraph (h), the application of 
    the major input rule was mandatory in dealing with products completed 
    or assembled in other foreign countries. One commenter suggested that 
    use of the major input rule be mandatory in all cases. Another 
    suggested that it be discretionary in all cases.
        The SAA at 894 states that affiliation ``* * * can result in 
    application of the major input rule * * *'' (emphasis added). 
    Therefore, the Department has revised paragraph (h) to make application 
    of the rule discretionary for purposes of both U.S. and third country 
    assembly. We also have corrected a typographical error in the last 
    sentence of paragraph (g).
        Several commenters suggested that, in applying paragraphs (g) and 
    (h), the Department should not apply the major input rule in 
    determining the value of parts and components originating in the 
    country subject to the order. They argued that the statute requires a 
    determination of whether such parts and components constitute a 
    significant percentage of the final value of the finished product. 
    Because the major input rule provides for the use of cost of production 
    to value such parts or components, use of the rule, they asserted, 
    necessarily would omit a profit element, thereby understating the value 
    of the parts or components.
        The Department has not made the change suggested by these 
    commenters. First, the SAA, as noted above, clearly contemplates the 
    use of the major input rule in appropriate circumstances. Second, the 
    statute clearly states that in dealing with inputs from affiliated 
    persons, the Department may use the higher of transfer price, market 
    value, or cost of production to ``determine the value of the major 
    input. * * *'' Thus, cost of production may be used as the basis of the 
    ``value'' of such an input. Finally, as noted above, the application of 
    the major input rule is discretionary. Should the Department encounter 
    a case in which the application of this rule would, in our judgment, be 
    inappropriate, we will explore other methods of valuing such parts or 
    components.
        Anticircumvention/Other issues: Several commenters suggested that 
    the Department should provide more definitive guidance on what 
    constitutes circumvention. One commenter suggested a ``safe harbor'' of 
    35 percent value added in determining whether the value added in a 
    process of assembly or completion in the United States or a third 
    country is ``significant.'' Another commenter suggested the adoption of 
    value-added ranges for what the Department will consider 
    ``significant'' in examining assembly or completion or assembly in the 
    United States or a third country. Another suggested that the Department 
    adopt a standard of considering production in the United States or a 
    third country as ``significant'' and simple assembly as not 
    ``significant''. Still another commenter proposed that the Department 
    develop a framework for analyzing scope issues
    
    [[Page 27329]]
    
    and a comprehensive set of factors within that framework.
        The Department has not adopted these suggestions because we believe 
    that the wide variety of products and processes encountered in AD/CVD 
    proceedings makes the adoption of any more specific standards 
    inadvisable at this time. To establish a ``safe harbor'' or specific 
    guidelines might result in the incorrect classification of substantial 
    production operations as ``insignificant'' and ``screwdriver'' 
    operations as ``significant.'' As we gain more experience, we will 
    consider promulgating more detailed rules.
        One commenter suggested that for purposes of determining whether 
    completion or assembly processes in the United States or a third 
    country are minor or insignificant, the Department should require all 
    relevant factors in sections 781(a)(2) and 781(b)(2) to be present and 
    demonstrably insignificant before finding that circumvention exists. 
    The Department has not adopted this suggestion, because we believe it 
    to be at odds with the statute, which requires only that all the listed 
    factors be taken into account. Adoption of this suggestion would, we 
    believe, restrict the application of the anticircumvention provisions 
    in a manner contrary to the intent of the law.
        Another commenter suggested that the regulations (1) provide that 
    all anticircumvention inquiries will encompass at least the four most 
    recent fiscal quarters of any respondent subject to the inquiry, and 
    (2) make verification mandatory in all anticircumvention inquiries. The 
    Department has not adopted these suggestions because we believe that 
    the exact periods appropriately covered in an anticircumvention inquiry 
    may vary widely and are best left to a case-by-case judgment. Also, 
    verification can and will be conducted whenever the Department believes 
    it appropriate, but it is unnecessary to mandate it in every case.
        One commenter argued that because the emphasis in anticircumvention 
    inquiries concerning completion or assembly in the United States or a 
    third country is now on whether that process is minor or insignificant, 
    any parts or components sourced from third countries should not be 
    included in making that judgment. We have not adopted this suggestion. 
    The commenter is correct about the change in emphasis in 
    anticircumvention inquiries. However, the Department also must 
    determine whether the value of the parts or components from the subject 
    country is a significant portion of the total value of the merchandise. 
    Any parts or components sourced from a third country necessarily form 
    part of the total value of any such merchandise.
        Another commenter suggested that the regulations make clear that 
    the requirement that merchandise circumventing an order be of the same 
    ``class or kind'' as the merchandise subject to the order be broadly 
    construed to include within the same class or kind of merchandise a 
    component and a finished product. According to the commenter, such a 
    construction is necessary to effectuate Congress' intent and is fully 
    consistent with the terms of the statute, the Department's past 
    practice and judicial precedent.
        The Department has not adopted this suggestion. As we stated in the 
    AD Proposed Regulations, 61 FR at 7322, ``the term ``class or kind'' in 
    the circumvention context is not broader than the merchandise covered 
    by an order for other purposes of the statute.
        One commenter suggested that the Department include in the 
    regulations the factors for applying section 781(c) of the Act, the 
    ``minor alterations in the merchandise'' provisions, that are 
    enumerated in the Senate Report on the URAA. The Department believes 
    that the adoption of this suggestion would be inappropriate. While the 
    Department may apply them in practice, formal adoption of them might be 
    so restrictive as to make it more difficult to reach sound decisions on 
    such questions, given the widely varying fact patterns encountered in 
    such inquiries.
        Scope procedures: One commenter suggested that the final 
    regulations clarify that the Department has the authority to self-
    initiate anticircumvention and other types of scope inquiries. 
    According to the commenter, the proposed regulation did not state 
    expressly that the Department could self-initiate a scope inquiry.
        The Department has not adopted this suggestion, because we believe 
    that the regulation as proposed is clear that the Department has the 
    authority to self-initiate an anticircumvention inquiry, as well as any 
    other type of scope inquiry. The proposed regulation makes clear that 
    the term ``scope ruling'' includes rulings relating to 
    anticircumvention, and Sec. 351.225(b) clearly provides for self-
    initiated scope inquiries.
        Another commenter requested that the four-month time limit for 
    resolving formally initiated scope inquiries run from the date of 
    receipt of a request for a ruling, not the date of initiation of an 
    inquiry. The Department believes that such a change would so compress 
    the time available for making scope decisions as to hamper our ability 
    to make decisions that are both timely and proper. Accordingly, we have 
    not adopted this suggestion. However, as noted above, we have adopted a 
    45-day time limit on the initiation of scope inquiries to ensure that 
    there are no undue delays in the resolution of scope issues.
        One commenter suggested, in the context of comments regarding scope 
    issues, that the Department establish presumptions concerning the 
    domestic unavailability of a product at issue. According to the 
    commenter, these presumptions would be based upon allegations by 
    petitioners and the products produced by them. With respect to this 
    comment, the Department has addressed it in the section of this notice 
    dealing with comments relating to lack of domestic availability.
        Another commenter suggested that the Department specify in the 
    regulations that scope rulings are clarifications, not modifications, 
    of the scope of an order. We have not adopted this suggestion, because 
    we believe that this principle is so well-established that a regulation 
    is not necessary.
        One commenter suggested that the regulations be revised to require 
    the Department, after issuing an affirmative scope ruling, to (1) 
    canvas known importers to detect covered imports, and (2) then advise 
    Customs to proceed to suspend liquidation on entries of such 
    merchandise. The same commenter requested a regulation that would 
    require immediate electronic transmission from the Department to the 
    Customs Service of all final scope rulings.
        The Department believes that a canvassing process would be an 
    enormous burden, and one that is neither contemplated in the statute or 
    its legislative history nor necessary for effective enforcement of the 
    law. Accordingly, we have not adopted this suggestion. To the extent 
    that electronic transmittals of scope rulings to the Customs Service is 
    meritorious, it is unnecessary and inappropriate to provide for this in 
    the regulations.
        Two commenters asked the Department to revise the regulations to 
    clarify that in the case of an industrial user that has participated in 
    any segment of a proceeding, the Department will include the industrial 
    user on the scope service list and will notify the industrial user of a 
    ruling under Sec. 351.225(d). With respect to this suggestion, it was 
    our intent in the proposed regulations that all persons, whether 
    interested parties, industrial users, or a representative consumer 
    group, would be included on the scope service list and would be 
    notified of
    
    [[Page 27330]]
    
    scope rulings. Therefore, we are modifying the language in paragraphs 
    (d) and (n) of Sec. 351.225 to clarify this intent.
        One commenter suggested that the Department require service on all 
    parties included on the scope service list only in the case of an 
    application for a scope ruling. This commenter suggested that other 
    documents should be served only on those parties that entered an 
    appearance in the scope inquiry. According to the commenter, proposed 
    Sec. 351.225(n) and Sec. 351.303(f) both require service of all 
    documents on all parties included on the scope service list.
        The Department does not believe that a revision of Sec. 351.225(n) 
    is necessary. In our view, paragraph (n) makes clear that the term 
    ``scope service list'' differs from the term ``service list,'' and that 
    only applications for scope rulings need to be served on all parties 
    included on the scope service list. As for service of all other 
    submitted documents, the requirements of Sec. 351.303(f) apply, which 
    require only service on parties included on the normal ``service list'; 
    i.e., those parties that have entered an appearance and, in the case of 
    business proprietary information, have obtained an APO for the 
    particular scope inquiry. As noted above, we have modified 
    Sec. 351.225(d) so that all parties included on the scope service list 
    will be notified of scope rulings.
        The same commenter made a suggestion concerning paragraph (l)(4), 
    which provides for the inclusion of a product within a pending review 
    if, within 90 days after initiation of the review, the Secretary issues 
    a final scope ruling that the product is included within the scope. The 
    commenter suggested that we should extend the 90-day period if the 
    Secretary extends the time for a preliminary determination in the 
    review.
        The Department has not adopted this suggestion because the decision 
    to extend the time for a preliminary review determination often comes 
    only a short time before the expiration of the normal time limit and 
    well after the expiration of 90 days. Therefore, we could not implement 
    the proposal in a manner that would allow the Department to request and 
    receive the needed additional information in a timely manner.
        Another commenter made a suggestion regarding proposed 
    Sec. 351.225(l)(4). Paragraph (l)(4) provides, among other things, that 
    if the Secretary determines after 90 days of the initiation of a review 
    that a product is included within the scope of an order or suspended 
    investigation, the Secretary may decline to seek sales information 
    concerning the product for purposes of the review. The commenter 
    suggested that although it may not be practicable, for purposes of an 
    ongoing review, to collect information on sales found to be within the 
    scope of an order, the Department should collect this information for 
    use in a subsequent review.
        The Department has not adopted this suggestion, because we do not 
    believe it appropriate to collect information for a review that has not 
    yet been, and may never be, requested. However, paragraph (l)(4) makes 
    clear that while the Department may not collect information regarding 
    sales of a particular product, it will not disregard those sales for 
    purposes of the ongoing review. Instead, the Department will calculate 
    dumping margins or CVD rates, and will issue appropriate assessment 
    instructions, for sales of such products on the basis of non-adverse 
    facts available. Moreover, during the next requested review, if any, 
    the Department will examine all sales of the products determined to be 
    within the scope of the order or suspended investigation that were sold 
    during the time period covered by that review.
        Finally, in connection with proposed Sec. 351.225(k), one commenter 
    suggested that the Department should revise its scope criteria by 
    developing a framework for analyzing scope issues, and then developing 
    a comprehensive set of factors within that framework. In particular, 
    according to this commenter, to provide greater certainty for 
    industrial users of merchandise that may be covered by an investigation 
    or order, the Department should include factors that examine both 
    consumption and production substitutability.
        In our view, this suggestion relates to the broader topic of 
    domestic non-availability. Accordingly, we have addressed this 
    suggestion in the portion of this notice dealing with issues relating 
    to domestic non-availability.
    
    Other Procedural Comments
    
        In addition to the comments discussed above, we received other 
    comments relating to AD/CVD procedures that were not necessarily tied 
    to a particular provision of the AD Proposed Regulations. These 
    comments are addressed below.
        Publication of remand determinations: Numerous commenters 
    representing both domestic and foreign interests suggested that the 
    Department should make remand determinations more accessible to the 
    public, although the details of the particular suggestions differed. 
    Some commenters argued that the Department should publish remand 
    determinations in the Federal Register, or at least publish a notice 
    indicating the existence of a remand determination. Others argued that, 
    at a minimum, the Department should make remand determinations more 
    easily obtainable once their existence is known.
        The Department agrees that remand determinations constitute an 
    important source of precedential material, and that currently it is 
    unduly difficult for private parties to obtain access to remand 
    determinations. Indeed, in some instances, it has proven unduly 
    difficult for Department personnel to obtain copies of these documents. 
    Therefore, we agree that new procedures are necessary.
        On the other hand, we do not agree with the assertion that, as a 
    legal matter, remand determinations must be published in the Federal 
    Register, and we are reluctant to incur the expense of such publication 
    when less expensive alternatives are available. In addition, we do not 
    believe that it is necessary to publish a Federal Register notice 
    announcing the existence of a remand determination, because the court 
    or binational panel opinion giving rise to the remand determination 
    will indicate to the public that a case has been remanded and that a 
    remand determination will be forthcoming.
        Accordingly, the Department intends to take the following steps to 
    make remand determinations more readily accessible. First, the 
    Department will place the public version of each remand determination 
    on its Internet page so that remand determinations will be available 
    electronically. While this step may not permit electronic research, if 
    there is sufficient interest in conducting such research we would 
    expect that one or more of the commercial online research systems would 
    begin to include remand determinations in their databases, just as they 
    do in the case of ITC determinations that are not published in the 
    Federal Register.
        Second, the Department will place the public version of a remand 
    determination in the public file (located in the Department's Central 
    Records Unit) for the AD/CVD proceeding to which the determination 
    pertains. In addition, to further facilitate access, the Central 
    Records Unit also will maintain a separate, chronological file 
    containing public versions of all remand determinations.
        The Department hopes that through these steps it will have 
    addressed the concerns giving rise to the comments. If these steps 
    prove to be inadequate, we
    
    [[Page 27331]]
    
    remain open to further suggestions on improvement.
        Third country AD petitions: One commenter suggested that the 
    Department include in its regulations a provision for implementing new 
    section 783 of the Act, which deals with third country antidumping 
    petitions. The commenter also suggested that any regulation should 
    expressly provide that such petitions may be filed on behalf of a 
    regional industry or industries in the third country. We have not 
    adopted this suggestion because we believe that it is more 
    appropriately addressed to the Office of the U.S. Trade Representative.
        Binding ruling procedure: A few commenters proposed that the 
    Department should institute a system for issuing binding letter rulings 
    under which persons could obtain advance rulings regarding the 
    application of the Act and the regulations to particular factual 
    scenarios. Absent misrepresented, incomplete, or changed facts, these 
    rulings would be binding for purposes of an AD/CVD proceeding, unless 
    revoked. Even when revoked, the revocation of the ruling would have 
    prospective effect only.
        We have not adopted this proposal for several reasons. First, the 
    proponents of this binding letter ruling system contemplated an 
    essentially ex parte procedure in which the Department would issue 
    binding rulings within 30 days of receipt of a request for a ruling. In 
    our view, such a procedure would conflict with the numerous procedural 
    safeguards in the Act that are designed to ensure that all sides 
    involved in an AD/CVD proceeding have an equal opportunity to affect 
    the outcome.
        These procedural shortcomings cannot be overcome by the fact that 
    parties would be able to challenge the validity of the ruling in, for 
    example, an administrative review in order to have the ruling revoked. 
    Because, under the proposal, the revocation of the ruling would have 
    prospective, rather than retroactive, effect, a successful challenger 
    still would have been denied the opportunity to have input concerning 
    the application of the AD/CVD law to imports covered by a ruling prior 
    to its revocation.
        In addition to these procedural defects, we have serious doubts as 
    to the compatibility of a binding letter ruling system with the 
    requirements of section 751(a) of the Act. Section 751(a)(2)(C) of the 
    Act provides that the Department must assess antidumping and 
    countervailing duties (and establish cash deposit rates) in accordance 
    with the results of reviews under section 751(a). Thus, a letter ruling 
    could affect the rate at which entries are liquidated only to the 
    extent that (1) the facts upon which the ruling was based are 
    consistent with the administrative record established in the review, 
    and (2) the Department adopts in the review the policies set forth in 
    the ruling. With certain limited exceptions, it is doubtful that the 
    Department could bind itself to apply the results of a letter ruling in 
    a review.
        Having said this, we would consider the adoption of a non-binding 
    ruling procedure. At this point, however, we are uncertain as to 
    whether parties would find such a procedure useful. In addition, the 
    resource requirements that such a procedure would entail could be 
    substantial. Nevertheless, we intend to continue the dialogue with 
    persons having an interest in a possible letter ruling procedure. In 
    addition, if a sufficient number of persons indicate an interest, we 
    will convene a hearing on this topic.
    
    Subpart C--Information and Argument
    
        Subpart C of part 351 deals with collection of information and 
    presentation of arguments to the Department.
    
    Section 351.301
    
        Section 351.301 sets forth the time limits for submission of 
    factual information in investigations and reviews.
        Time limits for submission of factual information in investigations 
    and reviews: Section 351.301(b)(1) provides that with respect to 
    investigations, submission of factual information is due no later than 
    seven days before the verification of any person is scheduled to 
    commence. Several commenters suggested that the deadline be revised to 
    provide for submission of factual information no later than seven days 
    before the verification of the respondent to which the information 
    applies is scheduled to commence. The commenters expressed concern that 
    the proposed regulation unjustly penalizes respondents whose 
    information will not be verified until very late in the verification 
    schedule and that where there are multiple respondents, the different 
    respondents may not be aware of the other respondents' verification 
    schedules.
        We have not adopted this suggestion. In the past there has been 
    some confusion over the deadline for submission of factual information. 
    In furtherance of the goal of simplifying the Department's procedures, 
    the regulations clarify that the deadline for submission of factual 
    information is identical for all parties. Contrary to the suggestion 
    that this penalizes respondents scheduled for verification late in the 
    verification schedule, a single deadline ensures fairness in that all 
    parties have an equal amount of time to submit factual information to 
    the Department. Furthermore, a single deadline ensures that Department 
    analysts have time to review submitted information before they depart 
    for verification, particularly where they are scheduled to perform 
    consecutive verifications of different respondents. The Department 
    recognizes the concern that different respondents may not be aware of 
    other respondents' verification schedules and, as such, will respond 
    promptly to inquiries as to the date on which the first verification is 
    scheduled to commence once that date has been set.
        Section 351.301(b)(2) provides that with respect to administrative 
    reviews, submission of factual information is due no later than 140 
    days after the last day of the anniversary month. One commenter 
    suggested that the deadline for submission of factual information in 
    administrative reviews be triggered by publication of the notice of 
    initiation as are the deadlines for submission of factual information 
    in other types of reviews. Another commenter suggested that the 
    Department allow for submission of factual information in 
    administrative reviews up to 30 days after the publication of the 
    preliminary determination. A number of commenters also suggested that 
    the Department should automatically extend the deadline for submission 
    of factual information whenever it extends the deadline for the 
    preliminary or final determinations in an administrative review.
        We have not adopted these suggestions. The deadline for submission 
    of factual information in administrative reviews is tied to the 
    anniversary month because the statutory deadlines for preliminary and 
    final determinations are tied to the anniversary month (see section 
    751(a)(3) of the Act). In contrast, the deadlines for submission of 
    factual information in other types of reviews such as new shipper, 
    changed circumstances, or sunset reviews are tied to the publication of 
    the notice of initiation because the statutory deadlines for 
    preliminary and/or final determinations in these proceedings are either 
    tied to initiation or not prescribed (see, e.g., paragraphs (a)(1)(B), 
    (b), and (c) of section 751 of the Act). Furthermore, because the 
    Department normally conducts verification prior to issuing its 
    preliminary determination in an administrative review, a deadline for 
    submission of factual information of up
    
    [[Page 27332]]
    
    to 30 days after the preliminary determination would not allow 
    sufficient time for analysis and, if necessary, further submissions 
    upon request prior to any scheduled verifications. Finally, although 
    the regulations do not provide for automatic extension of the deadline 
    for submission of factual information in reviews whenever the deadline 
    for the preliminary or final determinations is extended, the Department 
    may extend any time limit, including deadlines for submission of 
    factual information, for good cause (see Sec. 351.302). Because the 
    Department's decision to extend the deadline for its determination in 
    an administrative review may be based on the fact that, for example, 
    there are a significant number of respondents to review or a number of 
    complicated issues to resolve, automatic extension of the deadline for 
    submission of factual information might result in the filing of 
    additional information requiring further analysis and review, thereby 
    frustrating the objective of the Department to allow additional time 
    for making its determination.
        Proposed sections 351.301(b) (1)-(4) provided that where 
    verification is scheduled for a person, factual information requested 
    by verifying officials will be due no later than seven days after the 
    date on which the verification of that person is complete. Two 
    commenters suggested that the seven-day deadline be eliminated and that 
    Department analysts be allowed to establish the deadlines for such 
    submissions on a case-by-case basis. One commenter suggested in the 
    alternative that the regulations should qualify the deadline with the 
    word ``normally'' to make it clear that the deadline can be extended 
    where appropriate.
        We have not eliminated the seven-day deadline for post-verification 
    submissions; however, we have added the word ``normally'' to the 
    regulations to clarify that the deadline can be extended where 
    appropriate. The seven-day deadline provides an equal amount of time 
    for all parties to file post-verification submissions upon request and 
    provides guidance to other parties to the proceeding, including 
    petitioners, as to when such submissions can be expected. Whether or 
    not a regulation includes the qualifier ``normally,'' the Department 
    retains the authority to extend any time limit established in these 
    regulations unless precluded by statute (see Sec. 351.302(b)). As 
    stated in the preamble to the proposed regulations, ``[p]arties should 
    not draw an inference that simply because a particular deadline does 
    not explicitly address the Department's authority to extend such 
    deadline that the Department may not do so. Unless expressly precluded 
    by statute, the Secretary may extend any deadline for good cause'' (61 
    FR at 7325).
        One commenter proposed that the regulations provide that 
    petitioners are required to submit any pre-verification comments at 
    least seven days before verification. We have not adopted this 
    proposal. There is no limitation on the submission of comments--as 
    opposed to new factual information--prior to verification. Written 
    argument may be submitted at any time during the course of an AD/CVD 
    duty proceeding through the submission of case and rebuttal briefs (see 
    Sec. 351.309 (note that Sec. 351.309(c)(2) provides that the case brief 
    must present all arguments that a party wants the Department to 
    consider in its final determination or final results of review)). While 
    it may be in a party's interest to submit pre-verification comments at 
    least seven days before verification so that the Department has 
    sufficient time to consider them prior to verification, it is not 
    required.
        Time limits for certain submissions: Section 351.301(c) sets forth 
    the time limits for certain submissions, including information to 
    rebut, clarify, or correct factual information submitted by another 
    party, information in questionnaire responses, and publicly available 
    information to obtain values for factors in nonmarket economy AD cases.
        Submission of factual information to rebut, clarify, or correct 
    factual information: Section 351.301(c)(1) provides that any interested 
    party may submit factual information to rebut, clarify, or correct 
    factual information submitted by any other interested party at any time 
    prior to the applicable deadline for submission of such factual 
    information or, if later, 10 days after the date such factual 
    information is served on the interested party or, if appropriate, made 
    available under APO to the authorized applicant. Upon further review, 
    we have revised this provision to eliminate potentially confusing 
    language and to clarify that in no case will a party have less than 10 
    days to submit factual information to rebut, clarify, or correct 
    factual information submitted by any other interested party.
        Two commenters proposed that the regulations provide that only 
    domestic interested parties be allowed to submit new factual 
    information to rebut, clarify, or correct factual information submitted 
    by foreign interested parties. According to the commenters, this would 
    avoid the selective provision of rebuttal information by foreign 
    interested parties. Another commenter proposed that the 10-calendar day 
    deadline be changed to 10 business days.
        We have not adopted either of these proposals. The prior 
    regulations allowed only domestic interested parties to rebut, clarify, 
    or correct factual information submitted by respondent interested 
    parties. However, the Department reconsidered the regulation and the 
    rationale behind it and determined that the goal of accurate 
    determinations is enhanced by allowing any interested party and, as now 
    provided in Sec. 351.312, industrial users and consumers, to comment on 
    submissions of factual information. One commenter specifically 
    expressed support for this change. Additionally, the Department has 
    maintained the 10-calendar day deadline. This deadline is relevant only 
    where factual information is submitted less than 10 days before, on, or 
    after (normally, only with the Department's permission) the applicable 
    deadline for submission of factual information; at this point in the 
    proceeding, the Department and the parties have an interest in 
    finalizing the addition of new factual information to the record. The 
    Department believes that 10 calendar days provide ample time for an 
    interested party to rebut, clarify, or correct factual information 
    submitted by another interested party.
        Two commenters proposed that the regulations provide that any 
    interested party may submit factual information to rebut, clarify, or 
    correct factual information contained in the Department's verification 
    reports. We have not adopted this proposal. Verification is the process 
    by which the Department checks, reviews, and corroborates factual 
    information previously submitted. Parties are free to comment on 
    verification reports and to make arguments concerning information in 
    the reports up to and including the filing of case and rebuttal briefs 
    (note that Sec. 351.309(c)(2) provides that the case brief must present 
    all arguments that a party wants the Department to consider in its 
    final determination or final results of review). In making their 
    arguments, parties may use factual information already on the record or 
    may draw on information in the public realm to highlight any perceived 
    inaccuracies in a report. Though comment on the Department's 
    verification findings is appropriate, submission of new factual 
    information at this stage in the proceeding is not, because the 
    Department is unable to verify post-verification submissions of new 
    factual information.
    
    [[Page 27333]]
    
        Questionnaire responses: Section 351.301(c)(2) deals with 
    questionnaire responses and other submissions on request. Section 
    351.301(c)(2)(ii) provides that the Department must give notice of 
    certain requirements to each interested party from whom the Department 
    requests information.
        One commenter proposed that the Department should review and revise 
    its questionnaire to reduce reporting burdens. In addition, the 
    commenter suggested that the Department accept the reporting of 
    financial data in the form consistent with the generally accepted 
    accounting principles of the respondent's country of origin. The 
    Department already has significantly revised its standard questionnaire 
    to make it more ``user friendly'' and efficient by simplifying 
    information requests and reducing reporting burdens. One of the areas 
    in which the Department has simplified reporting burdens is in the 
    reporting of cost data. Consistent with past practice and section 
    773(f)(1)(A) of the Act, the Department normally will calculate costs 
    based on a respondent's records, if such records are kept in accordance 
    with the generally accepted accounting principles of respondent's 
    country of origin and reasonably reflect the costs associated with the 
    production and sale of the merchandise. As such, much of the required 
    reporting of cost and financial data is consistent with a respondent's 
    normal books and records. However, given the requirements of the AD 
    law, it is not always possible to accept the reporting of financial or 
    cost data in the form such data are maintained in a respondent's books 
    and records. To the extent that a party has specific suggestions for 
    improvements in the Department's questionnaire and reporting 
    requirements, the Department welcomes those suggestions. Also, if a 
    questionnaire requirement poses specific difficulties in a particular 
    proceeding, the respondent can request the Department to modify the 
    requirement on an ad hoc basis.
        One commenter proposed that the regulations provide a deadline for 
    the introduction of issues so that respondents would have adequate time 
    to research, draft, and translate a complete response. The Department 
    has not adopted this proposal. Barring specific statutory or regulatory 
    deadlines or subject matter constraints, parties may raise relevant 
    issues which may arise throughout the course of an AD/CVD duty 
    proceeding. A generalized deadline on raising issues would have 
    unforeseeable consequences such that we do not feel confident in 
    foreclosing debate on them in advance. Furthermore, the Department may 
    request any person to submit factual information at any time during a 
    proceeding (see Sec. 351.301(c)(2)(i)).
        Two commenters proposed that the regulations indicate that the 
    Department is required to rapidly respond to a respondent's request for 
    clarification of an information request. One of the commenters proposed 
    a three-day deadline for response, which, if not met, would lead to an 
    automatic extension of the time for the respondent to supply the 
    information in question by the length on time it took the Department to 
    provide the necessary clarification. The Department has not adopted 
    this proposal. The Department makes every effort to respond to requests 
    for clarifications as soon as possible. Hence, a specific regulatory 
    deadline is unnecessary. While it is possible that the Department might 
    find good cause for granting a request for an extension where response 
    to a clarification request was delayed, an automatic extension 
    provision could lead to the filing of clarification requests simply to 
    extend the deadline for filing a questionnaire response or other 
    submission.
        One commenter proposed that the regulations provide that the 
    Department must notify a party if the information it submitted is 
    deficient and provide the party with an opportunity to remedy the 
    deficiency. The Department has not adopted this proposal as this issue 
    is covered specifically in the statute (see section 782(d) of the Act), 
    and, as noted above, the Department has sought to avoid repeating the 
    statute in the regulations. Parties will be informed in the initial 
    questionnaire, and in supplemental questionnaires, that failure to 
    submit requested information in the requested form and manner by the 
    date specified may result in the use of facts available under section 
    776 of the Act and Sec. 351.308. The Department's practice is to send a 
    respondent a supplemental questionnaire where the Department needs 
    clarification of a response or the Department seeks additional 
    information to address questions arising out of reported information. 
    The Department, however, will not necessarily repeat a precise or 
    direct question that the respondent has not answered. The decision to 
    specifically inform a party that information it submitted is deficient 
    is a decision that can only be made on a case-by-case basis taking into 
    consideration the Department's initial information request and the 
    party's response to that request.
        One commenter suggested that the Department reduce the scope of 
    supplemental questionnaires to curb the use of data demands as a 
    tactical measure by petitioners to harass respondents by imposing 
    additional financial burdens on them. The Department disagrees with the 
    characterization of the issuance of supplemental questionnaires as a 
    method to harass respondents. In its supplemental questionnaires, the 
    Department typically seeks clarification of reported information or 
    seeks responses to questions precipitated by reported information. In 
    drafting its supplemental questionnaires, the Department may 
    incorporate lines of questioning based on input from petitioners. 
    However, where the Department chooses to use input from petitioners, it 
    does so precisely because such input is constructive. The Department 
    only requests information it deems to be necessary and will continue to 
    do so. However, a blanket requirement that supplemental data requests 
    be reduced is inconsistent with the Department's obligation to conduct 
    a thorough investigation based on the necessary facts.
        Section 351.301(c)(2)(iii) provides that interested parties shall 
    have at least 30 days from the date of receipt to respond to the full 
    initial questionnaire. This subparagraph also provided that the ``date 
    of receipt'' will be seven days from the date on which the initial 
    questionnaire was ``transmitted.''
        One commenter proposed that the regulations require the Department 
    to release the questionnaire within five days after initiation. We have 
    not adopted this proposal. Release of the questionnaire immediately 
    after initiation, particularly in investigations, often is not possible 
    because the Department needs input from companies, for example, to 
    identify appropriate respondents, tailor information requests, and 
    format requirements to the specific merchandise under investigation. 
    The Department will continue its current practice of releasing the 
    questionnaire as soon as possible.
        Another commenter proposed that the regulations provide a mechanism 
    under which the Department would consult with the parties and decide 
    certain issues--such as date of sale, product matching criteria, the 
    identity of affiliated parties, whether downstream sales by affiliated 
    parties in the home market should be reported, and whether affiliated 
    party transactions are at arm's length--prior to the issuance of the 
    questionnaire. The Department has not adopted this proposal. Consistent 
    with its normal practice, the Department already consults with parties 
    and decides certain issues prior to issuance
    
    [[Page 27334]]
    
    of the questionnaire. For example, the Department normally consults 
    with the parties to identify appropriate respondents or model matching 
    criteria. However, deciding all of the issues listed by the commenter 
    prior to release of the questionnaire is not feasible. Either an issue 
    cannot be decided until the Department has reviewed and analyzed all of 
    the submitted data or it is not practicable to gather all of the data 
    necessary to decide the issue prior to release of the questionnaire 
    given the statutory time limits for conduct of investigations and 
    reviews.
        Two commenters proposed that the regulations provide interested 
    parties at least 30 days to respond to a questionnaire or any part of a 
    questionnaire. Other commenters proposed that the regulations provide 
    for at least 45 days to respond to the questionnaire or for automatic 
    15-day extensions upon request. Finally, another commenter proposed 
    that the regulations provide for an additional 30 days to respond to a 
    questionnaire that requests information on two administrative reviews 
    in situations where the Department has deferred initiation of an 
    administrative review for one year and that all deadlines for the 
    deferred administrative review are counted with respect to the later 
    POR's anniversary month. The SAA, at 866, provides that interested 
    parties shall have at least 30 days from the date of receipt to respond 
    to the full initial questionnaire. As the Department explained in the 
    preamble to the proposed regulations, 61 FR at 7324, the time limit for 
    response to individual sections of the questionnaire, if the Secretary 
    requests a separate response to such sections, may be less than the 30 
    days allotted for response to the full questionnaire. For example, the 
    Department anticipates that the response to section A of an AD 
    questionnaire, which seeks general information about a company, will be 
    due before the expiration of the 30-day period. The Department's 
    ability to timely identify appropriate respondents, in particular, 
    would be hampered were the Department to delay the deadline for 
    submission of this information. The Department, therefore, has not 
    adopted the proposal that parties be granted 30 days to respond to any 
    part of the questionnaire. Likewise, the Department has not adopted the 
    proposal that the regulatory deadline for questionnaire responses be 
    extended to 45 days. Only with prompt responses will the Department be 
    able to meet its statutory obligations of conducting timely 
    investigations and administrative reviews. Parties can, if necessary, 
    request an extension of the time limit for submission of a 
    questionnaire response under Sec. 351.302. The Department also has not 
    adopted the proposal that the regulations provide a 60-day deadline for 
    submission of questionnaire responses where the Department has deferred 
    initiation of an administrative review. While the Department will 
    examine and would like to adopt schedules that allow a longer 
    questionnaire response time for deferred reviews, it is reluctant to 
    adopt such a regulation prior to gaining experience in administering 
    deferred reviews. The Department also believes that it is appropriate 
    to determine a deadline on a case-by-case basis taking into 
    consideration the companies and merchandise under review. Because the 
    Department has no experience yet with the deferred administrative 
    review provision and, hence, cannot foresee every timing issue that 
    might arise, it has not codified in the regulations the proposal that 
    all deadlines for the deferred administrative review be counted with 
    respect to the later POR's anniversary month. The proposal on its face 
    makes sense, however, and the Department will attempt to implement it 
    in practice.
        With respect to the ``transmission'' of the questionnaire, one 
    commenter proposed that the regulations define ``transmitted'' and 
    provide for notification of parties when ``transmission'' occurs. 
    Another commenter proposed that the regulations provide that seven days 
    should be added to the date of transmission of the questionnaire to 
    calculate receipt date only where the agency does not have evidence 
    that the questionnaire was actually received at an earlier date. One 
    commenter opposed this second proposal.
        We have not adopted either proposal. The Department considers the 
    date of transmission to be the date the Department indicates on the 
    questionnaire. Thus, it is obvious from looking at the document when 
    ``transmission'' has ccurred, and, as such, it is not necessary to 
    codify this definition in the regulations. The Department has not 
    adopted the second proposal because it is not practicable for the 
    Department to try and keep track of a possible range of receipt dates.
        Section 351.301(c)(2)(iv) provides a 14-day deadline for 
    notification by an interested party, under section 782(c)(1) of the 
    Act, of difficulties in submitting a questionnaire response. Section 
    782(c)(1) of the Act provides that, if promptly asked to do so by an 
    interested party, the Department may modify its requests for 
    information to avoid imposing an unreasonable burden on that party.
        One commenter proposed that the regulations recognize that the 
    Department's questionnaire may be modified to reduce reporting burdens 
    under certain circumstances pursuant to section 782(c)(1) of the Act. 
    In our view, section 351.301(c)(2)(iv) of these regulations does just 
    that.
        Another commenter proposed that any notification by a foreign 
    interested party of difficulties in submitting information in response 
    to the Department's questionnaire must be placed formally on the record 
    of the proceeding. With respect to this suggestion, it was always the 
    Department's intent under Sec. 351.301(c)(2)(iv) to require 
    notification in writing. However, to avoid any confusion, the final 
    regulation clarifies that such notification is to be submitted ``in 
    writing.''
        One commenter suggested that the regulations provide petitioners 
    with a right to comment on requests to modify an original questionnaire 
    at the time the request is made. The Department has not adopted this 
    proposal. As the Department explained in the preamble to the proposed 
    regulations, parties have the right generally to submit comments on any 
    relevant issue throughout the course of a proceeding. As such, the 
    Department does not believe that a specific regulation addressing this 
    issue is necessary. See 61 FR at 7324.
        One commenter proposed that the regulations ensure that 
    difficulties experienced by interested parties (in particular, small 
    companies) will be taken into account when the Department requests 
    information and plans and conducts verification. In addition, the 
    commenter proposed that the regulations include provisions that the 
    Department will take into account the size of the respondent in 
    assessing the adequacy of a response and also in determining whether 
    facts available should be applied, and, if so, whether an adverse 
    inference should be drawn.
        With respect to these suggestions, section 782(c)(2) of the Act 
    provides that the Department will take into account difficulties 
    experienced by interested parties, particularly small companies, in 
    supplying information, and will provide any assistance that is 
    practicable. The statute does not indicate that the Department is 
    specifically required to take into account the size of the company in 
    assessing the adequacy of the response or whether application of 
    adverse facts available is applicable. Rather, section 776(b) of the 
    Act provides for use of an
    
    [[Page 27335]]
    
    adverse inference where the Department finds that an interested party 
    ``has failed to cooperate by not acting to the best of its ability to 
    comply with a request for information.'' Under this standard the 
    Department may consider the size of a company in determining whether it 
    acted to the best of its ability. Any decision to do so would be made 
    on a case-by-case basis.
        One commenter proposed that the regulations provide that the 14-day 
    deadline for notifying the Department under section 782(c)(1) of the 
    Act of difficulties in submitting information in response to a 
    questionnaire is subject to extension upon request and that the request 
    need not be made within the 14-day period. We have not adopted this 
    proposal. Section 351.302 of these regulations contains the general 
    provision for extensions of time limits upon request. As such, a 
    specific provision regarding the 14-day deadline is unnecessary. 
    Whether the Department would grant an extension of the 14-day period 
    where the request for the extension was filed after the 14-day period 
    had expired can only be determined on a case-by-case basis upon review 
    of the party's explanation of the ``good cause'' for such a request and 
    for the lateness of the request.
        Section 351.301(c)(2)(v) indicates that a respondent interested 
    party may request that the Department conduct a questionnaire 
    presentation during which Department officials will explain the 
    requirements of the questionnaire. One commenter proposed that the 
    regulations clarify that explanations provided during a questionnaire 
    presentation are not intended as a modification of the questionnaire or 
    as an ``understanding'' between the Department and any respondent 
    regarding the questionnaire, except as expressly provided in the 
    questionnaire or subsequent modifications and supplements to the 
    questionnaire. Furthermore, the commenter proposed that the regulations 
    provide that the substance of a questionnaire presentation be 
    memorialized for the record.
        The Department agrees in principle with these proposals but does 
    not believe that a specific regulation is necessary. Any modifications 
    or supplements to the questionnaire, or any agreed-upon changes in 
    reporting requirements between a respondent and the Department will be 
    reflected in the record.
        Submission of publicly available information to value factors: 
    Section 351.301(c)(3) contains the time limits for submission of 
    publicly available information to obtain values for factors in 
    nonmarket economy AD cases. One commenter expressed support for the 
    proposed deadlines. Another commenter proposed changing the deadline 
    for such submissions to the date the case briefs are due. The commenter 
    argued that this minor difference (the proposed deadlines are 
    approximately 10 days before the date for submission of case briefs) 
    will still allow the other parties to comment on the new information in 
    their rebuttal briefs, while permitting the potential submitting 
    parties to make the decision on what information is relevant, worth 
    obtaining or placing on the record at a time when arguments in the case 
    brief have been drafted, thus preventing missed documents or cluttering 
    of the record with documents ultimately deemed unnecessary by the 
    submitter.
        While the Department agrees with some of the commenter's reasoning, 
    it has not adopted this proposal for several reasons. First, the 
    Department is concerned that the short deadline for filing rebuttal 
    briefs, i.e., five calendar days after case briefs are filed, will not 
    allow parties enough time to prepare rebuttal arguments and review and 
    comment on new factor information. Second, the Department does not 
    believe that inclusion of new factual information with submission of 
    arguments in case briefs allows for thorough analysis by the 
    Department. Finally, inclusion of new factual information in case 
    briefs is not consistent with the purpose of case briefs; namely to 
    comment on what the Department did in its preliminary determination and 
    to place before the Department any arguments that continue, in the 
    submitter's view, to be relevant to the Secretary's final determination 
    or results of review.
        Time limits for certain allegations: Section 351.301(d) sets forth 
    the time limits for certain allegations, including allegations 
    concerning market viability, allegations of sales at prices below the 
    cost of production, countervailable subsidy allegations, and upstream 
    subsidy allegations. In response to suggestions from several 
    commenters, we have added a time limit for allegations of purchases of 
    major inputs from an affiliated party at prices below the affiliated 
    party's cost of production.
        Allegations regarding market viability: Section 351.301(d)(1) 
    establishes a deadline for allegations regarding market viability of 40 
    days after the date on which the initial questionnaire was transmitted. 
    Several commenters proposed a longer alternative deadline of 120 days 
    after initiation. Another commenter proposed that the deadline for 
    allegations regarding market viability be tied to the receipt of the 
    response to the relevant section of the questionnaire instead of to the 
    date of transmittal of the initial questionnaire.
        We have not adopted either proposal. The information necessary to 
    make allegations concerning market viability typically is contained in 
    a respondent's section A response. Normally section A responses are due 
    no later than 21 days after transmittal of the initial questionnaire. 
    The 40-day deadline, therefore, should allow parties sufficient time to 
    review the questionnaire responses and, if desired, make market 
    viability allegations. The regulation makes clear that the Secretary 
    may alter this time limit. The Secretary is likely to do so where the 
    deadline for section A responses is extended, the responses themselves 
    are so incomplete as to hinder a party's ability to make a market 
    viability allegation, or the information necessary to make a market 
    viability allegation is not available as part of the section A 
    response.
        Allegations of sales at prices below the cost of production: 
    Section 351.301(d)(2) establishes the time limits in investigations and 
    reviews for allegations of sales at prices below the cost of production 
    (COP) under section 773(b) of the Act.
        One commenter proposed that the deadline for cost allegations be 
    extended by seven days to take into account the additional seven days 
    for receipt of the questionnaire. We have not adopted this proposal 
    because the proposed deadlines already take into account the seven days 
    for receipt of the questionnaire by tying the deadline to the date of 
    receipt of the relevant questionnaire response. Country-wide 
    allegations do not depend on information contained in questionnaire 
    responses.
        A number of other commenters proposed eliminating entirely the 
    notion of company-specific cost allegations for a number of reasons. 
    One commenter argued that company-specific costs are not likely to be 
    reasonably available to petitioner even after submission of the Section 
    B response.
        The Department has not adopted this proposal. Complete company-
    specific costs normally are not placed on the record until the 
    Department requests them, i.e., typically after the Department has 
    initiated a cost investigation. Nonetheless, the Department commonly 
    receives adequate company-specific cost allegations based on data that 
    are reasonably available to the petitioner. In making company-specific 
    cost allegations, petitioners often use data provided for difference in 
    merchandise adjustments and data from a
    
    [[Page 27336]]
    
    respondent's financial statements which are submitted with a 
    respondent's section A and B questionnaire responses. In addition, a 
    domestic interested party may compare company-specific home market 
    prices from a respondent's section B response with its own adjusted 
    cost data in order to make a company-specific cost allegation (see 
    section 773(b)(2)(A)(i) of the Act).
        Two other commenters reasoned that country-wide cost allegations 
    may provide reasonable grounds for an investigation of all respondents 
    even if submitted after receipt of all sales responses because, for 
    example, the allegation could demonstrate that prices among producers 
    are similar and could be based on the cost data of the most efficient 
    producer. The Department believes that where company-specific 
    information has been placed on the record, any subsequent sales below 
    cost allegation must take into consideration such information. As the 
    Department noted in the preamble to the proposed regulations, the SAA 
    at 833 states that the standard for initiation of a sales below cost 
    investigation is the same as the standard for initiating an AD 
    investigation. The Department interprets this to mean that an 
    allegation of sales below cost, like an allegation of dumping, must be 
    supported by information reasonably available to petitioner, including 
    information already on the record. See 61 FR at 7324. Therefore, 
    demonstrating that one company's sales are below cost does not 
    demonstrate that other companies' sales are below cost if the other 
    companies' information is reasonably available.
        Finally, two additional commenters argued that respondents will do 
    everything possible to avoid submitting responses that could form the 
    grounds for the filing of a COP allegation. It is our experience that 
    respondents do not behave in such a manner. We believe that it is 
    unlikely respondents would intentionally submit grossly deficient 
    responses simply to avoid providing data sufficient to form the basis 
    for a cost allegation. To do so might subject them to the application 
    of adverse facts available, surely a more daunting prospect than the 
    possible initiation of a cost investigation.
        One commenter argued that cost allegations on a country-wide basis 
    are not permitted under the statute because the statutory ``reasonable 
    grounds to believe or suspect'' standard for initiating a cost 
    investigation has not changed since the Department adopted a policy of 
    entertaining only company-specific allegations under the CIT's holding 
    in Al Tech Specialty Steel Corp. v. United States, 575 F. Supp. 1277, 
    1281 (1983). Contrary to the commenter's suggestion, the SAA at 833 
    specifically provides for the consideration of cost allegations on a 
    country-wide basis. The commenter also argued that a country-wide 
    allegation must contain some demonstration of the representativeness of 
    the presented data where there are substantial variants of the subject 
    merchandise under investigation. The Department agrees that a country-
    wide allegation should contain some demonstration of the 
    representativeness of the presented data, but only to the extent that 
    pertinent data are reasonably available to the petitioner.
        Allegations of purchases of major inputs from an affiliated party 
    at prices below the affiliated party's cost of production: In response 
    to several comments, we have added a new provision in these final 
    regulations establishing deadlines for allegations under section 
    773(f)(3) of the Act regarding purchases of major inputs from an 
    affiliated party at prices below the affiliated party's cost of 
    production. One commenter proposed that the regulations provide that 
    such allegations are due within seven days after a COP response is 
    filed. Another commenter proposed that the deadlines be identical to 
    the deadlines for cost allegations.
        We have not adopted either of these proposed deadlines. Instead, 
    new Sec. 351.301(d)(3) provides for filing such allegations within 20 
    days after a respondent files a response to the relevant section of the 
    questionnaire; i.e., the section D response containing cost data. The 
    applicability of this provision is limited, however. Specifically, 
    because the Department's normal practice is to analyze an affiliated 
    supplier's production cost data for major inputs whenever it conducts a 
    cost investigation, this provision is only applicable where the 
    Department has determined to base foreign market value on constructed 
    value for reasons other than that sales were disregarded under the cost 
    test.
        Two commenters additionally proposed that the regulations establish 
    a deadline for determining which inputs are deemed to be ``major.'' We 
    have not adopted this proposal. The determination of which inputs are 
    ``major'' must be made on a case-by-case basis taking into 
    consideration the nature of the product, its inputs, and the company-
    specific information on the record.
        Countervailable subsidy and upstream subsidy allegations: Proposed 
    Sec. 351.301(d)(3), now renumbered as Sec. 351.301(d)(4), sets forth 
    the time limits for countervailable subsidy allegations in 
    investigations and reviews and upstream subsidy allegations in 
    investigations. We received one comment regarding this provision which 
    was supportive of the Department's treatment of this issue. After a 
    further review of this provision, we have left it unchanged except for 
    the change in numbering.
        Targeted dumping allegations: Proposed Sec. 351.301(d)(4), now 
    renumbered as Sec. 351.301(d)(5), sets forth the time limit for a 
    targeted dumping allegation in an AD investigation. A number of 
    commenters proposed that the deadline for targeted dumping allegations 
    be eliminated, or, at a minimum, revised so as to merely require that 
    an allegation of targeted dumping be made no later than the date case 
    briefs are due. Two commenters reasoned that a targeted dumping 
    analysis does not require the collection of additional data not 
    requested in the questionnaire. Two other commenters reasoned that the 
    deadline should be eliminated because the Department should always test 
    for targeted dumping. One commenter supported the maintenance of a 
    deadline for targeted dumping allegations. The Department has not 
    adopted the proposals eliminating or changing the proposed deadline for 
    targeted dumping allegations. The Department believes that the deadline 
    of 30 days before the scheduled date of the preliminary determination 
    will provide petitioners with sufficient time to analyze the applicable 
    data and submit an allegation if appropriate. To extend the deadline 
    would make it difficult for the Department to consider the allegation 
    for the preliminary determination. However, the Department recognizes 
    the burden such a deadline may place on domestic interested parties in 
    some situations and intends to be flexible with respect to the deadline 
    where appropriate. For example, if the timing of responses does not 
    permit adequate time for analysis, the Department will consider that 
    ``good cause'' to extend the deadline under Sec. 351.302. Additional 
    comments concerning the substantive targeted dumping provisions are 
    discussed below in connection with Sec. 351.414(f).
    
    Section 351.302
    
        Section 351.302 sets forth the procedures for requesting an 
    extension of a time limit and clarifies the Department's authority to 
    grant extensions. In addition, this section explains when and how the 
    Department will reject untimely or unsolicited submissions.
    
    [[Page 27337]]
    
        Extension of time limits: Sections 351.302 (b) and (c) provide that 
    the Department may extend a regulatory deadline based upon its own 
    determination that there is good cause to do so or where an interested 
    party shows good cause for such extension. One commenter expressed 
    support for this provision. Another commenter proposed that extensions 
    of up to 15 days will normally be granted upon a reasonable showing of 
    good cause. A third commenter argued that the regulation providing for 
    extensions for ``good cause shown'' is too restrictive and suggested 
    that the regulation provide that the Department will grant an extension 
    where it would not delay the completion of an investigation or review 
    or cause other interested parties difficulties in representing their 
    interests.
        The Department has not specifically adopted these suggestions, but 
    does recognize that some of these concepts factor into its decision as 
    to whether good cause has been shown. As the Department indicated in 
    the preamble to the proposed regulations, decisions regarding the 
    possibility of extensions will be based on the ability of the party to 
    respond within the original deadline and the parties' and the 
    Department's ability to accommodate the requested extension. Thus, the 
    Department believes that it is appropriate to determine whether to 
    grant an extension, and for how long, based upon the facts in a 
    particular proceeding. 61 FR at 7326.
    
    Section 351.303
    
        Section 351.303 contains the procedural rules regarding filing, 
    format, service, translation, and certification of documents.
        Time of filing: One commenter proposed that the regulations provide 
    that in computing any period of time prescribed or allowed by the 
    statute, the regulations, or the instructions of the Department, when 
    the last day of the period is not a business day, the period runs to 
    the first business day. In our view, the regulations as drafted 
    accommodate the commenter's proposition. Specifically, Sec. 351.303(b) 
    provides that if the applicable time limit expires on a non-business 
    day, the Secretary will accept documents that are filed on the next 
    business day (see also Sec. 351.103 describing the location and 
    function of Import Administration's Central Records Unit).
        The commenter also proposed that the regulations provide that 
    whenever a period is less than 11 days, intermediate non-business days 
    are excluded from the count. The Department has not adopted this 
    proposal. The very few deadlines in these regulations of less than 11 
    days were specifically established by the Department after 
    consideration of related timing issues.
        Filing of submissions: One commenter suggested that the regulations 
    provide that the additional copies of APO documents should be filed 
    within the applicable time limits for filing business proprietary 
    versions instead of waiting for the one-day lag rule so that analysts 
    have an extra day to review the documents. The Department has not 
    adopted this suggestion. A principal reason that the Department revised 
    and codified the one-day lag rule in the regulations was to avoid the 
    problem of analysts working from documents with mistakes in bracketing 
    of business proprietary information. As a result, Sec. 351.303(c)(2)(i) 
    provides for filing of only one copy of the business proprietary 
    version of a document within the applicable time limit; 
    Sec. 351.303(c)(2)(ii) provides for filing of six copies of the 
    complete, final business proprietary version, i.e., with bracketing 
    mistakes corrected, on the next business day. This final version is the 
    one distributed internally to the analysts. If parties wish to send 
    additional courtesy copies directly to the analysts, they should 
    similarly send this complete, final business proprietary version.
        Document markings: We have made a minor change to 
    Sec. 351.303(d)(2)(v) to clarify that only the business proprietary 
    version of a document filed under Sec. 351.303(c)(2)(i) of the one-day 
    lag rule should include the warning ``Bracketing of Business 
    Proprietary Information is Not Final for One Business Day After Date of 
    Filing'' on pages containing business proprietary information.
        Translation to English: Section 351.303(e) requires that documents 
    submitted in a foreign language be accompanied by an English 
    translation. One commenter proposed that regulations provide that 
    English language summaries of foreign language documents may be 
    submitted in lieu of complete translations. We have not adopted this 
    proposal. When parties are unable to comply with the English-
    translation requirement, the Department will work with them on an 
    acceptable alternative. Furthermore, as explained in the preamble to 
    the proposed regulations, parties may submit an English translation of 
    pertinent portions of a non-English language document. 61 FR at 7326. 
    Another commenter proposed that the regulations include this latter 
    clarification. We agree that the clarification that parties may submit 
    an English translation of only pertinent portions of a document, as 
    opposed to the entire document, is helpful and have included it in the 
    final regulations. The regulation makes clear, however, that parties 
    must obtain the Department's approval for submission of an English 
    translation of only portions of a document prior to submission to the 
    Department.
        Service of copies on other persons: Section 351.303(f) provides for 
    service of documents filed with the Department on all other persons on 
    the service list. The Department has received a number of informal 
    suggestions and comments by parties seeking permission to serve certain 
    documents by facsimile or other electronic transmission processes. The 
    Department believes that under certain conditions, service by means 
    other than personal service or first class mail is permissible. As a 
    result, we have added new paragraph (f)(1)(ii) to provide for service 
    of public versions and business proprietary versions containing only 
    the server's own business proprietary information on other persons on 
    the service list by facsimile or other electronic means, such as e-
    mail, where the intended recipient consents to such service. This 
    provision does not apply to filing documents with the Department. 
    Proposed paragraph (f)(1) has been renumbered as paragraph (f)(1)(i).
        One commenter proposed that the regulations require the Department 
    to serve all parties on the service list copies of any document that 
    the Department transmits to another party in the proceeding. The 
    commenter also proposed that the regulations require the Department to 
    notify immediately all parties whenever it transmits a document to a 
    party. A second commenter supported these proposals.
        The Department has not adopted these proposals. We recognize the 
    importance of making documents available to parties and believe that 
    the current mechanisms for making documents available are adequate. 
    Specifically, for documents the Department releases under APO, under 
    the terms of the APO application (where parties may ask to receive all 
    memoranda generated by the Department) the Department releases such 
    documents to all parties under APO. All public documents, including 
    public versions of documents containing business proprietary 
    information, generated by the Department are made available to parties 
    in our Central Records Unit (see Sec. 351.103). As circumstances 
    warrant, the Department also releases public
    
    [[Page 27338]]
    
    documents directly to parties other than the recipient and will 
    continue to do so.
        Certifications: Section 351.303(g) provides that each submission 
    containing factual information must be accompanied by the appropriate 
    certification regarding the accuracy of the information. One commenter 
    proposed that the regulations provide that the required party 
    certification may be submitted for the first time when the party files 
    its public version and any corrections to its proprietary version. The 
    Department has not adopted this proposal. A person must file the 
    applicable certification(s) with each submission of factual 
    information, including the original business proprietary version of a 
    document filed with the Department, within the applicable time limits 
    pursuant to Sec. 351.303(c)(2). The public version and the final 
    business proprietary version filed on the following business day must 
    be identical to the business proprietary version filed the previous day 
    except for any bracketing corrections. Therefore, there is no reason 
    why the certification should change.
        Another commenter proposed that to authenticate the date of 
    certification, the Department should require an original dated 
    certification sworn before an authorized equivalent to a notary public 
    for each submission. One commenter opposed this proposal. We have not 
    adopted this proposal. The Department believes that such a regulation 
    would not provide substantially greater assurance of completeness and 
    accuracy of submitted information, yet it would further complicate the 
    process of submitting information. We assume that legal counsel, other 
    representatives, and company officials are acting in good faith when 
    they certify to the completeness and accuracy of a specific submission. 
    For this reason, we also have not adopted regulations authorizing 
    sanctions for certification violations as proposed by two commenters.
    
    Section 351.304  [Reserved--APO]
    
    Section 351.305  [Reserved--APO]
    
    Section 351.306  [Reserved--APO]
    
    Section 351.307
    
        Section 351.307 deals with verification of information.
        Conducting verification: One commenter suggested that there is no 
    need for automatic verifications where the Department intends to revoke 
    an order as the result of a sunset review. The commenter proposed that 
    the regulations clarify that verifications for sunset reviews should 
    occur only for good cause. The Department has not adopted this 
    suggestion. Section 782(i) of the Act mandates that the Department 
    conduct verification before revoking an order as the result of a sunset 
    review.
        Another commenter proposed that the regulations establish 30 days 
    after receipt of the supplemental response as the deadline for 
    verification requests. The commenter was concerned that because the 
    Department frequently grants extensions to respondents to answer 
    questionnaires and supplemental questionnaires, the ability of domestic 
    interested parties to demonstrate the requisite ``good cause'' would be 
    hampered by time constraints.
        The Department has not adopted this suggestion. While the 
    regulations establish a deadline for requesting verification in an 
    administrative review upon request where no verification was conducted 
    during either of the two immediately preceding administrative reviews 
    (Sec. 351.307(b)(1)(v)), there is no deadline for requesting 
    verification in an administrative review based on good cause 
    (Sec. 351.307(b)(1)(iv)). Thus, nothing prevents domestic interested 
    parties from making good cause arguments at any point in the review, 
    including after supplemental responses are filed. However, the 
    Department's practice is to conduct verification in administrative 
    reviews prior to issuing its preliminary results. Good cause arguments 
    made late in the proceeding may not allow sufficient time for the 
    Department to conduct verification. The third-year verification 
    provision has a deadline for domestic interested parties to request 
    verification of 100 days after publication of the notice of initiation 
    of review. This timeframe allows the Department sufficient time to 
    prepare for verification.
        Verification of a sample: Section 351.307(b)(3) provides that the 
    Department may select and verify a sample of exporters and producers 
    where it is impracticable to verify relevant factual information for 
    each person due to the large number of exporters or producers included 
    in an investigation or administrative review. One commenter proposed 
    that the regulation be revised to provide that sample verifications 
    will be relied upon in only exceptional circumstances, and that it is 
    the Department's intention, in cases involving numerous potential 
    respondents, to select a reasonable number of companies that can be 
    examined and verified.
        The Department has not adopted this proposal. As provided in the 
    regulation, the Department may verify a sample of respondents where it 
    is impracticable to verify every respondent due to the large number of 
    companies included in an investigation or review. A decision as to 
    whether it is impracticable to verify every respondent is made on a 
    case-by-case basis, considering the circumstances particular to a 
    specific investigation or review.
        Verification report: Section 351.307(c) provides that the 
    Department will issue a verification report. One commenter proposed 
    that the regulations require the Department to issue a verification 
    report normally no later than 30 days after completion of verification 
    in an investigation, and no later than 14 days prior to the issuance of 
    preliminary results in an administrative review. Another commenter 
    proposed that the regulations provide that documents that are retained 
    by the Department and designated as verification exhibits in the 
    verification report be served within 48 hours after service of the 
    verification report.
        The Department has not adopted these proposals. Because the 
    Department's standard practice is to issue verification reports and 
    require service of verification exhibits as soon as possible after 
    verification, the Department does not believe that specific regulatory 
    deadlines are necessary.
        Another commenter proposed that the regulations provide that 
    verification reports will not be released to respondent's counsel for 
    comments on bracketing proprietary information before release to 
    domestic industry counsel because to do so allows respondents to obtain 
    an unfair head-start on preparation of verification comments, case 
    briefs, etc. An additional commenter proposed that draft verification 
    reports, as well as the final report, should be included on the record.
        The Department has not adopted either proposal. Because they are 
    not final, draft verification reports, including reports where 
    bracketing has not been finalized, are not included in the record or 
    released generally to all interested parties. Furthermore, release of 
    an unfinished version of the final document risks inadvertent release 
    of business proprietary information belonging to the verified 
    respondent. The sole purpose of providing this draft is to allow a 
    respondent to comment on proper bracketing..
        One commenter suggested that regulations should provide that within 
    seven days of the completion of verification, the verifying official 
    should memorialize for the administrative record all requests for new 
    information as a result of the completed verification, the date 
    verification for that company was completed, and any other official
    
    [[Page 27339]]
    
    requests for adjustments to the database relied on in the preliminary 
    phase of the proceeding, whether or not considered new information. In 
    addition, the commenter proposed that in a cover letter transmitting 
    the requested information the government or person supplying the 
    requested information should be required to separately identify every 
    change to the computer database from the database relied on by the 
    Department in the preliminary phase, identify every change to the 
    computer database made as a result of the verifying officials' request, 
    and certify that no changes have been made to the database relied on by 
    the Department in the preliminary phase with the exception of those 
    noted in the cover letter.
        The Department does not believe that additional specific 
    regulations are necessary, because Department practice already 
    incorporates many of the commenters' suggestions. The Department 
    intends to incorporate the remaining suggestions into its practice 
    because they represent improvements to the verification process.
        Procedures for verification: Section 351.307(d) describes certain 
    procedures for verification. A number of commenters proposed that the 
    regulations require the Department to provide respondents with the 
    complete verification outline, including the date and place of 
    verification, the information to be verified, and a detailed outline of 
    verification steps to be followed, by a particular date prior to the 
    commencement of verification. Some commenters proposed seven days; 
    others proposed 14 days.
        With respect to these suggestions, the Department in practice 
    issues the verification outline normally not less than seven days prior 
    to the commencement of verification. Thus, a specific regulation on 
    this issue is unnecessary.
        One commenter proposed that the regulations provide that any member 
    of the verification team who is not an officer of the U.S. government 
    must agree to be subject to the APO. We have not adopted this 
    suggestion, because as part of the Department's standard practice, 
    individuals that are not Department employees, such as interpreters or 
    embassy personnel, are required to sign a standard non-disclosure 
    agreement regarding limited disclosure of business proprietary 
    information.
        Two commenters opposed the Department's stated intention to require 
    respondents to submit any computer programs used to identify sales 
    subject to review in advance of verification. One commenter argued that 
    the computer program was not likely to be helpful because it would 
    reflect the unique aspects of each company's computer systems and it 
    would be very difficult for someone not familiar with the company's 
    computer system to understand the program. The other commenter argued 
    that the record consists of the sales listing and not the programs used 
    to generate that listing. A third commenter expressed support for the 
    Department's intention to request the computer programs.
        With respect to these suggestions, where helpful, the Department 
    intends to require that, prior to the commencement of verification, 
    respondents submit any computer programs used to identify the sales 
    subject to investigation or review. If, over time, it becomes clear 
    that nothing helpful to the verification process is gained by reviewing 
    these computer programs, the Department will end this practice.
        Another commenter proposed that the regulations provide that all 
    parties have an opportunity to comment on significant aspects of 
    verification, such as notice of verification and the verification 
    outline. Another commenter proposed that the regulations provide that 
    petitioners must submit any pre-verification comments no later than 14 
    days before the scheduled starting date of any verification.
        We have not adopted these suggestions, because subject to the 
    applicable statutory, regulatory, or submission-specific deadlines, 
    parties are free to comment on any aspect of verification.
        One commenter proposed that the regulations clarify that the scope 
    of verification is limited to reviewing the accuracy of factual 
    information submitted by respondents and that the Department will pay 
    deference to the verification reports prepared by its analysts. The 
    Department has not adopted these proposals. Consistent with section 
    782(i) of the Act, the Department will verify, where applicable, 
    information relied on in making its final determination. The SAA at 868 
    states that the Department is not precluded from requesting further 
    information during a verification. Contrary to the commenter's 
    suggestion, therefore, the Department is not limited during 
    verification to reviewing only the accuracy of factual information 
    previously submitted by respondents. We agree that verification reports 
    are evidence on the record that the Department must consider in making 
    its final determination along with all other relevant information on 
    the record.
        Another commenter proposed that the regulations provide that if the 
    Department is not able to trace information in the responses to 
    documents generated by the company or government in the normal course 
    of business or is not able to reconcile the cost of production response 
    to the company's financial statements, the Department will reject the 
    response and use facts available.
        Section 776(a)(2)(D) of the Act provides that the Department may 
    use facts available where a person provides information that cannot be 
    verified. In the interest of not repeating statutory provisions in the 
    regulations, the Department has not adopted this proposal.
        Other comments: One commenter correctly pointed out that the 
    preamble to the proposed regulations, 61 FR at 7327, incorrectly states 
    that Sec. 351.307(d)(2) provides for access to the records of persons 
    not affiliated with respondents. The correct provision is 
    Sec. 351.307(d)(3).
        Several commenters expressed support for the Department's rejection 
    of suggestions by several other commenters that the Department allow a 
    neutral third party to attend verification, copy all documentation 
    relied upon in verification, allow all parties to review all draft 
    verification reports, include in the record both the draft and final 
    versions of the verification reports, conduct verification in 
    Washington, and permit domestic counsel and consultants to participate 
    at verification. See 61 FR at 7327 (discussing the Department's 
    original response to these suggestions in the preamble to the proposed 
    regulations). We continue to believe that the original suggestions 
    should not be adopted in the final regulations.
    
    Section 351.308
    
        Section 351.308 deals with determinations on the basis of the facts 
    available.
        When to apply facts available: Section 351.308(b) provides that the 
    Department may make a determination based on facts available in 
    accordance with section 776(a) of the Act.
        Two commenters proposed that the regulations provide that the 
    Department should take into account the magnitude of the deficiencies 
    or the effect on the margin in applying facts available. One of the 
    commenters suggested that total facts available normally should not be 
    applied unless there is a consistent pattern of inaccurate and 
    unverifiable information which affects the reliability of a substantial 
    portion of the information on which the Department
    
    [[Page 27340]]
    
    must rely for its determination. Another commenter proposed that the 
    Department only apply total facts available under extreme 
    circumstances, for example, where a respondent fails to answer a 
    questionnaire, refuses to allow verification, or totally fails 
    verification. An additional commenter proposed that the regulations 
    require the use of facts available when the government or person 
    objects to verification. Another commenter proposed that the 
    regulations provide that facts available may be used to fill gaps in 
    the record. Another commenter proposed that the regulations provide 
    that partial facts available should only be used where the information 
    deemed inaccurate or unverifiable affects a large number of the 
    necessary costs or price comparisons, the information deemed to be 
    inaccurate or unverifiable is likely to have a material effect on the 
    outcome of the calculation, and insufficient transactions remain 
    unaffected by the deficiency to base the dumping margins on those 
    transactions alone.
        We have not adopted these suggestions. Some suggestions 
    unnecessarily limit the application of facts available; others already 
    are directly covered by the statute or regulations.
        Section 776(a) of the Act provides that the Department may make 
    determinations on the basis of the facts available whenever necessary 
    information is not available on the record, an interested party or any 
    other person withholds or fails to provide information requested in a 
    timely manner and in the form required or significantly impedes a 
    proceeding, or the Secretary is unable to verify submitted information. 
    In addition, Sec. 351.307(b)(4) provides that if a person or government 
    objects to verification, the Department may disregard any or all 
    information submitted by the person in favor of use of facts available.
        One commenter proposed that the regulations clarify that where 
    information has been submitted on the record as to a particular issue, 
    facts available will be used only if the information does not meet the 
    requirements of section 782(e) of the Act. The commenter also suggested 
    that Sec. 351.308(a) should be modified to clarify that the use of 
    facts available is subject to sections 782 (c)(1) and (e) of the Act 
    regarding the Department's modification of certain information 
    requirements and paragraph (e) of Sec. 351.308.
        We have not adopted these suggestions. Section 351.308(e) provides 
    that the Department will not decline to consider information that is 
    submitted by an interested party and is necessary to the determination 
    but does not meet all the applicable requirements established by the 
    Department if the conditions listed under section 782(e) of the Act are 
    met. This is different from the commenter's proposal that facts 
    available will only be used if information does not meet the 
    requirements of section 782(e) of the Act. Where the Department agrees 
    to modifications of certain information requirements under sections 
    782(c)(1) of the Act, it would have no reason to apply facts available 
    to a respondent that complied fully with the modified information 
    requirements, barring other problems involving, for example, failure of 
    verification completely or in part.
        When to make an adverse inference: Section 776(b) of the Act 
    provides that the Department may use an inference adverse to the 
    interests of a party in selecting facts available where the Department 
    finds that that party ``has failed to cooperate by not acting to the 
    best of its ability to comply with a request for information.''
        One commenter recognized that the regulations provide the 
    Department with significant discretion in determining when a respondent 
    is ``acting to the best of its ability,'' and urged the Department to 
    apply this standard reasonably and fairly in actual practice. Other 
    commenters proposed that the regulations provide that when a respondent 
    fails to cooperate, the imposition of adverse inferences should be 
    mandatory, not discretionary. These commenters argued that application 
    of neutral facts available when a respondent fails to cooperate with 
    requests for information would undermine the Department's ability to 
    obtain complete, timely, and accurate information when carrying out its 
    statutory obligations.
        The Department does not agree that the imposition of adverse 
    inferences is mandatory. Section 776(b) of the Act provides that if the 
    Department finds that an interested party has failed to cooperate by 
    not acting to the best of its ability to comply with a request for 
    information, the Department, in reaching its determination, ``may use 
    an inference that is adverse to the interests of that party in 
    selecting from the facts otherwise available.''
        A number of commenters proposed that the regulations should provide 
    that generally a good faith effort to provide information responsive to 
    the Department's request meets the ``best of its ability'' requirement. 
    Several parties opposed the ``good faith effort'' standard, arguing 
    that good faith has nothing to do with ``best of its ability.'' One 
    commenter proposed that the regulations provide that in determining 
    whether a respondent has acted to the best of its ability to supply 
    requested data, the Department should take into account all information 
    submitted by respondents. Another commenter suggested that the 
    regulations provide that in determining whether a respondent's failure 
    to provide certain data constitutes grounds for adverse inferences, the 
    Department will consider all circumstances of the respondent's 
    position, including the number of reviews in which identical 
    information has been requested. One commenter proposed that the 
    regulations provide that the Department is required to identify 
    affirmative evidence of a respondent's bad faith before making an 
    adverse inference. One commenter also proposed that the regulations 
    provide that where the Department determines that an interested party 
    has not made a good faith effort, the Department should be required to 
    state on the record the reasons for its conclusion that the interested 
    party had not made a good faith effort before drawing an adverse 
    inference.
        The Department has not adopted these proposals. As the Department 
    explained in the preamble to the proposed regulations, the 
    determination of whether a company has acted to the best of its ability 
    will be decided on a fact- and case-specific basis. The Department will 
    consider whether a failure to respond was due to practical difficulties 
    that made the company unable to respond by the specified deadline. It 
    is clear, however, that affirmative evidence of bad faith on the part 
    of a respondent is not required before the Department may make an 
    adverse inference. See 61 FR at 7327-28.
        One commenter suggested that the regulations reserve ``punitive'' 
    use of facts available for cases of deliberate misrepresentation of 
    facts because it is not fair to penalize a company for making an 
    economically rational decision about the costs and benefits of whether 
    to participate in a proceeding. Two other commenters proposed that the 
    regulations provide that no adverse inference should be drawn if a 
    party submits information that is in the form that is regularly kept 
    for corporate records, provided that such information is substantially 
    equivalent to the information requested and the party shows that 
    submitting the information requested in the required form would pose a 
    significant burden. Another commenter proposed that the regulations 
    clarify that if late in the
    
    [[Page 27341]]
    
    proceeding the Department disagrees with a respondent's methodology, as 
    a result of which the necessary information is not on the record, no 
    adverse inference should be drawn if there is no time to supplement the 
    record. Other commenters proposed that the regulations require that 
    where the Department disagrees with a respondent's methodology on a 
    given adjustment or issue, the Department will provide respondents with 
    a reasonable opportunity to provide any data necessary so that the 
    Department's revised methodology can be based on the company's actual 
    data rather than on adverse facts available.
        The Department has not adopted these proposals. As discussed above, 
    the Department will make its determination of whether to apply facts 
    available on a fact- and case-specific basis. The determination of 
    whether a company has acted to the best of its ability to comply with 
    an information request can only be made based on the record evidence in 
    a particular proceeding.
        One commenter proposed that the regulations provide that the 
    Department may conclude that a party has ``failed to cooperate by not 
    acting to the best of its ability'' even though it has submitted some 
    information to the agency, if it has not submitted other information 
    requested or failed to clarify an inconsistency the agency identifies. 
    In addition, the commenter proposed that the regulations provide that 
    the Department may use available data in an adverse manner when the 
    Department has determined that a party has failed to cooperate and when 
    no alternative ``adverse'' information is available. The commenter was 
    concerned that respondents may fail to cooperate by deliberately 
    withholding information requested by the Department until verification, 
    but then benefit from use of the information discovered at verification 
    without an adverse inference being made because it becomes the only 
    information available on the record.
        While we do not disagree with the substance of the comment, we do 
    not believe that this specific addition to the regulation is necessary. 
    Under section 776 of the Act and Sec. 351.308, the Department has the 
    authority to adequately address these types of situations as they 
    arise.
        Another commenter proposed that the regulations provide that 
    respondents must certify that their responses comply with prior 
    Department rulings as to reporting requirements applicable to their 
    company. The commenter also suggests that the regulations provide that 
    the Department will make an adverse inference whenever a respondent 
    fails to comply with prior Department rulings with regard to that 
    company without identifying and justifying such non-compliance.
        The Department has not adopted these proposals. The Department may 
    reconsider its position on an issue during the course of a proceeding 
    in light of the facts and arguments presented by the parties. Parties 
    are entitled, at the risk of the Department determining otherwise, to 
    argue against a prior Department determination.
        Two commenters proposed that the regulations provide that failure 
    to produce data from ``affiliated'' parties, over which a respondent 
    has no real leverage or control, would not justify the use of adverse 
    inferences. Another commenter proposed that the regulations should 
    provide that where a respondent has made a good faith effort to obtain 
    information from an affiliate, failure of the affiliate to provide the 
    information should not give rise to an adverse inference. One commenter 
    proposed that the Department avoid use of adverse facts available when 
    a foreign law prohibits or constrains an affiliated party from 
    providing to the respondent information requested by the Department. 
    Several commenters also suggested that the regulations provide that 
    failure to produce data where the timeframe for compiling data is 
    unduly short, mistakes in calculations and unintentional errors of 
    commission or omission, and failures to produce all requested documents 
    should not justify the use of adverse inferences.
        While we do not disagree with the substance of some of these 
    comments, we do not believe the addition of these specific provisions 
    is warranted. The Department will make determinations on the basis of 
    the facts available and determine whether to apply adverse inferences 
    on a fact- and case-specific basis.
        What to use as facts available: One commenter urged the Department 
    to apply its new regulations regarding the selection of facts available 
    in a fair and flexible manner so as to faithfully implement the spirit 
    of the law. Two other commenters proposed that the regulations provide 
    that the Department should consider information submitted by 
    respondents for use as facts available even if it is not ideal in all 
    respects. Another commenter proposed that the regulations provide that 
    in determining what data should be applied as facts available, the 
    Department will take into account all information and arguments 
    supplied by the parties including comments concerning the accuracy of 
    the data to be used as facts available.
        With respect to these suggestions, the Department will consider all 
    information on the record, including comments from the parties, in 
    determining what to use as facts available. No additional regulation is 
    necessary to accomplish this.
        Another commenter proposed that the regulations make clear that the 
    Department will not follow its previous policy of applying the highest 
    rate ever applied to the respondent to particular sales as ``partial 
    BIA.'' This would be an unlawful use of an adverse inference, because 
    the respondent would have provided information to allow the calculation 
    of margins on the majority of its sales and thus presumably has 
    cooperated to the best of its ability. We have not adopted this 
    suggestion because, the fact that the Department has not adopted the 
    two-tiered methodology for selecting BIA developed under the old law 
    (see 61 FR at 7327) does not preclude the Department from applying 
    information in a similar manner under the new facts available provision 
    where such application would be consistent with the new law and 
    regulations.
        Several commenters proposed that the regulations provide that all 
    respondents, regardless of the degree to which they are deemed to have 
    cooperated, are entitled to submit comments on what to use as facts 
    available, and to propose independent sources for use as secondary 
    information. Another commenter opposed the proposition that 
    noncomplying respondents be entitled to comment on what information 
    should be used as facts available.
        Although the Department has not adopted a specific regulation as 
    suggested, nothing prevents parties from filing comments regarding what 
    to use as facts available. Furthermore, the statute does not limit the 
    specific sources from which the Department can obtain facts available.
        One commenter proposed that the regulations provide that data 
    contained in a petition will not be used if it is based on unreasonable 
    and unsubstantiated assumptions, is otherwise distorted or is not 
    corroborated. Another commenter proposed that the regulations provide 
    that information in the petition should only be used as a last resort 
    or when all parties agree to the use of such information, and that 
    petition information may only be used to the extent that it is 
    verifiable and consistent with findings in the investigation or review.
        We have not adopted these proposals. Section 776(c) of the Act 
    provides that,
    
    [[Page 27342]]
    
    to the extent practicable, the Department will corroborate secondary 
    information, which includes the petition, from independent sources that 
    are reasonably at the disposal of the Department. The Department 
    believes the suggested additional restraints on the use of such 
    information are not warranted.
        Corroboration of secondary information: Section 351.308(d) provides 
    that where the Department relies on secondary information, to the 
    extent practicable the Department will corroborate that information 
    from independent sources, such as published price lists, official 
    import statistics and customs data, and information obtained from 
    interested parties during the instant investigation or review.
        One commenter expressed support for the Department's rejection of 
    the suggestion that information from a petition be deemed corroborated. 
    The commenter suggested that the final regulations retain the 
    requirement that information from a petition, like information from any 
    other secondary source, must be corroborated.
        We have retained this requirement. Consistent with the SAA at 870 
    and section 776(c) of the Act, Secs. 351.308(c) and (d) provide that, 
    to the extent practicable, the Department will corroborate secondary 
    information, including information derived from a petition.
        Another commenter proposed that the regulations provide that in 
    determining what facts available to use, the Department will choose the 
    most probative facts available. The Department has not adopted this 
    proposal. The SAA at 870 explains that corroborate means that the 
    Department must satisfy itself that secondary information to be used as 
    facts available has probative value, not that the Department must 
    choose the most probative information as facts available.
        One commenter proposed that the regulations provide that the 
    Department may consider information provided by industrial users and 
    consumers in corroborating secondary information. Section 351.308(d) 
    provides that independent sources used to corroborate secondary 
    information ``may include, but are not limited to, published price 
    lists, official import statistics and customs data, and information 
    obtained from interested parties during the instant investigation or 
    review.'' The Department has not amended the regulation to include 
    information provided by industrial users and consumers because it is 
    unnecessary. The Department agrees with the commenter that the 
    Department may also consider information provided by industrial users 
    and consumers in corroborating secondary information. The regulation is 
    clear that the list is not an exhaustive list of independent sources.
    
    Section 351.309
    
        Section 351.309 deals with written argument. We have made a minor 
    change to paragraphs (c)(2) and (d)(2) to encourage parties to include 
    a table of statutes, regulations, and cases cited in their case and 
    rebuttal briefs in addition to summaries of their arguments.
        Several commenters proposed that the Department accept reply briefs 
    after a hearing. With respect to this proposal, in certain 
    circumstances, the Department may request parties to file reply briefs 
    after a hearing. The Department will decide whether to do so on a case-
    by-case basis.
        Another commenter proposed that the deadline for filing rebuttal 
    briefs in investigations and reviews, under Sec. 351.309(d), be five 
    business days after the filing of case briefs, instead of five calendar 
    days. We have not adopted this proposal. Given the statutory time frame 
    for completion of investigations and reviews, the Department has 
    determined that five calendar days is appropriate.
    
    Section 351.310
    
        Section 351.310 deals with matters related to hearings.
        One commenter proposed that the regulations retain the provision 
    that certain high-level employees chair the hearing to ensure that the 
    hearings are effective and useful. The commenter also proposed that the 
    regulations provide that all Department employees who have been 
    involved in the investigation or review normally will be present at the 
    hearing to ensure that those individuals involved in the decision-
    making process will be familiar with all relevant issues prior to 
    reaching the final determination.
        While we agree with the substance of the comments, we do not 
    believe that a specific regulation on this point is necessary. The 
    Department's practice is to have a high-level employee chair the 
    hearing and to ensure that employees involved in the proceeding attend 
    the hearing.
        Two commenters proposed that parties should be allowed to comment 
    on any issue raised in the proceeding during the hearing, whether or 
    not that issue is specifically addressed in the party's case brief or 
    rebuttal brief. One commenter proposed that the regulations allow for 
    witness testimony and the collection of new evidence at hearings.
        The Department has not adopted these proposals. The introduction of 
    testimony, other new evidence, and new arguments at the hearing is not 
    feasible given that parties will have no way to prepare rebuttals or 
    respond to introduction of new information and argument. Furthermore, 
    the Department would have difficulty analyzing and verifying such new 
    information and argument at this stage of the proceeding.
        A number of commenters supported the proposed improvements to the 
    hearing process including allowing for closed hearing sessions to 
    discuss proprietary data. One commenter proposed that Sec. 351.310(f) 
    be revised to allow for consolidated hearings only if all interested 
    parties in each case agree. The Department has not adopted this 
    proposal. However, the Department certainly will take into 
    consideration any opposition to consolidation of hearings in making is 
    decision.
        Another commenter proposed that the regulations provide that 
    parties will be notified in advance of the hearing of the issues of 
    concern to the Department. We have not adopted this proposal. The 
    Department has on occasion requested that parties brief specific issues 
    of concern to the Department and will continue to do so where 
    necessary.
    
    Section 351.311
    
        Section 351.311 deals with countervailable subsidy practices 
    discovered during an investigation or review. We received one comment 
    regarding Sec. 351.311 to the effect that the Department should: (1) 
    clarify that Sec. 351.311 covers a broad array of subsidies and subsidy 
    practices; (2) clarify that petitioners do not carry the burden of 
    establishing that a newly discovered subsidy is countervailable, but 
    rather than a subsidy need only be potentially countervailable; and (3) 
    specify how much time is insufficient to preclude the Department from 
    considering a practice in the course of the proceeding. One commenter 
    opposed these suggestions.
        We have not adopted these suggestions. With respect to (1), we do 
    not believe that the requested change is necessary, because 
    Sec. 351.311 is not limited by its terms to particular types of 
    subsidies. With respect to (2), we believe that the phrase ``appears to 
    provide a countervailable subsidy with respect to the subject 
    merchandise'' adequately covers practices for which there may not have 
    been a definitive determination of countervailability. Finally, with 
    respect to (3), we agree with the opposing commenter that the time 
    necessary to investigate a
    
    [[Page 27343]]
    
    particular subsidy practice will vary from case to case.
    
    Section 351.312
    
        Section 351.312 clarifies the regulatory provisions under which 
    industrial users and consumers are entitled to provide information and 
    comments and clarifies that all such submissions are subject to the 
    Department's standard filing requirements.
        One commenter proposed that the phrase ``concerning dumping or a 
    countervailable subsidy'' be deleted from Sec. 351.312(b) because it 
    could be interpreted to limit the right of industrial users and 
    consumers to comment or file information on only the existence or 
    amount of dumping or subsidization. Another commenter proposed that the 
    regulations provide that there is no limitation on the issues that 
    industrial users may address. A third commenter proposed that the 
    regulations define ``relevant factual information'' as used in 
    Sec. 351.312(b) to include information relevant strictly to the 
    substantive issues before the Department, the sections of the statute 
    involved, and the statutory mission of the Department so as to not 
    allow already complex proceedings to be sidetracked because of 
    information and argument submitted on irrelevant issues, such as the 
    impact of orders on consumer prices. The commenter also proposed that 
    the regulations provide for the return of information and briefs that 
    go beyond this definition so that domestic interested parties would not 
    feel obliged to rebut irrelevant argumentation.
        We have not adopted these proposals. The language in Sec. 351.312, 
    which provides that industrial users and consumers may submit 
    ``relevant factual information and written argument * * * concerning 
    dumping or a countervailable subsidy'' parallels language in section 
    777(h) of the Act. The SAA at 871 also states that industrial users and 
    consumers comments ``must concern matters relevant to a particular 
    determination of dumping [or] subsidization * * *.'' This language is 
    intended to clarify that submissions and comments by industrial users 
    and consumers should focus on matters within the purview of the 
    Department's statutory authority to investigate and review dumping and 
    subsidization. In order to address the concerns raised by the 
    commenters, we wish to clarify that industrial users and consumers are 
    not limited to commenting on only the existence or amount of dumping, 
    and, for example, are entitled to comment on the scope of an 
    investigation. However, the Department will not consider comments on 
    matters not within the Department's purview in antidumping and 
    countervailing duty proceedings to be ``relevant.'' Although we 
    recognize the concern raised by the third commenter regarding 
    submissions on ``irrelevant'' issues, we do not consider it appropriate 
    to have a regulation providing for the rejection of information or 
    argument not ``relevant'' to the proceeding because the requisite 
    subjective determinations concerning the relevancy of submissions or 
    parts of submissions throughout the course of the proceeding would be 
    too time consuming.
        Proposed Sec. 351.312(b) provided for the submission of relevant 
    factual information and argument to the Department under 
    Sec. 351.301(b) and paragraphs (c) and (d) of Sec. 351.309. Two 
    commenters proposed that the regulations allow for submission of 
    factual information and argument under all provisions of Sec. 351.301 
    and Sec. 351.309.
        Upon further review, we have modified Sec. 351.312(b) to allow for 
    submission of relevant factual information and written argument by 
    industrial users and consumers also under Sec. 351.301(c)(1), providing 
    for rebuttal, clarification, or correction of factual information 
    submitted by another party, and under Sec. 351.301(c)(3), providing for 
    the submission of publicly available information to value factors under 
    Sec. 351.408(c). These provisions, in addition to the ones previously 
    listed in Sec. 351.312(b) provide industrial users and consumers the 
    opportunity to submit relevant information and argument to the 
    Department to assist us in our determinations. In addition, we note 
    that nothing in the regulations or the statute precludes industrial 
    users and consumers from making written submissions upon request from 
    the Department.
        One commenter proposed that the Department formally establish a 
    practice of seeking industrial users' comments on the issue of industry 
    support for a petition. With respect to this suggestion, section 
    732(c)(4)(E) of the Act provides for pre-initiation filing of comments 
    on the issue of industry support for a petition only by those who would 
    qualify as an ``interested party'' if an investigation were initiated. 
    As a result, we have not adopted this proposal. However, the Department 
    has the authority to seek comments from any person, including 
    industrial users, and will determine whether to do so on a case-by-case 
    basis.
    
    Subpart D--Calculation of Export Price, Constructed Export Price, Fair 
    Value, and Normal Value
    
        Subpart D, which corresponds to subpart D of part 353 of the 
    Department's prior regulations, deals with what is commonly referred to 
    as ``AD methodology.'' Specifically, subpart D sets forth rules 
    concerning the calculation of export price (``EP''), constructed export 
    price (``CEP'') and normal value (``NV'').
    
    Section 351.401
    
        Section 351.401 deals with principles common to the calculation of 
    export price, constructed export price and normal value.
        Adjustments in general: Section 351.401(b) sets forth certain 
    general principles that the Department will apply with respect to the 
    adjustments that go into the calculation of export price, constructed 
    export price, and normal value. We have revised paragraph (b) by 
    inserting ``and'' between paragraphs (b)(1) and (b)(2). In addition, 
    for the reasons discussed below, we have revised paragraph (b)(1).
        Proposed paragraph (b)(1) stated that the party claiming an 
    adjustment must establish the claim to the satisfaction of the 
    Secretary. In connection with this paragraph, two commenters suggested 
    that the Department expressly provide that the respondent bears the 
    burden of establishing that selling expenses incurred in connection 
    with home market sales are direct expenses and that selling expenses 
    incurred in connection with U.S. sales are indirect expenses. These 
    commenters also argued that the regulations should state that the 
    respondent has the burden of establishing its entitlement to any 
    downward adjustment to normal value and any upward adjustment to export 
    price or constructed export price. They argued that, as drafted, 
    proposed paragraph (b)(1) could be construed as placing on domestic 
    interested parties the burden of establishing any downward adjustment 
    to export price or constructed export price.
        In drafting proposed paragraph (b)(1), our intent was not to break 
    new ground, but rather to codify an established principle developed and 
    applied over the years by the Department and the courts. According to 
    this principle, the party in possession of the relevant information has 
    the burden of establishing to the satisfaction of the Secretary the 
    amount and nature of a particular adjustment. In the context of 
    adjustments to normal value, this rule was reflected in 19 CFR 
    Sec. 353.54 (1995) of the former regulations, which served
    
    [[Page 27344]]
    
    as the model for proposed paragraph (b)(1). Section 353.54 stated: 
    ``Any interested party that claims an adjustment under Secs. 353.55 
    through 353.58 must establish the claim to the satisfaction of the 
    Secretary.''
        Section 353.54, however, dealt only with adjustments to foreign 
    market value (now normal value), whereas in proposed paragraph (b)(1), 
    the Department was seeking to articulate a principle that would be 
    applicable to the calculation of both normal value and export price (or 
    constructed export price). Unfortunately, in the context of adjustments 
    to the U.S. side of the AD equation, proposed paragraph (b)(1), as 
    drafted, could be interpreted as shifting the burden to domestic 
    interested parties, something that was not our intent.
        Accordingly, we have revised paragraph (b)(1) to accurately reflect 
    the principle discussed above. In particular, instead of referring to a 
    ``claim'' for an adjustment in an undifferentiated manner, we have 
    referred to the two separate components of an adjustment: The amount 
    and the nature of an adjustment. With respect to establishing the 
    ``nature'' of the adjustment, it is our intent to codify the well-
    established principle that the Secretary will treat a selling expense 
    related to a U.S. sale as a direct expense unless a respondent 
    interested party establishes to the Secretary's satisfaction that the 
    expense is an indirect selling expense in nature. Conversely, the 
    Secretary will treat a selling expense related to a foreign market sale 
    as an indirect expense unless a respondent interested party establishes 
    that the expense is direct in nature. As the courts have recognized, 
    this assignment of the burden of proof is necessary to provide those in 
    possession of the relevant information with an incentive to produce it. 
    See, e.g., RHP Bearings v. United States, 875 F. Supp. 854, 859 (Ct. 
    Int'l Trade 1995), and cases cited therein.
        A different commenter maintained that proposed paragraph (b)(1) 
    appropriately reflected the Department's practice of requiring a 
    respondent to provide sufficient support for claimed adjustments 
    without, at the same time, imposing rigid presumptions concerning the 
    nature of adjustments. This commenter suggested, however, that the 
    Department should further clarify paragraph (b)(1) by stating that the 
    Department will consider both the nature of the expense and the 
    individual circumstances of each respondent's records and accounting 
    system when determining whether a respondent has provided sufficient 
    support for an adjustment at issue.
        This comment relates to another comment addressed in the section 
    entitled ``Other Comments'' at the end of our discussion of subpart D. 
    The issue common to both comments is the extent to which a firm's 
    internal record keeping procedures should dictate the results of an AD 
    analysis. As we state below with respect to the other comment, we have 
    sought, and will continue to seek, ways in which the AD process can be 
    made less onerous for all parties involved. However, the statute 
    imposes certain standards, such as standards relating to adjustments to 
    normal value and export price and constructed export price, that the 
    Department is not free to revise in order to accommodate a particular 
    respondent's accounting practices. Thus, while we certainly would take 
    a respondent's records and accounting systems into consideration in 
    determining whether that respondent had cooperated to the best of its 
    ability, we have not adopted this suggestion to revise paragraph 
    (b)(1).
        Price adjustments: Proposed paragraph (c) restated the Department's 
    practice with respect to price adjustments, such as discounts and 
    rebates. The comments we received demonstrated a certain amount of 
    confusion concerning the meaning of paragraph (c), as well as the 
    nature of ``price adjustments'' in general. This confusion may be due, 
    in part, to a lack of precision in the Department's terminology over 
    the years.
        In these final regulations, the Department has taken several steps 
    aimed at alleviating that confusion. First, we have added a definition 
    of the term ``price adjustment'' in Sec. 351.102. As discussed above, 
    contrary to the assumption of many commenters, price adjustments are 
    not expenses, either direct or indirect. Instead, price adjustments 
    include such things as discounts and rebates that do not constitute 
    part of the net price actually paid by a customer.
        Second, we have made a clarification in paragraph (c) itself. 
    Paragraph (c) now provides that in calculating export price, 
    constructed export price, or a price-based normal value, the Secretary 
    will use a price that is net of any price adjustment that is reasonably 
    attributable to the subject merchandise or the foreign like product. 
    This use of a net price is consistent with the view that discounts, 
    rebates and similar price adjustments are not expenses, but instead are 
    items taken into account to derive the price paid by the purchaser.
        The third clarification relates to the Department's policy 
    regarding the allocation of price adjustments. The Department's policy 
    concerning the allocation of both expenses and price adjustments is now 
    contained in a single paragraph, paragraph (g), and is discussed in 
    more detail below.
        One commenter suggested that, at least for purposes of normal 
    value, the regulations should clarify that the only rebates Commerce 
    will consider are ones that were contemplated at the time of sale. This 
    commenter argued that foreign producers should not be allowed to 
    eliminate dumping margins by providing ``rebates'' only after the 
    existence of margins becomes apparent.
        The Department has not adopted this suggestion at this time. We do 
    not disagree with the proposition that exporters or producers will not 
    be allowed to eliminate dumping margins by providing price adjustments 
    ``after the fact.'' However, as discussed above, the Department's 
    treatment of price adjustments in general has been the subject of 
    considerable confusion. In resolving this confusion, we intend to 
    proceed cautiously and incrementally. The regulatory revisions 
    contained in these final rules constitute a first step at clarifying 
    our treatment of price adjustments. We will consider adding other 
    regulatory refinements at a later date.
        Movement expenses: Paragraph (e) deals with adjustments for 
    movement expenses. At the outset, we should note that the Department 
    has restructured paragraph (e) so that paragraph (e)(1) now deals with 
    the term ``original place of shipment'' and paragraph (e)(2) deals with 
    warehousing expenses.
        In discussing proposed paragraph (e)(2) (now paragraph (e)(1)), the 
    Department explained that in situations where the Department bases 
    export price, constructed export price, or normal value on sales made 
    by an unaffiliated reseller, the Department intended to measure the 
    movement adjustment from the place of shipment by a reseller, as 
    opposed to the production facility. See AD Proposed Regulations, 61 FR 
    at 7330. One commenter observed that this was only a partial 
    explanation, because it did not reflect the principle objective of the 
    statute, which is, according to the commenter, to measure the deduction 
    of movement expenses from both U.S. and foreign market prices from the 
    point of production. Accordingly, the commenter proposed that the 
    Department restate the general rule, as well as the application of the 
    rule in a reseller situation.
        The Department recognizes that the term ``seller'' in the proposed 
    paragraph (e)(2) was subject to misinterpretation. Therefore, the 
    Department has modified
    
    [[Page 27345]]
    
    this paragraph (which, again, is now paragraph (e)(1)) to clarify that, 
    where the Department bases export price, constructed export price, or 
    normal value on sales by the producer of the subject merchandise or 
    foreign like product, the Department will deduct all movement expenses 
    (including all warehousing) that the producer incurred after the goods 
    left the production facility. However, in situations where the 
    Department uses sales by an unaffiliated reseller (i.e., a person that 
    purchased, rather than produced, the subject merchandise or foreign 
    like product and that is not affiliated with the producer), the 
    Secretary may limit the deduction to movement and related expenses that 
    the reseller incurred after the goods left the place of shipment of the 
    reseller.
        The purpose of distinguishing between sales by a producer and sales 
    by an unaffiliated reseller is to avoid deducting expenses that form 
    part of the reseller's cost of acquisition. In this regard, however, 
    one commenter noted that there may be different delivery patterns for 
    home market sales and sales to the United States. In response to this 
    comment, the Department has made paragraph (e)(1) permissive, in order 
    to maintain the flexibility needed to address certain delivery patterns 
    by resellers that differ by market.
        Another commenter suggested that paragraph (e) should require 
    expressly that the Department limit adjustments to normal value to 
    movement expenses that are shown to be reasonably attributable to sales 
    of the foreign like product. In addition, the same commenter argued 
    that the Department should not limit adjustments to EP or CEP in any 
    way unless a respondent demonstrates that certain expenses are not 
    reasonably attributable to sales of subject merchandise.
        In our view, the issues raised by this commenter involve the 
    allocation of expenses, a topic that the Department has dealt with 
    under paragraph (g), discussed below. Therefore, the Department has not 
    adopted this suggestion to revise paragraph (e).
        Another commenter proposed that the Department modify paragraph 
    (e)(1) (now paragraph (e)(2)) to eliminate the reference to warehousing 
    expenses, because whether a particular direct warehouse cost is a 
    movement expense or a selling expense is a fact-specific inquiry. This 
    commenter argued that the proposed rule misleadingly suggested that all 
    warehousing expenses are movement expenses, a concept that is at odds 
    with past Department practice, unwarranted by case law, and unwarranted 
    given commercial practices. According to the commenter, the proposed 
    rule constituted a change in law and practice that was not intended in 
    the URAA. As with all expenses and adjustments, the Department can seek 
    information regarding the nature of any warehousing expenses in its 
    questionnaire, instruct respondents accordingly, and make an 
    appropriate determination, based on the record in each case, as to 
    whether a particular expense qualifies as a movement expense or a 
    selling expense.
        The Department has not adopted this suggestion. The URAA specified, 
    for the first time, that the Department is to deduct movement and 
    related expenses from export price, constructed export price, and 
    normal value, and that this deduction should account for all such 
    expenses incurred after the merchandise left the place of production. 
    In this regard, the SAA at 823 specifies that in calculating EP and 
    CEP, the Department is to deduct ``transportation and other expenses, 
    including warehousing expenses, incurred in bringing the subject 
    merchandise from the original place of shipment in the exporting 
    country to the place of delivery in the United States.'' (Emphasis 
    added). The SAA includes similar language with respect to the 
    corresponding adjustment to normal value. SAA at 827. In addition, the 
    requirement to deduct warehousing expenses as movement expenses is made 
    even more plain by the language of the Senate Report, which states that 
    the Department must ``when included in the price used to establish 
    normal value, deduct * * * transportation, warehousing, and other 
    expenses incurred in bringing the merchandise from the original place 
    of shipment in the exporting country to the place of delivery in the 
    exporting country or a third country.'' S. Rep. No. 412, 103d Cong., 2d 
    Sess. 70 (1994).
        In light of these clear legislative instructions, the Department 
    has continued to provide in paragraph (e)(2) for the treatment of 
    warehousing expenses as movement expenses. However, the Department has 
    modified this paragraph to clarify that the Department will not deduct 
    factory warehousing as a movement expense.
        Collapsing of producers: Proposed paragraph (f) described the 
    circumstances under which the Department will treat two or more 
    affiliated producers as a single entity (i.e., ``collapse'' the 
    producers). Proposed paragraph (f) provided for the collapsing of 
    affiliated producers if (1) the producers have production facilities 
    for similar or identical products that would not require substantial 
    retooling of either facility in order to restructure manufacturing 
    priorities; and (2) there is a significant potential for the 
    manipulation of price or production. In addition, paragraph (f) 
    contained a non-exhaustive list of the factors to be considered in 
    identifying a significant potential for the manipulation of price or 
    production.
        With respect to paragraph (f), several commenters suggested that 
    the Department should provide that it will collapse affiliated 
    producers only in extraordinary circumstances, an approach which, the 
    commenters alleged, is the Department's current practice. These 
    commenters also proposed that the regulations contain illustrations of 
    the extraordinary circumstances in which the Department will collapse 
    affiliated producers.
        Other commenters urged that, in connection with the potential for 
    manipulation, the Department delete the word ``significant.'' According 
    to these commenters, this constitutes an unduly high threshold for 
    collapsing, in conflict with what these commenters alleged to be the 
    Department's existing practice.
        Finally, one commenter suggested that the Department clarify that 
    (1) not all of the criteria of paragraph (f) need to be present in 
    order to collapse affiliated producers, and (2) the Department will 
    look to the potential for future price manipulation.
        The differing descriptions of the Department's practice offered by 
    the commenters indicates that there has been a degree of confusion 
    concerning the Department's practice of collapsing affiliated 
    producers. We have promulgated paragraph (f) in order to clarify this 
    practice. In particular, the Department has codified the ``significant 
    potential'' criterion. The Department has not adopted the suggestion 
    that it will collapse only in ``extraordinary'' circumstances. A 
    determination of whether to collapse should be based upon an evaluation 
    of the factors listed in paragraph (f), and not upon whether fact 
    patterns calling for collapsing are commonly or rarely encountered.
        On the other hand, we have retained the word ``significant'' with 
    respect to the potential for manipulation. The suggestion that the 
    Department collapse upon finding any potential for price manipulation 
    would lead to collapsing in almost all circumstances in which the 
    Department finds producers to be affiliated. This is neither the 
    Department's current nor intended practice. As indicated in paragraph 
    (f), collapsing requires a finding of more than mere affiliation.
        We also have declined to include in the regulations examples of 
    situations in which the Department will collapse
    
    [[Page 27346]]
    
    affiliated producers. In our view, these determinations are very much 
    fact-specific in nature, requiring a case-by-case analysis, as 
    reflected in the Department's determinations in actual cases, which are 
    published in the Federal Register.
        With respect to the suggestion that not all of the factors 
    identified in paragraph (f) need be present in order to collapse 
    affiliated producers, to the extent that this suggestion is directed at 
    the factors relating to a significant potential for manipulation, we 
    agree. However, we believe that this principle already is clearly 
    reflected in proposed paragraph (f), and that an additional change is 
    not necessary.
        On the other hand, the factors concerning a significant potential 
    for manipulation relate to only one of the two elements that must be 
    present in order to collapse affiliated producers. In addition to 
    finding a significant potential for manipulation, the Secretary also 
    must find the requisite type of production facilities. To clarify this 
    point, we have revised paragraph (f) so that paragraph (f)(1) refers to 
    the two basic elements, while paragraph (f)(2) contains the non-
    exhaustive list of factors that the Secretary will consider in 
    determining whether there is a significant potential for manipulation.
        With respect to the suggestion that the regulations clarify that 
    the Department will consider future manipulation as well as actual 
    manipulation in the past, we agree that the Department must consider 
    future manipulation. However, we believe the proposed regulation was 
    sufficiently clear on this point. In this regard, we selected the 
    standard of ``significant potential'' to deal with precisely this 
    point. In the past, the Department at times had used a standard of 
    ``possible manipulation.'' As recognized recently by the Court of 
    International Trade, this latter standard may require evidence of 
    actual manipulation, whereas a standard based on the potential for 
    manipulation focuses on what may transpire in the future. FAG 
    Kugelfischer Georg Schafer KGaA v. United States, slip op. 96-108 at 23 
    (July 10, 1996).
        In addition to the changes described above, the Department also has 
    changed what is now paragraph (f)(2)(ii) to clarify that the Department 
    will examine not only whether affiliated producers share management or 
    board members, but also whether they share board members or management 
    with, for example, a common parent.
        Allocation of expenses and price adjustments: Proposed paragraph 
    (g) dealt with the treatment of expenses that are reported on an 
    allocated basis. In response to the substantial number of comments we 
    received concerning the subject of allocation, we have revised 
    paragraph (g) to provide greater clarity with respect to the allocation 
    of expenses. In addition, we have expanded the coverage of paragraph 
    (g) to include the allocation of price adjustments, and we have revised 
    the heading of paragraph (g) accordingly. Also, we have renumbered 
    proposed paragraph (g) as paragraph (g)(1).
        By way of background, neither the pre-URAA statute nor the 
    Department's prior regulations addressed allocation methods, although 
    issues relating to allocation methods arose in almost every AD 
    investigation and review. Instead, the Department and the courts 
    resolved these issues on a case-by-case basis. The resulting absence of 
    guidelines has been responsible for a considerable amount of litigation 
    that increased the costs of AD proceedings for all parties involved, 
    including the Department. Therefore, the Department believes that its 
    administration of the AD law would be enhanced by the adoption of some 
    general guidelines on allocation methods that provide a greater measure 
    of certainty and predictability.
        The statute, as amended by the URAA, continues to be silent on the 
    question of allocation methods. However, the SAA at 823-24 states that 
    ``[t]he Administration does not intend to change Commerce's current 
    practice, sustained by the courts, of allowing companies to allocate 
    these expenses when transaction-specific reporting is not feasible, 
    provided that the allocation method used does not cause inaccuracies or 
    distortions.'' Although this statement was made in the context of 
    deductions from constructed export price for direct selling expenses, 
    we believe that the principle embodied in the statement applies equally 
    to price adjustments and other types of selling expenses, as well.
        The commenters disagreed with respect to the Department's treatment 
    of allocated expenses and price adjustments and the interpretation to 
    be accorded the language in the SAA. Several commenters argued that all 
    allocations result in the attribution of expenses and price adjustments 
    to some sales that did not incur them, and remove them from some sales 
    that did. These commenters essentially argued that, as compared to 
    transaction-specific reporting, all allocation methods are defective. 
    Therefore, they asserted, the Department should consider all allocation 
    methods to be inaccurate or distortive within the meaning of the SAA.
        With respect to these comments, the Department agrees that 
    allocated expenses or price adjustments may not be as exact as expenses 
    or price adjustments reported on a transaction-specific basis. However, 
    in our view, the drafters of the URAA and the SAA could not have 
    intended that all allocations are inherently distortive or inaccurate 
    for purposes of the AD law. Under such an interpretation (1) Congress 
    and the Administration permitted something less than transaction-
    specific reporting, but (2) because allocation methods are per se 
    inaccurate and distortive, only transaction-specific reporting is 
    acceptable.
        In our view, the drafters of the URAA and the SAA were not dealing 
    with abstract concepts, but instead were dealing with issues concerning 
    the application of a law to real life factual scenarios. As the Federal 
    Circuit stated many years ago in connection with this very issue: ``In 
    a purely metaphysical sense, Smith-Corona is correct in that the ad 
    expense cannot be directly correlated with specific sales. Yet, the 
    statute does not deal in imponderables.'' Smith-Corona Group v. United 
    States, 713 F.2d 1568, 1581 (1983). Therefore, when the drafters 
    referred to allocation methods as causing ``inaccuracies or 
    distortions,'' they must have been referring to allocation methods that 
    result in inaccuracies or distortions that are unreasonable in light of 
    the objectives of the AD law.
        General rule: With the preceding discussion in mind, we now turn to 
    a discussion of the specific provisions of paragraph (g). Paragraph 
    (g)(1) contains the basic principle that the Department will follow in 
    dealing with allocated expenses and price adjustments, and continues to 
    establish a preference for transaction-specific reporting. There are 
    two principal changes from proposed paragraph (g).
        First, we have revised paragraph (g)(1) to provide that the 
    Secretary will consider allocated expenses and price adjustments if the 
    Secretary is satisfied that the allocation method used ``does not cause 
    inaccuracies or distortions.'' As discussed above, because all 
    allocation methods are, in some sense, inexact, the Department intends 
    to reject only those allocations methods that produce unreasonable 
    inaccuracies or distortions.
        Second, we have revised paragraph (g)(1) to cover the allocation of 
    price adjustments. As discussed in connection with Sec. 351.102(b) and 
    the new definition of the term ``price adjustments,'' price adjustments 
    are distinguishable from expenses.
    
    [[Page 27347]]
    
        In this regard, we received several comments that addressed the 
    relevance of Torrington v. United States, 82 F.3d 1039 (Fed. Cir. 
    1996), to the allocation of price adjustments. In that case, although 
    the Court appeared to question whether price adjustments constituted 
    expenses at all, id., at 1050, note 15, it held that assuming that the 
    price adjustments in question were expenses, they had to be treated as 
    direct selling expenses rather than indirect selling expenses. 
    According to the Court, ``[t]he allocation of expenses . . . does not 
    alter the relationship between the expenses and the sales under 
    consideration.'' Id., at 1051.
        In our view, Torrington is of limited relevance to the instant 
    issue, because the Court did not address the propriety of the 
    allocation methods used in reporting the price adjustments in question. 
    Instead, it simply stated that regardless of the allocation methods 
    used, the Department could not treat the price adjustments as indirect 
    selling expenses. Moreover, these regulations are consistent with the 
    holding of the case, because, by distinguishing price adjustments from 
    expenses, we have ensured that the Department will not treat price 
    adjustments as any selling expenses, including indirect selling 
    expenses.
        Reporting allocated expenses and price adjustments: Paragraph 
    (g)(2) deals with the information that a party must provide when 
    reporting an expense or a price adjustment on an allocated basis. One 
    commenter expressed concern that proposed paragraph (g) placed too much 
    emphasis on the Department's responsibility to verify an allocation 
    method, and insufficient emphasis on a respondent's obligation to 
    demonstrate its entitlement to an adjustment based on a particular 
    allocation method. We agree with the commenter, and have added 
    paragraph (g)(2) in order to address the commenter's concern.
        First, the party must demonstrate to the Secretary's satisfaction 
    that it is not feasible to report the expense or price adjustment on a 
    more specific basis. Such a demonstration should include an explanation 
    of accounting systems, the manner in which the expenses or price 
    adjustments are incurred or granted, and an explanation of the 
    accounting practices in the industry in question.
        In addition, paragraph (g)(2) also requires a party to explain why 
    the allocation method used does not cause inaccuracies or distortions. 
    With respect to this latter requirement, it is not our intent to 
    require a party to ``prove a negative'' or demonstrate what the amount 
    of the expense or price adjustment would have been if transaction-
    specific reporting had been used. However, the party must provide a 
    sufficiently detailed explanation of the allocation method used so that 
    the Department can make an initial judgment at the time when 
    information is submitted as to the reasonableness of the method and, if 
    necessary, issue a supplemental questionnaire. Of course, allocation 
    methods, like any other type of factual information, are subject to 
    verification.
        In this regard, we have not identified in paragraph (g) itself 
    specific types of allocation methods that the Department would consider 
    as acceptable. Before doing so, we first would like to gain more 
    experience in applying paragraph (g) in actual cases. However, there 
    are certain types of allocation methods that we believe would be 
    acceptable.
        One such allocation method applies to cases where the Department 
    uses averages, such as when using the average-to-average price 
    comparison method under section 777A(d)(1)(A)(i) of the Act and 
    Sec. 351.414(d). In such instances, we would consider as acceptable an 
    allocation method that allocates total expenses incurred, or total 
    price adjustments made, in connection with sales included within an 
    averaging group over those sales.
        For example, assume that an averaging group consists of sales of 
    products X, Y, and Z. The respondent in question is able to identify 
    the warranty expenses incurred in connection with sales of X, Y, and Z 
    in the aggregate, but cannot identify the warranty expenses incurred on 
    a product-specific basis. In this situation, it would be acceptable for 
    the respondent to allocate the total warranty expenses over total sales 
    of products X, Y, and Z. Because the sales of products X, Y, and Z will 
    be averaged together, transaction-specific reporting, if it were 
    feasible, would achieve the same result as the allocation method just 
    described.
        In addition, while not addressed in paragraph (g), the Department 
    normally will accept an allocation method that calculates expenses or 
    price adjustments on the same basis as the expenses were incurred or 
    the price adjustments granted. Thus, for example, where a producer 
    offers a rebate conditioned on the purchase of a certain amount of 
    merchandise, it would not be inaccurate or distortive to spread the 
    value of the rebate over the purchases needed to earn the rebate. 
    Similarly, if a producer granted a $100 rebate for a particular month, 
    it would not be inaccurate or distortive to apportion that $100 over 
    all sales made during that month. Such a method merely apportions the 
    price adjustment over the sales on which it was actually earned.
        Feasibility: Paragraph (g)(3) deals with the factors the Secretary 
    will take into account in determining (1) whether transaction-specific 
    reporting is not feasible under paragraph (g)(1); or (2) whether an 
    allocation is calculated on as specific a basis as is feasible under 
    paragraph (g)(2). Paragraph (g)(3) provides that among the factors the 
    Secretary will take into account are: (i) the records maintained by the 
    firm in the ordinary course of its business; (ii) normal accounting 
    practices in the country and industry in question; and (iii) the number 
    of sales made by the firm during the period of investigation or review.
        In this regard, one commenter suggested that the Department should 
    clarify that it will accept allocated expenses or price adjustments 
    where transaction-specific reporting is neither appropriate nor 
    ``reasonably feasible.'' In response, another commenter objected to any 
    departure from the language of the SAA, which refers to ``feasible'' 
    rather than ``reasonably feasible.''
        With respect to these comments, the Department agrees with the 
    second commenter that the standard in the SAA is ``feasible,'' not 
    ``reasonably feasible.'' On the other hand, the feasibility of 
    reporting transaction-specific information is not something that the 
    Department can analyze in the abstract, but instead is something that 
    the Department must consider on a case-by-case basis. For example, what 
    may be feasible for firms in one industry may not be feasible for firms 
    in another. In our view, paragraph (g)(3) appropriately reflects these 
    types of considerations.
        Some commenters suggested that in assessing the feasibility of 
    transaction-specific reporting, the Department should look solely to 
    the records of the party in question to determine what level of 
    detailed reporting is feasible. The Department has not adopted this 
    suggestion, because it might provide an incentive for firms that are 
    (or are likely to be) subject to an AD proceeding to maintain their 
    records in a less specific manner than they otherwise would. Although 
    the Department will accept allocated expenses or price adjustments in 
    certain circumstances, the regulations still retain a preference for 
    transaction-specific information.
        Allocation methods involving ``out-of-scope'' merchandise: 
    Paragraph (g)(4) deals with the issue of allocation methods that 
    involve ``out-of-scope'' merchandise. Specifically, paragraph (g)(4) 
    deals with situations in which an allocation includes expenses or price
    
    [[Page 27348]]
    
    adjustments that were incurred or made in connection with sales of 
    merchandise that is not ``subject merchandise'' or a ``foreign like 
    product.'' In some cases, the inclusion of ``out-of-scope'' merchandise 
    per se has been considered as rendering an allocation method as 
    distortive and, thus, automatically unacceptable.
        In our view, such a position is too extreme. An allocation method 
    that includes ``out-of-scope'' merchandise is distortive only where the 
    expenses or price adjustments likely are incurred or granted 
    disproportionately on the out-of-scope or the in-scope merchandise. 
    However, based on our experience, there is no basis for irrebuttably 
    presuming such disproportionality without regard to the facts of a 
    specific case.
        Therefore, paragraph (g)(4) provides that the Secretary will not 
    reject an allocation method solely because the method includes ``out-
    of-scope'' merchandise. Instead, the Secretary will apply the standards 
    of paragraph (g) to ensure that the allocation method used is not 
    inaccurate or distortive. However, in the case of these types of 
    allocation methods, it will be particularly important that a party 
    claiming an adjustment provide the explanation required under paragraph 
    (g)(2) as to why the allocation method used is not inaccurate or 
    distortive. In addition, the Secretary will pay special attention to 
    the extent to which the out-of-scope merchandise included in the 
    allocation pool is different from the in-scope merchandise in terms of 
    value, physical characteristics, and the manner in which it is sold. 
    Such information will be important in determining whether it is more or 
    less likely that expenses were incurred, or price adjustments were 
    made, in proportionate amounts with respect to sales of out-of-scope 
    and in-scope merchandise.
        Additional comments: In connection with the topic of allocation 
    methods, many commenters made suggestions as to the manner in which the 
    Department should classify expenses and price adjustments as direct or 
    indirect. The Department has not adopted these suggestions for the 
    following reasons. First, insofar as expenses are concerned, the method 
    of allocating an expense does not dictate the nature of the expense. 
    Torrington, supra, at 1051. Second, with respect to price adjustments, 
    as discussed above, price adjustments are neither direct nor indirect 
    expenses, but rather are additions or deductions necessary to arrive at 
    the actual price paid by the customer.
        Several commenters stated that the Department must be careful in 
    evaluating (1) a respondent's procedures for granting price 
    adjustments, and (2) the extent to which allocations used by a 
    respondent in its normal business records are non-distortive. According 
    to these commenters, if the Department sets standards that, in 
    practice, result in the rejection of most or all allocated price 
    adjustments and expenses, the result will be distorted comparisons.
        The Department agrees with the notion that it should attempt to use 
    allocations that are based on the most precise information available in 
    light of a respondent's books and records. Such an approach helps to 
    avoid comparisons that do not reflect the actual prices paid by 
    customers or the actual expenses incurred by respondents. On the other 
    hand, the Department cannot allow a respondent's accounting procedures 
    to dictate the Department's methodology in a particular case. The 
    Department always must balance the reporting burdens of respondents 
    against the objective of obtaining accurate results. If a particular 
    allocation method is unreasonably inaccurate or distortive, the 
    Department cannot rely on that method simply because it is the only 
    method that the respondent's records will allow.
        Another commenter stated that the professed ``need'' to allocate 
    price adjustments often flows from artificially narrow agency 
    determinations regarding the scope of a proceeding. In addition, this 
    commenter contended that the Department should expect foreign companies 
    found guilty of injuring an American industry to adjust their 
    accounting and bookkeeping practices to conform to the requirements of 
    the AD law.
        With respect to this comment, we are not persuaded that there is 
    any relationship between the need to allocate adjustments and the 
    Department's alleged narrowing of the scope of a proceeding. Moreover, 
    the commenter appeared to be arguing more against the wisdom of 
    narrowing subject merchandise than the propriety of accepting 
    allocations. In our view, questions concerning the narrowness or 
    breadth of the scope of a particular proceeding are more appropriately 
    addressed on a case-by-case basis in actual AD proceedings. Finally, 
    with respect to the comment regarding changes in respondents' record 
    keeping practices, if the Department denies an adjustment because a 
    firm's record keeping practices do not permit it to use an acceptable 
    allocation method, we would expect that the firm would revise those 
    practices if it hopes to have the Department grant the adjustment in 
    some future segment of the particular proceeding.
        Date of sale: Paragraph (i) deals with the identification of the 
    date of sale for sales of the subject merchandise and foreign like 
    product. Paragraph (i) continues to provide that the Secretary normally 
    will consider the date of invoice, as recorded in a firm's records kept 
    in the ordinary course of business, to be the date of sale.
        Use of uniform date of sale: Several commenters supported the 
    notion of using a uniform date for purposes of identifying the date of 
    sale, and specifically endorsed the use of invoice date. According to 
    these commenters, the use of a uniform date of sale would promote 
    predictability.
        Other commenters, however, opposed the use of a uniform date. 
    According to these commenters, the use of a uniform date of sale is 
    inconsistent with Article 2.4.1, note 8 of the AD Agreement. They also 
    suggested that a reasonable reading of the statute does not support 
    using the date of invoice, because that is not necessarily the date on 
    which price and quantity are established, and, thus is not the date on 
    which the domestic industry lost the ability to make a sale to a U.S. 
    customer. In addition, some of these commenters argued that in 
    situations where exchange rates fluctuate between the date on which the 
    terms of sale are established and the date of invoice, the results of 
    the Department's calculations will become less, rather than more, 
    predictable.
        In these final regulations, we have retained the preference for 
    using a single date of sale for each respondent, rather than a 
    different date of sale for each sale. Contrary to suggestions made by 
    some of the commenters, this has been the Department's practice in the 
    past.
        Moreover, there are several valid reasons for this practice. First, 
    by simplifying the reporting and verification of information, the use 
    of a uniform date of sale makes more efficient use of the Department's 
    resources and enhances the predictability of outcomes.
        Second, as a matter of commercial reality, the date on which the 
    terms of a sale are first agreed is not necessarily the date on which 
    those terms are finally established. In the Department's experience, 
    price and quantity are often subject to continued negotiation between 
    the buyer and the seller until a sale is invoiced. The existence of an 
    enforceable sales agreement between the buyer and the seller does not 
    alter the fact that, as a practical matter, customers frequently change 
    their
    
    [[Page 27349]]
    
    minds and sellers are responsive to those changes. The Department also 
    has found that in many industries, even though a buyer and seller may 
    initially agree on the terms of a sale, those terms remain negotiable 
    and are not finally established until the sale is invoiced. Thus, the 
    date on which the buyer and seller appear to agree on the terms of a 
    sale is not necessarily the date on which the terms of sale actually 
    are established. The Department also has found that in most industries, 
    the negotiation of a sale can be a complex process in which the details 
    often are not committed to writing. In such situations, the Department 
    lacks a firm basis for determining when the material terms were 
    established. In fact, it is not uncommon for the buyer and seller 
    themselves to disagree about the exact date on which the terms became 
    final. However, for them, this theoretical date usually has little, if 
    any, relevance. From their perspective, the relevant issue is that the 
    terms be fixed when the seller demands payment (i.e., when the sale is 
    invoiced).
        Finally, with respect to the arguments that the date on which 
    material terms are established is the date on which the domestic 
    industry is injured and the date on which respondents rely for exchange 
    rate purposes, in our view, these arguments beg the question of ``when 
    are material terms established?'' In paragraph (i), we merely have 
    provided that, absent satisfactory evidence that the terms of sale were 
    finally established on a different date, the Department will presume 
    that the date of sale is the date of invoice.
        Therefore, for the foregoing reasons, we have continued to provide 
    for the use of a uniform date of sale, which normally will be the date 
    of invoice. However, we have revised paragraph (i) in response to 
    suggestions that the Department clarify its authority to use a date 
    other than date of invoice in appropriate cases. In some cases, it may 
    be inappropriate to rely on the date of invoice as the date of sale, 
    because the evidence may indicate that, for a particular respondent, 
    the material terms of sale usually are established on some date other 
    than the date of invoice. In proposed paragraph (i), we had intended 
    this type of flexible approach through our use of the word 
    ``normally.'' In light of the comments, however, we have revised 
    paragraph (i) to provide that ``the Secretary may use a date other than 
    the date of invoice if the Secretary is satisfied that a different date 
    better reflects the date on which the exporter or producer establishes 
    the material terms of sale.''
        Although the date of invoice will be the presumptive date of sale 
    under paragraph (i), the Department intends to continue to require that 
    a respondent provide a full description of its selling processes. Among 
    other things, this information will permit domestic interested parties 
    to submit comments concerning the selection of the date of sale in 
    individual cases. Of course, a respondent also will be free to argue 
    that the Department should use some date other than the date of 
    invoice, but the respondent must submit information that supports the 
    use of a different date. Finally, a respondent's description of its 
    selling processes, like any other item of information, will be subject 
    to verification.
        If the Department is presented with satisfactory evidence that the 
    material terms of sale are finally established on a date other than the 
    date of invoice, the Department will use that alternative date as the 
    date of sale. For example, in situations involving large custom-made 
    merchandise in which the parties engage in formal negotiation and 
    contracting procedures, the Department usually will use a date other 
    than the date of invoice. However, the Department emphasizes that in 
    these situations, the terms of sale must be firmly established and not 
    merely proposed. A preliminary agreement on terms, even if reduced to 
    writing, in an industry where renegotiation is common does not provide 
    any reliable indication that the terms are truly ``established'' in the 
    minds of the buyer and seller. This holds even if, for a particular 
    sale, the terms were not renegotiated.
        Date of invoice versus date of shipment: Several commenters argued 
    that if the Department uses a uniform date of sale, it should use date 
    of shipment rather than date of invoice. These commenters claimed that 
    because respondents can control the timing of invoice issuance, they 
    will be able to manipulate the Department's dumping calculations by 
    manipulating the date of sale. According to these commenters, date of 
    shipment is ``manipulation-proof,'' because the date on which 
    merchandise is shipped is largely determined by the needs of the 
    customer.
        For several reasons, the Department has not adopted this 
    suggestion. First, date of shipment is not among the possible dates of 
    sale specified in note 8 of the AD Agreement. Second, based on the 
    Department's experience, date of shipment rarely represents the date on 
    which the material terms of sale are established. Third, unlike 
    invoices, which can usually be tied to a company's books and records, 
    firms rarely use shipment documents as the basis for preparation of 
    financial reports. Thus, reliance on date of shipment would make 
    verification more difficult.
        Finally, with respect to the commenters' concerns regarding 
    possible manipulation, we do not believe that these concerns warrant 
    substituting date of shipment for date of invoice as the presumptive 
    date of sale. As explained above, the Department will continue to 
    require respondents to provide a full description of their sales 
    processes. Moreover, these descriptions will be subject to 
    verification, and we are confident that we will be able to uncover, 
    through verification, attempts at manipulation. For example, the 
    Department can verify the average length of time between invoice date 
    and shipment date, and can scrutinize deviations from the norm. In 
    addition, most firms have a standard invoicing practice (e.g., three 
    days after shipment, every two weeks). Where a firm does not have such 
    a practice, or where it changes that practice, the Department will be 
    particularly attentive to the possibility of manipulation of dates of 
    sale.
        Early resolution of date of sale issues: One commenter suggested 
    that because issues surrounding date of sale must be resolved in the 
    early stages of an investigation or review, the regulations should 
    provide a mechanism under which the Department consults with the 
    parties and decides these issues prior to the issuance of a request for 
    information. This commenter was concerned that unilateral judgments by 
    a respondent as to the appropriate date of sale can result in the 
    unfair and prejudicial use of ``facts available'' should the Department 
    ultimately disagree with that judgment.
        The Department has not adopted this suggestion. While we recognize 
    that it is preferable to settle issues regarding the date of sale early 
    in an investigation or review, we believe that the mechanisms in place 
    are adequate. First, the response to the section of the Department's 
    questionnaire that addresses general selling practices, including 
    selling processes, is due to the Department earlier than those sections 
    that require information pertaining to specific sales, thereby allowing 
    parties an early opportunity to comment on date of sale. Second, 
    paragraph (i) will put parties on notice that, in the absence of 
    information to the contrary, the Department will use date of invoice as 
    the date of sale.
        Finally, there is a limit on the Department's ability to guarantee 
    that date of sale issues are always resolved
    
    [[Page 27350]]
    
    definitively at the outset of an investigation or review. Among other 
    things, domestic interested parties must have an opportunity to comment 
    on information describing a respondent's selling processes. In 
    addition, the Department also must verify this information. In some 
    cases, the Department may be persuaded by the arguments of domestic 
    interested parties or the results of verification that its initial 
    identification of the date of sale was in error.
        Indirect export price: One commenter proposed that the Department 
    make clear that its method for identifying the date of sale will not 
    change the determination of when a sale constitutes an ``indirect 
    export price'' sale. Although the Department has not revised the final 
    regulations in light of this comment, we agree that the method for 
    identifying the date of sale does not affect the method for determining 
    whether a particular sale constitutes an ``indirect export price'' 
    sale.
        Long-term contracts: Several commenters raised issues concerning 
    long-term contracts. One commenter suggested that the Department codify 
    in the regulations its statement in the AD Proposed Regulations, 61 FR 
    at 7330-7331, that the Department will continue to determine the date 
    of sale for long-term contracts on a case-by-case basis, without 
    presuming that date of invoice is the date of sale. Another commenter 
    suggested that the Department should presume that the date of invoice 
    is the date of sale in the case of long-term contracts.
        The Department has not adopted either of these suggestions. Because 
    of the unusual nature of long-term contracts, whereby merchandise may 
    not enter the United States until long after the date of contract, the 
    Department will continue to review these situations carefully on a 
    case-by-case basis. In our view, paragraph (i) is sufficiently flexible 
    so as to eliminate the need for a separate provision addressing long-
    term contracts. We should note, however, that date of invoice normally 
    would not be an appropriate date of sale for such contracts. The date 
    on which the material terms of sale are finally set would be the 
    appropriate date of sale for such contracts.
        Effect on reviews: One commenter argued that in implementing 
    paragraph (i), the Department should ensure that, in conducting 
    administrative reviews, it does not omit sales in those proceedings 
    where some date other than invoice date was used as the date of sale in 
    prior segments of the proceeding. Another commenter suggested that the 
    Department should permit parties to continue to use the date of sale 
    method established in prior segments.
        Although we have not revised the regulations in light of these 
    comments, the Department will be particularly attentive to the 
    possibility that sales may be missed in administrative reviews in which 
    the date of sale changes due to the implementation of paragraph (i). 
    The Department will address these types of issues on a case-by-case 
    basis to ensure that all sales are reviewed.
        Currency conversions: One commenter proposed that the Department 
    retain its prior practice, without adopting the date of invoice 
    presumption, for purposes of establishing the date on which currency 
    will be converted. Essentially, this commenter suggested that the 
    Department establish two dates of sale, one for purposes of determining 
    which sales to report, and a different one for exchange rate purposes.
        We have not adopted this suggestion. There is no indication in the 
    statute, the SAA, or the AD Agreement that the Department should use 
    different dates of sale for different purposes. For all purposes, the 
    date of sale is the date on which the material terms of sale are 
    established. In promulgating paragraph (i), the Department merely has 
    adopted a rebuttable presumption that this date is the date of invoice. 
    The Department cannot adopt a system under which two different dates 
    are identified as being the date on which the material terms of sale 
    were established.
    
    Other Comments Concerning Sec. 351.401
    
        Fair comparison: Two commenters contended that the AD Agreement and 
    the URAA require that a dumping margin be based on a ``fair 
    comparison.'' They believed that this requirement for a fair comparison 
    should be carried forward into the regulations, which should state 
    clearly that the Department will apply this principle to all aspects of 
    its AD methodology, including decisions regarding the prices to be 
    compared and the type and amount of adjustments to make to those 
    prices. Another commenter suggested that the regulations, or at least 
    the preamble, refer to a ``fair comparison'' as a fundamental 
    requirement.
        In response, another commenter, while agreeing that the purpose of 
    the AD law is to reach a ``fair comparison'' between the sales being 
    compared, argued that there is no reason to insert into the agency's 
    regulations a requirement that, in the commenter's view, was vague. 
    According to the commenter, in the statute Congress identified in 
    detail the method for accomplishing a ``fair comparison.''
        In our view, the regulations do not require any further 
    clarification on this particular issue. Congress dealt explicitly with 
    this question in the statute itself. Specifically, section 773(a) of 
    the Act provides: ``In determining under this title whether subject 
    merchandise is being, or is likely to be, sold at less than fair value, 
    a fair comparison shall be made between the export price or constructed 
    export price and normal value. In order to achieve a fair comparison 
    with the export price or constructed export price, normal value shall 
    be determined as follows: [i.e., in accordance with the provisions 
    discussing the calculation of normal value].'' The House Report on the 
    URAA provided further clarification by stating: ``The requirement of 
    Article 2.4 of the Agreement that a fair comparison be made between the 
    export price or constructed export price, and normal value is stated in 
    and implemented by new section 773.'' H.R. Rep. No. 826, Pt. 1, 103d 
    Cong., 2d Sess. 82 (1994) (emphasis added). Given the clarity of the 
    statute and the legislative history on this point, we do not believe 
    that additional elaboration in the regulations is necessary.
        Indirect export price: One commenter suggested that the Department 
    codify in the regulations its four-factor test for determining whether 
    sales made through an affiliate located in the United States are 
    classifiable as ``export price'' (formerly ``purchase price'') 
    transactions. According to the commenter, this test for identifying so-
    called ``indirect export price sales'' is firmly rooted in Department 
    practice, has been repeatedly approved by the courts, and was endorsed 
    by Congress in the URAA. The commenter argued that because this test 
    involves a fundamental issue in AD proceedings, the public would 
    benefit from the codification of the test in the regulations.
        A second commenter, however, objected to codification of the test. 
    According to this commenter, because the four factors of the indirect 
    export price test continue to be subject to interpretation, the 
    Department should not restrict its discretion at this time by issuing a 
    regulation. This commenter also disagreed specifically with the first 
    commenter's articulation of some of the factors. Finally, referring to 
    the factor dealing with inventory, this commenter suggested that if the 
    Department should include the test in the regulations, the Department 
    should clarify that the merchandise need only be included in inventory, 
    not physical inventory.
    
    [[Page 27351]]
    
        We have not adopted the suggestion of the first commenter that we 
    codify the ``indirect export price'' test in the regulations. While we 
    do not disagree with the commenter's characterization of the test's 
    pedigree, we have not attempted in these regulations to codify all 
    aspects of the Department's AD methodology that are well-established. 
    We generally have refrained from codifying principles that are clearly 
    set forth in the statute and/or the legislative history. In our view, 
    the ``indirect export price'' test is one of these principles. As for 
    the suggestions of the second commenter, these suggestions are moot in 
    light of our decision to refrain from codifying the ``indirect export 
    price'' test.
    
    Section 351.402
    
        Section 351.402 deals with the calculation of export price and 
    constructed export price under section 772 of the Act.
        Adjustments to constructed export price: Proposed paragraph (b) 
    addressed the expenses that the Department will deduct from the 
    starting price in calculating constructed export price (``CEP'') under 
    section 772(d) of the Act. In addition to a stylistic change, we have 
    made one substantive revision to paragraph (b), as discussed below.
        In proposed paragraph (b), the Department stated that it would 
    adjust for ``expenses associated with commercial activities in the 
    United States, no matter where incurred.'' Noting that this language 
    only required a deduction for expenses associated with United States 
    selling activities, several commenters argued that the Department 
    should adjust for all expenses incurred on CEP sales, including 
    expenses incurred in the foreign market. These commenters contended 
    that proposed paragraph (b) was inconsistent with: (1) The plain 
    language of section 772(d); (2) judicial precedent interpreting the 
    pre-URAA version of the statute, which contained language identical to 
    that of section 772(d); and (3) established Department practice.
        A second set of commenters argued in response that, in calculating 
    constructed export price, the Department may deduct from the starting 
    price only those expenses associated with activities occurring in the 
    United States. According to these commenters, expenses incurred in the 
    exporting country that are directly attributable to United States sales 
    (i.e., that are not indirect expenses) are subject to adjustment under 
    the circumstances of sale provision of section 773(a)(6)(C)(iii) of the 
    Act.
        In these final regulations, we have clarified that the Secretary 
    will deduct only expenses associated with a sale to an unaffiliated 
    customer in the United States. With respect to the suggestion of the 
    first group of commenters that we deduct all expenses incurred in 
    connection with the CEP sale, we do not believe such an approach is 
    consistent with the statute. Although section 772(d)(1) is ambiguous on 
    this particular point, section 772(f), which deals with the deduction 
    of profit from CEP, refers to the expenses to be deducted under section 
    772(d)(1) as ``United States expenses,'' thereby suggesting that the 
    coverage of section 772(d)(1) is limited to those expenses incurred in 
    connection with a sale in the United States. In addition, the SAA makes 
    clear that only those expenses associated with economic activities in 
    the United States should be deducted from CEP. In discussing section 
    772(d)(1), the SAA states that the deduction of expenses in calculating 
    CEP relates to ``expenses (and profit) associated with economic 
    activities occurring in the United States.'' SAA at 823 (emphasis 
    added).
        In addition to conflicting with the SAA, the suggestion that we 
    deduct all expenses would disrupt the statutory scheme with respect to 
    the level-of-trade (``LOT'') adjustment. The statute clearly 
    anticipates that an adjustment for differences in levels of trade will 
    not be necessary every time the Department uses CEP. However, under the 
    proposed interpretation, because the Department always would calculate 
    CEP exclusive of all expenses and normal value inclusive of such 
    expenses, CEP and normal value always would be at different levels of 
    trade. Thus, an adjustment for differences in levels of trade would be 
    necessary in almost every case. This would frustrate the legislative 
    intent that the Department make comparisons at the same level of trade 
    to the extent possible, and that the Department make level of trade 
    adjustments only when such comparisons are not possible.
        Finally, the Department believes that the deduction of all expenses 
    from CEP would conflict with Article 2.4 of the AD Agreement. Article 
    2.4, on which section 772(d) is based, requires the deduction of costs 
    ``incurred between importation and resale.'' The suggestion of the 
    first group of commenters would call for the deduction of expenses that 
    are incurred before importation and that do not relate to activities 
    between importation and resale.
        With regard to the argument concerning judicial and administrative 
    precedents under the pre-URAA version of the statute, the Department 
    notes that the URAA changed the manner in which CEP (formerly 
    ``exporter's sales price'') is calculated. Because of this change, and 
    in light of the clear intent expressed in the SAA, we do not believe 
    that these old law precedents govern the interpretation of section 
    772(d)(1) with respect to this particular point.
        Although we have not adopted the suggestion that we deduct all 
    expenses from CEP, we have revised paragraph (b) to clarify its 
    meaning. In the first sentence of paragraph (b), we have deleted the 
    phrase ``no matter where incurred'' and have replaced it with the 
    phrase ``that relate to the sale to the unaffiliated purchaser, no 
    matter where or when paid.'' In addition, we have added the following 
    new sentence: ``The Secretary will not make an adjustment for any 
    expense that is related solely to the sale to an affiliated importer in 
    the United States, although the Secretary may make an adjustment to 
    normal value for such expenses under section 773(a)(6)(C)(iii) of the 
    Act.''
        The purpose of these changes is to distinguish between selling 
    expenses incurred on the sale to the unaffiliated customer, which may 
    be deducted under 772(d)(1), and those associated with the sale to the 
    affiliated customer in the United States, which may not be deducted. In 
    addition, the phrase ``no matter where or when paid'' is intended to 
    indicate that if commercial activities occur in the United States and 
    relate to the sale to an unaffiliated purchaser, expenses associated 
    with those activities will be deducted from CEP even if, for example, 
    the foreign parent of the affiliated U.S. importer pays those expenses. 
    Finally, the reference to adjustments to normal value reflects our 
    agreement with the comment that the Secretary may adjust for direct 
    selling expenses (as well as assumed expenses) associated with the sale 
    to the affiliated importer under the circumstance of sale provision, 
    discussed below.
        One commenter urged the Department to define ``selling expenses'' 
    to exclude ``general and administrative expenses.'' The Department has 
    not adopted this suggested change. Typically, the primary, if not sole, 
    function of an affiliated U.S. importer is to sell. Therefore, many or 
    all general and administrative expenses of such firms are properly 
    considered as selling expenses and must be deducted under section 
    772(d)(1)(D).
        Another commenter stated that, in the past, the Department would 
    not deduct selling expenses in calculating CEP (formerly ESP) in AD 
    proceedings involving nonmarket economies. According to the commenter, 
    the
    
    [[Page 27352]]
    
    Department's stated reason for not making a deduction was its inability 
    to make an offsetting circumstance-of-sale adjustment to normal value 
    (formerly foreign market value). The commenter stated that the 
    Department has reevaluated this particular practice, and now recognizes 
    that the statute requires CEP deductions in nonmarket economy cases 
    irrespective of whether a circumstance-of-sale adjustment is possible. 
    The commenter suggests that the agency's regulations should reflect 
    this change in practice, and should make clear that CEP deductions are 
    required in nonmarket economy cases.
        With respect to this suggestion, the commenter is correct 
    concerning the Department's reevaluation of its practice. In a recent 
    determination, the Department stated: ``Regarding the necessity of 
    making CEP deductions, we have reevaluated our practice in this area 
    and have concluded that CEP deductions are required by the plain 
    language of the statute, which states in section 772(d)(2)(D) that CEP 
    `shall be reduced' by the selling expenses associated with economic 
    activity in the United States. Consequently, we have made deductions to 
    CEP for all selling expenses associated with economic activities in the 
    United States in accordance with our practice.'' Bicycles from the 
    People's Republic of China, 61 FR 19026, 19031 (April 30, 1996). 
    However, because the statute is clear on this point, we do not believe 
    that a change to paragraph (b) is necessary.
        ``Special rule'' for merchandise with value added after 
    importation: Proposed paragraph (c) addressed the ``special rule'' of 
    section 772(e) of the Act that is applicable in situations where 
    imported merchandise is subject to further manufacture or assembly in 
    the United States before it is sold to an unaffiliated customer. Except 
    for the modification of the percentage threshold normally used to 
    determine when the special rule applies (discussed below), we have not 
    changed paragraph (c).
        By way of background, prior to the enactment of the URAA, section 
    772(e)(3) of the Act required that the Department calculate ESP (now 
    CEP) by deducting the amount of any increased value resulting from a 
    process of manufacture or assembly performed on imported merchandise 
    prior to its sale to an unaffiliated customer. In situations where the 
    amount of value added in the United States was very large, the process 
    of calculating this deduction was very difficult and time-consuming for 
    the Department. In addition, the legislative history of section 
    772(e)(3) provided that if the final product sold did not contain a 
    significant amount of the subject merchandise, the Department was to 
    refrain from assessing antidumping duties, even though the merchandise 
    may have been dumped.
        Congress retained the U.S. value-added adjustment, in modified 
    form, in section 772(d)(2) of the Act. However, in the URAA, Congress 
    addressed the problems described in the preceding paragraph by 
    providing an alternative method for dealing with imported merchandise 
    for which a large amount of value is added in the United States. Under 
    section 772(e), the merchandise no longer is excepted from the 
    assessment of duties. In addition, instead of requiring that the 
    Department calculate and deduct the precise amount of value added in 
    the United States from the price of the finished product, section 
    772(e) permits the Department, in certain circumstances, to determine 
    the dumping margin for value-added merchandise on some other basis, 
    such as by relying on the dumping margins calculated on sales to 
    unaffiliated customers for which no value was added in the United 
    States. Under section 772(e), the Department may use an alternative 
    method where the value added to the subject merchandise ``is likely to 
    exceed substantially'' the value of the subject merchandise as 
    imported. The SAA at 826 explains that this ``special rule'' does not 
    require the Department to make a precise calculation of the value 
    added. Instead, the phrase ``exceed substantially'' means that the 
    Department estimates that the value added in the United States is 
    ``substantially more than half'' of the price of the merchandise as 
    sold to the unaffiliated customer. The SAA at 825-826 further explains 
    that the intent of the new rule is to avoid requiring the Department to 
    calculate and back out large amounts of value added, while also 
    avoiding the undesirable result of subject merchandise escaping the 
    assessment of antidumping duties entirely.
        Threshold for applying the ``special rule'' and use of transfer 
    prices: In proposed paragraph (c)(2), the Department provided that if 
    the Secretary estimated the value added in the United States to be at 
    least 60 percent of the price charged to the first unaffiliated 
    purchaser, the Secretary normally would determine that the value added 
    in the United States was likely to exceed substantially the value of 
    the subject merchandise; i.e., that the special rule applied. The 
    Department reasoned that a 60 percent threshold met the SAA's 
    requirement of ``substantially more than half.'' See AD Proposed 
    Regulations at 7331. In addition, in estimating the value added, 
    proposed paragraph (c)(2) called for the use of transfer prices between 
    the foreign exporter/producer and the affiliated U.S. importer.
        Several commenters argued against the adoption of a bright-line 
    test for determining whether the estimated value added is 
    ``substantially more than half,'' the finding that triggers the 
    application of the special rule. These commenters argued that a bright-
    line test was inappropriate and inconsistent with the SAA. In addition, 
    these commenters argued that if the Department insisted upon using a 
    bright-line test, it should use a threshold higher than 60 percent. 
    Finally, these commenters argued that the Department should not 
    estimate the U.S. value added by relying on transfer prices, because of 
    the risk that exporters might manipulate these prices to their 
    advantage. Instead, they asserted, the Department should compare the 
    price charged to unaffiliated customers for the finished goods to the 
    constructed value (cost) of the imported merchandise.
        A different group of commenters supported the use of a bright-line 
    test and transfer prices. While most of these commenters also supported 
    a 60 percent value-added standard, one commenter argued that in 
    proceedings where the absolute volume of merchandise is large, the 
    standard should be 50 percent value added. This latter commenter argued 
    that a 50 percent standard is warranted because of (1) the heavy burden 
    of reporting value added information in these types of cases, and (2) 
    the alleged distortions in dumping margins caused by the value-added 
    calculations.
        With respect to the comments concerning the use of a bright-line 
    test, the Department continues to believe that such a test is 
    appropriate and desirable. Neither the SAA nor the statute indicates 
    that the Department may not adopt guidelines in this area, and there 
    are sound policy reasons for having a bright-line test. First, if the 
    Department did not adopt a standard in these final regulations, the 
    burden of establishing on a case-by-case basis the amount of value 
    added that constitutes ``significantly more than half'' would erase the 
    administrative savings that Congress intended section 772(e) to 
    generate. Second, a bright-line standard enables the Department to 
    inform respondents early in an investigation or review as to whether 
    they will have to provide detailed value-added information.
        We must emphasize, however, that the Department does not intend 
    that its bright-line standard operate as an
    
    [[Page 27353]]
    
    irrebuttable presumption for all cases. The Department may use a 
    different threshold where it is satisfied, based on the facts, that a 
    different threshold is more appropriate in a particular case. In 
    addition, the Department retains the discretion to refrain from 
    applying the special rule in situations where there are an insufficient 
    number of sales to unaffiliated customers to use as an alternative 
    basis for determining the dumping margin on value added sales. Finally, 
    because the purpose of section 772(e) is to reduce the administrative 
    burden on the Department, the Department retains the authority to 
    refrain from applying the special rule in those situations where the 
    value added, while large, is simple to calculate.
        With respect to the issue of transfer prices, paragraph (c)(2) 
    continues to provide for the use of transfer prices in estimating U.S. 
    value added. Section 772 and the SAA are silent on the precise manner 
    by which the Department is to estimate the amount of value added. 
    However, in discussing the alternate methods that the Department may 
    use to determine CEP once the Department has determined that the 
    special rule applies, the SAA at 826 states that the Department may use 
    transfer prices. This suggests to us that, had the drafters of the 
    statute and the SAA focussed on the matter, they would have permitted 
    the use of transfer prices in estimating U.S. value added.
        While the Department appreciates the arguments raised concerning 
    the possible manipulation of transfer prices, in our view, there are 
    several factors that minimize this danger. First, because a respondent 
    does not control the selection of the alternative method used in 
    situations where the special rule applies, a respondent will not know 
    in advance whether it would be better or worse off through the 
    application of the special rule. Thus, if a respondent chose to 
    manipulate transfer prices, it would do so at its peril. Second, while 
    transfer prices may be suspect, there are some independent constraints 
    on transfer pricing, such as the transfer pricing rules of the U.S. 
    Internal Revenue Service and the valuation rules of the Customs 
    Service. Finally, as discussed below, to guard against the misuse of 
    transfer prices, the Department has raised the bright-line threshold to 
    account for the fact that any estimate of U.S. value added might be 
    inflated due to artificial transfer prices.
        We have balanced the dangers of using transfer prices against the 
    alternatives. In our view, absent reliance on transfer prices, there is 
    no other reasonable way to measure the amount of value added that 
    accomplishes the burden-reducing objective of the special rule. The 
    alternative suggested by the commenters (use of constructed value of 
    the subject merchandise) would be as complex and burdensome a method as 
    the method that section 772(e) was intended to replace.
        Having explained our retention of a bright-line test based on the 
    use of transfer prices, this brings us to the issue of the precise test 
    that the Department should apply. The Department has reviewed proposed 
    paragraph (c)(2), and agrees with the commenters that by increasing the 
    threshold, the Department would ensure that the special rule applies 
    only in appropriate circumstances. While the Department continues to 
    believe that 60 percent is ``substantially more than half,'' the 
    Department recognizes that section 772(e) requires an imprecise 
    ``estimate,'' an estimate which, as discussed above, the Department 
    must base in part on transfer prices. Because of the imprecision 
    inherent in any estimate, in these final regulations we have adopted a 
    standard of 65 percent, thereby providing additional assurance that the 
    actual value added is substantially greater than half.
        We have not adopted the suggestion that we use a 50 percent 
    standard. As discussed above, the SAA states that the Department will 
    apply the special rule only where the U.S. value added is 
    ``substantially more than half'' of the total value of the finished 
    product. Therefore, the Department cannot adopt a standard that would 
    trigger the use of the special rule when the U.S. value added is only 
    one half on the total value. Moreover, while the commenter making this 
    suggestion cited the need to reduce the burden on respondents, the SAA 
    indicates that the focus of section 772(e) was on reducing the burden 
    on the Department. Finally, we do not agree with the commenter that the 
    value added calculation is distortive or that the special rule was 
    motivated by a concern over distorted calculations. While the 
    legislative history demonstrates a recognition that the value added 
    calculation is complex and time-consuming, there is no indication that 
    Congress or the Administration considered the calculation to be 
    distortive.
        One commenter proposed that the regulations contain a presumption 
    against use of the ``special rule'' when: (a) The final goods are 
    trademarked; (b) an essential feature or characteristic of the further 
    manufactured good exists at importation; (c) the transfer price to an 
    affiliated person is less than the sales price of the imported 
    component to an unaffiliated person; (d) sales to unaffiliated persons 
    of identical or similar merchandise are not in significant quantity; or 
    (e) the Secretary believes that the circumstances preclude use of the 
    special rule. The Department has not incorporated this suggestion into 
    the final regulations. However, we believe that under section 772(e) 
    and paragraph (c), the Department has sufficient flexibility to refrain 
    from applying the special rule where the circumstances so warrant. As 
    for the specific circumstances identified by the commenter, whether 
    these circumstances would justify a departure from the special rule 
    would depend upon the facts of a particular case.
        One commenter proposed that the Department calculate the amount of 
    value added by comparing the price at which subject merchandise 
    (without value added) is sold to unaffiliated customers to the price at 
    which merchandise (with value added) is sold to unaffiliated customers. 
    Although we believe that this method would be permissible, given our 
    lack of experience in applying section 772(e), we have not codified 
    this method in these final regulations.
        Application of alternative methods to determine dumping margins: 
    One commenter argued that under proposed paragraph (c)(3), the 
    Department might assign dumping margins to special rule entries in 
    situations where no dumping margins should be found at all. This 
    commenter suggested that the Department should provide in its final 
    regulation that its preferred approach in applying the special rule 
    will be to determine the export price for sales subject to the rule 
    based on the most similar sales of subject merchandise, and that such 
    an export price will be used to compare to normal value. This commenter 
    urged the Department to give careful consideration to all relevant 
    differences between the ``special rule'' sales and the sales used in 
    applying the ``special rule.''
        We have not adopted this suggestion. In the Department's view, the 
    methodology set forth in proposed paragraph (c)(3) for determining 
    dumping margins on merchandise to which the special rule applies is in 
    accordance with section 772(e). Section 772(e) authorizes the 
    Department to use an alternative means of calculating the dumping 
    margin where merchandise has a substantial amount of U.S. value added, 
    including reliance on the dumping margins calculated on sales for which 
    there is no U.S. value added. In adopting section 772(e), Congress and 
    the Administration were aware that the dumping margins determined by 
    use of these alternative means might not be
    
    [[Page 27354]]
    
    identical to those that would be determined if the Department were to 
    calculate the precise amount of U.S. value added and deduct that amount 
    from the price. However, they concluded that the burden on the 
    Department of performing the value added calculations far outweighed 
    any marginal increase in accuracy gained by such calculations.
        Finally, with respect to the sales from which the Department will 
    derive dumping margins to apply to special rule sales, we must 
    emphasize that the Department has little experience with this new 
    methodology. Therefore, the Department is not in a position at this 
    time to provide a great deal of guidance beyond what is contained in 
    section 772(e) and the SAA. However, we do believe that whether 
    merchandise is identical may be a factor to consider in selecting the 
    sales to be substituted for the value added sales. We do not believe, 
    however, that most similar in the United States is a consideration, and 
    have not, therefore, incorporated this comment in the rule.
        Another commenter asked the Department to clarify that in applying 
    the special rule, it will base surrogate margins on sales to 
    unaffiliated persons only if those sales have been made in sufficient 
    quantities. While the Department agrees with the substance of this 
    comment, we do not believe that a regulation is necessary, because 
    section 772(e) expressly requires that sales to an unaffiliated person 
    be in ``a sufficient quantity.''
        One commenter suggested that the Department clarify that, when the 
    special rule applies, the Department will base its alternative methods 
    for calculating a dumping margin exclusively on a producer's own 
    information, as opposed to information pertaining to another exporter 
    or producer. We have not adopted this suggestion. While the Department 
    agrees that it should rely on a respondent's own data where possible, 
    section 772(e) does not impose such a limitation. In some cases, it may 
    be necessary for the Department to rely on another respondent's data, 
    such as in situations where all of a particular respondent's sales have 
    U.S. value added and are subject to the special rule.
        One commenter proposed that the Department reflect in the final 
    regulations the statement in the AD Proposed Regulations that the 
    Department normally will base dumping margins for merchandise to which 
    the special rule applies on margins calculated on other merchandise. 
    The final regulation reflects the particular requirements of section 
    772(e) of the Act. As the Department explained in the AD Proposed 
    Regulations, in situations in which the special rule applies, the 
    Department normally will apply the methodology described in paragraph 
    (c)(3); i.e., assigning a margin equal to the weighted-average margin 
    calculated based upon the prices of identical or other subject 
    merchandise sold to unaffiliated parties.
        CEP profit deduction: Proposed paragraph (d) dealt with the 
    deduction of profit from CEP. Although we received several comments 
    concerning the CEP profit deduction, for the reasons set forth below, 
    we have left paragraph (d) unchanged.
        Several commenters suggested that the Department clarify that the 
    amount of profit to be deducted in calculating CEP may never be less 
    than zero. In addition, these commenters contended that in calculating 
    the total actual profit used to derive the CEP profit deduction, the 
    Department must ignore all home market sales made at prices below the 
    cost of production.
        The Department has not adopted these suggestions. With respect to 
    the first suggestion, we believe that section 772(f) and the SAA at 825 
    clearly provide that the profit deduction never may be less than zero. 
    Therefore, we do not believe that a regulation is necessary on this 
    point.
        Regarding the suggestion concerning the treatment of below-cost 
    sales, in order to determine the total actual profit earned by a 
    respondent on the relevant sales, the Department must take into account 
    sales made at a profit and sales made at a loss. As we stated in the AD 
    Proposed Regulations, 61 FR at 7332, ``there is no provision in the 
    statute for disregarding sales below cost in this context, and doing so 
    would conflict with the statutory requirement to use `actual profit.' 
    ''
        Several commenters urged the Department to retain the flexibility 
    to calculate the CEP profit deduction on the basis of something less 
    than all sales of the subject merchandise and the foreign like product 
    throughout the period of investigation or review (e.g., on the basis of 
    a specific model or sales channel, or on a time period less than a full 
    year). We have not adopted this suggestion, because we believe that 
    paragraph (d)(1) provides the Department with sufficient flexibility to 
    use such approaches in those instances where the facts so warrant.
        However, we believe that such instances should be the exception, 
    rather than the rule, because the suggested approaches would add yet 
    another layer of complexity to an already complicated exercise and 
    would be more susceptible to manipulation, which the Department wishes 
    to safeguard against, as suggested by the Senate Report.
        One commenter suggested that the Department provide further 
    guidance regarding the calculation of the CEP profit deduction in 
    situations where there are no useable home market or third country 
    sales. We have not adopted this suggestion, because, as stated in the 
    AD Proposed Regulations, 61 FR at 7332, the Department currently does 
    not have enough experience to provide further guidance on this issue.
        Another commenter, alleging that the Department generally 
    calculates profit by deducting expenses from revenues, argued that to 
    avoid double-counting, the Department should deduct all expenses, 
    including imputed expenses, in calculating the CEP profit deduction. We 
    have not adopted this suggestion, because the Department does not take 
    imputed expenses into account in calculating cost. Moreover, normal 
    accounting principles permit the deduction of only actual booked 
    expenses, not imputed expenses, in calculating profit.
        Other commenters proposed that the Department should (1) cap the 
    CEP profit deduction by the amount of actual profit accruing on CEP 
    sales, and (2) make a corresponding deduction from normal value. We 
    have not adopted these suggestions. With respect to the first 
    suggestion, as the Department stated in the AD Proposed Regulations, 61 
    FR at 7332, the statute does not authorize a cap on the amount of 
    profit deducted from CEP. Moreover, the SAA at 825 states that the 
    transfer price between the producer and the affiliated importer should 
    not be used to determine the profit. In our view, this indicates that 
    Congress and the Administration did not intend that there be a cap. 
    With respect to the deduction of profit from normal value, we discuss 
    this suggestion below in connection with Sec. 351.410.
        Finally, one commenter argued that the Department is required to 
    calculate the CEP profit deduction on a transaction-specific basis. The 
    final regulations do not reflect this approach. In our view, section 
    772(f), through its references to ``total actual profit'' and ``total 
    expenses,'' clearly does not contemplate the calculation of the CEP 
    profit deduction on a transaction-specific basis.
        Reimbursement of antidumping duties and countervailing duties: 
    Paragraph (f) deals with the deduction from export price or CEP of the 
    amount of any reimbursed antidumping duties or countervailing duties. 
    Although we
    
    [[Page 27355]]
    
    received several comments concerning duty reimbursement, for the 
    reasons set forth below, we have left paragraph (f) unchanged.
        Reimbursement of countervailing duties: In proposed paragraph (f), 
    the Department expanded the scope of former 19 CFR Sec. 353.26 to 
    include the reimbursement of countervailing duties in situations where 
    imported merchandise is subject to both AD and CVD orders. As the 
    Department explained in the AD Proposed Regulations, 61 FR at 7332, the 
    reimbursement of countervailing duties effectively is nothing more than 
    a reduction in the price paid by the importer. Absent the 
    reimbursement, the effective price paid by the importer would increase 
    by the amount of any such duties. As such, a deduction for reimbursed 
    countervailing duties is a necessary price adjustment in AD 
    calculations.
        Several commenters objected to the proposed change, asserting that 
    the Department lacks statutory authority to deduct reimbursed 
    countervailing duties. In addition, these commenters argued that such a 
    deduction would violate Article 19.4 of the SCM Agreement, which 
    prohibits the levying of countervailing duties in excess of the amount 
    of subsidization found. They also claimed that the deduction could 
    violate section 772(c)(1)(C) of the Act by permitting the imposition of 
    both antidumping and countervailing duties to offset the same situation 
    of dumping or export subsidization. Other commenters, however, 
    supported a deduction for reimbursed countervailing duties, asserting 
    that such a deduction is consistent with the SCM Agreement and the Act.
        In these final regulations, we have retained the deduction for 
    reimbursed countervailing duties. In the Department's view, this 
    deduction is consistent with the SCM Agreement and the Act. A deduction 
    for reimbursed countervailing duties neither increases the amount of 
    countervailing duties assessed nor imposes duties for the same 
    situation of dumping and export subsidization. The deduction simply 
    recognizes that the reimbursement of countervailing duties constitutes 
    a reduction in the price paid by the purchaser. Moreover, any 
    reimbursement of countervailing duties on specific sales is directly 
    tied to such sales and is no different in substance from any of the 
    other types of price adjustments that the Department routinely factors 
    into its calculations. Because antidumping duties are reduced by the 
    amount of any countervailing duties attributable to an export subsidy, 
    no double assessment is involved.
        Finally, we do not believe that the absence of a statutory 
    provision expressly dealing with the reimbursement of countervailing 
    duties is fatal. The courts have long recognized the Department's 
    ability to develop methodologies to deal with situations not expressly 
    addressed by the statute. As the Federal Circuit stated in Melamine 
    Chemicals, Inc. v. United States, 732 F.2d 924, 930 (1984), ``there is 
    no stultifying requirement that [the Department] cite a statute 
    detailing in haec verba the specific action it may take when confronted 
    with a particular set of circumstances among the myriad that may 
    occur.''
        Reimbursement in general: Referring to situations involving 
    affiliated importers, several commenters urged the Department to 
    automatically investigate whether the foreign affiliate reimbursed the 
    importer for antidumping or countervailing duties. Other commenters 
    went even further, arguing that in cases involving affiliated 
    importers, the Department should make an irrebuttable presumption that 
    reimbursement has occurred, or, at a minimum, a rebuttable presumption. 
    They alleged that because the Department treats affiliated exporters 
    and importers as a single entity for virtually all other purposes, 
    there is no reason to treat them differently for purposes of analyzing 
    reimbursement.
        We have not adopted these suggestions, because we do not believe 
    that they are necessary or justifiable. As under former 19 CFR 
    Sec. 353.26, paragraph (f) applies to affiliated importers, and 
    requires that they certify that they have not been reimbursed by the 
    exporter. Should an affiliated importer fail to make this 
    certification, the Department would deduct the appropriate amount of 
    antidumping duties or countervailing duties to establish the EP or the 
    CEP, just as it would in the case of an unaffiliated importer. 
    Moreover, in our view, it is not justifiable to presume that the 
    existence of an affiliation will result in reimbursement or that an 
    affiliated U.S. importer, because of its affiliation, is more likely to 
    file a false certification.
    
    Section 351.403
    
        Section 351.403 deals with sales and offers for sale and the use of 
    sales to or through an affiliated party. Comments on this section 
    addressed paragraph (c) and the approach the Department should take in 
    determining whether sales to an affiliated party are an appropriate 
    basis for determining normal value (the ``arm's length test''). 
    Comments also addressed paragraph (d) and the issue of when the 
    Department should require the reporting of sales made by affiliated 
    customers (``downstream sales'').
        Arm's length test: The Department's current policy is to treat 
    prices to an affiliated purchaser as ``arm's length'' prices if the 
    prices to affiliated purchasers are on average at least 99.5 percent of 
    the prices charged to unaffiliated purchasers. We received several 
    comments asking that we codify the current 99.5 percent test. We also 
    received several comments asking that we refrain from codifying the 
    99.5 percent test, and that we instead develop and codify a new 
    methodology for testing affiliated prices.
        After considering the comments received on this issue, we have 
    decided not to codify an arm's length test at this time. We believe 
    that, while the 99.5 percent test has functioned adequately in numerous 
    cases, there may be other methods available. We will continue to apply 
    the current 99.5 percent test unless and until we develop a new method. 
    If we develop a new methodology, the Department will describe that 
    methodology in a policy bulletin. We will also publicly announce the 
    issuance of policy bulletins and ensure that they are easily accessible 
    to the public.
        One commenter asked that the Department adopt a separate test for 
    situations where the vast majority of a firm's sales are to affiliated 
    parties. We have not adopted this suggestion, because we believe that, 
    in this context, the appropriate means to make this determination is by 
    comparison to known arm's length prices. In order to perform such an 
    arm's length test, the Department first must establish that sales to 
    unaffiliated purchasers are sufficient in number or quantity sold to 
    serve as a benchmark for testing affiliated party transactions. If 
    sales to unaffiliated purchasers are insufficient, we simply will not 
    use sales to affiliated purchasers to determine normal value.
        One commenter argued that in determining whether sales are at arm's 
    length, the Department should consider normal business practices, such 
    as volume discounts, preferences for longstanding customers, and 
    differences due to level of trade. Many other commenters stated that 
    under the 99.5 percent test, the Department correctly limits its 
    examination to a comparison of prices.
        The Department agrees that a proper comparison focuses on the 
    comparability of prices charged to affiliated and unaffiliated 
    purchasers. However, the Department also agrees
    
    [[Page 27356]]
    
    that it should take into account differences in levels of trade, 
    quantities, and other factors that affect price. For example, in 
    comparing prices charged to affiliated and unaffiliated purchasers, we 
    would attempt to make comparisons on the basis of sales made at the 
    same level of trade.
        Several commenters argued that the Department should disregard not 
    only affiliated party sales that fall below 99.5 percent, but also 
    sales that fall above 100.5 percent. We have not adopted this 
    suggestion. The purpose of an arm's length test is to eliminate prices 
    that are distorted. We test sales between two affiliated parties to 
    determine if prices may have been manipulated to lower normal value. We 
    do not consider home market sales to affiliates at prices above the 
    threshold to have been depressed due to the affiliation. Therefore, the 
    Department should treat such sales in the same manner as sales to 
    unaffiliated customers. However, if a party wishes to argue that sales 
    at high prices to an affiliate are outside the ordinary course of 
    trade, the Department would consider such arguments on a case-by-case 
    basis.
        Downstream sales: With respect to paragraph (d) and the use of 
    ``downstream sales,'' certain commenters asked that the regulations 
    provide that the Department normally will require a respondent to 
    report downstream sales by an affiliated party to the first 
    unaffiliated customer. Other commenters argued that the Department 
    should require a respondent to report downstream sales only if the 
    sales to the affiliated party are not made at arm's length.
        The Department does not believe it necessary or appropriate to 
    require the reporting of downstream sales in all instances. Questions 
    concerning the reporting of downstream sales are complicated, and the 
    resolution of such questions depends on a number of considerations, 
    including the nature of the merchandise sold to and by the affiliate, 
    the volume of sales to the affiliate, the levels of trade involved, and 
    whether sales to affiliates were made at arm's length.
        However, we have decided to codify the Department's current 
    practice regarding the reporting of downstream sales when the volume of 
    sales to affiliates is small. Under our current practice, we normally 
    do not require the reporting of downstream sales if total sales of the 
    foreign like product by a firm to all affiliated customers account for 
    five percent or less of the firm's total sales of the foreign like 
    product. In such situations, the Department calculates normal value on 
    the basis of sales to unaffiliated customers and arm's-length sales to 
    affiliated customers. In addition, in certain cases, the Department may 
    decide that a percentage higher than five percent is an appropriate 
    benchmark, and, in such cases, the Department will not require the 
    reporting of downstream sales. Also, while the Department normally will 
    calculate this percentage on the basis of total sales value, there may 
    be cases where it is more appropriate to use total volume or sales 
    quantity.
        If the Department determines that an affiliate made downstream 
    sales of a foreign like product, the Department usually will not 
    require the reporting of both the sales to the affiliate and the 
    downstream sales by the affiliate. We will examine the sales between 
    the affiliated parties under paragraph (c). If sales to the affiliate 
    fail the arm's-length test, the Department will require the respondent 
    to report that affiliate's downstream sales. If sales to the affiliate 
    pass the arm's-length test, the Department normally will not require 
    the respondent to report the affiliate's downstream sales and will 
    calculate normal value based on sales to the affiliate.
        The Department will require a respondent to demonstrate in each 
    segment of an AD proceeding that the reporting of downstream sales is 
    not necessary. Similarly, the Department will analyze affiliated party 
    transactions in each segment. In other words, the fact that the 
    Department may have determined in an investigation or review that 
    affiliated party transactions are at arm's length does not mean that 
    the Department automatically will treat such transactions as being at 
    arm's length in subsequent segments of a proceeding.
        One commenter stated that the quantity of sales sold in the foreign 
    market to an affiliated customer is not necessarily relevant to the 
    calculation of a dumping margin, because the Department may compare 
    those sales to a large number of sales in the U.S. market. Other 
    commenters stated that all home market sales should be reported so that 
    Department can address each situation on its facts. Another commenter 
    stated that section 771(16) of the Act requires the reporting of all 
    downstream sales of the foreign like product.
        With respect to these comments, the Department believes that 
    imposing the burden of reporting small numbers of downstream sales 
    often is not warranted, and that the accuracy of determinations 
    generally is not compromised by the absence of such sales. Even if a 
    respondent demonstrates that its sales to affiliated parties account 
    for less than five percent of its total sales, the Department still 
    will require the respondent to report its sales to the affiliated 
    parties. Where all sales to all affiliates represent less than 5 
    percent of total sales, and where the only match for a U.S. sale is a 
    downstream sale, the Department normally will base normal value on 
    constructed value, as opposed to requiring that a respondent report 
    downstream sales.
        In our view, this methodology does not conflict with section 
    771(16) of the Act, because section 771(16) deals with the type of 
    merchandise for which the Department needs to obtain sales information. 
    Section 771(16) does not require that the Department obtain information 
    on all possible sales of the foreign like product.
        Some commenters argued that where certain types of affiliation are 
    involved, such as long-term supplier relationships, the Department 
    should not require the reporting of downstream sales under paragraph 
    (d), nor should the Department conduct an arm's-length test analysis 
    under paragraph (c). We have not adopted this suggestion, because the 
    Department believes that it should apply these provisions whenever 
    there are transactions between parties that are affiliated within the 
    meaning of section 771(33) of the Act. Therefore, if two parties are 
    affiliated, any transactions between those parties are subject to 
    paragraphs (c) and (d). However, in instances where a respondent does 
    not report downstream sales, the Department will consider the nature of 
    the affiliation in deciding how to apply facts available.
    
    Section 351.404
    
        Section 351.404 deals with the selection of the market to be used 
    in establishing normal value. We have not made any changes from 
    proposed Sec. 351.404.
        Viability, particular market situation, and representative price: 
    In proposed paragraph (c)(1), the Department provided that decisions 
    concerning the calculation of a price-based normal value generally will 
    be governed by the Secretary's determination as to whether the market 
    in a particular country is ``viable'' (i.e., whether sales in that 
    country constitute 5 percent or more of a firm's sales to the United 
    States). In proposed paragraph (c)(2), however, the Department provided 
    that the Secretary may decline to calculate normal value based on sales 
    in a particular market if it is established to the satisfaction of the 
    Secretary that (1) a particular market situation exists that does not 
    permit a proper comparison, or (2) in the case of a third country, the 
    price is not
    
    [[Page 27357]]
    
    representative. In addition, in the preamble to the AD Proposed 
    Regulations, 61 FR at 7334, the Department stated that a party would 
    have to submit ``convincing evidence'' in order to overcome a 
    determination, based on an application of the 5 percent standard, that 
    a particular market is an appropriate basis for calculating normal 
    value.
        Several commenters objected to the Department's proposed approach 
    to the ``particular market situation'' criterion. According to these 
    commenters, section 773(a)(1) of the Act identifies the ``particular 
    market situation'' in the exporting country or in a third country as 
    one of three coequal factors that the Department must consider in 
    determining whether it may use sales in that country as the basis for 
    calculating normal value. Therefore, they argued, it is improper for 
    the Department to require that parties present ``convincing evidence'' 
    of the extraordinary nature of a particular market situation before the 
    Department will invoke this statutory provision. Consistent with the 
    statute and the SAA, the Department's proposed regulations should not 
    impose a higher evidentiary standard for determinations regarding the 
    ``particular market situation'' than for other determinations that the 
    Department makes during the course of an AD proceeding.
        The Department has not revised paragraph (c) in light of these 
    comments. There are a variety of analyses called for by section 773 
    that the Department typically does not engage in unless it receives a 
    timely and adequately substantiated allegation from a party. For 
    example, the Department does not engage in a fictitious market analysis 
    under section 773(a)(2) absent an adequate allegation from a party. 
    See, e.g., Tubeless Steel Disc Wheels from Brazil, 56 FR 14083 (1991); 
    and Porcelain-on-Steel Cooking Ware from Mexico, 58 FR 32095 (1993). 
    Likewise, the Department does not automatically request information 
    relevant to a multinational corporation analysis under section 773(d) 
    of the Act in the absence of an adequate allegation. See, e.g., Certain 
    Small Business Telephone Systems and Subassemblies Thereof from Taiwan, 
    54 FR 31987 (1989); and Appendix B, Antifriction Bearings from the 
    Federal Republic of Germany, 54 FR 18993, 19027 (1989). Also, as 
    discussed above, the Department and the courts have held that the party 
    claiming that a sale is not in the ``ordinary course of trade'' has the 
    burden of proof. Significantly, both the ``ordinary course of trade'' 
    and the ``particular market situation'' criteria appear in section 
    773(a)(1).
        In short, the Department's AD methodology contains presumptions 
    that certain provisions of section 773 do not apply unless adequately 
    alleged by a party or unless the Department uncovers relevant 
    information on its own. In our view, this is an eminently reasonable 
    approach. A common feature of these provisions is that they call for 
    analyses based on information that is quantitatively and/or 
    qualitatively different from the information normally gathered by the 
    Department as part of its standard AD analysis. If the Department were 
    to routinely seek the information called for by these provisions in 
    every case, the Department's ability to comply with its statutory 
    deadlines would be significantly impaired. Moreover, in many instances, 
    the exercise would prove to be pointless and a waste of resources for 
    both the Department and the parties involved. For example, absent an 
    adequate allegation, it would not make much sense to routinely 
    investigate whether Japan is a nonmarket economy country merely to 
    ensure that section 773(c) of the Act does not apply.
        In the Department's view, the criteria of a ``particular market 
    situation'' and the ``representativeness'' of prices fall into the 
    category of issues that the Department need not, and should not, 
    routinely consider. In this regard, we note that the SAA at 822, 
    through its repeated use of the words ``may'' and ``might,'' appears to 
    treat the ``particular market situation'' criterion as a discretionary 
    criterion that is subordinate to the primary criterion of 
    ``viability.'' In addition, the SAA at 821 recognizes that the 
    Department must inform exporters at an early stage of a proceeding as 
    to which sales they must report. This objective would be frustrated if 
    the Department routinely analyzed the existence of a ``particular 
    market situation'' or the ``representativeness'' of third country 
    sales.
        Having said this, however, we believe that the language in the 
    preamble concerning ``convincing evidence'' was not consistent with 
    proposed paragraph (c)(2) and was unartful, at best. It was not the 
    Department's intent to establish an entirely new evidentiary standard, 
    such as the ``clear and convincing evidence'' standard that is 
    sometimes used in civil matters. Instead, by using the phrase ``if it 
    is established to the satisfaction of the Secretary'' in paragraph 
    (c)(2), we merely were attempting to provide that the party alleging 
    the existence of a ``particular market situation'' or that sales are 
    not ``representative'' has the burden of demonstrating that there is a 
    reasonable basis for believing that a ``particular market situation'' 
    exists or that sales are not ``representative.''
        One commenter proposed that the Department recognize that 
    significant sales to affiliated parties constitute a ``particular 
    market situation'' that may cause a specific market to be 
    ``inappropriate as a basis for determining normal value.'' The 
    Department has not adopted this recommendation, because under the 
    statute and these regulations, the Department may use affiliated party 
    sales if they are made at arm's-length prices. If affiliated party 
    sales are made at arm's-length prices, there is no basis for concluding 
    that the mere fact of affiliation precludes a proper comparison. By 
    definition, such sales are equivalent to sales to unaffiliated parties.
        Another commenter suggested that the Department revise Sec. 351.404 
    to allow the Department to reject a given third-country market if 
    prices to that country are ``not representative for reasons other than 
    for supporting dumping.'' In other words, if high prices in a third 
    country support dumping to the United States, the Department should not 
    disregard those prices as ``not representative.'' This commenter also 
    argued that it would be useful for the regulations to contain a 
    definition of ``representative,'' and that ``representative prices'' 
    are market-set prices, as opposed to fictitious or artificial prices.
        The Department has not included a definition of representative 
    prices in these regulations, because the Department does not yet have 
    sufficient experience with this new statutory term to provide 
    meaningful guidance. However, the Department does not agree with the 
    implication in the comment that ``not representative'' can mean only 
    that the prices are unrepresentatively low, nor does the Department 
    agree with the suggestion that it must identify the reasons for a 
    particular respondent's pricing scheme.
        Another commenter, referring to the Department's explanation of 
    proposed Sec. 351.404, proposed that the final regulation provide that 
    the Department will interpret the term ``quantity'' in a broad manner. 
    In addition, this commenter argued, the final rule should clarify that 
    the Department always will determine quantity on the basis of the 
    ``aggregate'' sales of the foreign like product. This commenter also 
    urged the Department to define the terms ``representative,'' 
    ``particular market situation,'' and ``proper comparison,''
    
    [[Page 27358]]
    
    and to use narrow definitions based on the language in the SAA. 
    Finally, with regard to selection of a third country market, this 
    commenter suggested that the Department elaborate on the ``other 
    relevant factors'' it will consider under Sec. 351.404(e)(3), and that 
    the final regulation include a statement that all of the criteria do 
    not have to be present in order to select a market and that no one 
    criterion is dispositive.
        The Department has not adopted these suggestions. First, with 
    respect to ``quantity,'' because the SAA at 821 is clear that the term 
    quantity is to be interpreted broadly, there is no need for a 
    regulation. Second, regarding ``aggregate sales,'' the final regulation 
    adopts the language of the proposed Sec. 351.404(b)(2), which states 
    that the Secretary ``normally'' will determine whether sales are in 
    sufficient quantity based on ``aggregate'' sales of the foreign like 
    product. We have retained the word ``normally'' in order to provide the 
    Department with the flexibility to deal with unusual situations. Third, 
    regarding definitions of terms, as suggested previously, ``particular 
    market situation'', ``representative'' prices, and ``proper 
    comparisons'' are new concepts added to the Act by the URAA. The 
    Department does not have sufficient experience in applying these new 
    terms to provide any additional guidance at this time. Finally, with 
    respect to the selection of a third country market, in proposed 
    Sec. 351.404(e)(3), we left the term ``other relevant factors'' 
    undefined precisely because we cannot foresee all of the possible 
    factual scenarios that we may encounter in future cases. In addition, 
    we believe that Sec. 351.404(e) is sufficiently clear that (1) not all 
    of the three criteria need be present in order to justify the selection 
    of a particular market, and (2) no single criterion is dispositive.
        Time limits: Proposed paragraph (d) cross-referenced proposed 
    Sec. 351.301(d)(1), in which the Department provided that allegations 
    regarding viability, including allegations regarding a particular 
    market situation or the unrepresentativeness of prices, must be 
    submitted within 40 days after the date on which the initial AD 
    questionnaire was transmitted. Section 351.301(d)(1) also authorized 
    the Secretary to alter the 40-day time limit. We have addressed 
    comments regarding Sec. 351.301(d)(1) below in connection with our 
    discussion of that section.
        One commenter proposed that the regulations explicitly state that 
    the Department will make its viability determination early in a 
    proceeding. The Department has not adopted this suggestion. We agree 
    that the Department should strive to make viability determinations 
    early in an investigation or review, and, as noted above, we have 
    drafted Sec. 351.404 with this objective in mind. However, there may be 
    instances in which the Department must delay or reconsider a decision 
    on viability.
    
    Section 351.405
    
        Section 351.405 deals with the calculation of normal value based on 
    constructed value (``CV'').
        Appropriate market for determining profit: Subparagraph (A) of 
    section 773(e)(2) of the Act sets forth the preferred method for 
    determining the amount of selling, general, and administrative 
    (``SG&A'') expenses and profit to be included in constructed value. 
    Subparagraph (B) of that section sets forth three alternative methods. 
    In proposed Sec. 351.405(b), the Department defined the term ``foreign 
    country'' differently for purposes of subparagraphs (A) and (B).
        With respect to these definitions, one commenter argued that well-
    established rules of statutory construction preclude the Department 
    from defining the term ``foreign country'' differently in different 
    subparagraphs of the same statutory provision. This commenter observed 
    that section 773(e)(2) provides that for both the preferred method 
    under subparagraph (A) and the alternative methods under subparagraph 
    (B), the Department must determine SG&A expenses and profit on the 
    basis of sales of the foreign like product ``for consumption in the 
    foreign country.'' The commenter further noted that the phrase ``for 
    consumption in the foreign country'' appears in the statute with 
    respect to each of the four methods for computing SG&A and profit. 
    Thus, according to the commenter, there is no basis for the Department 
    to construe the phrase ``foreign country'' to mean either the home 
    market or a third country for purposes of subparagraph (A), while at 
    the same time interpreting the identical phrase to mean only the home 
    market for purposes of subparagraph (B). The commenter believed that 
    the Department should compute SG&A and profit for CV exclusively by 
    reference to home market sales.
        Another commenter also argued that the Department should not 
    interpret the term ``foreign country'' differently for purposes of 
    subparagraphs (A) and (B). However, unlike the prior commenter, this 
    commenter believed that the correct interpretation allows the 
    Department to compute SG&A and profit on the basis of either home 
    market or third country sales, as appropriate, under any of the methods 
    listed in section 773(e)(2). In this commenter's view, to limit the 
    alternative SG&A and profit methods to home market experience, as the 
    Department proposed, would be inconsistent with the intent of the 
    drafters of the URAA and the AD Agreement. Moreover, this commenter 
    noted, such an interpretation would be logically inconsistent in 
    circumstances where, because the Department has found the home market 
    to be non-viable, the Department uses third country data for normal 
    value. Accordingly, the commenter suggested, the Department should 
    revise proposed paragraph (b) in order to retain flexibility to use 
    third country profit and SG&A experience in computing CV under the 
    alternative methods of subparagraph (B), as well as under the preferred 
    method of subparagraph (A).
        The Department has not adopted the suggestions of either commenter. 
    With respect to the three alternative methods, the SAA and the AD 
    Agreement expressly indicate that profit and SG&A are to be based on 
    home market sales. Thus, the Department cannot adopt the proposal to 
    use third country profit and SG&A under the alternative methods. By 
    contrast, with respect to the preferred method, the SAA and the AD 
    Agreement are silent as to the market on which SG&A and profit should 
    be based. The absence of any express intent in the SAA or other 
    legislative history with respect to the preferred method--in contrast 
    to the express intent set forth in these same documents regarding the 
    alternative methods--indicates that, in the case of this particular 
    issue, the drafters did not intend that the preferred and alternative 
    methods be identical.
        The Department believes that in situations where an exporter's 
    third country sales form the basis for normal value, but the Department 
    resorts to CV (because, for example, third country sales are below 
    cost), third country sales constitute the most reasonable and accurate 
    basis for calculating profit and SG&A. In such situations, because the 
    Department already has rejected a respondent's home market sales as a 
    basis for normal value, the Department also must reject SG&A and profit 
    based on those sales. Further, where a respondent reports third country 
    COP data, use of third country sales is the most practical basis for 
    deriving profit and SG&A for both the Department and the respondent, 
    because the respondent already will have reported the necessary data.
        Determination of product categories for calculation of SG&A and 
    profit: In the AD Proposed Regulations, 61 FR at 7335, the Department 
    stated that it would calculate SG&A and profit on the
    
    [[Page 27359]]
    
    basis of aggregate figures for all covered foreign like products. A 
    number of commenters disagreed with this approach. Although differing 
    somewhat in their respective statutory interpretations and suggestions, 
    all of the commenters generally agreed that the Act requires the 
    Department to compute SG&A and profit on a basis narrower than that 
    contemplated by the Department. In this regard, some of the commenters 
    recommended that the regulations provide for the calculation of SG&A 
    and profit on the basis of different product groupings, and that such 
    groupings be limited to those models of the foreign like products 
    capable of comparison to each model of the subject merchandise. Other 
    commenters suggested an even narrower, model-specific basis for 
    computing SG&A and profit; i.e., when the Department disregards all 
    home market sales of a particular model of the foreign like product, it 
    would select the next most similar model as the basis for computing 
    SG&A and profit.
        The Department recognizes that there are other methods available 
    for computing SG&A and profit for CV under section 773(e)(2)(A) of the 
    Act, including those suggested by the commenters. We continue to 
    believe, however, that an aggregate calculation that encompasses all 
    foreign like products under consideration for normal value represents a 
    reasonable interpretation of the statute. This approach is consistent 
    with the Department's method of computing SG&A and profit under the 
    pre-URAA version of the statute, and, while the URAA revised certain 
    aspects of the SG&A and profit calculation, we do not believe that 
    Congress intended to change this particular aspect of our practice.
        Moreover, the Department believes that in applying the preferred 
    method for computing SG&A and profit under section 773(e)(2)(A), the 
    use of aggregate data results in a reasonable and practical measure of 
    profit that the Department can apply consistently in each case. By 
    contrast, a method based on varied groupings of foreign like products, 
    each defined by a minimum set of matching criteria shared with a 
    particular model of the subject merchandise, would add an additional 
    layer of complexity and uncertainty to AD proceedings without 
    generating more accurate results.
        Inclusion of below-cost sales in the calculation of profit: One 
    commenter argued that, in calculating CV profit, the Department should 
    exclude all below-cost sales, whether or not the Department disregarded 
    such sales as being outside the ordinary course of trade under section 
    773(b) of the Act. This commenter believed that the SAA at 840 supports 
    this position in that it provides for the use of profitable sales as 
    the basis for calculating CV profit in most cases. In the commenter's 
    view, the Department's regulations should implement the legislative and 
    administrative intent by providing that the loss resulting from any 
    below-cost sale will not enter into the profit calculation for CV.
        Another commenter disagreed with the proposal that the Department 
    automatically exclude all below-cost sales from the profit calculation, 
    arguing that the statutory directive for computing CV profit (as well 
    as SG&A expenses) requires that the Department use sales ``in the 
    ordinary course of trade'' in making its profit calculations. This 
    commenter contended that if, under its below-cost test, the Department 
    does not disregard below-cost sales of a foreign like product, those 
    sales are in the ordinary course of trade, notwithstanding that they 
    are at below-cost prices. Thus, according to the commenter, the 
    Department should account for such sales in the CV profit calculation. 
    The commenter further noted that the statute provides no restriction on 
    using home market sales in the ordinary course of trade in the first 
    and third alternative profit methods under section 773(e)(2)(B) of the 
    Act. Accordingly, the commenter maintained, the Department must use all 
    home market sales to compute profit under these alternative profit 
    methods.
        The Department believes that, in computing profit for CV, the 
    automatic exclusion of below-cost sales would be contrary to the 
    statute. In computing profit under the preferred and second alternative 
    methods, the statute allows for the exclusion of sales outside the 
    ordinary course of trade. The statutory definition of ordinary course 
    of trade, in turn, provides that only those below-cost sales that are 
    ``disregarded under section 773(b)(1)'' of the Act are automatically 
    considered to be outside the ordinary course of trade. In other words, 
    the fact that sales of the foreign like product are below cost does not 
    automatically trigger their exclusion. Instead, such sales must have 
    been disregarded under the cost test before the Department will exclude 
    from the calculation of CV profit.
        In addition, we believe that the SAA at 840 supports this position. 
    The SAA states that unlike the Department's old law practice (under 
    which the Department accounted for all sales, including sales 
    disregarded as being below-cost, in the computation of profit), the new 
    statute precludes the Department from including in its calculation of 
    profit any below-cost sales that the Department disregards under 
    section 773(b)(1) of the Act. Consequently, under the new law and as 
    described in the SAA, profitable sales would constitute the majority of 
    the transactions used to compute profit for CV under the preferred and 
    second alternative methods.
        With respect to the other alternative profit methods authorized by 
    section 773(e)(2)(B), the Department believes that the absence of any 
    ordinary course of trade restrictions under the first alternative is a 
    clear indication that the Department normally should calculate profit 
    under this method on the basis of all home market sales, without regard 
    to whether such sales were made at below-cost prices. However, the same 
    cannot be said of the third alternative method, which provides for the 
    use of ``any other reasonable method'' in determining CV profit. The 
    SAA at 841 makes it clear that, given the absence of any comparable 
    standard under the prior statute, it would be inappropriate to 
    establish methods and benchmarks for applying this alternative. Thus, 
    depending on the circumstances and the availability of data, there may 
    be instances in which the Department would consider it necessary to 
    exclude certain home market sales that are outside the ordinary course 
    of trade in order to compute a reasonable measure of profit for CV 
    under the third alternative method.
        Abnormally high profits: One commenter recommended that the 
    regulations state that above-cost sales are not ``in the ordinary 
    course of trade'' for purposes of determining CV profit when the use of 
    those sales would lead to irrational or unrepresentative results. This 
    commenter noted that the SAA at 834 and 840 refers to sales with 
    ``abnormally high profits'' and merchandise sold at ``aberrational 
    prices'' as examples of transactions that the Department may consider 
    as being ``outside the ordinary course of trade'' for purposes of 
    determining CV profit. Based on these examples, the commenter posited 
    that if the Department excluded the vast majority of a respondent's 
    sales from the profit calculation because they were below cost, the few 
    remaining above-cost sales, by definition, would be sold at 
    aberrational prices. As such, the Department also would have to exclude 
    those sale from the CV profit calculation.
        Another commenter suggested that the regulations stringently define 
    the phrase ``abnormally high profits.'' This
    
    [[Page 27360]]
    
    commenter argued that the fact that profit margins are relatively high 
    is an insufficient basis for determining that profits are ``abnormal.'' 
    Instead, the commenter argued, the burden of establishing that a given 
    profit amount is ``abnormal'' should be very high, and should be based 
    on express economic assumptions.
        The Department agrees that the sales used as the basis for CV 
    profit should not lead to irrational or unrepresentative results. 
    However, we have not adopted the first commenter's recommendation, 
    because there may be instances in which it would be appropriate to base 
    profit on a small number of above-cost sales. Specifically, where the 
    Department finds a majority of sales of a foreign like product to be at 
    below-cost prices (and, thus, excludes those sales from the calculation 
    of profit), the fact that only a few sales remain at above-cost prices 
    does not, by itself, render such sales outside the ordinary course of 
    trade. Rather, it is the below-cost sales that are outside the ordinary 
    course of trade. Whether the few remaining above-cost sales are also 
    outside the ordinary course of trade is a separate issue that depends 
    on the facts and circumstances surrounding these transactions.
        In this regard, the Department believes that the burden of showing 
    that profits earned from above-cost sales are ``abnormal'' (or 
    otherwise unusable as the basis for CV profit) rests with the party 
    making the claim. We do not consider it appropriate, however, to 
    establish a stringent evidentiary burden in the regulations, as 
    suggested by the second commenter. In most instances, proof that the 
    profits earned by respondent on specific sales are abnormal will depend 
    on a number of factors, including the type of merchandise under 
    investigation or review and the normal business practices of the 
    respondent and of the industry in which the merchandise is sold. Thus, 
    the Department believes it appropriate to make such ordinary course of 
    trade determinations on a case-by-case basis.
        Profit ceiling: One commenter proposed that the regulations impose 
    a ceiling on the amount of profit to be used in those cases where no or 
    too few foreign market sales are found to be made ``in the ordinary 
    course of trade.'' For such a ceiling, the commenter suggested that the 
    Department use the average profit rate for the industry that produces/
    sells the subject merchandise.
        The Department does not believe that there is a statutory basis for 
    imposing a profit ceiling. Consistent with our position in the 
    preceding comment, where there are only a few sales made by a 
    respondent in the ordinary course of trade, such sales would form the 
    basis for CV profit, because they would fulfill the requirement for 
    actual profits under section 773(e)(2)(A) of the Act. It would 
    contradict the plain language of the statute (which calls for the use 
    of respondent's actual profits for a foreign like product) were the 
    Department to impose an industry-wide ceiling on the profit used for 
    CV.
        Moreover, in instances where there are no sales in the ordinary 
    course of trade from which to compute profit, section 773(e)(2)(B) of 
    the Act does not provide that a profit ceiling be imposed for each of 
    the alternative methodologies. Instead, only the third alternative 
    method (i.e., amounts realized under any other reasonable method) 
    requires that the Department consider a ``ceiling'' on the amount 
    calculated for CV profit. Here too, however, the Department believes 
    that the commenter's recommended industry-wide average profit ceiling 
    does not conform to the statutory requirement. Section 
    773(e)(2)(B)(iii) of the Act provides that the so-called ``profit cap'' 
    be determined based on amounts realized by other exporters or producers 
    in the foreign country in connection with sales of merchandise that is 
    the same general category as the subject merchandise. This differs from 
    the commenter's suggestion in two important respects. First, the 
    statutory profit cap is to be derived from sales in the general 
    category of products and, thus, encompasses a group of products that is 
    broader than the subject merchandise. Second, where it relies on the 
    third alternative method, the Department is required to determine the 
    profit cap figure based on sales in the foreign country exclusive of 
    profits realized by the exporter or producer under investigation or 
    review. By contrast, the proposed average industry-wide profit figure 
    presumably would include sales by all exporters and producers in all 
    markets, including sales by the exporter and producer in question and 
    sales to the United States. In our view, the statute prohibits the use 
    of such sales for this purpose.
        Finally, it is important to note that the SAA at 841 anticipates 
    situations in which the Department will be unable to determine a profit 
    cap due to an absence of the appropriate data. In these instances, the 
    Department may apply the third alternative profit method on the basis 
    of facts available. However, the Department will not make adverse 
    inferences in applying facts available, unless the respondent did not 
    cooperate to the best of its ability during the course of the 
    investigation or review.
        Use of other producer's profit data: One commenter suggested that 
    the regulations state that, when calculating a respondent's profit for 
    CV under section 773(e)(2)(B) of the Act, the Department will resort to 
    the second alternative method (other producers' profits for the foreign 
    like product) only in exceptional circumstances. The commenter 
    contended that the adoption of this principle will help to ensure 
    fairness and predictability in AD proceedings.
        In our view, the SAA at 840 makes clear that there is no hierarchy 
    or preference among the three alternative methods for calculating 
    profit under section 773(e)(2)(B). Rather, the SAA provides that the 
    Department's selection of an alternative profit calculation method will 
    be made on a case-by-case basis, and will depend, to an extent, on the 
    data available with regard to profits earned in the foreign market. For 
    this reason, we have not adopted the commenter's recommendation to 
    limit the use of the second alternative method to exceptional 
    circumstances, because such an approach would impose a preference in 
    favor of the first and third alternative methods.
    
    Section 351.406
    
        Section 351.406 deals with the analysis of whether to disregard 
    certain sales as below the cost of production under section 773(b) of 
    the Act.
        Extended period of time: Several commenters made suggestions 
    regarding the ``extended period of time'' criterion for below-cost 
    sales under section 773(b)(1)(A) of the Act. Two of these commenters 
    disagreed with the statement in the AD Proposed Regulations, 61 FR at 
    7336, that the Department would exclude below-cost sales made during 
    only one month of the period of investigation or review. These 
    commenters maintained that because one-month's worth of sales do not 
    represent the pricing practices of a company over a full investigation 
    or review period, the Department should not consider such sales to have 
    been made within an extended period of time. Similarly, another 
    commenter recommended that the Department establish criteria for 
    determining when sales of ``custom'' products (products not 
    manufactured continuously throughout the period of investigation or 
    review) have been made ``within an extended period of time in 
    substantial quantities.''
        The Department has not adopted these suggestions, because we 
    believe that the SAA is clear as to when below-
    
    [[Page 27361]]
    
     cost sales have occurred ``within an extended period of time.'' The 
    SAA at 831-832 states that ``below-cost sales need occur only within 
    (rather than over) an extended period of time.'' According to the SAA, 
    this means that the Department ``no longer must find that below-cost 
    sales occurred in a minimum number of months before excluding such 
    sales from its analysis.'' Thus, for example, where a particular model 
    is sold at prices below the cost of production during one month of the 
    period of investigation or review (and where such sales are in 
    substantial quantities and are not at prices that would permit cost 
    recovery), the Department may disregard these sales in its 
    determination of normal value.
        Another commenter made two recommendations regarding the language 
    in proposed paragraph (b) that an extended period of time ``normally 
    will coincide with the period in which the sales under consideration 
    for the determination of normal value were made.'' First, the commenter 
    cited the statutory requirement that the substantial quantity of below-
    cost sales occur ``within'' the extended period of time, and not 
    ``over'' that period. Based on this requirement, the commenter argued, 
    paragraph (b) should not state that the period required to satisfy the 
    ``extended period of time'' criterion must be as long as, or 
    ``coincide'' with, the period of investigation or review. Second, this 
    commenter noted that under proposed paragraph (b), the period in which 
    ``sales under consideration'' are made could vary by model or part 
    number. For example, according to this commenter, if a model was 
    discontinued only a few months into the period of review, paragraph 
    (b), as drafted, would limit the ``extended period of time'' to the 
    duration of sales of that model. The commenter suggested that if the 
    Department intends that the entire period of investigation or review 
    constitute the ``extended period of time,'' it should make this clear 
    in the final regulations.
        It was not the Department's intention (nor do we believe it to be 
    the case) that the use of the word ``coincide'' in proposed paragraph 
    (b) changes the clear language of section 773(b)(1)(A) from ``within an 
    extended period of time'' to ``over'' such a period. Instead, proposed 
    paragraph (b) merely establishes the duration of that interval which 
    the Department normally will consider as being ``an extended period of 
    time'' for purposes of determining whether below-cost sales were made 
    in substantial quantities under section 773(b)(1) of the Act. Below-
    cost sales need only occur within that period in order to be counted 
    toward the substantial quantities threshold.
        The Department does not believe it appropriate to redraft paragraph 
    (b) to refer to sales within the period of investigation or review. The 
    commenter making this suggestion presented a scenario in which a firm 
    sells a particular model of a foreign like product only during the 
    first few months of a review period. This commenter argued that 
    paragraph (b) could be construed in such a way as to limit the extended 
    period of time to the duration of sales of that model. We do not 
    believe this to be the case, however, because the extended period of 
    time is based on the period during which all foreign market sales were 
    made, not merely sales of individual models. In other words, although 
    it has been the Department's practice to conduct the sales below cost 
    analysis on a model-specific basis, the extended period of time 
    interval is generally the same for all models of the foreign like 
    product that are under consideration for normal value. The fact that a 
    firm makes sales of a particular model in only a few months does not 
    alter the defined ``extended period of time.''
        This being the case, it is important to note that paragraph (b) 
    allows the Department to adhere to the statutory requirement that an 
    extended period of time normally be one year. At the same time, 
    however, it recognizes that the foreign market sales used as the basis 
    for determining normal value (and that may become the subject of a 
    sales below cost analysis) can occur over a period that is longer or 
    shorter than one year. For example, in an administrative review, 
    because of our practice of looking to ``contemporaneous'' sales in 
    months other than the month in which the sale of the subject 
    merchandise took place, the Department often requests a respondent to 
    submit data regarding contemporaneous sales of foreign like products 
    for specific months prior to and after the normal one-year period of 
    review. In this instance, the extended period of time would be longer 
    than twelve months. Likewise, the extended period of time could be 
    shorter than one year if, for example, the subject merchandise 
    consisted of highly perishable agricultural products with growing and 
    selling seasons that are shorter than one year.
    
    Section 351.407
    
        Section 351.407 contains rules regarding the allocation of costs, 
    the application of the major input rule under section 773(f)(3) of the 
    Act, and the application of the startup adjustment to CV and COP under 
    section 773(f)(1)(C) of the Act.
        Affiliated party transactions/major input rule: In response to a 
    number of comments, the Department has added a new paragraph (b) to 
    Sec. 351.407 that clarifies the Department's practice with respect to 
    the determination of the value of major inputs purchased from 
    affiliated suppliers in cases involving cost of production and/or CV. 
    (We have redesignated proposed paragraphs (b) and (c) as paragraphs (c) 
    and (d), respectively.) The new paragraph provides that, when the 
    Department applies the major input rule, the Department normally will 
    use the transfer price paid by the producer for a major input so long 
    as that price is not below the input's market price or the supplier's 
    cost of production for the input. In addition, if both the transfer 
    price and the market price for a major input are less than the 
    supplier's cost of production for the input, the Department normally 
    will use production costs as the appropriate value for the major input 
    under section 773(f)(3) of the Act.
        Several commenters made recommendations regarding the Department's 
    treatment of production inputs purchased from affiliated parties under 
    section 773(f)(2) and (3) of the Act (affiliated party transactions 
    disregarded and the major input rule). In general, these commenters 
    suggested that, in determining the value of production inputs, the 
    Department should place greater reliance on transfer prices between 
    producers and their affiliated suppliers, especially where the 
    reporting burden on respondents outweighs the value of conducting an 
    arm's length test for every input. More specifically, two commenters 
    suggested that the regulations establish an arm's-length test for 
    inputs obtained from affiliated parties. One commenter believed that 
    only significant differences--for instance, plus or minus 10 percent--
    between the average price charged to affiliated parties and the average 
    price charged to unaffiliated parties should cause the Department to 
    reject the affiliated party transactions as not being at arm's-length 
    prices. As an alternative, this commenter suggested that the 
    regulations provide that affiliated party prices are at arm's length if 
    they do not deviate from the average non-affiliated party prices by 
    substantially more than the deviation of non-affiliated party prices 
    from that average. The other commenter suggested that if record 
    evidence demonstrates that a producer cannot manipulate the price of 
    inputs purchased from an affiliated party, the Department should
    
    [[Page 27362]]
    
    conclude that the producer purchased the input at arm's length.
        We have not adopted the proposal to include in the regulations an 
    arm's-length test for inputs sourced from affiliated suppliers. 
    Although a test along these lines may be appropriate in some instances, 
    it may not be in others. For instance, where a particular input 
    represents a significant portion of the cost of the merchandise under 
    investigation, a 10 percent difference between the price charged to the 
    affiliated producer and the price charged to unaffiliated producers 
    could have a significant effect on the results of the Department's AD 
    analysis. In other instances, where inputs sourced from an affiliated 
    party represent an immaterial part of the overall manufacturing costs 
    of the merchandise, the Department may find it appropriate to accept a 
    producer's transfer prices (or to test those prices on a sample basis) 
    without conducting a full-blown arm's-length test based on the prices 
    paid for all such inputs. Thus, instead of implementing a single arm's-
    length test applicable to all situations involving affiliated party 
    inputs, we think it is important that the Department consider the facts 
    of each case in order to determine the appropriate level of scrutiny it 
    should give to affiliated party transactions.
        With respect to the recommendation that the Department consider the 
    ability of a producer to manipulate the price of inputs purchased from 
    an affiliated party, we do not think that the potential price 
    manipulation standard described by the commenter is appropriate for 
    purposes of examining the arm's-length nature of input transfer prices. 
    The indeterminate nature of such a standard would make it 
    unadministrable and impractical. Instead, the Department believes that 
    the appropriate standard for determining whether input prices are at 
    arm's length is its normal practice of comparing actual affiliated 
    party prices with prices to or from unaffiliated parties. This practice 
    is the most reasonable and objective basis for testing the arm's length 
    nature of input sales between affiliated parties, and is consistent 
    with section 773(f)(2) of the Act.
        With respect to the major input rule, two of the commenters 
    recommended that the regulations establish a threshold for determining 
    when an input will be considered ``major.'' These commenters suggested 
    that normally the Department should not consider affiliated party 
    inputs to be ``major'' if they represent less than 20 percent of the 
    cost of production. Two commenters added that where a producer cannot 
    obtain cost data from an affiliated supplier, the Department should 
    allow the producer to report transfer prices.
        Another commenter opposed these suggestions, noting that the only 
    substantive change made by the URAA with respect to the issue of input 
    dumping was to clarify that section 773(f) applies to the calculation 
    of both cost of production and CV. Thus, the commenter argued, the 
    Department should reject as inappropriate the suggestions of the other 
    commenters.
        The Department has not adopted the suggested definitions of ``major 
    input.'' We continue to believe that the determination of whether an 
    affiliated party input constitutes a ``major input'' in a particular 
    case depends on several factors, including the nature of the input and 
    the product under investigation. The determination also may depend on 
    the nature of the transactions and operations between the producer and 
    its affiliated supplier. For example, a producer could purchase a 
    number of significant inputs from an affiliated supplier that 
    individually account for a small percentage of the total cost of 
    production for the subject merchandise, but, when considered in the 
    aggregate, comprise a substantial portion of the total cost of 
    production. In this instance, it may be appropriate for the Department 
    to consider the inputs to be major inputs for purposes of examining the 
    affiliated supplier's production costs under section 773(f)(3) of the 
    Act. Similarly, the Department may find it necessary to analyze, on a 
    sample basis, the production costs incurred for affiliated party inputs 
    where a large number of such inputs are purchased from various 
    affiliated suppliers and the combined value of the inputs purchased 
    represents a significant portion of the total manufacturing cost of the 
    subject merchandise.
        These examples illustrate the difficulties inherent in relying on a 
    single, all-encompassing definition of ``major input.'' There also is 
    an additional problem associated with using a single numerical 
    standard. In identifying ``major input,'' the Department generally must 
    rely on the transfer price charged by the affiliated supplier. However, 
    because the transfer price itself may be below cost, it may not 
    constitute an appropriate basis on which to measure the significance of 
    the input. Because of this problem, we do not believe that the 
    Department would have sufficient flexibility to examine affiliated 
    party transactions were we to adopt the 20 percent-of-cost definition 
    or any other specific threshold for major inputs suggested by the 
    commenters.
        Nonrecurring costs: One commenter suggested that the Department add 
    a new paragraph to its regulations to clarify the treatment of 
    nonrecurring costs under section 773(f)(1)(B) of the Act. Specifically, 
    this commenter recommended that the regulations establish a rebuttable 
    presumption that all nonrecurring costs benefit current and/or future 
    production, and that the Department either will (1) expense such costs 
    to current production, or (2) allocate the costs over current and 
    future production, as appropriate.
        As the Department stated in the AD Proposed Regulations, 61 FR at 
    7342, the allocation of nonrecurring costs, such as research and 
    development costs, for purposes of computing COP and CV is dependent on 
    case-specific factors. Section 773(f)(1)(B) recognizes the fact-
    specific nature of these allocation issues by providing only that the 
    Department adjust costs appropriately to take account of any benefit 
    that may accrue to a respondent's current and/or future production as a 
    result of incurring such costs. Thus, in these final regulations, we 
    have not elaborated on the allocation of nonrecurring costs. Instead, 
    the Department will continue to determine the appropriate allocation of 
    non-recurring costs on a case-by-case basis.
        Reliance on generally accepted accounting principles: With respect 
    to the allocation of costs, one commenter recommended that the 
    regulations provide that the Department normally will allocate costs in 
    accordance with the generally accepted accounting principles (GAAP) of 
    the country of exportation.
        The Department has not adopted this suggestion, because it would 
    establish a standard for computing COP and CV different from the 
    standard contemplated by the Act. Section 773(f)(1)(A) provides that 
    the Department normally will calculate costs ``based on the records of 
    the exporter or producer of the merchandise, if such records are kept 
    in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles of the 
    exporting country (or the producing country, where appropriate) and 
    reasonably reflect the costs associated with the production and sale of 
    the merchandise.'' Thus, the statute expresses a preference for 
    computing costs on the basis of foreign country GAAP only when those 
    practices measure costs in a reasonable manner. In addition, where a 
    producer does not keep its normal accounting records in accordance with 
    foreign country GAAP, the statute does not require that such records be 
    made to conform with foreign GAAP.
        We do not mean to suggest that the Department would not look to the
    
    [[Page 27363]]
    
    GAAP of the foreign country (or to U.S. or international accounting 
    principles) in establishing whether the normal accounting practices of 
    the producer reasonably reflect the costs associated with the 
    production of the merchandise in question. Instead, we mean only that, 
    for AD purposes, the fact that a producer does not follow its national 
    accounting principles does not automatically mean that the producer's 
    accounting practices do not reasonably reflect costs.
        Startup adjustment: We received several comments concerning various 
    aspects of proposed paragraph (c) (now paragraph (d)) and the new 
    startup adjustment.
        Definition of startup: One commenter, stating that the definition 
    of terms in proposed paragraph (c) seemed to conform to the statute and 
    the AD Agreement, urged the Department to apply paragraph (c) in a 
    manner consistent with the SAA and the URAA. Specifically, this 
    commenter maintained that the Department should allow for a startup 
    adjustment in those instances where a semiconductor producer can 
    demonstrate that a substantial investment was required to change a 
    design, significantly reduce wafer size, or produce other new types of 
    products that fall within a current chip generation.
        Another commenter contended that the definitions of ``new 
    products'' and ``new production facilities'' in proposed paragraph 
    (c)(1) were exceedingly narrow. This commenter asked the Department to 
    confirm that improvements to products or production facilities that 
    entail substantial costs and that involve significant decreases in 
    productivity will qualify for the startup adjustment.
        Two commenters oppose the suggestions described above. One 
    commenter argued that the startup adjustment does not apply to the 
    semiconductor design changes described. In support, this commenter 
    cited the SAA at 836, which states that ``a 16 megabyte Dynamic Random 
    Access Memory (DRAM) chip, for example, would be considered a new 
    product if the latest version of the product had been a 4 megabyte 
    chip. However, an improved version of a 16 megabyte chip (e.g., a 
    physically smaller version) would not be considered a new product.''
        The other commenter opposing the suggestions argued that the 
    definition of ``new products'' in proposed paragraph (c)(1)(ii) was too 
    broad, and suggested that the regulations provide examples that would 
    limit the circumstances under which the ``complete revamping or 
    redesign'' of products would be eligible for a startup cost adjustment. 
    This commenter noted that in many industries, firms continually revamp 
    or redesign products in order to obtain incremental improvements in 
    performance or to reduce production costs, or both. In the commenter's 
    view, however, such process or performance improvements that do not 
    change the dimensions and construction of an article are not sufficient 
    to result in a ``new product.'' The commenter recognized that in 
    proposed paragraph (c)(1)(ii), the Department sought to distinguish 
    ``mere improvements'' to products from the ``complete revamping or 
    redesign'' of such products. However, the commenter believed that this 
    paragraph was unduly vague and that the Department should clarify it by 
    means of specific, narrowly defined examples of ``new products.''
        The Department has not incorporated the suggestions made by these 
    commenters in the regulations. Nor do we consider this explanatory 
    preamble an appropriate vehicle for making determinations as to whether 
    situations specific to the semiconductor industry would warrant a 
    startup adjustment under section 773(f)(1)(C). Instead, paragraph 
    (d)(1) continues to set forth the definitions contained in the SAA at 
    836. Given the variety of products and industries with which the 
    Department deals and the fact that the startup provision is new to the 
    statute, we believe that these examples are well-suited to the task of 
    providing guidance to parties without unintentionally expanding or 
    limiting the availability of a startup adjustment.
        Standard for granting a startup adjustment: One commenter noted 
    that proposed paragraph (c) correctly recognized that the standard for 
    granting a startup adjustment is no more or less stringent than those 
    applicable to other types of adjustments under the Act. This commenter 
    added that because there are numerous situations that may call for some 
    form of startup adjustment, proposed paragraph (c) properly left the 
    Department wide latitude in analyzing and granting startup adjustments.
        Another commenter, however, argued that the Department should 
    strengthen paragraph (c) to ensure that respondents are not encouraged 
    to file meritless claims for startup adjustments. To achieve this, the 
    commenter recommended that the regulations provide that a respondent 
    must submit substantial evidence demonstrating that the expenses for 
    which a startup adjustment is sought can be directly tied to a startup 
    phase of production.
        A third commenter suggested that, because respondents bear the 
    burden of proof in demonstrating they are entitled to a startup 
    adjustment, the regulations should clarify the information necessary to 
    obtain the adjustment. This commenter asked that the Department give 
    specific examples of the types of documentation that will be sufficient 
    to meet its requirements.
        With respect to these suggestions, the Department notes that the 
    SAA at 838 provides that the burden of establishing entitlement to a 
    startup adjustment rests with the party seeking the adjustment. Among 
    other things, the claimant must demonstrate that the costs for which an 
    adjustment is claimed are directly associated with the startup phase of 
    operations. Having said this, however, we have not adopted the 
    suggestion that we establish a special burden of proof for startup 
    adjustments, because we believe that the burden of establishing 
    eligibility for a startup adjustment is the same as that applicable to 
    any other AD adjustment. However, as in the case of any other 
    adjustment, the Department intends to seek the case-specific 
    information and documentation necessary to establish whether a startup 
    adjustment is appropriate.
        We also have chosen not to implement the suggestion that the 
    Department provide specific examples of the documentation required in 
    order to qualify for a startup adjustment. The SAA indicates that 
    startup inquiries will be based on the specific facts of each case. For 
    example, the SAA at 838 states that ``companies must demonstrate that, 
    for the period of investigation or review, production levels were 
    limited by technical factors associated with the initial phase of 
    commercial production and not by factors unrelated to startup, such as 
    marketing difficulties or chronic production problems. In addition, to 
    receive a startup adjustment, companies will be required to explain 
    their production situation and identify those technical difficulties 
    associated with startup that resulted in the underutilization of 
    facilities.'' Here, the SAA clearly contemplates a fact-based inquiry 
    that includes consideration of a respondent's specific production 
    situation and the unique technical difficulties that led to decreases 
    in its normal production output. Moreover, other portions of the SAA 
    further support the conclusion that the Department must conduct a fact-
    based examination of claims for a startup adjustment. Thus, it would be 
    inappropriate, as well as impractical, for the Department to impose a 
    mandatory set of information requirements that would apply to all 
    cases.
    
    [[Page 27364]]
    
        Duration of startup period: One commenter recommended that the 
    regulations refer expressly to the quality of merchandise produced as a 
    criterion to be considered in determining the length of the startup 
    period. The commenter argued that where merchandise, although in 
    production, is not yet of a quality sufficient for sale, some startup 
    adjustment would be appropriate. Another commenter, however, opposed 
    this proposal, arguing that the ``quality of a product'' is an 
    amorphous concept that respondents could manipulate.
        The Department has not adopted the suggestion to make product 
    quality a criterion in determining the length of the startup period, 
    because we believe that this suggestion is inconsistent with the 
    statute and the SAA. Section 773(f)(1)(C)(ii) of the Act provides that 
    the Department will consider startup as having ended as of the time the 
    producer achieves a level of commercial production that is 
    characteristic of the merchandise, producer, or industry concerned. The 
    SAA at 836 states that in making a determination as to when a producer 
    reaches commercial production levels, the Department will measure the 
    producer's actual production levels based on the number of units 
    processed. The SAA also provides that, to the extent necessary, the 
    Department will examine other factors (such as historical data 
    reflecting the same producer's or other producer's experiences in 
    producing the same or similar products) in determining the end of the 
    startup period.
        We note also that the SAA does not refer to quality of merchandise 
    as a criterion for measuring the length of the startup period, but 
    instead relies strictly on the number of units processed as a primary 
    indicator of the end of the startup period. In fact, the SAA at 836 
    states that the Department will not extend the startup period in a 
    manner that would cover product improvements and cost reductions that 
    may occur over the life cycle of a product. The Department believes 
    this to be a clear reference to product quality and yield improvements 
    that may continue to exist long after startup has ended and, if taken 
    into consideration, could result in extending the startup period beyond 
    the point at which commercial production is achieved.
        Startup costs: One commenter suggested revisions to proposed 
    paragraph (c)(4) (now paragraph (d)(4)) regarding the types of costs 
    that are eligible for a startup adjustment under the Act. According to 
    this commenter, these revisions would help to clarify the legislative 
    intent that, in making a startup adjustment, the Department may 
    consider only those costs that are tied directly to manufacturing of 
    the merchandise.
        We have adopted the revisions suggested by the commenter. These 
    changes provide additional clarification regarding the types of non-
    production costs that the Department will consider as ineligible for a 
    startup adjustment. These costs include general and administrative 
    (``G&A'') expenses and general research and development costs that the 
    Department normally considers to be part of G&A.
        Amortization of startup costs: One commenter disagreed with the 
    Department's position that it should amortize over a reasonable period 
    of time any excess between a respondent's actual costs and the costs 
    adjusted and calculated for startup costs. In this commenter's view, 
    there is no basis under the AD Agreement for such an approach. In 
    addition, the commenter maintained that any adjustments for startup 
    costs are isolated adjustments that the Department reasonably can take 
    into account during the period of investigation or review.
        Another commenter recommended that the Department provide that 
    amortized expenses related to prior startup operations be included as 
    part of respondent's startup costs during the period under 
    investigation or review. This commenter maintained that its 
    recommendation was consistent with sound accounting principles and 
    would preclude a respondent from receiving an unintended and improper 
    benefit as a result of a startup adjustment.
        The Department believes that its position concerning the 
    amortization of unrecognized startup costs is fully consistent with the 
    URAA and the AD Agreement. As a result of making a startup adjustment 
    under section 773(f)(1)(C), the difference between actual production 
    costs during the startup phase and costs at the end of the startup 
    phase are not accounted for during the startup phase. Because this 
    difference represents actual costs incurred by the producer, it is 
    reasonable to expect that the producer recoup these costs over an 
    appropriate time period. Failing to consider these costs would mean 
    ignoring a portion of the actual costs incurred by the producer in 
    manufacturing subject merchandise.
        Moreover, as described in the SAA at 837, the difference between 
    actual and adjusted startup costs is recouped through amortization over 
    a reasonable period of time (subsequent to the startup phase) based on 
    the life of the product or production machinery, as appropriate. 
    Because the amortization period is based on the estimated life cycle of 
    a product or machinery, this period may extend beyond the period of 
    investigation or review. Therefore, it is not possible for the 
    Department, in all instances, to account for startup costs within the 
    investigation or review period.
        The Department also has not adopted the recommendation that 
    respondents be required to account for startup operations that may have 
    taken place prior to the period of investigation. The Department 
    believes that only where respondents have adjusted for startup costs in 
    an investigation or review period would they be required to account for 
    (through amortization in periods subsequent to the startup phase) the 
    difference between actual costs and costs computed for startup. As 
    noted above, this practice ensures that respondents account for all 
    actual costs incurred to produce the merchandise. Where merchandise was 
    produced, or production facilities have been in place, prior to the 
    period of investigation, the Department considers it unnecessarily 
    burdensome to require that respondents account for previously incurred 
    startup costs in the same manner as for startup operations that 
    occurred during the investigation or review period. Nor is such a 
    requirement contemplated under the statute as a condition for granting 
    a startup adjustment.
    
    Section 351.408
    
        Section 351.408 implements section 773(c) of the Act, which creates 
    a special methodology for calculating normal value in AD proceedings 
    involving a nonmarket economy (``NME'') country. We received numerous 
    comments on this section.
        Market-oriented industry test: Section 773(c)(1) of the Act permits 
    the Department, in certain circumstances, to use the ``market economy'' 
    methodology set forth in section 773(a) to determine normal value in an 
    NME case. To identify those situations where we would apply the market 
    economy methodology and calculate normal value based on domestic prices 
    or costs in the NME, we developed our so-called ``market oriented 
    industry'' or ``MOI'' test. However, we elected not to codify the MOI 
    test in the AD Proposed Regulations because of our concern that the 
    test did not succeed in ``identifying situations where it would be 
    appropriate to use domestic prices or cost in an NME as the basis for 
    normal value * * *.'' 61 FR at 7343.
        Several comments were filed concerning the MOI test and whether the 
    Department should codify its
    
    [[Page 27365]]
    
    current test or an amended version of the MOI test. One commenter put 
    forward numerous arguments against the current MOI test. First, this 
    commenter argued that the third leg of the MOI test is unrealistic. 
    (The third leg of the test requires that market-determined prices must 
    be paid for virtually all inputs before the Department will find a 
    particular industry to be an MOI.) In this commenter's view, this third 
    leg extends the Department's inquiry beyond the pricing of the input 
    itself to factors that only remotely impact the price of the input, 
    such as land use and energy policies. Because of the breadth of this 
    inquiry, this commenter believed that the Department effectively 
    requires an examination of the entire NME economy, an approach that 
    contravenes the stated purpose of the MOI test; i.e., to determine 
    whether a particular input or sector in the NME is sufficiently subject 
    to market forces.
        According to this commenter, another indication that the MOI test 
    is unreasonable is that few, if any, market economy countries have 
    industries in which every single input is 100 percent subject to market 
    forces. To make the MOI test more reasonable, this commenter suggested 
    amending the third leg of the test to require only that a reasonable 
    portion of inputs be subject to market forces.
        This commenter also questioned the Department's all-or-nothing 
    approach under the third leg of the MOI test. Specifically, this 
    commenter contended that the Department's requirement that all inputs 
    sourced in the NME be obtained at market-determined prices overlooks 
    the fact that certain inputs may be purchased at market prices. Where 
    certain inputs are purchased at market prices, this commenter argued, 
    the Department should use those prices. Moreover, in this commenter's 
    view, doing so would be consistent with the Department's policy of 
    using the actual input prices paid by an NME producer when the producer 
    purchases the input from a market economy supplier and pays for the 
    input in a market economy currency. The all-or-nothing approach also 
    leads to anomalous results, in this commenter's view. When an NME 
    industry is unable to meet the burden of showing that virtually all of 
    its inputs are purchased at market-determined prices, the Department 
    uses the NME methodology and values the NME producers' inputs in a 
    surrogate market economy country that, according to this commenter, 
    would itself fail the MOI test.
        This same commenter also questioned the second leg of the MOI test, 
    particularly as it applies to the People's Republic of China (``PRC''). 
    (In order to qualify under the second leg of the test, the industry 
    producing the merchandise should be characterized by private or 
    collective ownership.) In this commenter's view, government ownership 
    should not be dispositive of whether an industry is subject to market 
    forces. The Department investigates many state-owned companies in 
    market economy countries, and government ownership of those companies 
    does not lead the Department to apply a different AD methodology. 
    Moreover, based on its experience in administering the separate rates 
    test (see Sec. 351.102(b)), the Department has found on numerous 
    occasions that PRC companies ``owned by the people'' operate 
    independently of the government. Hence, in this commenter's view, 
    ownership by the people should not preclude a PRC industry from 
    achieving MOI status.
        On a more general level, this commenter urged the Department to 
    apply the MOI test on a company-specific basis rather than to all 
    companies within a given industry. The failure of particular companies 
    to provide evidence that market forces are at work should not, in this 
    commenter's view, work unfairly against those companies that are able 
    to satisfy the test. Similarly, according to this commenter, the 
    regional nature of certain economic reforms in the PRC argues for a 
    company-specific approach.
        Two commenters raised various policy arguments against the rigidity 
    of the MOI test. In their view, the MOI test should be applied in such 
    a way as to encourage market reforms in NMEs. Instead, they claimed 
    that the current MOI test sends a signal to NMEs that the Department 
    will not recognize their reforms. Additionally, in the view of one 
    commenter, NME producers and exporters would be more willing to 
    cooperate in AD proceedings if the Department changed the MOI test, 
    because they would have an opportunity to avoid the unfairly high 
    margins generated by the NME methodology.
        Two commenters suggested amendments to the current MOI test to make 
    it meaningful and fair for ``economies in transition'' to market 
    economies. Specifically, they urged the Department to adopt a 
    presumption that when the first two legs of the current MOI test are 
    met (i.e., there is no government involvement in setting the prices or 
    production quantities of the product, and the industry is characterized 
    by private and collective ownership), the Department will perform a 
    market economy AD analysis. Under their proposal, the presumption could 
    be rebutted by evidence showing that the central government set the 
    prices paid for inputs constituting a substantial value of the final 
    product.
        One commenter urged the Department either to (1) retain the current 
    MOI test (on the grounds that it does succeed in identifying those 
    situations where it would be appropriate to use prices or costs in the 
    NME), or (2) abandon the notion of MOIs altogether. In this commenter's 
    view, it is not possible to reconcile the notion that a country is an 
    NME with the notion that the prices or costs of some participants in 
    that economy are immune from that economy's influences.
        We have not codified the current MOI test in our final regulations. 
    Nor have we adopted a modified version of the MOI test. Given the 
    changing conditions in NMEs, we believe that we should continue to 
    develop our policy in this area through the resolution of individual 
    cases, and the comments that were submitted will help us in that 
    process. This area of the law continues to be extremely important to 
    the agency and will receive the Department's careful attention.
        Surrogate selection: In applying the NME AD methodology, the first 
    step is to identify the so-called ``surrogate country'' to be used for 
    valuing the NME producers' factors of production. Under section 
    773(c)(4) of the Act, the surrogate should be a country (or countries) 
    at a level of economic development comparable to the NME and a 
    significant producer of merchandise comparable to the merchandise being 
    investigated. In proposed paragraph (b), we stated that we would place 
    primary emphasis on per capita GDP as the measure of economic 
    comparability. More generally with respect to surrogate selection, we 
    explained that the relative weights we would place on the two selection 
    criteria (i.e., economic comparability and significant production of 
    comparable merchandise) would vary based on the specific facts 
    presented by individual cases.
        We received two comments on the issue of surrogate selection. One 
    commenter suggested that where other economic indicators (e.g., growth 
    rates, distribution of labor between the manufacturing, agricultural 
    and service sectors) reflect disparities in economic comparability, the 
    Department should take this into account. The second commenter agreed 
    with the Department's position that surrogate selection should be made 
    on the basis of the particular circumstances presented by each case.
    
    [[Page 27366]]
    
        Regarding the comment on economic comparability, we believe that 
    paragraph (b) provides the Department with adequate flexibility to take 
    into account economic indicators other than per capita GDP. While 
    similar levels of per capita GDP would always be considered the primary 
    indicator of comparability, other measures of comparability could 
    outweigh it where the circumstances so warranted.
        Valuation of the factors of production: Once the Department 
    identifies an appropriate surrogate country, the next step in an AD 
    proceeding involving an NME is to value the NME producers' factors of 
    production. Proposed paragraph (c) contained rules for determining 
    these values. In general, under proposed paragraph (c), we would value 
    inputs using publicly available information regarding prices in a 
    single surrogate country. However, we articulated certain exceptions to 
    this general rule. First, where the NME producer purchases inputs from 
    a market economy producer and these inputs are paid for in a market 
    economy currency, we would use the price paid by the NME producer to 
    value that input. Second, we proposed valuing the NME producer's labor 
    input by reference to a regression-derived calculation that effectively 
    includes wage information from a number of countries, rather than a 
    single country.
        We received several comments on the proposed factor valuation 
    rules. One commenter called for the Department to seek internal 
    coherence among the factor values by obtaining them from a single 
    source. In this commenter's view, the goals espoused by the Department 
    (i.e., to achieve accuracy, fairness and predictability) would be 
    better served if where there were a tight interrelationship among the 
    surrogate values. Moreover, because the Department calculates certain 
    values (such as manufacturing overhead, general expenses, and profit) 
    relative to labor and material costs, this commenter believed the 
    Department should derive all of these amounts from the same source.
        We have not adopted this suggestion. In order to derive 
    ``internally consistent'' values, as the commenter used the term, it 
    would be necessary to obtain valuation data from a single producer in 
    the surrogate country. We have tried this approach in the past and it 
    has not worked well. Frequently, we have been unable to obtain a 
    surrogate producer willing to share this type of information with the 
    Department. Moreover, even when we have been able to obtain data, this 
    approach is much less transparent than use of publicly available input 
    values, because while a surrogate producer might share data with the 
    U.S. government, it would be less likely to make it available to a U.S. 
    petitioner or an NME producer. Finally, we question the accuracy of 
    this approach as it applies to individual input prices. When compared 
    to a publicly available price that reflects numerous transactions 
    between many buyers and sellers, a single input price reported by a 
    surrogate producer may be less representative of the cost of that input 
    in the surrogate country. For these reasons, we have continued the 
    general schema put forward in the proposed paragraph (c) of relying on 
    publicly available data (which will not normally be producer-specific) 
    for material inputs, while relying on producer- or industry-specific 
    data for manufacturing overhead, general expenses, and profit.
        Two commenters discussed the proposal in paragraph (c)(1) regarding 
    the use of prices paid by NME producers when they import the input from 
    a market economy and pay for the input in a market economy currency. 
    One commenter objected to the Department's approach on the grounds that 
    (1) such prices are not publicly available, and (2) they are not 
    internally coherent with other values included in the calculation (see 
    discussion above). In this commenter's view, if the Department does use 
    the prices paid by NME producers, it should ensure that those prices 
    are free of any distorting effects attributable to barter transactions 
    or savings achieved through centralized purchasing. Moreover, this 
    commenter continued, the Department should not use those input values 
    except for the specific transactions to which they pertain. Thus, if an 
    NME producer sourced some of the input from market economy suppliers 
    and the remainder from domestic sources, then the value for the 
    domestically-sourced inputs should be based on surrogate values and not 
    on the price paid by the NME producers to the market economy suppliers. 
    In support, this commenter stated that: (1) relying solely on the price 
    paid to the market economy supplier to value the input is inappropriate 
    because it assumes that the NME producer could purchase all of its 
    needs at this price, and (2) it ignores the statutory requirement that 
    the NME producer's factors of production be valued in a surrogate 
    market economy country to the extent possible. The second commenter 
    supported the Department's proposal to use the price paid by the NME 
    producer to a market economy supplier in these situations, because that 
    price is a more reasonable and accurate indicator of the value of the 
    input than a surrogate price would be.
        We have not adopted the suggestions put forward by the first 
    commenter. While we acknowledge that prices paid by the NME producer to 
    a market economy supplier will not be publicly available, we have 
    weighed this consideration against the increased accuracy achieved by 
    our proposal. We note that the Federal Circuit has upheld our practice 
    of using prices paid for inputs imported from market economies instead 
    of surrogate values. Lasko Metal Products, Inc. v. United States, 43 
    F.3d. 1442 (1994) (``Lasko''). While we certainly do not view this 
    decision as permitting us to use distorted (i.e., non-arm's length) 
    prices, we believe that the Court's emphasis on ``accuracy, fairness 
    and predictability'' does provide us with the ability to rely on prices 
    paid by the NME producer to market economy suppliers, in lieu of 
    surrogate values, for the portion of the input that is sourced 
    domestically in the NME. Moreover, as noted in the AD Proposed 
    Regulations, 61 FR at 7345, we would not rely on the price paid by an 
    NME producer to a market economy supplier if the quantity of the input 
    purchased was insignificant. Because the amounts purchased from the 
    market economy supplier must be meaningful, this requirement goes some 
    way in addressing the commenter's concern that the NME producer may not 
    be able to fulfill all its needs at that price.
        Another commenter suggested that the Department should ``test'' 
    surrogate values for reasonableness. For example, if the Department has 
    two values for a particular input that are very different, but one is 
    closer to the price paid by the NME producer in the NME, the Department 
    should select the price that is closer to the price paid by the NME 
    producer. More generally, this commenter urged the Department to apply 
    the law as fairly as possible by closely matching the characteristics 
    of the input used by the NME producer with the input selected in the 
    surrogate country for valuation purposes.
        We agree that ``aberrational'' surrogate input values should be 
    disregarded (see, e.g., Certain Cased Pencils from the People's 
    Republic of China, 59 FR 55625, 55630 (1994)). However, we have not 
    accepted this commenter's benchmark for determining whether a 
    particular surrogate value is reasonable. Use of an NME price as a 
    benchmark is inappropriate because it is the unreliability of NME 
    prices that drives us to use the special NME methodology in the first 
    place. The Department does attempt to match the surrogate product
    
    [[Page 27367]]
    
    used for valuation purposes closely with the input used by the NME 
    producer. This practice is reflected in paragraph (c), wherein the 
    Department elected to codify a preference for publicly available 
    information rather than publicly available published information. This 
    approach allows us to use input-specific data instead of the aggregated 
    data that frequently appear in published statistics. See AD Proposed 
    Regulations, 61 FR at 7344.
        Finally, we received a comment regarding factor valuation in 
    general. This commenter urged the Department to add to the regulations 
    an illustrative list of the factors of production that are included in 
    calculating the normal value of an import from an NME. The commenter 
    believed that including such a list will increase the likelihood that 
    all the appropriate factors of production will be identified. We have 
    not adopted this proposal, because, in our view, the statute is 
    sufficiently clear regarding the identify of the factors of production 
    to be valued. If a party to a particular proceeding believes that 
    certain factors are not being reported, it should raise its concerns 
    with the Department in the context of that proceeding.
        Valuation of the labor input: Proposed paragraph (c)(3) included a 
    proposal for valuing the labor input in NME cases. Rather than relying 
    on the wage rate in the selected surrogate country, under this proposal 
    the Department would have valued the labor input using a wage rate 
    developed through a regression analysis of wages and per capita GDP. 
    After a further review of paragraph (c)(3) and the comments relating 
    thereto, we have left paragraph (c)(3) unchanged.
        Three commenters submitted views on the Department's proposal. One 
    commenter noted that the proposal did not provide different wage levels 
    for skilled and unskilled labor. The second commenter urged the 
    Department to allow itself the flexibility to use other types of wage 
    data if the record indicated that the other data would be better. Also, 
    to value NME labor inputs, this commenter urged the Department to 
    include full labor costs rather than simply wages, and to use industry-
    specific data because wages can vary dramatically from industry to 
    industry within a single surrogate country.
        We agree with the first commenter that the regression-based 
    calculation fails to provide differentiated wage rates for skilled and 
    unskilled labor. However, this results from limitations on the 
    available data, not from the proposed approach. Even using a single 
    country as a surrogate, it has been rare for the Department to find 
    different wage rates for skilled and unskilled labor. Limitations on 
    available data also prevent us from considering whether we should be 
    using full labor costs or industry-specific wages, as suggested by the 
    second commenter.
        The third commenter also urged the Department not to adopt the 
    regression-based wage rate. First, in this commenter's view, the 
    proposal ignored the statutory requirement that factors be valued in a 
    country that is economically comparable to the NME and is a significant 
    producer of comparable merchandise. More specifically, this commenter 
    pointed out that because the regression was based on wage rates and per 
    capita GDP, the Department would have calculated NME wage values 
    without regard to the significant production criterion. In a related 
    argument, this commenter stated that the regression-based wage value 
    was inconsistent with the intent of Congress that the Department select 
    a surrogate country where input prices allow significant production to 
    occur. Third, this commenter claimed that the proposal was contrary to 
    standard and accepted economic theory on the grounds that when a 
    producer locates in a country, that producer will choose the 
    appropriate mix of capital and labor based on their relative prices. By 
    applying a theoretical wage rate, the Department's proposal would have 
    upset that relative price structure with the result that NME 
    calculations would be less accurate and less related to real economic 
    conditions. Finally, this commenter contended that the premise 
    underlying the Department's proposal was unsound. In this commenter's 
    view, because many potential factor valuations vary significantly 
    between and among eligible surrogate countries, there is no reason for 
    singling out labor as a factor to be valued under a regression approach 
    while using single values for other inputs.
        Addressing these comments in reverse order, we do not share the 
    commenter's concern that the premise underlying our wage rate proposal 
    was unsound because values for other factors of production are not 
    similarly averaged. In general, we believe that more data is better 
    than less data, and that averaging of multiple data points (or 
    regression analysis) should lead to more accurate results in valuing 
    any factor of production. However, it is only for labor that we have a 
    relatively consistent and complete database covering many countries. To 
    employ a parallel approach for other factors of production, the 
    Department would have to develop a comparable database. Even if we were 
    to limit our search for data to those countries that meet both the 
    economic comparability criterion and the significant production 
    criterion, the burden imposed on the Department in compiling such a 
    database normally would outweigh any gains in accuracy.
        Regarding the commenter's point that the proposed approach violates 
    standard economic theory, we do not dispute that the relative prices of 
    labor and capital are important and that relatively cheap labor usually 
    will be substituted for relatively expensive capital. However, in order 
    to capture the precise tradeoff between labor and capital that this 
    commenter is seeking, we would have to value all factors using 
    information from a single surrogate producer. As discussed above, we 
    have not adopted that general approach to factor valuation.
        Finally, regarding the argument that proposed paragraph (c)(3) 
    ignores the significant manufacturer criterion for surrogate selection, 
    we believe that the regression-based wage rate significantly enhances 
    the accuracy, fairness, and predictability of our AD calculations in 
    NME cases, all of which were attributes highlighted by the Court in 
    Lasko. As we stated in the AD Proposed Regulations, for some inputs 
    there is no direct correspondence between significant levels of 
    production and input price or availability. When looking at a surrogate 
    country to obtain labor rates, we believe it is appropriate to place 
    less weight on the significant producer criterion, because economic 
    comparability is more indicative of appropriate labor rates. As 
    discussed above in connection with the calculation of average values 
    for other factors, by combining data from more than one country, the 
    regression-based approach will yield a more accurate result. It also is 
    fairer, because the valuation of labor will not vary depending on which 
    country the Department selects as the economically comparable surrogate 
    economy. Finally, the results of the regression are available to all 
    parties, thus making the labor value in all NME cases entirely 
    predictable. Given these attributes of the regression-based wage rate, 
    we believe that paragraph (c)(3) is fully consistent with the statute.
        Manufacturing overhead, general expenses, and profit: Regarding 
    these factors of production, proposed paragraph (c)(4) stated that the 
    Department normally will use information from producers of identical or 
    comparable merchandise in the surrogate country.
        One commenter suggested that the Department should rigorously check 
    the information it uses to value
    
    [[Page 27368]]
    
    manufacturing overhead, general expense and profit. Specifically, the 
    Department should make sure the data are reliable and that they do not 
    double-count items such as electricity and water. In this commenter's 
    view, the Department could check the reasonableness of these values 
    against the experience of the NME producers under investigation.
        For the reasons explained above, we do not believe it is 
    appropriate to check surrogate values against the NME respondents' 
    experience. Regarding the reliability of the surrogate values for 
    manufacturing overhead, general expenses and profit, we do attempt to 
    obtain good data and avoid double-counting where possible. Parties to 
    the proceeding are encouraged to submit data on these factor values and 
    to identify areas where the data are questionable.
    
    Section 351.409
    
        Section 351.409 sets forth the guidelines for making adjustments to 
    normal value for differences in quantities. We have made a few 
    revisions in light of the comments received.
        One commenter proposed that the Department liberalize its policy 
    regarding quantity adjustments, noting that the Department typically 
    ignores the requirement in former 19 CFR 353.55(a) that the Secretary 
    normally will use sales of comparable quantities of merchandise. 
    Because the statute itself does not require that the Department use 
    sales of comparable quantities, but instead merely authorizes an 
    adjustment when the Department compares sales in different quantities, 
    we have decided to delete this requirement from paragraph (a).
        In addition, we also have deleted the last sentence of proposed 
    paragraph (a), which refers to the consideration of industry practice 
    in determining whether to make a quantity adjustment. Upon further 
    consideration, the Department believes that the granting of an 
    adjustment should depend more on the pricing behavior of the individual 
    firm in question, and not on whether other firms in the industry engage 
    in similar behavior.
        As a matter of calculation mechanics, the Secretary may adjust for 
    differences in quantities by deducting from all prices used to 
    calculate normal value quantity discounts even if all sales did not 
    receive the quantity discount. Paragraph (b) contains standards that 
    must be satisfied before the Secretary will calculate normal value in 
    this manner.
        One commenter stated that under paragraph (b), the two situations 
    in which the Department will make a quantity adjustment are so narrow 
    that it is virtually impossible for a respondent to meet the applicable 
    standards. The commenter argued that the 20 percent threshold is 
    excessively high, that it is not required by section 773(a)(6)(C)(i) of 
    the Act, and that there is no rationale to support it. Moreover, 
    according to the commenter, the requirement that the discounts be ``of 
    at least the same magnitude'' violates the statutory directive that the 
    adjustment be made whether the price difference is ``wholly or partly 
    due to differences in quantities.'' The commenter suggested that the 
    Department provide for additional situations where it will make 
    quantity-based adjustments, such as when the exporter or producer can 
    correlate quantity levels and prices.
        While the Department does not agree with all of the arguments made 
    by the commenter, we agree that former 19 CFR Sec. 353.55(b), which 
    formed the basis of paragraph (b), should be modified so as to allow 
    other methods of establishing entitlement to a quantity adjustment. 
    Therefore, in proposed paragraph (b), the Department added the word 
    ``normally'' to indicate that the two methods described in paragraph 
    (b) are not exclusive.
        Under proposed paragraph (e), the Department stated that it will 
    not make both a quantity adjustment and a level of trade adjustment 
    unless it is established that the difference in quantities has an 
    effect on price comparability that is separate from the difference in 
    level of trade. One commenter argued that paragraph (e) was superfluous 
    in light of Sec. 351.401(b)(2), which contains a general prohibition 
    against the double-counting of adjustments. In addition, this commenter 
    contended that the proposed paragraph (e) did not provide any guidance 
    (beyond what normally would be required for any claimed adjustment) as 
    to the kind of showing necessary to establish the difference in the 
    effects of each type of adjustment on price comparability. Third, the 
    commenter argued that because the Department will identify level of 
    trade differences by focusing primarily on the selling functions, to 
    the extent that the quantity sold is one factor in a claimed level of 
    trade difference, the Department can determine on a case-by-case basis 
    whether an additional claimed quantity adjustment would be duplicative.
        The Department recognizes that the prohibition against double-
    counting adjustments in Sec. 351.401(b)(2) applies to situations in 
    which a party claims a level of trade adjustment and an adjustment for 
    differences in quantities. However, the Department believes that it is 
    appropriate to emphasize that, in this specific area, it is 
    particularly concerned about the possibility of double-counting. Based 
    on our experience, firms tend to sell in different quantities to 
    different levels of trade, thereby increasing the possibility of 
    double-counting where both adjustments are claimed. This concern is 
    expressed in the SAA at 830, where, in discussing the effect on price 
    comparability necessary for a level of trade adjustment, the 
    Administration stated: ``Commerce will ensure that a percentage 
    difference in price is not more appropriately attributable to 
    differences in the quantities purchased in individual sales.''
        With respect to the commenter's suggestion that the Department 
    provide additional guidance as to the showing necessary to establish 
    the individual effect of each adjustment, the Department does not have 
    enough experience to provide additional guidance at this time. 
    Essentially, we agree with the commenter that the Department, at least 
    initially, will have to resolve these issues on a case-by-case basis.
    
    Section 351.410
    
        Section 351.410 clarifies aspects of the Department's practice 
    concerning adjustments to normal value for differences in the 
    circumstances of sale (``COS'').
        One commenter, noting that proposed Sec. 351.410 did not indicate 
    the types of expenses eligible for a COS adjustment, suggested that the 
    final regulation clarify, in accordance with the SAA, that the 
    Department will make a COS adjustment only for direct selling expenses 
    and assumed expenses, as opposed to indirect selling expenses.
        We agree with the commenter that in proposed Sec. 351.410, we 
    failed to connect the definitions of ``direct selling expenses'' and 
    ``assumed expenses'' in paragraphs (b) and (c) to the COS adjustment 
    itself. Therefore, we have revised this section by (1) redesignating 
    proposed paragraphs (b) and (c) as paragraphs (c) and (d), 
    respectively; (2) redesignating proposed paragraph (d) as paragraph 
    (f); and (3) adding a new paragraph (b) that indicates the expenses 
    eligible for a COS adjustment. In this regard, however, in paragraph 
    (e) we have maintained the special ``commission offset'' rule, 
    previously codified in 19 CFR Sec. 353.56(b)(1).
        Another commenter suggested that the Department clarify that it may 
    treat allocated expenses as direct selling
    
    [[Page 27369]]
    
    expenses eligible for a COS adjustment. We have not revised 
    Sec. 351.410 in light of this comment. However, as stated above in 
    connection with Sec. 351.401(g), the Department will accept the 
    allocation of direct selling expenses, subject to certain conditions.
        One commenter noted that under proposed Sec. 351.412, the 
    Department would establish the level of trade for CEP sales only after 
    having made the adjustments required under 772(d) of the Act; i.e., 
    after having converted the CEP sale to the equivalent of an export 
    price sale. However, this commenter argued, because U.S. resale prices 
    are the starting point for calculating CEP, and because such prices may 
    differ substantially from one distribution channel to another, some 
    sales cannot be compared logically to home market sales at the relevant 
    level of trade, absent some appropriate adjustment. Accordingly, this 
    commenter maintained, if the Department retains proposed Sec. 351.412, 
    the Department should clarify in Sec. 351.410 that it normally will 
    compare sales made in the same distribution channels. In this regard, 
    the commenter asserted that the new law ``requires Commerce to make 
    fair comparisons of price, 19 U.S.C. 1677b(a), and Commerce has 
    traditionally used COS to achieve this all-important objective.''
        The Department has not adopted this suggestion. First, as discussed 
    below, section 773(a) of the Act specifies the adjustments that are 
    required in order to achieve a ``fair comparison.'' Moreover, under the 
    statute, the COS adjustment is not a vehicle for identifying sales 
    matches. Instead, the Department makes a COS adjustment only after it 
    first has identified appropriate sales matches. Finally, the 
    commenter's proposal would require the Department to match sales on the 
    basis of a level of trade other than the level of trade of the CEP. 
    However, section 773(a)(1)(B)(i) of the Act requires the Department to 
    identify the level of trade of the CEP (which the SAA at 829 defines as 
    a starting price to which the Department has made adjustments), and to 
    determine normal value at the same level as the CEP, if possible. If 
    the Department must rely on sales in the foreign market that are at a 
    level of trade different from the level of trade of the CEP sale, and 
    if the level of trade difference is reflected in different selling 
    functions and a pattern of consistent price differences, then the 
    Department must make an adjustment for the different levels of trade.
        Nevertheless, as discussed in connection with Sec. 351.412, the 
    Department has modified the methodology it will use to identify 
    different levels of trade. Under Sec. 351.412, as revised, the 
    Department will not rely solely on selling activities to identify 
    levels of trade, but instead will evaluate differences in selling 
    activities in the context of a seller's whole scheme of marketing. This 
    new methodology will deal with the problem identified by the commenter.
        One commenter argued that the Department should provide for a COS 
    adjustment to normal value for resale profit in situations where the 
    Department makes a profit deduction to CEP. The commenter stated that 
    ``[t]he Department rightly notes in its explanations that the statute 
    does not `provide for an adjustment to normal value' '' for resale 
    profit. However, the commenter argued that this is a ``grossly 
    inadequate rationale'' for refusing to make such an adjustment, because 
    neither the statute nor the SAA prohibits such an adjustment, and 
    because such an adjustment is necessary ``for proceedings to be fair.'' 
    The commenter contended that because the CEP profit deduction will be 
    based on profit earned in both the United States and the home market, 
    the deduction amounts to double-counting. According to the commenter, 
    this is unfair, and it will have the perverse effect of discouraging 
    foreign investment in the United States and adding value to imported 
    products in the United States.
        Another commenter argued that any time a home market producer sells 
    the foreign like product through an affiliated reseller, either in the 
    home market or in the third country, a reseller profit will exist. 
    However, under the proposed regulations, the Department will deduct 
    profit only from CEP sales, and not from sales used to calculate normal 
    value. To achieve a fair comparison, the Department should add a new 
    provision to Sec. 351.402(d) (special rule for determining profit) and 
    deduct this affiliated reseller profit from normal value whenever it 
    compares normal value to CEP.
        The Department has not adopted these suggestions. First, with 
    respect to the argument concerning a double-deduction of profit, we 
    disagree. Under section 772(f), the Department does not deduct the CEP 
    profit earned in both the United States and the home market from the 
    price in the United States. Instead, because transfer prices cannot be 
    relied upon for this purpose, section 772(f) provides for the 
    allocation of total profit in the United States and the home market to 
    CEP sales based upon the proportion of expenses incurred in the U.S. 
    market vis-a-vis total expenses.
        In addition, the statute specifies the adjustments that the 
    Department may make to normal value in order to achieve a fair 
    comparison between normal value and export price or CEP. Therefore, 
    adjustments beyond those called for by the statute (such as an 
    adjustment for resale profit) are not appropriate. Finally, the courts 
    have made it clear that where, as here, Congress has provided for an 
    adjustment to sales made in one market, but not for an adjustment to 
    sales made in the other, the Department must comply with the scheme 
    established by Congress. Ad Hoc Committee of AZ-NM-TX-FL Producers of 
    Gray Portland Cement v. United States, 13 F.3d 398, 401-02 (Fed. Cir. 
    1994).
        One commenter stated that the Department should clarify that if 
    prices are reported net of any rebated or uncollected taxes, no 
    adjustment to normal value under this provision is required. We have 
    not adopted this suggestion, because the Department believes that 
    section 773(a)(6)(B)(iii) of the Act clearly provides that the 
    Department need adjust for taxes only where such taxes are included in 
    the price of the foreign like product that is reported to the 
    Department. While the topic of taxes has been fertile ground for 
    misinterpretation and litigation, Congress has now established 
    conclusively that dumping comparisons are to be tax-neutral in all 
    cases. SAA at 827.
        Regarding the definition of direct selling expense contained in 
    proposed paragraph (b), one commenter suggested that the Department 
    specifically state that the allocation of expenses, even over non-scope 
    merchandise, does not automatically relieve that expense of its direct 
    nature. Again, the Department has addressed this and similar comments 
    above in connection with Sec. 351.401(g).
    
    Section 351.411
    
        Section 351.411 deals with adjustments for differences in physical 
    characteristics (also known as ``differences in merchandise'' or 
    ``DIFMER'' adjustments).
        One commenter suggested that the Department amend Sec. 351.411 to 
    provide that the Department will not make DIFMER adjustments when it 
    compares merchandise with identical control numbers, or (in the case of 
    comparisons involving ``identical'' or ``similar'' merchandise) for 
    characteristics that the Department did not select as product-matching 
    criteria. In addition, this commenter suggested that the regulations 
    state that, in reviews, the Department will use the same product 
    matching criteria as it used in the initial investigation, unless 
    revised by the Department. Another commenter agreed
    
    [[Page 27370]]
    
    with this commenter, and added that the Department never should base 
    DIFMER adjustments upon differences in the ``market value'' of 
    products, but instead should base such adjustments only upon 
    differences in variable costs. This commenter cited the SAA at 828, 
    which states that ``Commerce will continue its current practice of 
    limiting this adjustment to differences in variable costs associated 
    with physical differences.''
        The Department has not modified Sec. 351.411 in light of these 
    suggestions. The final regulation follows the proposed regulation and 
    prior regulations in providing that ``the Secretary will not consider 
    differences in cost of production when compared merchandise has 
    identical physical characteristics.'' By comparing merchandise 
    considered identical, the Department can avoid the need to make DIFMER 
    adjustments entirely.
        Regarding the proposal that the Department not alter its matching 
    criteria after the initial investigation, the Department agrees that 
    continuity and consistency from one segment of a proceeding to another 
    is desirable. However, the Department must have the flexibility to 
    revise these criteria where the facts so warrant.
        Finally, the Department has retained the language concerning the 
    use of effect on market value in measuring the amount of a DIFMER 
    adjustment. This provision has been in the Department's prior 
    regulations, although the Department rarely has quantified a DIFMER 
    adjustment on the basis of value. Moreover, the Federal Circuit has 
    held that while the Department may maintain a methodological preference 
    for cost over value in making adjustments, the Department may not rely 
    on cost to the exclusion of value. Smith-Corona Group v. United States, 
    713 F.2d 1568, 1577 (1983). In addition, although the SAA discusses the 
    Department's practice of making DIFMER adjustments based on variable 
    costs, which is the usual basis for such adjustments, it is silent on 
    the issue of market value. Therefore, the Department believes it is 
    necessary to retain the discretion to use market value in appropriate 
    circumstances.
        Another commenter noted that under proposed Sec. 351.411, the 
    Department would disregard fixed costs, SG&A, and profit that are 
    allocable to the physical differences. This commenter argued that this 
    approach is illogical, because the purpose of the DIFMER adjustment is 
    to put the price of the similar home market merchandise on the same 
    basis as the price of the comparison U.S. merchandise. The commenter 
    noted that, in the context of constructed value, the Department 
    includes all fixed and variable costs attributable to production of the 
    merchandise, plus amounts for general expenses and profit. We have not 
    adopted this suggestion, because the SAA at 828 is clear that when the 
    Department uses cost to measure the amount of a DIFMER adjustment, it 
    is to consider only differences in variable costs associated with 
    physical differences in the merchandise.
    
    Section 351.412
    
        Section 351.412 addresses the Department's methodology for 
    identifying differences in LOT and adjusting for such differences, 
    where appropriate. It also addresses how and when the Department will 
    apply the CEP offset. There have been several changes from the proposed 
    regulation.
        First, a number of commenters suggested that the Department abandon 
    its efforts to regulate in this area because of the Department's lack 
    of experience in making LOT adjustments under new statute. They 
    proposed instead that Sec. 351.412 merely track section 773(a)(7)(A) of 
    the Act, and provide that an LOT adjustment is allowed only when the 
    claimant demonstrates entitlement ``to the satisfaction of Commerce.''
        The Department believes that it is necessary to provide as much 
    guidance in this area as it can at this time. The LOT adjustment is one 
    of the most significant issues under the new statute and is an area in 
    which parties are in need of guidance. It is also an area in which 
    there has been considerable debate concerning the requirements of the 
    statute and the SAA. Therefore, while we have avoided regulating some 
    areas in which the Department needs more experience, such as the 
    definition of a ``pattern of consistent price differences,'' discussed 
    below, we have clarified our interpretations of the legal requirements, 
    and have given as much indication as possible as to how we intend to 
    identify, and adjust for, differences in levels of trade.
        One commenter proposed that the regulations make clear that the 
    burden of proof is on the respondent to prove entitlement to an LOT 
    adjustment to its advantage, just as the burden is on a respondent to 
    prove any other adjustment in its favor. The commenter also suggested 
    that the regulations make clear that neither adjustments for LOT 
    differences nor the CEP offset are automatic, but may be made only 
    where the statutory requirements are satisfied.
        While the Department generally agrees with these concepts, we do 
    not believe that it is necessary to incorporate them in the 
    regulations. The statute provides clear guidelines regarding the 
    conditions that must be satisfied before the Department may grant an 
    LOT adjustment. In addition, Sec. 351.401(b) makes clear that all 
    adjustments, including LOT adjustments, must be demonstrated to the 
    satisfaction of the Secretary. New Sec. 351.412(f) also clarifies that 
    the Department will grant a CEP offset only where a respondent has 
    succeeded in establishing that there is a difference in the levels of 
    trade, but, although the respondent has cooperated to the best of its 
    ability, the available data do not permit the Department to determine 
    whether that difference affects price comparability.
        Section 351.412(b) generally tracks the statute in explaining the 
    general conditions precedent to making an LOT adjustment. Although, for 
    organizational clarity, we have transposed paragraphs (b) and (c), we 
    do not intend this modification to have any substantive impact.
        Section 351.412(c) explains the basis on which the Department will 
    determine whether there are differences in the levels of trade of the 
    EP or CEP and normal value. Paragraph (c) is substantively the same as 
    the proposed regulation. Paragraph (c)(1) explains the basis on which 
    the Department will determine the LOT of sales and CV. Paragraph 
    (c)(1)(i) provides that the Department will determine the LOT of EP 
    sales on the basis of the starting prices of sales to the United 
    States, before any adjustments under section 772(c) of the Act. 
    Paragraph (c)(1)(ii) provides that the Department will base the LOT of 
    CEP on the U.S. affiliate's starting price in the United States, after 
    the CEP deductions under section 772(d) of the Act, but before the 
    deductions under section 772(c). Paragraph (c)(1)(iii) provides that 
    the Department will base the LOT of a price-based normal value on the 
    starting prices in the market in which normal value is determined, 
    before any deductions under section 773(a)(6) of the Act. The 
    Department will base the LOT of CV on the LOT of the sales from which 
    the Department derives SG&A and profit under section 773(e) of the Act.
        Section 773(a)(1)(B) of the Act requires that, to the extent 
    practicable, the Department base normal value on sales at the same LOT 
    as EP or CEP. Sections 772(a) and (b) define EP and CEP, respectively, 
    as the starting price in the United States as adjusted under sections 
    772(c) and (d). The adjustments under subsection (d) normally change 
    the LOT, so that the Department must
    
    [[Page 27371]]
    
    determine the LOT of CEP sales after any deductions under subsection 
    (d). The adjustments under subsection (c), however, are made to both EP 
    and CEP. Therefore, determining the LOT on the basis of EP or CEP 
    before any deductions under subsection (c) yields the LOT of the EP or 
    CEP. Similarly, we will not make the adjustments under section 
    773(a)(6) before determining the LOT of normal value.
        Several commenters contended that the Department's proposed 
    regulation, which identified the LOT of CEP sales based on the price 
    after adjustments under section 772(d), was contrary to the statute and 
    ignored commercial reality. According to these commenters, the 
    Department's proposed analysis would make CEP offsets virtually 
    automatic, contrary to the intent of Congress. These commenters 
    suggested that the Department revise its proposed regulation to state 
    that, in all situations, it will identify LOT on the basis of the 
    starting price.
        Other commenters contended that there is no basis for identifying 
    the LOT of CEP any differently than the LOT of EP and normal value. 
    They argued that such an approach would result in comparing a CEP that, 
    in reality, had been reduced to a ``factory door'' price with a normal 
    value at a more advanced stage of distribution, thereby necessitating 
    an LOT adjustment in virtually every instance. However, other 
    commenters argued that the Department's identification of the LOT of 
    CEP after adjustments was in accordance with the statute and SAA.
        As discussed above, we have maintained the methodology of the 
    proposed regulation. The statute directs the Department to determine 
    normal value at the LOT of the CEP, which includes any CEP deductions 
    under section 772(d). We note that many of the commenters opposed to 
    the use of adjusted CEP appear to believe that the deductions under 
    section 772(d) involve all direct and indirect expenses. However, as 
    discussed above in connection with Sec. 351.402, the deduction under 
    section 772(d) removes only expenses associated with economic 
    activities in the United States. Thus, CEP is not a price exclusive of 
    all selling expenses, because it contains the same type of selling 
    expenses as a directly observed export price.
        Paragraph (c)(2) describes how the Department will determine 
    whether two sales were made at different levels of trade. We have 
    modified the proposed regulation to provide that the Department will 
    not identify levels of trade based solely on selling activities. We 
    have made this change in order to avoid any implication that every 
    substantial difference in selling functions or activities constitutes a 
    difference in the levels of trade.
        Numerous commenters stated that the proposed regulation appeared to 
    be inconsistent with the statute because it based the identification of 
    levels of trade on the identification of different selling activities. 
    These commenters argued that the statute requires that the Department 
    identify levels of trade first, and that it consider selling activities 
    only to determine whether an LOT adjustment is authorized.
        Other commenters asserted that the proposed regulation 
    appropriately made differences in selling activities the test for 
    identifying levels of trade. These commenters argued, however, that the 
    Department should not merely count the number of different selling 
    activities, but instead should take a qualitative approach, weighing 
    the extent and importance of each selling activity.
        In the Department's view, while neither the statute nor SAA defines 
    level of trade, section 773(a)(7)(A)(i) of the Act provides for LOT 
    adjustments where there is a difference in levels of trade and the 
    difference ``involves'' the performance of different selling 
    activities. Thus, the statute uses the term ``level of trade'' as a 
    concept distinct from selling activities. The SAA at 829 reinforces 
    this point by explaining that the Department must analyze the functions 
    performed by the sellers, but need not find that two levels involve no 
    common selling activities before finding two levels of trade. In other 
    words, the statute indicates that two sales with substantial 
    differences in selling activities nevertheless may be at the same level 
    of trade, and the SAA adds that two sales with some common selling 
    activities nevertheless may be at different levels of trade. Taken 
    together, the two points establish that an analysis of selling 
    activities alone is insufficient to establish the LOT. Rather, the 
    Department must analyze selling functions to determine if levels of 
    trade identified by a party are meaningful. In situations where some 
    differences in selling activities are associated with different sales, 
    whether that difference amounts to a difference in the levels of trade 
    will have to be evaluated in the context of the seller's whole scheme 
    of marketing.
        If the Department treated every substantial difference in selling 
    activities as a separate LOT, the Department potentially would be 
    required to address dozens of levels of trade--many of which would be 
    artificial creations. In addition to being extremely burdensome, this 
    would make the Department less likely to find ``patterns of consistent 
    price differences'' between the apparently different levels of trade. 
    This would result either in denial of LOT adjustments altogether or 
    routine use of the CEP offset. Neither of these results was intended by 
    the URAA.
        Section 351.412(c)(2) states that an LOT is a marketing stage ``or 
    the equivalent'' (which means that the merchandise does not necessarily 
    have to change hands twice in order to reach the more remote LOT). It 
    is sufficient that, at the more remote level, the seller takes on a 
    role comparable to that of a reseller if the merchandise had changed 
    hands twice. For example, a producer that normally sells to 
    distributors (that, in turn, resell to industrial consumers) could make 
    some sales directly, taking over the functions normally performed by 
    the distributors. Such sales would be at the same LOT as the sales 
    through the distributors. Each more remote level must be characterized 
    by an additional layer of selling activities, amounting in the 
    aggregate to a substantially different selling function. Substantial 
    differences in the amount of selling expenses associated with two 
    groups of sales also may indicate that the two groups are at different 
    levels of trade.
        Although the type of customer will be an important indicator in 
    identifying differences in levels of trade, the existence of different 
    classes of customers is not sufficient to establish a difference in the 
    levels of trade. Similarly, while titles, such as ``original equipment 
    manufacturer,'' ``distributor,'' ``wholesaler,'' and ``retailer'' may 
    actually describe levels of trade, the fact that two sales were made by 
    entities with titles indicating different stages of the marketing 
    process is not sufficient to establish that the two sales were made at 
    different levels of trade.
        Section 351.412(d) provides that the Department will grant an LOT 
    adjustment only if it is demonstrated to the satisfaction of the 
    Secretary that the difference between the LOT of the sales in the 
    United States and normal value affects price comparability, based on a 
    pattern of consistent price differences between sales at those two 
    levels of trade in the market in which normal value is determined. The 
    Department will develop its practice in this area in the course of 
    administrative proceedings, and intends to issue a policy bulletin once 
    its methodology is more fully developed.
        Section 351.412(e) provides that the Department will calculate LOT 
    adjustments by determining the weighted average of the adjusted prices
    
    [[Page 27372]]
    
    at the two relevant levels of trade in the market in which normal value 
    is determined. These two levels are the level corresponding to EP or 
    CEP and the level at which normal value is determined. The Department 
    will apply the average percentage difference between these weighted 
    averages to normal value, as otherwise adjusted.
        Several commenters contended that the Department should base the 
    amount of any adjustment on the pattern of consistent price 
    differences, rather than on a weighted average. The Department has not 
    adopted this proposal. The SAA at 830 clearly states that ``any 
    adjustment * * * will be calculated as the percentage by which the 
    weighted-average prices at each of the two levels of trade differ in 
    the market used to establish normal value.''
        Several commenters proposed that the Department make clear that LOT 
    adjustments, or the CEP offset, can be applied when normal value is 
    based on CV, as well as when normal value is based on prices. The 
    Department agrees, and has revised the proposed regulation to remove 
    any suggestion that LOT adjustments will be made only to prices. 
    Section 773(a)(8) of the Act provides that the Department may adjust 
    CV, as appropriate, under subsection 773(a). Section 773(a)(7)(B) 
    provides that the CEP offset is made to ``normal value.'' There is no 
    limitation confining the adjustment to home market prices, or 
    precluding its application to CV. Therefore, it is clear that LOT 
    adjustments are appropriate regardless of the basis on which normal 
    value is determined.
        Where there are sales of the foreign like product at the LOT in the 
    home market corresponding to the LOT of the EP or CEP, the Department 
    will determine normal value on the basis of those sales, and the 
    Department will not make an LOT adjustment. In situations where the 
    Department seeks to make an LOT adjustment, there may be no usable 
    sales of the foreign like product in the market in which normal value 
    is determined at the LOT of the EP or CEP. In order to calculate LOT 
    adjustments in such situations, the Department will examine price 
    differences in the home market either for sales of broader or different 
    product lines or for sales made by other companies.
        The regulation also makes clear that the Department will make the 
    LOT adjustment on the basis of adjusted prices. Although neither the 
    statute nor the SAA stipulates whether the average prices compared to 
    determine the amount of the LOT adjustment should be adjusted prices, 
    the adjustment can accomplish its purpose only if calculated on the 
    basis of adjusted prices. This is because the adjustment is intended to 
    eliminate only differences that are: (1) attributable to a difference 
    in levels of trade; and (2) not otherwise adjusted for. In order to 
    avoid having the LOT adjustment duplicate other adjustments, the LOT 
    adjustment must be calculated on the basis of prices to which those 
    adjustments have already been made. To achieve this, the Department 
    will adjust prices at each level of trade in the foreign market as 
    appropriate under section 773(a)(6) before it determines the amount of 
    the LOT adjustment.
        One commenter asked the Department to specify that an LOT 
    adjustment can have any value, positive, negative, or zero. We have not 
    adopted this proposal because the statute and SAA make clear that LOT 
    adjustments can be upwards or downwards. SAA at 830.
        Section 351.412(f) describes the situations in which the Department 
    will grant a CEP offset. Some commenters suggested that the CEP offset 
    is ``automatic.'' This is not the case. The Department will calculate 
    CEP by deducting only selling expenses and profit associated with 
    selling activities in the United States. Thus, the resulting CEP will 
    retain an element of selling expenses and an element of profit, as do 
    directly observed export prices. We do not agree that there never will 
    be comparable sales in the foreign market.
        The Department will not make a CEP offset where the sales to the 
    United States are EP sales or where the Department bases normal value 
    on home market sales at the same LOT as the CEP. The Department will 
    grant a CEP offset only where: (1) normal value is determined at a more 
    remote level of trade than CEP sales; and (2) despite the fact that a 
    respondent cooperated to the best of its ability, the data available do 
    not provide an appropriate basis to determine whether the difference in 
    levels of trade affects price comparability.
        One commenter contended that the Department should make the CEP 
    offset in addition to any adjustment for differences in levels of 
    trade. The Department has not adopted this proposal. Section 
    773(a)(7)(B) of the Act authorizes the Department to make the CEP 
    offset only where the data available do not provide an appropriate 
    basis to determine an LOT adjustment. Therefore, whenever an LOT 
    adjustment can be calculated, the Department cannot also make the CEP 
    offset.
    
    Section 351.413
    
        Section 351.413 deals with the Department's authority to disregard 
    insignificant adjustments under section 777A(a)(2) of the Act. More 
    specifically, Sec. 351.413 defines the term ``insignificant'' with 
    respect to an individual adjustment and a group of adjustments.
        Two commenters observed that proposed Sec. 351.413 provided that 
    the Department may ignore any ``group of adjustments'' with an ad 
    valorem effect of less than one percent. Because the proposed 
    regulations identify three separate ``groups of adjustments,'' it is 
    possible that the Department could ignore three separate groups of 
    ``insignificant'' adjustments for which the combined ad valorem effect 
    could be nearly three percent. To prevent this, one commenter suggested 
    that the Department delete the final sentence of proposed Sec. 351.413 
    dealing with groups of adjustments. The other commenter suggested that 
    the Department make clear that the total ad valorem effect of all 
    disregarded adjustments can be no more than one percent.
        The Department has not adopted these suggestions. In Sec. 351.413, 
    the percentages used and the definition of groups of adjustments 
    reflects the legislative history of section 777A(a)(2) of the Act, the 
    statutory provision on which the regulation is based. See, e.g., S. Rep 
    No. 249, 96th Cong., 2d Sess. 96 (1979). Moreover, with the exception 
    of changes in terminology (e.g., from ``foreign market value'' to 
    ``normal value'') a revision to render this provision applicable to the 
    calculation of export price and constructed export price, Sec. 351.413 
    is unchanged from former 19 CFR Sec. 353.59(a).
        We believe that part of the commenters' concerns may arise from a 
    misperception that the references to ``an ad valorem effect'' in 
    Sec. 351.413 relate to the ad valorem dumping margin, so that if the 
    Department ignored groups of adjustments with a total ad valorem effect 
    of three percent, the Department, for example, might transform a 
    dumping margin of 4 percent ad valorem to 1 percent ad valorem. 
    However, this is not what is contemplated by Sec. 351.413, because that 
    section clearly states that the ad valorem effect in question is the 
    percentage change to ``export price, constructed export price, or 
    normal value, as the case may be,'' and not the percentage change in 
    the dumping margin.
        Finally, we should note that both section 777A(a)(2) and 
    Sec. 351.413 give the Department the flexibility to determine, on a 
    case-by-case basis, whether it should disregard a particular 
    insignificant adjustment. Given this flexibility, and given that 
    Sec. 351.413 is taken almost verbatim from the
    
    [[Page 27373]]
    
    legislative history, we do not believe there is a reason to eliminate 
    the guidance provided by the last sentence defining ``groups of 
    adjustments.''
    
    Section 351.414
    
        Section 351.414 implements section 777A(d) of the Act and sets 
    forth the three statutory methods for establishing and measuring 
    dumping margins. Section 351.414(c) sets forth the preference for 
    comparisons of average U.S. prices to average comparison market prices 
    in investigations, and for comparison of transaction-specific U.S. 
    prices to average comparison market prices in administrative reviews.
        Averaging groups: In establishing the particular averaging groups 
    to be used for price comparisons, Sec. 351.414(d)(2) of the proposed 
    rule stated that an averaging group will consist of subject merchandise 
    that is identical or virtually identical in all physical 
    characteristics and that is sold to the United States at the same level 
    of trade. The Secretary also will take into account, where appropriate, 
    the region of the United States in which the merchandise is sold and 
    such other factors as are considered relevant.
        One commenter objected to the Department's interpretation of the 
    statutory provision, and suggested that the true purpose of averaging 
    groups, as reflected in the SAA, is to identify potential targeted 
    dumping to certain U.S. customers or certain U.S. regions, not to 
    invite a similar division of the home market into such groups as a 
    means of thwarting the AD law. The commenter concluded that the 
    regulations should make clear that price averaging pertains solely to 
    U.S. sales and that no product averaging groups will be undertaken with 
    respect to normal value sales.
        We disagree with the comment. The SAA provides that in an 
    investigation Commerce will normally establish and measure dumping 
    margins on the basis of a comparison of weighted-average normal values 
    and weighted-average export or constructed export prices. The SAA 
    specifically states:
    
        To ensure that these averages are meaningful, Commerce will 
    calculate averages for comparable sales of subject merchandise to 
    the U.S. and sales of foreign like products. In determining the 
    comparability of sales for purposes of inclusion in a particular 
    average, Commerce will consider factors it deems appropriate, such 
    as the physical characteristics of the merchandise, the region of 
    the country in which the merchandise is sold, the time period, and 
    the class of customer involved. (Emphasis added.)
    
    SAA at 842.
        In the Department's view, the language of the SAA makes clear that 
    Congress and the Administration contemplated the use of averaging 
    groups for both U.S. and normal value sales. Nothing in the statute or 
    SAA supports the view that normal value sales should not be averaged, 
    or that normal value sales should not be averaged on the same basis as 
    U.S. sales. Moreover, the purpose of establishing particular price 
    averaging groups is to make accurate and meaningful price comparisons, 
    not to identify (and address) potential targeted dumping.
        Time period over which weighted-average is calculated: Under 
    Sec. 351.414(d)(3) of the proposed rule, the Department normally will 
    calculate averages for the entire period of investigation or review 
    when the average-to-average method is applied. However, the Secretary 
    may calculate weighted-averages for shorter periods when normal values, 
    export prices, or constructed export prices differ significantly over 
    the course of the period of investigation or review.
        One commenter pointed out that there is no reason to default to the 
    entire period given the complete reporting requirements of the law and 
    the capability for analysis of prices through computer support. For 
    perishable products, the commenter noted that the Department should 
    average prices over the shortest period necessary to take account of 
    the perishable nature of the products, but should not average prices 
    over a period that would mask price trends unrelated to the perishable 
    nature of the product.
        For products such as manufactured goods, the commenter contended 
    that the Department should adopt a one-month average as the standard 
    time period over which prices would be averaged when the Department 
    employs the average-to-average method. According to the commenter, use 
    of a one-month average time period results in a more precise comparison 
    of normal values and export/constructed export prices than would a 
    single period-wide average comparison. With a one-month standard, the 
    Department may allow averaging over longer periods only where it is 
    shown that a longer period does not distort the price-to-price 
    comparison.
        Another commenter supported the Department's proposed rule that the 
    Department will rely on shorter periods in appropriate circumstances 
    and urges the Department to give full consideration to all relevant 
    circumstances in applying the rule.
        In the Department's view, price averaging means establishing an 
    average price for all comparable sales. In general, we believe it is 
    appropriate to average prices across the period of investigation, 
    though we recognize that there are circumstances in which other 
    averaging periods are more appropriate. Accordingly, the proposed rule 
    is designed to ensure that the time periods over which price averages 
    and comparisons are made comports with the circumstances of the case, 
    while maintaining a preference for period-wide averaging. Where 
    perishable products are concerned, the Department has not fashioned a 
    rule with respect to a particular type of product because such an 
    approach may limit the agency's ability to address, for example, price 
    trends unrelated to the perishable nature of the product.
        Use of the average-to-average method in administrative reviews: 
    Section 351.414(c)(2) of the proposed regulations states that in a 
    review the Secretary normally will use the transaction-to-average 
    method. One commenter urged the Department to expand the application of 
    the average-to-average price comparison method to administrative 
    reviews. In contrast, another commenter contended that such an 
    expansion is clearly impermissible. Citing the SAA, the opposing 
    commenter argued that both Congress and the Administration recognized 
    that the transaction-to-average method would continue to be used in 
    administrative reviews. Another commenter agreed and advocated adoption 
    of a final rule that would preclude application of the average-to-
    average methodology in reviews, other than in exceptional 
    circumstances.
        The Department specifically addressed these divergent positions in 
    the preamble to the proposed regulation. The final rule reflects the 
    SAA, which expressly states that the transaction-to-average method is 
    the preferred approach for administrative reviews. SAA at 843. However, 
    these regulations do not preclude the use of average-to-average price 
    comparisons in every review. Circumstances may exist that warrant 
    application of the average-to-average method and the final rule 
    reflects the Department's authority to apply this method where 
    necessary.
        On the subject of the transaction-to-transaction method of price 
    comparisons, one commenter suggested that the final rule state that 
    this method be applied ``in appropriate situations,'' rather than 
    ``only in unusual situations'' as contemplated in the proposed 
    regulation, Sec. 351.414(c)(1). In the commenter's view, the language 
    of the proposed rule establishes a strong presumption that the 
    transaction-to-
    
    [[Page 27374]]
    
     transaction method should not be used. The commenter believed that 
    anyone who advocates use of this alternative method should bear the 
    burden of providing good reason for its application, but that the final 
    rule should not discourage this option.
        In the Department's view, the SAA makes clear that Congress did not 
    contemplate broad application of the transaction-to-transaction method. 
    SAA at 842. Specifically, the SAA recognizes the difficulties the 
    agency has encountered in the past with respect to this methodology and 
    suggests that even in situations where there are very few sales, the 
    merchandise in both markets should also be identical or very similar 
    before the agency would make transaction-to-transaction comparisons. 
    Accordingly, we continue to maintain that the transaction-to-
    transaction methodology should only be applied in unusual situations.
        Targeted dumping: Paragraph (f) of Sec. 351.414 of the proposed 
    regulation implemented the ``targeted dumping'' provision of section 
    777A(d)(1)(B) of the Act. Several parties commented that the final rule 
    should provide more specific guidelines as to what constitutes targeted 
    dumping. One commenter suggested the Department provide guidance by 
    establishing more specific criteria for making targeted dumping 
    determinations. Another commenter suggested that the Department needs 
    to gain more experience in order to develop the proper standard for 
    making such determinations, and should establish guidelines through 
    policy bulletins as it develops its practice in this area.
        More specifically, several commenters suggested that the Department 
    recognize in its final rule that certain ``common commercial patterns 
    of pricing'' do not constitute targeted dumping, such as (1) different 
    pricing for larger or smaller orders, (2) seasonal pricing, and (3) 
    price changes associated with industry practices, such as downward 
    price changes pursuant to lower costs as are typical for 
    semiconductors, personal computers, and other technical products. In 
    contrast, other commenters contended that common commercial practices 
    in an industry can constitute targeted dumping and that such behavior 
    should not be excused or ignored simply because it is considered to be 
    a common commercial practice.
        Other commenters proposed additional substantive guidance. For 
    example, one party suggested that targeted dumping should not be found 
    to exist where the pattern of prices exists in both the U.S. and the 
    comparison market. Another commenter suggested that the Department not 
    obligate itself to use ``standard statistical techniques'' in all of 
    its determinations. Several commenters suggested that the Department 
    define in the final regulations the evidentiary threshold for 
    initiating a targeted dumping inquiry. One commenter, in particular, 
    contended that the final rule establish a low threshold for an 
    allegation to be accepted, similar to allegations of sales below cost. 
    Another commenter expressed concern that the Department's brief 
    practice in this area already has established an arbitrarily high 
    initiation standard.
        In the preamble to the proposed regulations, the Department 
    specifically avoided the adoption of any per se rules on targeted 
    dumping due to the Department's limited experience administering this 
    provision of the Act. However, the Department recognizes the need to 
    establish guidance in this area and thus will issue policy bulletins 
    setting forth more specific criteria as the Department develops its 
    practice in this area. Moreover, the Department plans to employ common 
    statistical methods in its targeted dumping determinations in order to 
    ensure that the test is applied on a consistent basis and in a manner 
    that ensures transparency and predictability to all parties concerned. 
    In addition, the Department will ensure that parties have an 
    opportunity to explain whether a particular pattern of export prices or 
    constructed export prices constitutes targeted dumping. A policy 
    bulletin setting forth some basic guidelines for applying statistical 
    techniques to targeted dumping questions will be issued in the near 
    future. As we gain more experience in this area, the bulletins will be 
    supplemented or replaced.
        Allegation requirement: In proposed Sec. 351.414(f)(3), the 
    Department stated that ``the Secretary will not consider targeted 
    dumping absent an allegation.'' Many commenters opposed the allegation 
    requirement on several grounds. First, they claimed that the burden 
    imposed on interested domestic parties is substantial in that these 
    parties would have to examine multiple respondents, and then reexamine 
    revised responses, sometimes submitted subsequent to verification. 
    Second, the commenters added that the Department's proposed rule 
    effectively precluded self-initiation of a targeted dumping examination 
    by the Department. One commenter contended that the Department should 
    place the burden of proof on respondents to demonstrate that they did 
    not engage in targeted dumping, thereby removing the improper burden 
    placed on domestic interested parties. The commenter went on to state 
    that, contrary to the Department's reasoning in the preamble to the AD 
    Proposed Regulations, it is the Department, and not domestic interested 
    parties, that is in the best position to find targeted dumping. 
    According to the commenter, a domestic interested party's knowledge of 
    the market in question offers no special insight into whether a foreign 
    company has engaged in targeted dumping. While a domestic company may 
    recognize that it is losing sales to foreign competitors, it surely can 
    have no way of knowing the reasons behind, or pattern emanating from, 
    such dumping. According to the commenter, the Department, through its 
    power to assess margins based on facts available, is in the best 
    position to obtain the information necessary to make a targeted dumping 
    determination.
        It is the Department's view that normally any targeted dumping 
    examination should begin with domestic interested parties. It is the 
    domestic industry that possesses intimate knowledge of regional 
    markets, types of customers, and the effect of specific time periods on 
    pricing in the U.S. market in general. Without the assistance of the 
    domestic industry, the Department would be unable to focus 
    appropriately any analysis of targeted dumping. For example, the 
    Department would not know what regions may be targeted for a particular 
    product, or what time periods are most significant and can impact 
    prices in the U.S. market. Ultimately, the domestic industry possesses 
    the expertise and knowledge of the product and the U.S. market. 
    Information on these factors are significant for both the burden aspect 
    and the determination itself. If the Department were required to 
    explore the contours of the U.S. market for every product subject to an 
    investigation, absent the knowledge as to how the market functions, the 
    Department would be compelled to conduct countless comparisons of 
    prices between customers, possible regions, and possibly significant 
    time periods in every case. Absent any guiding insight as to how the 
    market truly functions, such a requirement would be an enormous 
    undertaking. Fundamentally, the Department needs the assistance of the 
    domestic industry to focus the inquiry and to properly investigate the 
    possibility of targeted dumping.
        Nevertheless, there may be instances in which the Department 
    recognizes targeted dumping on its own, without an allegation from 
    domestic interested parties. In such cases, the Department must be able 
    to address the targeted
    
    [[Page 27375]]
    
    dumping behavior regardless of whether any domestic interested party 
    filed a timely and sufficient allegation. Accordingly, the Department 
    has modified the proposed rule in order to ensure that the regulation 
    properly reflects the Department's authority to address instances of 
    targeted dumping absent an allegation. However, the final rule 
    anticipates that targeted dumping examinations normally will flow from 
    allegations of targeted dumping.
        With respect to the availability of information, the Department 
    recognizes that parties' access to relevant information on the record 
    is crucial for making targeted dumping allegations of merit and will 
    continue to take steps to ensure that public summaries provide the 
    parties with adequate information. For example, the authority to 
    determine margins based on facts available should continue to enable 
    the Department to obtain the information necessary for domestic 
    interested parties to make targeted dumping allegations. For example, 
    the Department intends to calculate dumping margins using the 
    transaction-to-average method as facts available for any respondent who 
    refuses to supply the necessary data for a targeted dumping 
    determination.
        Time in which to file targeted dumping allegations: Section 
    351.301(d)(4) sets forth the time in which targeted dumping allegations 
    must be filed. Although we received comments on the proposed regulatory 
    deadline for filing targeted dumping allegations, for the final rule we 
    have adopted the time requirement set forth in the proposed rule for 
    the reasons discussed below.
        Under proposed Sec. 351.301(d)(4), the Department stated that an 
    allegation of targeted dumping must be filed ``no later than 30 days 
    before the scheduled date of the preliminary determination.'' 
    Commenters pointed out that there is no reason to impose such a 
    deadline for submitting an allegation given that the Department will 
    receive the necessary information on targeted dumping in the normal 
    course of every investigation. Thus, unlike cost investigations, the 
    Department need not request additional information to conduct its 
    examination. Accordingly, commenters contended, the Department need not 
    require the stringent deadlines set forth in the proposed rule. 
    Commenters also contended that the proposed deadline imposed a 
    substantial burden in that for many cases the Department has limited, 
    unusable information on the record 30 days prior to the preliminary 
    determination. Commenters also noted that the proposed early and 
    inflexible time limit would impose the added burden on petitioners at a 
    time when the domestic industry must examine questionnaire responses 
    for identification of deficiencies and for potential below-cost 
    allegations. These commenters proposed that the final rule permit 
    domestic interested parties to file allegations at any time until the 
    deadline for the case briefs, which would allow allegations to include 
    information uncovered at verification.
        The Department has adopted the proposed regulation relating to the 
    time in which to file targeted dumping allegations. To extend the 
    deadline would make it impossible for the Department to consider the 
    allegation for the preliminary determination. Furthermore, it would 
    make any verification of issues relative to the allegation extremly 
    difficult. However, the Department recognizes the burden such a 
    deadline may place on domestic interested parties in some situations 
    and intends to be flexible with respect to the deadline. For example, 
    if the timing of the responses does not permit adequate time for 
    analysis, the Department may consider that to be ``good cause'' and 
    extend the deadline under section 351.302.
        Limited application of average-to-transaction method: Under 
    proposed paragraph (f)(2), the Secretary will normally limit the 
    application of average-to-transaction comparisons exclusively to those 
    sales in which the criteria for determining targeted dumping are 
    satisfied. The preamble to the proposed regulations states that it 
    would be ``unreasonable and unduly punitive'' to apply the transaction-
    to-average approach to all sales where, for example, targeted dumping 
    accounted for only one percent of a firm's total sales. The preamble 
    also states that the approach would not always be limited in 
    application ``because there may be situations in which targeted dumping 
    by a firm is so pervasive that the average-to-transaction method 
    becomes the benchmark for gauging the fairness of that firm's pricing 
    practices.''
        Several commenters argued that neither the AD Agreement, statute, 
    nor the SAA supports limited application, and advocated broad 
    application of the transaction-to-average approach to all of a firm's 
    sales once targeted dumping is found. In general, these commenters also 
    were concerned that limiting the application exclusively to those sales 
    in which the targeting criteria are met would have significant 
    implications for submitting allegations. One commenter, in particular, 
    noted that the ``hybrid approach'' proposed by the Department would 
    require an exhaustive recitation, rather than a representative 
    allegation, if all instances of targeted dumping are to be addressed. 
    The commenter also rejected the view that broad application would be 
    ``punitive'' and claimed that the average-to-average method was 
    designed to simplify the dumping calculations, not to provide more 
    accurate means of calculating dumping margins. In the commenter's view, 
    the transaction-to-average method should be viewed as a more accurate, 
    not more punitive, measure of dumping. Another commenter suggested that 
    the targeted dumping provision is intended to prevent foreign producers 
    from unduly and inappropriately benefitting from an averaging of U.S. 
    sales. The commenter reasoned that once a party engages in targeted 
    dumping, it has violated the spirit of the average-to-average method 
    and forfeits entirely the privilege of receiving an average-to-average 
    calculation. In the alternative, one commenter suggested that the 
    Department consider application of the transaction-to-average method 
    for all of a firm's sales where it is established that targeted dumping 
    exists for 10 percent or more of that firm's sales.
        The Department has considered the scope of application of the 
    average-to-transaction methodology raised in the comments on this 
    issue. Based upon our examination, the Department is adopting the 
    proposed regulation without modification. In the Department's view, 
    section 777A(d)(1) of the Act establishes a preference for average-to-
    average price comparisons in investigations. The statute contemplates a 
    divergence from the normal average-to-average (or transaction-to-
    transaction) price comparison out of concern that such a methodology 
    could conceal ``targeted dumping.'' SAA at 842. Accordingly, the 
    Department will apply the average-to-transaction approach solely to 
    address the practice of targeted dumping. Nevertheless, the Department 
    contemplates that in some instances it may be necessary to apply the 
    average-to-transaction method to all sales to the targeted area, such 
    as a region or a customer, or even all sales of a particular 
    respondent. For example, where the targeted dumping practice is so 
    widespread it may be administratively impractical to segregate targeted 
    dumping pricing from the normal pricing behavior of a company. 
    Moreover, the Department recognizes that where a firm engages 
    extensively in the practice of targeted dumping, the only adequate 
    yardstick available to measure such pricing behavior may be the 
    average-to-transaction methodology.
        With respect to the contention that limiting the application of the 
    transaction-to-average method solely to
    
    [[Page 27376]]
    
    targeted sales would require an extensive allegation, as opposed to a 
    representative one, we disagree. The proposed regulation speaks to 
    limited application of the transaction-to-average method once targeted 
    dumping is found to exist. It does not address the scope of the 
    targeted dumping examination itself. Interested parties may make 
    representative targeted dumping allegations based upon prices to 
    purchasers, regions, or periods of time, provided they explain how the 
    evidence examined in the allegations is relevant to prices of other 
    products or models, or other companies.
    
    Section 351.415
    
        Section 351.415 implements section 773A of the Act, which deals 
    with the selection of the exchange rate used to convert foreign 
    currencies to U.S. dollars. For the reasons set forth below, we have 
    not revised Sec. 351.415.
        Forward sales of currency: Section 351.415(b) creates an exception 
    to the general rule that the Department will use the actual exchange 
    rate on the date of sale to convert foreign currencies to U.S. dollars. 
    Under paragraph (b), if a currency transaction on forward markets is 
    directly linked to an export sale under consideration, the Department 
    will use the exchange rate specified in the forward sales agreement 
    instead of the actual exchange rate on the date of sale.
        Two commenters made suggestions regarding the application of the 
    ``directly linked'' standard. One commenter suggested that if an 
    exporter actually applies forward exchange rates to its export sales, 
    then the Department should use those forward exchange rates (whether 
    they be daily, quarterly, or quarterly averages). The second commenter 
    proposed that in order for the Department to use a forward exchange 
    rate, the forward sale of currency must relate specifically to the 
    export sale, i.e., the forward rate should not be allocated. According 
    to the second commenter, this would prevent an exporter from claiming 
    that its general hedging operations are directly linked to particular 
    export sales. This same commenter also argued that where the forward 
    sale agreement spans a period of time, the Department should use the 
    exchange rate specified in the agreement only if the date of sale of 
    the export transaction falls within that period.
        With respect to these suggestions, while the Department believes 
    that it might be desirable to have more detailed rules concerning the 
    ``directly linked'' standard, we do not have enough experience with 
    this standard to provide such rules at this time. Therefore, we intend 
    to develop our practice in the context of future investigations and 
    reviews.
        Another commenter, noting that forward currency transactions 
    usually involve a fee, suggested that the Department either should 
    include this fee as part of the forward exchange rate or should make a 
    COS adjustment under Sec. 351.410 to account for the fee. We agree that 
    the Department should account for these types of fees, but we do not 
    believe that an additional regulation is necessary. In the case of 
    Sec. 351.410, for example, we believe that the provision is 
    sufficiently flexible to encompass a COS adjustment for forward 
    exchange rate fees.
        Model for identifying and addressing fluctuations and sustained 
    movements in exchange rates: Several commenters made suggestions to 
    amend the model proposed by the Department for identifying and 
    addressing fluctuations and sustained movements in exchange rates. (We 
    described this model briefly in the AD Proposed Regulations, 61 FR at 
    7351, and then published a more detailed description in Policy Bulletin 
    (96-1): Currency Conversions, 61 FR 9434 (March 8, 1996) (``Policy 
    Bulletin 96-1'')). Regarding fluctuations in exchange rates, two 
    commenters suggested that the Department replace the 8-week rolling 
    average benchmark for determining fluctuations with a 17-week (120-day) 
    rolling average. They also suggested that the benchmark should not 
    include exchange rates that the Department has determined to be 
    fluctuations, because section 773A of the Act requires the Department 
    to ignore fluctuations.
        Regarding sustained movements in an exchange rate, certain 
    commenters claimed that the Department's model is overly rigid in 
    identifying such movements, as evidenced by the fact that the model 
    only identifies one sustained movement for one currency in the period 
    since 1992. These commenters suggested several amendments to the model 
    to ensure that it would serve the purpose of protecting exporters when 
    the value of their currency changes faster than they can raise prices. 
    These suggestions included: changing the so-called ``recognition 
    period'' for sustained movements from 8 weeks to 13 weeks (90 days); 
    requiring fewer than 8 consecutive weeks of changes before recognizing 
    a sustained movement, or using monthly rather than weekly averages to 
    determine whether a sustained movement has occurred; applying an 
    historic rate (such as the rate from the quarter preceding the 
    recognition period) during the recognition period; and, using the 
    official exchange rate from the first day of the recognition period 
    during the 60-day adjustment period.
        One commenter argued against the latter two suggestions on the 
    grounds that the purpose of section 773A(b) is to allow exporters an 
    adjustment period after a sustained movement in exchange rates has 
    occurred. Therefore, in this commenter's view, it makes no sense to use 
    an exchange rate that predates the sustained movement, nor would 
    section 773A(b) permit the use of an historic rate occurring during the 
    recognition period. Finally, one commenter requested that the 
    Department provide additional guidance on the exchange rate that it 
    intends to apply when a foreign currency is depreciating, as opposed to 
    appreciating, against the U.S. dollar.
        The Department welcomes the numerous comments submitted on the 
    model for identifying and addressing fluctuations and sustained 
    movements in exchange rates. As we stated in the AD Proposed 
    Regulations, we intend to use the model for one year and then evaluate 
    its performance based on public comment. As part of that evaluation, we 
    will consider the comments we have received in connection with the 
    instant rulemaking. Moreover, as indicated in Policy Bulletin 96-1, we 
    will consider comments we received on the model through December 31, 
    1996.
        At this time, however, we would like to make two points. First, 
    based on a preliminary review of the comments, we do not believe that 
    using a benchmark rate that includes past fluctuations contravenes 
    section 773A(a). The fluctuations identified under the model are 
    fluctuations that are relative to a particular number calculated at a 
    particular point in time; i.e., the average of the actual exchange 
    rates on each of the prior 40 days. The fact that a particular daily 
    rate fluctuates vis-a-vis that number is sufficient to disqualify that 
    daily rate for purposes of conversion on that date. However, the 
    designation of a particular daily rate as a fluctuation does not render 
    that rate unusable for all purposes. In particular, we believe that 
    actual exchange rates provide the best gauge of whether a particular 
    daily rate should be viewed as a fluctuation. Therefore, we consider it 
    appropriate to include past fluctuations in the rolling average 
    benchmark.
        Moreover, when the Department deems a particular daily rate to be a 
    fluctuation, we believe we should use the benchmark (which includes 
    past fluctuations) in lieu of the daily rate. For
    
    [[Page 27377]]
    
    example, the fact that a daily rate three weeks ago is considered to be 
    a fluctuation means only that the daily rate varied from the historic 
    average as of that time. It does not mean that one should continue to 
    view that daily rate as a fluctuation three weeks later. Because the 
    designation of fluctuations is time-sensitive in this sense, the 
    commenters appear to be reading too much into the statutory prohibition 
    against the use of fluctuating exchange rates.
        Second, regarding the comment on our treatment of depreciating 
    currencies, we note that the Department addressed this issue in Certain 
    Pasta from Turkey, 61 FR 30309, 30325 (June 14, 1996). In that case, 
    which involved a situation where the foreign currency was depreciating 
    against the U.S. dollar, we used actual daily exchange rates rather 
    than the benchmark rates generated by the model. We agree with the 
    commenter that we should address depreciating currencies more fully in 
    a final model, and we welcome further suggestions on this point.
        Sustained movements: While the model discussed above identifies and 
    addresses sustained movements in exchange rates, paragraph (d) sets 
    forth a general rule that where there is a sustained movement 
    ``increasing the value of the foreign currency relative to the U.S. 
    dollar,'' exporters will be given 60 days in which to adjust their 
    prices. Two commenters claimed that paragraph (d) is ``one-sided.'' 
    Specifically, one commenter objected to the fact that paragraph (d) 
    only addresses sustained appreciations in a foreign currency relative 
    to the U.S. dollar. In this commenter's view, section 773A(b) does not 
    specify whether the sustained movement must be upward or downward. The 
    second commenter (presumably referring to the fact that paragraph (d) 
    does not address sustained depreciations in a foreign currency) pointed 
    out that under paragraph (d), respondents can take advantage of 
    favorable exchange rates when a foreign currency appreciates, but 
    domestic industries do not receive a comparable benefit when the 
    currency depreciates. The commenter suggested that the Department 
    should address this by establishing a special rule for situations where 
    exporters should be raising their U.S. prices in response to exchange 
    rate changes, but, instead, are lowering them.
        We are not adopting the proposals put forward by these commenters. 
    The language contained in paragraph (d) regarding upward sustained 
    movements reflects the legislative intent expressed in the SAA, which 
    specifically discusses the granting of an adjustment period following 
    ``a sustained increase in the value of a foreign currency relative to 
    the U.S. dollar.'' SAA at 842. Moreover, we do not believe that the 
    statute provides any authority for the Department to deny an adjustment 
    period when a sustained increase in the value of a foreign currency 
    relative to the U.S. dollar has occurred, even in the event that an 
    exporter is lowering U.S. prices.
        Another commenter pointed out that paragraph (d) would provide an 
    adjustment period for sustained movements in exchange rates only in 
    investigations, and not in reviews. This commenter questioned whether 
    such a limitation was consistent with the AD Agreement. In the 
    Department's view, paragraph (d) is consistent with the AD Agreement, 
    because Article 2.4.1 specifies that the 60-day period for adjusting 
    prices applies ``in an investigation.''
        Finally, one commenter urged the Department to use the exchange 
    rate in effect on the date that the price and quantity terms of a sale 
    are first established, rather than under the methodology used to 
    identify the date of sale for other purposes. We have not adopted this 
    suggestion because section 773A(a) of the Act directs the Department to 
    use the exchange rate in effect on the ``date of sale of the subject 
    merchandise.'' We have clarified how we will identify the date of sale 
    in section 351.401(i) of these regulations. The Department cannot 
    establish a different date of sale for currency conversion purposes 
    from that which is used for all other purposes. This issue is discussed 
    further with respect to that provision, above.
    
    Other Comments
    
        In addition to the comments discussed above, the Department also 
    received several comments that did not relate to a particular provision 
    in the AD Proposed Regulations. A common theme of these comments, 
    however, was the extent to which the Department should rely on data as 
    recorded in a firm's books and records.
        One commenter criticized the Department's practice of requiring 
    that respondents submit data in the specific format established by the 
    Department. According to the commenter, this requirement was 
    unnecessary, it rendered the cost of complying with Department 
    information requests excessively high, and, when combined with the 
    Department's tight deadlines, it made the entire process extremely 
    onerous for a firm attempting to comply with a request for data. 
    Another commenter, citing the increasing convergence of accounting 
    standards as companies compete with one another for capital on an 
    international level, proposed that the Department accept data responses 
    in a format that conforms to the generally accepted accounting 
    principles of the company's home country. Another commenter supported 
    these proposals.
        With respect to these comments, we first must note that in 
    enforcing the AD law, the Department must balance two different 
    objectives. On the one hand, the Department has a responsibility to 
    identify and measure dumping accurately and in accordance with the 
    standards set forth in the AD law. In some instances, this may mean 
    that the Department must seek information of a type that is not readily 
    retrievable from a company's accounting or financial records or that is 
    in a format different from the format in which a company maintains its 
    records. On the other hand, the Department is cognizant of the need to 
    avoid imposing, in the words of section 782(c) of the Act, ``an 
    unreasonable burden'' on respondents.
        In implementing the URAA, we have reviewed our practices and 
    regulations in light of the two objectives described above. As a 
    result, we have taken several steps that we believe will make the AD 
    process less onerous for parties, but that, at the same time, preserve 
    the Department's ability to apply the standards of the AD law. For 
    example, the Department has revised its standard AD questionnaire to 
    clarify that the Department will be flexible in accepting responses 
    that reflect different accounting standards and systems. In addition, 
    as discussed above, in the final regulations relating to allocations, 
    date of sale, and CEP profit, we also have taken steps to accommodate 
    different accounting standards and systems. In our view, in addition to 
    making the AD process less onerous for parties, these changes will make 
    the Department's verifications more efficient and effective, thereby 
    enhancing the Department's ability to enforce the AD law.
        On a somewhat related topic, one commenter stated that the 
    regulations should address the matter of ``model-matching'' 
    methodology.3 According to
    
    [[Page 27378]]
    
    the commenter, the Department currently instructs respondents as to the 
    relative importance of physical characteristics of the subject 
    merchandise and the foreign like product, rather than permitting 
    respondents to make that determination, as under traditional practice. 
    The commenter also alleged that there were two principal problems with 
    the Department's current approach: (1) the Department's manner of 
    identifying product characteristics, and the relative importance 
    assigned to those characteristics, bears no necessary relation to the 
    product coding system used by a respondent for commercial purposes; and 
    (2) the use of the product coding system formulated by the Department 
    in individual cases often results in inappropriate comparisons. 
    Therefore, the commenter argued, the Department should make clear in 
    the preamble to its regulations that the Department generally will use 
    a respondent's existing product coding system as the starting point for 
    identifying identical and similar merchandise. The Department then can 
    make modifications and additions to those codes to the extent necessary 
    to reflect desired model-match criteria.
    ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
    
        \3\ ``Model-matching'' is a shorthand expression for the process 
    the Department uses to identify identical or similar home market or 
    third-country merchandise. In order to identify and measure dumping, 
    the Department must compare a U.S. sale of a particular type or 
    model of merchandise to a home market or third-country sale of 
    identical or similar merchandise. Typically, in an AD proceeding, 
    the Department will develop ``model-matching'' criteria for 
    identifying identical or similar merchandise in that particular 
    case.
    ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
    
        We have not adopted the suggestion. Under section 771(16) of the 
    Act, the starting point for model-matching is always the physical 
    characteristics of the product. Based on our experience, a company's 
    internal product coding system often does not provide sufficient 
    information to allow the Department to match products in accordance 
    with their physical characteristics. Therefore, we do not believe that 
    it would be appropriate to establish what, in effect, would be a 
    rebuttable presumption that a company's internal product coding system 
    should be used for purposes of model-matching.
        On the other hand, however, we do not intend to suggest that a 
    company's product coding system is irrelevant to the model-matching 
    exercise. We agree that the model-matching methodology used by the 
    Department in a particular case should reflect the most significant 
    physical characteristics of a product. We also agree that it often is 
    the case that a company's product coding system is informative, if not 
    dispositive, as to what those characteristics are. For example, the 
    fact that the product coding systems of every respondent involved in an 
    AD proceeding capture a particular physical characteristic usually is a 
    good indication that the characteristic is significant. Therefore, the 
    Department will continue to consider producer coding systems in 
    developing model-match methodologies in particular cases, and will use 
    these codes where such use is consistent with the standards set forth 
    in section 771(16).
    
    Subpart G--Effective Dates
    
        Subpart G consists of a single Sec. 351.701 which (1) establishes 
    the dates on which the new regulations contained in Part 351 will 
    become effective, and (2) explains the extent to which the Department's 
    prior regulations will govern segments of proceedings to which the new 
    regulations do not apply. Section 351.701 also explains the limited 
    role of these new regulations in proceedings to which they do not 
    apply.
        The new regulations will apply to all investigations and other 
    segments of proceedings (such as scope requests), other than 
    administrative reviews, initiated on the basis of petitions filed or 
    requests made more than thirty days after the date on which the new 
    regulations are published. The new regulations also will apply to all 
    investigations or other segments of proceedings that the Department 
    self-initiates more than thirty days after the date on which the new 
    regulations are published. In addition, the new regulations will apply 
    to all administrative reviews initiated on the basis of requests filed 
    in the month following the month in which the date 30 days after 
    publication of this notice falls. The slight difference in effective 
    date for administrative reviews is to avoid confusion over whether the 
    new regulations apply to administrative reviews requested by different 
    parties on different days during the month in which the new regulations 
    become effective for investigations and other segments of proceedings 
    (in other words, during the month that includes the day thirty days 
    after the date on which these regulations are published).
        Investigations, reviews, and other segments of proceedings to which 
    these regulations do not apply will continue to be governed by the old 
    regulations, except to the extent that those regulations were 
    invalidated by the URAA or were replaced by the interim final 
    regulations published on May 11, 1995 (60 FR 25130 (1995)).
        For segments of proceedings to which these regulations do not 
    apply, but which are subject to the Act as amended by the URAA because 
    they were initiated on the basis of petitions filed or requests made 
    after January 1, 1995 (the effective date of the URAA), the new 
    regulations will serve as a restatement of the Department's 
    interpretation of the amended Act. In other words, the new regulations 
    describe the administrative practice that the Department will follow, 
    unless there is a reason consistent with the amended Act to depart from 
    that practice. The AD Proposed Regulations no longer will serve that 
    purpose.
    
    Annexes to Part 351
    
        We have revised Annexes I through V to reflect changes made in 
    these final regulations, as well as to correct typographical errors 
    identified in the annexes attached to the AD Proposed Regulations. In 
    addition, we have revised the charts to include certain deadlines that 
    were not included in the AD Proposed Regulations.
        One commenter suggested that the Department should refrain from 
    adopting the ``inflexible deadlines'' outlined in the annexes, and 
    instead should adapt the timetable to the complexity of each 
    investigation or review. With respect to this suggestion, we must 
    emphasize that the tables and charts contained in Annexes I through VII 
    are intended to serve only as a guide to potential petitioners and 
    respondents, as well as other persons potentially interested or 
    involved in an AD/CVD proceeding. The tables themselves are not 
    ``rules,'' and they do not represent the timetables that the Department 
    will follow in all proceedings. In fact, they may not represent the 
    timetables that the Department will follow in a majority of 
    proceedings. The tables and charts simply cross-reference relevant 
    provisions of the regulations so that parties and other persons will be 
    aware of when such things as extensions or postponements might occur. 
    As stated previously, under Sec. 351.302(b), the Secretary may, for 
    good cause, extend any time limit established by Part 351 unless such 
    an extension is expressly precluded by statute.
    
    Classification
    
    E.O. 12866
    
        This final rule has been determined to be significant under E.O. 
    12866.
    
    Regulatory Flexibility Act
    
        The Assistant General Counsel for Legislation and Regulation of the 
    Department of Commerce certified to the Chief Counsel for Advocacy of 
    the Small Business Administration that this final rule will not have a 
    significant economic impact on a substantial number of small entities. 
    The Department does not believe that there will be any substantive 
    effect on the outcome of AD and CVD proceedings as a result of the 
    streamlining and
    
    [[Page 27379]]
    
    simplification of their administration. With respect to the substantive 
    amendments implementing the Uruguay Round Agreements Act, the 
    Department believes that these regulations benefit both petitioners and 
    respondents without favoring either, and, therefore, would not have a 
    significant economic effects. As such, a regulatory flexibility 
    analysis was not prepared.
    
    Paperwork Reduction Act
    
        Notwithstanding any other provision of law, no person is required 
    to respond to nor shall a person be subject to a penalty for failure to 
    comply with a collection of information subject to the requirements of 
    the Paperwork Reduction Act unless that collection of information 
    displays a currently valid OMB Control Number. This final rule does not 
    contain any new reporting or recording requirements subject to the 
    Paperwork Reduction Act. The collections of information contained in 
    this rule are currently approved by the Office of Management and Budget 
    under OMB Control Numbers 0625-0105, 0625-0148, and 0625-0200. The 
    public reporting burdens for these collections of information are 
    estimated to average 40 hours for the AD and CVD petition requirements, 
    and 15 hours for the initiation of downstream product monitoring. These 
    estimates include the time for reviewing instructions, searching 
    existing data sources, gathering and maintaining the data needed, and 
    completing and reviewing the collections of information. Send comments 
    regarding these burden estimates or any other aspect of these 
    collections of information, including suggestions for reducing the 
    burden, to OMB Desk Officer, New Executive Office Building, Washington, 
    D.C. 20503.
    
    E.O. 12612
    
        This final rule does not contain federalism implications warranting 
    the preparation of a Federalism Assessment.
    
    List of Subjects
    
    19 CFR Part 351
    
        Administrative practice and procedure, Antidumping, Business and 
    industry, Cheese, Confidential business information, Countervailing 
    duties, Investigations, Reporting and recordkeeping requirements.
    
    19 CFR Part 353
    
        Administrative practice and procedure, Antidumping, Business and 
    industry, Confidential business information, Investigations, Reporting 
    and recordkeeping requirements.
    
    19 CFR Part 355
    
        Administrative practice and procedure, Business and industry, 
    Cheese, Confidential business information, Countervailing duties, 
    Freedom of Information, Investigations, Reporting and recordkeeping 
    requirements.
    
        Dated: May 2, 1997.
    Robert S. LaRussa,
    Acting Assistant Secretary for Import Administration.
    
        For the reasons stated, 19 CFR chapter III is amended as follows:
    
    Parts 353 and 355 [Removed]
    
        1. Parts 353 and 355 are removed.
        2. A new Part 351 is added to read as follows:
    
    PART 351--ANTIDUMPING AND COUNTERVAILING DUTIES
    
    Subpart A--Scope and Definitions
    
    Sec.
    351.101  Scope.
    351.102  Definitions.
    351.103  Central Records Unit.
    351.104  Record of proceedings.
    351.105  Public, business proprietary, privileged, and classified 
    information.
    351.106  De minimis net countervailable subsidies and weighted-
    average dumping margins disregarded.
    351.107  Deposit rates for nonproducing exporters; rates in 
    antidumping proceedings involving a nonmarket economy country.
    
    Subpart B--Antidumping and Countervailing Duty Procedures 351.201 Self-
    initiation.
    
    351.202  Petition requirements.
    351.203  Determination of sufficiency of petition.
    351.204  Transactions and persons examined; voluntary respondents; 
    exclusions.
    351.205  Preliminary determination.
    351.206  Critical circumstances.
    351.207  Termination of investigation.
    351.208  Suspension of investigation.
    351.209  Violation of suspension agreement.
    351.210  Final determination.
    351.211  Antidumping order and countervailing duty order.
    351.212  Assessment of antidumping and countervailing duties; 
    provisional measures deposit cap; interest on certain overpayments 
    and underpayments
    351.213  Administrative review of orders and suspension agreements 
    under section 751(a)(1) of the Act.
    351.214  New shipper reviews under section 751(a)(2)(B) of the Act.
    351.215  Expedited antidumping review and security in lieu of 
    estimated duty under section 736(c) of the Act.
    351.216  Changed circumstances review under section 751(b) of the 
    Act.
    351.217  Reviews to implement results of subsidies enforcement 
    proceeding under section 751(g) of the Act.
    351.218  Sunset reviews under section 751(c) of the Act.
    351.219  Reviews of countervailing duty orders in connection with an 
    investigation under section 753 of the Act.
    351.220  Countervailing duty review at the direction of the 
    President under section 762 of the Act.
    351.221  Review procedures.
    351.222  Revocation of orders; termination of suspended 
    investigations.
    351.223  Procedures for initiation of downstream product monitoring.
    351.224  Disclosure of calculations and procedures for the 
    correction of ministerial errors.
    351.225  Scope rulings.
    
    Subpart C--Information and Argument
    
    351.301  Time limits for submission of factual information.
    351.302  Extension of time limits; return of untimely filed or 
    unsolicited material.
    351.303  Filing, format, translation, service, and certification of 
    documents.
    351.304  Establishing business proprietary treatment of information 
    [Reserved].
    351.305  Access to business proprietary information [Reserved].
    351.306  Use of business proprietary information [Reserved].
    351.307  Verification of information.
    351.308  Determinations on the basis of the facts available.
    351.309  Written argument.
    351.310  Hearings.
    351.311  Countervailable subsidy practice discovered during 
    investigation or review.
    351.312  Industrial users and consumer organizations.
    Subpart D--Calculation of Export Price, Constructed Export Price, Fair 
    Value, and Normal Value
    351.401  In general.
    351.402  Calculation of export price and constructed export price; 
    reimbursement of antidumping and countervailing duties.
    351.403  Sales used in calculating normal value; transactions 
    between affiliated parties.
    351.404  Selection of the market to be used as the basis for normal 
    value.
    351.405  Calculation of normal value based on constructed value.
    351.406  Calculation of normal value if sales are made at less than 
    the cost of production.
    351.407  Calculation of constructed value and cost of production.
    351.408  Calculation of normal value of merchandise from nonmarket 
    economy countries.
    351.409  Differences in quantities.
    351.410  Differences in circumstances of sale.
    351.411  Differences in physical characteristics.
    351.412  Levels of trade; adjustment for difference in level of 
    trade; constructed export price offset.
    351.413  Disregarding insignificant adjustments.
    
    [[Page 27380]]
    
    351.414  Comparison of normal value with export price (constructed 
    export price).
    351.415  Conversion of currency.
    
    Subpart E--[Reserved]
    
    Subpart F--Subsidy Determinations Regarding Cheese Subject to an In-
    Quota Rate of Duty
    351.601  Annual list and quarterly update of subsidies.
    351.602  Determination upon request.
    351.603  Complaint of price-undercutting by subsidized imports.
    351.604  Access to information.
    
    Subpart G--Applicability Dates
    
    351.701  Applicability dates.
    Annex I--Deadlines for Parties in Countervailing Investigations
    Annex II--Deadlines for Parties in Countervailing Administrative 
    Reviews
    Annex III--Deadlines for Parties in Antidumping Investigations
    Annex IV--Deadlines for Parties in Antidumping Administrative 
    Reviews
    Annex V--Comparison of Prior and New Regulations
    Annex VI--Countervailing Investigations Timeline
    Annex VII--Antidumping Investigations Timeline
    
        Authority: 5 U.S.C. 301; 19 U.S.C. 1202 note; 19 U.S.C. 1303 
    note; 19 U.S.C. 1671 et seq.; and 19 U.S.C. 3538.
    
    PART 351--ANTIDUMPING AND COUNTERVAILING DUTIES
    
    Subpart A--Scope and Definitions
    
    
    Sec. 351.101  Scope.
    
        (a) In general. This part contains procedures and rules applicable 
    to antidumping and countervailing duty proceedings under title VII of 
    the Act (19 U.S.C. 1671 et seq.), and also determinations regarding 
    cheese subject to an in-quota rate of duty under section 702 of the 
    Trade Agreements Act of 1979 (19 U.S.C. 1202 note). This part reflects 
    statutory amendments made by titles I, II, and IV of the Uruguay Round 
    Agreements Act, Pub. L. 103-465, which, in turn, implement into United 
    States law the provisions of the following agreements annexed to the 
    Agreement Establishing the World Trade Organization: Agreement on 
    Implementation of Article VI of the General Agreement on Tariffs and 
    Trade 1994; Agreement on Subsidies and Countervailing Measures; and 
    Agreement on Agriculture.
        (b) Countervailing duty investigations involving imports not 
    entitled to a material injury determination. Under section 701(c) of 
    the Act, certain provisions of the Act do not apply to countervailing 
    duty proceedings involving imports from a country that is not a 
    Subsidies Agreement country and is not entitled to a material injury 
    determination by the Commission. Accordingly, certain provisions of 
    this part referring to the Commission may not apply to such 
    proceedings.
        (c) Application to governmental importations. To the extent 
    authorized by section 771(20) of the Act, merchandise imported by, or 
    for the use of, a department or agency of the United States Government 
    is subject to the imposition of countervailing duties or antidumping 
    duties under this part.
    
    
    Sec. 351.102  Definitions.
    
        (a) Introduction. The Act contains many technical terms applicable 
    to antidumping and countervailing duty proceedings. In the case of 
    terms that are not defined in this section or other sections of this 
    part, readers should refer to the relevant provisions of the Act. This 
    section:
        (1) Defines terms that appear in the Act but are not defined in the 
    Act;
        (2) Defines terms that appear in this Part but do not appear in the 
    Act; and
        (3) Elaborates on the meaning of certain terms that are defined in 
    the Act.
        (b) Definitions.
        Act. ``Act'' means the Tariff Act of 1930, as amended.
        Administrative review. ``Administrative review'' means a review 
    under section 751(a)(1) of the Act.
        Affiliated persons; affiliated parties. ``Affiliated persons'' and 
    ``affiliated parties'' have the same meaning as in section 771(33) of 
    the Act. In determining whether control over another person exists, 
    within the meaning of section 771(33) of the Act, the Secretary will 
    consider the following factors, among others: corporate or family 
    groupings; franchise or joint venture agreements; debt financing; and 
    close supplier relationships. The Secretary will not find that control 
    exists on the basis of these factors unless the relationship has the 
    potential to impact decisions concerning the production, pricing, or 
    cost of the subject merchandise or foreign like product. The Secretary 
    will consider the temporal aspect of a relationship in determining 
    whether control exists; normally, temporary circumstances will not 
    suffice as evidence of control.
        Aggregate basis. ``Aggregate basis'' means the calculation of a 
    country-wide subsidy rate based principally on information provided by 
    the foreign government.
        Anniversary month. ``Anniversary month'' means the calendar month 
    in which the anniversary of the date of publication of an order or 
    suspension of investigation occurs.
        APO. ``APO'' means an administrative protective order described in 
    section 777(c)(1) of the Act.
        Applicant. ``Applicant'' means a representative of an interested 
    party that has applied for access to business proprietary information 
    under an administrative protective order.
        Article 4/Article 7 Review. ``Article 4/Article 7 review'' means a 
    review under section 751(g)(2) of the Act.
        Article 8 violation review. ``Article 8 violation review'' means a 
    review under section 751(g)(1) of the Act.
        Authorized applicant. ``Authorized applicant'' means an applicant 
    that the Secretary has authorized to receive business proprietary 
    information under an APO under section 777(c)(1) of the Act.
        Changed circumstances review. ``Changed circumstances review'' 
    means a review under section 751(b) of the Act.
        Customs Service. ``Customs Service'' means the United States 
    Customs Service of the United States Department of the Treasury.
        Department. ``Department'' means the United States Department of 
    Commerce.
        Domestic interested party. ``Domestic interested party'' means an 
    interested party described in subparagraph (C), (D), (E), (F), or (G) 
    of section 771(9) of the Act.
        Expedited antidumping review. ``Expedited antidumping review'' 
    means a review under section 736(c) of the Act.
        Factual information. ``Factual information'' means:
        (1) Initial and supplemental questionnaire responses;
        (2) Data or statements of fact in support of allegations;
        (3) Other data or statements of facts; and
        (4) Documentary evidence.
        Fair value. ``Fair value'' is a term used during an antidumping 
    investigation, and is an estimate of normal value.
        Importer. ``Importer'' means the person by whom, or for whose 
    account, subject merchandise is imported.
        Investigation. Under the Act and this Part, there is a distinction 
    between an antidumping or countervailing duty investigation and a 
    proceeding. An ``investigation'' is that segment of a proceeding that 
    begins on the date of publication of notice of initiation of 
    investigation and ends on the date of publication of the earliest of:
        (1) Notice of termination of investigation,
        (2) Notice of rescission of investigation,
        (3) Notice of a negative determination that has the effect of 
    terminating the proceeding, or
        (4) An order.
    
    [[Page 27381]]
    
        New shipper review. ``New shipper review'' means a review under 
    section 751(a)(2) of the Act.
        Order. An ``order'' is an order issued by the Secretary under 
    section 303, section 706, or section 736 of the Act or a finding under 
    the Antidumping Act, 1921.
        Ordinary course of trade. ``Ordinary course of trade'' has the same 
    meaning as in section 771(15) of the Act. The Secretary may consider 
    sales or transactions to be outside the ordinary course of trade if the 
    Secretary determines, based on an evaluation of all of the 
    circumstances particular to the sales in question, that such sales or 
    transactions have characteristics that are extraordinary for the market 
    in question. Examples of sales that the Secretary might consider as 
    being outside the ordinary course of trade are sales or transactions 
    involving off-quality merchandise or merchandise produced according to 
    unusual product specifications, merchandise sold at aberrational prices 
    or with abnormally high profits, merchandise sold pursuant to unusual 
    terms of sale, or merchandise sold to an affiliated party at a non-
    arm's length price.
        Party to the proceeding. ``Party to the proceeding'' means any 
    interested party that actively participates, through written 
    submissions of factual information or written argument, in a segment of 
    a proceeding. Participation in a prior segment of a proceeding will not 
    confer on any interested party ``party to the proceeding'' status in a 
    subsequent segment.
        Person. ``Person'' includes any interested party as well as any 
    other individual, enterprise, or entity, as appropriate.
        Price adjustment. ``Price adjustment'' means any change in the 
    price charged for subject merchandise or the foreign like product, such 
    as discounts, rebates and post-sale price adjustments, that are 
    reflected in the purchaser's net outlay.
        Proceeding. A ``proceeding'' begins on the date of the filing of a 
    petition under section 702(b) or section 732(b) of the Act or the 
    publication of a notice of initiation in a self-initiated investigation 
    under section 702(a) or section 732(a) of the Act, and ends on the date 
    of publication of the earliest notice of:
        (1) Dismissal of petition,
        (2) Rescission of initiation,
        (3) Termination of investigation,
        (4) A negative determination that has the effect of terminating the 
    proceeding,
        (5) Revocation of an order, or
        (6) Termination of a suspended investigation.
        Rates. ``Rates'' means the individual weighted-average dumping 
    margins, the individual countervailable subsidy rates, the country-wide 
    subsidy rate, or the all-others rate, as applicable.
        Respondent interested party. ``Respondent interested party'' means 
    an interested party described in subparagraph (A) or (B) of section 
    771(9) of the Act.
        Sale. A ``sale'' includes a contract to sell and a lease that is 
    equivalent to a sale.
        Secretary. ``Secretary'' means the Secretary of Commerce or a 
    designee. The Secretary has delegated to the Assistant Secretary for 
    Import Administration the authority to make determinations under title 
    VII of the Act and this Part.
        Section 753 review. ``Section 753 review'' means a review under 
    section 753 of the Act.
        Section 762 review. ``Section 762 review'' means a review under 
    section 762 of the Act.
        Segment of proceeding.
        (1) In general. An antidumping or countervailing duty proceeding 
    consists of one or more segments. ``Segment of a proceeding'' or 
    ``segment of the proceeding'' refers to a portion of the proceeding 
    that is reviewable under section 516A of the Act.
        (2) Examples. An antidumping or countervailing duty investigation 
    or a review of an order or suspended investigation, or a scope inquiry 
    under Sec. 351.225, each would constitute a segment of a proceeding.
        Sunset review. ``Sunset review'' means a review under section 
    751(c) of the Act.
        Suspension of liquidation. ``Suspension of liquidation'' refers to 
    a suspension of liquidation ordered by the Secretary under the 
    authority of title VII of the Act, the provisions of this Part, or 
    section 516a(g)(5)(C) of the Act, or by a court of the United States in 
    a lawsuit involving action taken, or not taken, by the Secretary under 
    title VII of the Act or the provisions of this Part.
        Third country. For purposes of subpart D, ``third country'' means a 
    country other than the exporting country and the United States. Under 
    section 773(a) of the Act and subpart D, in certain circumstances the 
    Secretary may determine normal value on the basis of sales to a third 
    country.
        URAA. ``URAA'' means the Uruguay Round Agreements Act.
    
    
    Sec. 351.103  Central Records Unit.
    
        (a) In general. Import Administration's Central Records Unit is 
    located at Room B-099, U.S. Department of Commerce, Pennsylvania Avenue 
    and 14th Street, NW., Washington, D.C. 20230. The office hours of the 
    Central Records Unit are between 8:30 A.M. and 5:00 P.M. on business 
    days. Among other things, the Central Records Unit is responsible for 
    maintaining an official and public record for each antidumping and 
    countervailing duty proceeding (see Sec. 351.104), the Subsidies 
    Library (see section 775(2) and section 777(a)(1) of the Act), and the 
    service list for each proceeding (see paragraph (c) of this section).
        (b) Filing of documents with the Department. While persons are free 
    to provide Department officials with courtesy copies of documents, no 
    document will be considered as having been received by the Secretary 
    unless it is submitted to the Central Records Unit and is stamped by 
    the Central Records Unit with the date and time of receipt.
        (c) Service list. The Central Records Unit will maintain and make 
    available a service list for each segment of a proceeding. Each 
    interested party that asks to be included on the service list for a 
    segment of a proceeding must designate a person to receive service of 
    documents filed in that segment. The service list for an application 
    for a scope ruling is described in Sec. 351.225(n).
    
    
    Sec. 351.104  Record of proceedings.
    
        (a) Official record. (1) In general. The Secretary will maintain in 
    the Central Records Unit an official record of each antidumping and 
    countervailing duty proceeding. The Secretary will include in the 
    official record all factual information, written argument, or other 
    material developed by, presented to, or obtained by the Secretary 
    during the course of a proceeding that pertains to the proceeding. The 
    official record will include government memoranda pertaining to the 
    proceeding, memoranda of ex parte meetings, determinations, notices 
    published in the Federal Register, and transcripts of hearings. The 
    official record will contain material that is public, business 
    proprietary, privileged, and classified. For purposes of section 
    516A(b)(2) of the Act, the record is the official record of each 
    segment of the proceeding.
        (2) Material returned. (i) The Secretary, in making any 
    determination under this part, will not use factual information, 
    written argument, or other material that the Secretary returns to the 
    submitter.
        (ii) The official record will include a copy of a returned 
    document, solely for purposes of establishing and documenting the basis 
    for returning the document to the submitter, if the document was 
    returned because:
        (A) The document, although otherwise timely, contains untimely
    
    [[Page 27382]]
    
    filed new factual information (see Sec. 351.301(b));
        (B) The submitter made a nonconforming request for business 
    proprietary treatment of factual information (see Sec. 351.304);
        (C) The Secretary denied a request for business proprietary 
    treatment of factual information (see Sec. 351.304);
        (D) The submitter is unwilling to permit the disclosure of business 
    proprietary information under APO (see Sec. 351.304).
        (iii) In no case will the official record include any document that 
    the Secretary returns to the submitter as untimely filed, or any 
    unsolicited questionnaire response unless the response is a voluntary 
    response accepted under Sec. 351.204(d) (see Sec. 351.302(d)).
        (b) Public record. The Secretary will maintain in the Central 
    Records Unit a public record of each proceeding. The record will 
    consist of all material contained in the official record (see paragraph 
    (a) of this section) that the Secretary decides is public information 
    under Sec. 351.105(b), government memoranda or portions of memoranda 
    that the Secretary decides may be disclosed to the general public, and 
    public versions of all determinations, notices, and transcripts. The 
    public record will be available to the public for inspection and 
    copying in the Central Records Unit (see Sec. 351.103). The Secretary 
    will charge an appropriate fee for providing copies of documents.
        (c) Protection of records. Unless ordered by the Secretary or 
    required by law, no record or portion of a record will be removed from 
    the Department.
    
    
    Sec. 351.105  Public, business proprietary, privileged, and classified 
    information.
    
        (a) Introduction. There are four categories of information in an 
    antidumping or countervailing duty proceeding: public, business 
    proprietary, privileged, and classified. In general, public information 
    is information that may be made available to the public, whereas 
    business proprietary information may be disclosed (if at all) only to 
    authorized applicants under an APO. Privileged and classified 
    information may not be disclosed at all, even under an APO. This 
    section describes the four categories of information.
        (b) Public information. The Secretary normally will consider the 
    following to be public information:
        (1) Factual information of a type that has been published or 
    otherwise made available to the public by the person submitting it;
        (2) Factual information that is not designated as business 
    proprietary by the person submitting it;
        (3) Factual information that, although designated as business 
    proprietary by the person submitting it, is in a form that cannot be 
    associated with or otherwise used to identify activities of a 
    particular person or that the Secretary determines is not properly 
    designated as business proprietary;
        (4) Publicly available laws, regulations, decrees, orders, and 
    other official documents of a country, including English translations; 
    and
        (5) Written argument relating to the proceeding that is not 
    designated as business proprietary.
        (c) Business proprietary information. The Secretary normally will 
    consider the following factual information to be business proprietary 
    information, if so designated by the submitter:
        (1) Business or trade secrets concerning the nature of a product or 
    production process;
        (2) Production costs (but not the identity of the production 
    components unless a particular component is a trade secret);
        (3) Distribution costs (but not channels of distribution);
        (4) Terms of sale (but not terms of sale offered to the public);
        (5) Prices of individual sales, likely sales, or other offers (but 
    not components of prices, such as transportation, if based on published 
    schedules, dates of sale, product descriptions (other than business or 
    trade secrets described in paragraph (c)(1) of this section), or order 
    numbers);
        (6) Names of particular customers, distributors, or suppliers (but 
    not destination of sale or designation of type of customer, 
    distributor, or supplier, unless the destination or designation would 
    reveal the name);
        (7) In an antidumping proceeding, the exact amount of the dumping 
    margin on individual sales;
        (8) In a countervailing duty proceeding, the exact amount of the 
    benefit applied for or received by a person from each of the programs 
    under investigation or review (but not descriptions of the operations 
    of the programs, or the amount if included in official public 
    statements or documents or publications, or the ad valorem 
    countervailable subsidy rate calculated for each person under a 
    program);
        (9) The names of particular persons from whom business proprietary 
    information was obtained;
        (10) The position of a domestic producer or workers regarding a 
    petition; and
        (11) Any other specific business information the release of which 
    to the public would cause substantial harm to the competitive position 
    of the submitter.
        (d) Privileged information. The Secretary will consider information 
    privileged if, based on principles of law concerning privileged 
    information, the Secretary decides that the information should not be 
    released to the public or to parties to the proceeding. Privileged 
    information is exempt from disclosure to the public or to 
    representatives of interested parties.
        (e) Classified information. Classified information is information 
    that is classified under Executive Order No. 12356 of April 2, 1982 (47 
    FR 14874 and 15557, 3 CFR 1982 Comp. p. 166) or successor executive 
    order, if applicable. Classified information is exempt from disclosure 
    to the public or to representatives of interested parties.
    
    
    Sec. 351.106  De minimis net countervailable subsidies and weighted-
    average dumping margins disregarded.
    
        (a) Introduction. Prior to the enactment of the URAA, the 
    Department had a well-established and judicially sanctioned practice of 
    disregarding net countervailable subsidies or weighted-average dumping 
    margins that were de minimis. The URAA codified in the Act the 
    particular de minimis standards to be used in antidumping and 
    countervailing duty investigations. This section discussed the 
    application of the de minimis standards in antidumping or 
    countervailing duty proceedings.
        (b) Investigations. (1) In general. In making a preliminary or 
    final antidumping or countervailing duty determination in an 
    investigation (see sections 703(b), 733(b), 705(a), and 735(a) of the 
    Act), the Secretary will apply the de minimis standard set forth in 
    section 703(b)(4) or section 733(b)(3) of the Act (whichever is 
    applicable).
        (2) Transition rule. (i) If:
        (A) the Secretary resumes an investigation that has been suspended 
    (see section 704(i)(1)(B) or section 734(i)(1)(B) of the Act); and
        (B) the investigation was initiated before January 1, 1995, then
        (ii) The Secretary will apply the de minimis standard in effect at 
    the time that the investigation was initiated.
        (c) Reviews and other determinations. (1) In general. In making any 
    determination other than a preliminary or final antidumping or 
    countervailing duty determination in an investigation (see paragraph 
    (b) of this section), the Secretary will treat as de minimis any 
    weighted-average dumping margin or countervailable subsidy rate that is 
    less
    
    [[Page 27383]]
    
    than 0.5 percent ad valorem, or the equivalent specific rate.
        (2) Assessment of antidumping duties. The Secretary will instruct 
    the Customs Service to liquidate without regard to antidumping duties 
    all entries of subject merchandise during the relevant period of review 
    made by any person for which the Secretary calculates an assessment 
    rate under Sec. 351.212(b)(1) that is less than 0.5 percent ad valorem, 
    or the equivalent specific rate.
    
    
    Sec. 351.107  Cash deposit rates for nonproducing exporters; rates in 
    antidumping proceedings involving a nonmarket economy country.
    
        (a) Introduction. This section deals with the establishment of cash 
    deposit rates in situations where the exporter is not the producer of 
    subject merchandise, the selection of the appropriate cash deposit rate 
    in situations where entry documents do not indicate the producer of 
    subject merchandise, and the calculation of dumping margins in 
    antidumping proceedings involving imports from a nonmarket economy 
    country.
        (b) Cash deposit rates for nonproducing exporters. (1) Use of 
    combination rates. (i) In general. In the case of subject merchandise 
    that is exported to the United States by a company that is not the 
    producer of the merchandise, the Secretary may establish a 
    ``combination'' cash deposit rate for each combination of the exporter 
    and its supplying producer(s).
        (ii) Example. A nonproducing exporter (Exporter A) exports to the 
    United States subject merchandise produced by Producers X, Y, and Z. In 
    such a situation, the Secretary may establish cash deposit rates for 
    Exporter A/Producer X, Exporter A/Producer Y, and Exporter A/Producer 
    Z.
        (2) New supplier. In the case of subject merchandise that is 
    exported to the United States by a company that is not the producer of 
    the merchandise, if the Secretary has not established previously a 
    combination cash deposit rate under paragraph (b)(1)(i) of this section 
    for the exporter and producer in question or a noncombination rate for 
    the exporter in question, the Secretary will apply the cash deposit 
    rate established for the producer. If the Secretary has not previously 
    established a cash deposit rate for the producer, the Secretary will 
    apply the ``all-others rate'' described in section 705(c)(5) or section 
    735(c)(5) of the Act, as the case may be.
        (c) Producer not identified. (1) In general. In situations where 
    entry documents do not identify the producer of subject merchandise, if 
    the Secretary has not established previously a noncombination rate for 
    the exporter, the Secretary may instruct the Customs Service to apply 
    as the cash deposit rate the higher of:
        (i) the highest of any combination cash deposit rate established 
    for the exporter under paragraph (b)(1)(i) of this section;
        (ii) the highest cash deposit rate established for any producer 
    other than a producer for which the Secretary established a combination 
    rate involving the exporter in question under paragraph (b)(1)(i) of 
    this section; or
        (iii) the ``all-others rate'' described in section 705(c)(5) or 
    section 735(c)(5) of the Act, as the case may be.
        (d) Rates in antidumping proceedings involving nonmarket economy 
    countries. In an antidumping proceeding involving imports from a 
    nonmarket economy country, ``rates'' may consist of a single dumping 
    margin applicable to all exporters and producers.
    
    Subpart B--Antidumping and Countervailing Duty Procedures
    
    
    Sec. 351.201  Self-initiation.
    
        (a) Introduction. Antidumping and countervailing duty 
    investigations may be initiated as the result of a petition filed by a 
    domestic interested party or at the Secretary's own initiative. This 
    section contains rules regarding the actions the Secretary will take 
    when the Secretary self-initiates an investigation.
        (b) In general. When the Secretary self-initiates an investigation 
    under section 702(a) or section 732(a) of the Act, the Secretary will 
    publish in the Federal Register notice of ``Initiation of Antidumping 
    (Countervailing Duty) Investigation.'' In addition, the Secretary will 
    notify the Commission at the time of initiation of the investigation, 
    and will make available to employees of the Commission directly 
    involved in the proceeding the information upon which the Secretary 
    based the initiation and which the Commission may consider relevant to 
    its injury determination.
        (c) Persistent dumping monitoring. To the extent practicable, the 
    Secretary will expedite any antidumping investigation initiated as the 
    result of a monitoring program established under section 732(a)(2) of 
    the Act.
    
    
    Sec. 351.202  Petition requirements.
    
        (a) Introduction. The Secretary normally initiates antidumping and 
    countervailing duty investigations based on petitions filed by a 
    domestic interested party. This section contains rules concerning the 
    contents of a petition, filing requirements, notification of foreign 
    governments, pre-initiation communications with the Secretary, and 
    assistance to small businesses in preparing petitions. Petitioners are 
    also advised to refer to the Commission's regulations concerning the 
    contents of petitions, currently 19 CFR 207.11.
        (b) Contents of petition. A petition requesting the imposition of 
    antidumping or countervailing duties must contain the following, to the 
    extent reasonably available to the petitioner:
        (1) The name, address, and telephone number of the petitioner and 
    any person the petitioner represents;
        (2) The identity of the industry on behalf of which the petitioner 
    is filing, including the names, addresses, and telephone numbers of all 
    other known persons in the industry;
        (3) Information relating to the degree of industry support for the 
    petition, including:
        (i) The total volume and value of U.S. production of the domestic 
    like product; and
        (ii) The volume and value of the domestic like product produced by 
    the petitioner and each domestic producer identified;
        (4) A statement indicating whether the petitioner has filed for 
    relief from imports of the subject merchandise under section 337 of the 
    Act (19 U.S.C. 1337, 1671a), sections 201 or 301 of the Trade Act of 
    1974 (19 U.S.C. 2251 or 2411), or section 232 of the Trade Expansion 
    Act of 1962 (19 U.S.C. 1862);
        (5) A detailed description of the subject merchandise that defines 
    the requested scope of the investigation, including the technical 
    characteristics and uses of the merchandise and its current U.S. tariff 
    classification number;
        (6) The name of the country in which the subject merchandise is 
    manufactured or produced and, if the merchandise is imported from a 
    country other than the country of manufacture or production, the name 
    of any intermediate country from which the merchandise is imported;
        (7) (i) In the case of an antidumping proceeding:
        (A) The names and addresses of each person the petitioner believes 
    sells the subject merchandise at less than fair value and the 
    proportion of total exports to the United States that each person 
    accounted for during the most recent 12-month period (if numerous, 
    provide information at least for persons that, based on publicly 
    available information, individually accounted for two percent or more 
    of the exports);
        (B) All factual information (particularly documentary evidence)
    
    [[Page 27384]]
    
    relevant to the calculation of the export price and the constructed 
    export price of the subject merchandise and the normal value of the 
    foreign like product (if unable to furnish information on foreign sales 
    or costs, provide information on production costs in the United States, 
    adjusted to reflect production costs in the country of production of 
    the subject merchandise);
        (C) If the merchandise is from a country that the Secretary has 
    found to be a nonmarket economy country, factual information relevant 
    to the calculation of normal value, using a method described in 
    Sec. 351.408; or
        (ii) In the case of a countervailing duty proceeding:
        (A) The names and addresses of each person the petitioner believes 
    benefits from a countervailable subsidy and exports the subject 
    merchandise to the United States and the proportion of total exports to 
    the United States that each person accounted for during the most recent 
    12-month period (if numerous, provide information at least for persons 
    that, based on publicly available information, individually accounted 
    for two percent or more of the exports);
        (B) The alleged countervailable subsidy and factual information 
    (particularly documentary evidence) relevant to the alleged 
    countervailable subsidy, including any law, regulation, or decree under 
    which it is provided, the manner in which it is paid, and the value of 
    the subsidy to exporters or producers of the subject merchandise;
        (C) If the petitioner alleges an upstream subsidy under section 
    771A of the Act, factual information regarding:
        (1) Countervailable subsidies, other than an export subsidy, that 
    an authority of the affected country provides to the upstream supplier;
        (2) The competitive benefit the countervailable subsidies bestow on 
    the subject merchandise; and
        (3) The significant effect the countervailable subsidies have on 
    the cost of producing the subject merchandise;
        (8) The volume and value of the subject merchandise imported during 
    the most recent two-year period and any other recent period that the 
    petitioner believes to be more representative or, if the subject 
    merchandise was not imported during the two-year period, information as 
    to the likelihood of its sale for importation;
        (9) The name, address, and telephone number of each person the 
    petitioner believes imports or, if there were no importations, is 
    likely to import the subject merchandise;
        (10) Factual information regarding material injury, threat of 
    material injury, or material retardation, and causation;
        (11) If the petitioner alleges ``critical circumstances'' under 
    section 703(e)(1) or section 733(e)(1) of the Act and Sec. 351.206, 
    factual information regarding:
        (i) Whether imports of the subject merchandise are likely to 
    undermine seriously the remedial effect of any order issued under 
    section 706(a) or section 736(a) of the Act;
        (ii) Massive imports of the subject merchandise in a relatively 
    short period; and
        (iii) (A) In an antidumping proceeding, either:
        (1) A history of dumping; or
        (2) The importer's knowledge that the exporter was selling the 
    subject merchandise at less than its fair value, and that there would 
    be material injury by reason of such sales; or
        (B) In a countervailing duty proceeding, whether the 
    countervailable subsidy is inconsistent with the Subsidies Agreement; 
    and
        (12) Any other factual information on which the petitioner relies.
        (c) Simultaneous filing and certification. The petitioner must file 
    a copy of the petition with the Commission and the Secretary on the 
    same day and so certify in submitting the petition to the Secretary. 
    Factual information in the petition must be certified, as provided in 
    Sec. 351.303(g). Other filing requirements are set forth in 
    Sec. 351.303.
        (d) Business proprietary status of information. The Secretary will 
    treat as business proprietary any factual information for which the 
    petitioner requests business proprietary treatment and which meets the 
    requirements of Sec. 351.304.
        (e) Amendment of petition. The Secretary may allow timely amendment 
    of the petition. The petitioner must file an amendment with the 
    Commission and the Secretary on the same day and so certify in 
    submitting the amendment to the Secretary. If the amendment consists of 
    new allegations, the timeliness of the new allegations will be governed 
    by Sec. 351.301.
        (f) Notification of representative of the exporting country. Upon 
    receipt of a petition, the Secretary will deliver a public version of 
    the petition (see Sec. 351.304(c)) to a representative in Washington, 
    DC, of the government of any exporting country named in the petition.
        (g) Petition based upon derogation of an international undertaking 
    on official export credits. In the case of a petition described in 
    section 702(b)(3) of the Act, the petitioner must file a copy of the 
    petition with the Secretary of the Treasury, as well as with the 
    Secretary and the Commission, and must so certify in submitting the 
    petition to the Secretary.
        (h) Assistance to small businesses; additional information. (1) The 
    Secretary will provide technical assistance to eligible small 
    businesses, as defined in section 339 of the Act, to enable them to 
    prepare and file petitions. The Secretary may deny assistance if the 
    Secretary concludes that the petition, if filed, could not satisfy the 
    requirements of section 702(c)(1)(A) or section 732(c)(1)(A) of the Act 
    (whichever is applicable) (see Sec. 351.203).
        (2) For additional information concerning petitions, contact the 
    Director for Policy and Analysis, Import Administration, International 
    Trade Administration, Room 3093, U.S. Department of Commerce, 
    Pennsylvania Avenue and 14th Street, NW, Washington, DC 20230; (202) 
    482-1768.
        (i) Pre-initiation communications. (1) In general. During the 
    period before the Secretary's decision whether to initiate an 
    investigation, the Secretary will not consider the filing of a notice 
    of appearance to constitute a communication for purposes of section 
    702(b)(4)(B) or section 732(b)(3)(B) of the Act.
        (2) Consultations with foreign governments in countervailing duty 
    proceedings. In a countervailing duty proceeding, the Secretary will 
    invite the government of any exporting country named in the petition 
    for consultations with respect to the petition. (The information 
    collection requirements in paragraph (a) of this section have been 
    approved by the Office of Management and Budget under control number 
    0625-0105.)
    
    
    Sec. 351.203  Determination of sufficiency of petition.
    
        (a) Introduction. When a petition is filed under Sec. 351.202, the 
    Secretary must determine that the petition satisfies the relevant 
    statutory requirements before initiating an antidumping or 
    countervailing duty investigation. This section sets forth rules 
    regarding a determination as to the sufficiency of a petition 
    (including the determination that a petition is supported by the 
    domestic industry), the deadline for making the determination, and the 
    actions to be taken once the Secretary has made the determination.
        (b) Determination of sufficiency. (1) In general. Normally, not 
    later than 20 days after a petition is filed, the Secretary, on the 
    basis of sources readily
    
    [[Page 27385]]
    
    available to the Secretary, will examine the accuracy and adequacy of 
    the evidence provided in the petition and determine whether to initiate 
    an investigation under section 702(c)(1)(A) or section 732(c)(1)(A) of 
    the Act (whichever is applicable).
        (2) Extension where polling required. If the Secretary is required 
    to poll or otherwise determine support for the petition under section 
    702(c)(4)(D) or section 732(c)(4)(D) of the Act, the Secretary may, in 
    exceptional circumstances, extend the 20-day period by the amount of 
    time necessary to collect and analyze the required information. In no 
    case will the period between the filing of a petition and the 
    determination whether to initiate an investigation exceed 40 days.
        (c) Notice of initiation and distribution of petition. (1) Notice 
    of initiation. If the initiation determination of the Secretary under 
    section 702(c)(1)(A) or section 732(c)(1)(A) of the Act is affirmative, 
    the Secretary will initiate an investigation and publish in the Federal 
    Register notice of ``Initiation of Antidumping (Countervailing Duty) 
    Investigation.'' The Secretary will notify the Commission at the time 
    of initiation of the investigation and will make available to employees 
    of the Commission directly involved in the proceeding the information 
    upon which the Secretary based the initiation and which the Commission 
    may consider relevant to its injury determinations.
        (2) Distribution of petition. As soon as practicable after 
    initiation of an investigation, the Secretary will provide a public 
    version of the petition to all known exporters (including producers who 
    sell for export to the United States) of the subject merchandise. If 
    the Secretary determines that there is a particularly large number of 
    exporters involved, instead of providing the public version to all 
    known exporters, the Secretary may provide the public version to a 
    trade association of the exporters or, alternatively, may consider the 
    requirement of the preceding sentence to have been satisfied by the 
    delivery of a public version of the petition to the government of the 
    exporting country under Sec. 351.202(f).
        (d) Insufficiency of petition. If an initiation determination of 
    the Secretary under section 702(c)(1)(A) or section 732(c)(1)(A) of the 
    Act is negative, the Secretary will dismiss the petition, terminate the 
    proceeding, notify the petitioner in writing of the reasons for the 
    determination, and publish in the Federal Register notice of 
    ``Dismissal of Antidumping (Countervailing Duty) Petition.''
        (e) Determination of industry support. In determining industry 
    support for a petition under section 702(c)(4) or section 732(c)(4) of 
    the Act, the following rules will apply:
        (1) Measuring production. The Secretary normally will measure 
    production over a twelve-month period specified by the Secretary, and 
    may measure production based on either value or volume. Where a party 
    to the proceeding establishes that production data for the relevant 
    period, as specified by the Secretary, is unavailable, production 
    levels may be established by reference to alternative data that the 
    Secretary determines to be indicative of production levels.
        (2) Positions treated as business proprietary information. Upon 
    request, the Secretary may treat the position of a domestic producer or 
    workers regarding the petition and any production information supplied 
    by the producer or workers as business proprietary information under 
    Sec. 351.105(c)(10).
        (3) Positions expressed by workers. The Secretary will consider the 
    positions of workers and management regarding the petition to be of 
    equal weight. The Secretary will assign a single weight to the 
    positions of both workers and management according to the production of 
    the domestic like product of the firm in which the workers and 
    management are employed. If the management of a firm expresses a 
    position in direct opposition to the position of the workers in that 
    firm, the Secretary will treat the production of that firm as 
    representing neither support for, nor opposition to, the petition.
        (4) Certain positions disregarded. (i) The Secretary will disregard 
    the position of a domestic producer that opposes the petition if such 
    producer is related to a foreign producer or to a foreign exporter 
    under section 771(4)(B)(ii) of the Act, unless such domestic producer 
    demonstrates to the Secretary's satisfaction that its interests as a 
    domestic producer would be adversely affected by the imposition of an 
    antidumping order or a countervailing duty order, as the case may be; 
    and
        (ii) The Secretary may disregard the position of a domestic 
    producer that is an importer of the subject merchandise, or that is 
    related to such an importer, under section 771(4)(B)(ii) of the Act.
        (5) Polling the industry. In conducting a poll of the industry 
    under section 702(c)(4)(D)(i) or section 732(c)(4)(D)(i) of the Act, 
    the Secretary will include unions, groups of workers, and trade or 
    business associations described in paragraphs (9)(D) and (9)(E) of 
    section 771 of the Act.
        (f) Time limits where petition involves same merchandise as that 
    covered by an order that has been revoked. Under section 702(c)(1)(C) 
    or section 732(c)(1)(C) of the Act, and in expediting an investigation 
    involving subject merchandise for which a prior order was revoked or a 
    suspended investigation was terminated, the Secretary will consider 
    ``section 751(d)'' as including a predecessor provision.
    
    
    Sec. 351.204  Time periods and persons examined; voluntary respondents; 
    exclusions.
    
        (a) Introduction. Because the Act does not specify the precise 
    period of time that the Secretary should examine in an antidumping or 
    countervailing duty investigation, this section sets forth rules 
    regarding the period of investigation (``POI''). In addition, this 
    section includes rules regarding the selection of persons to be 
    examined, the treatment of voluntary respondents that are not selected 
    for individual examination, and the exclusion of persons that the 
    Secretary ultimately finds are not dumping or are not receiving 
    countervailable subsidies.
        (b) Period of investigation. (1) Antidumping investigation. In an 
    antidumping investigation, the Secretary normally will examine 
    merchandise sold during the four most recently completed fiscal 
    quarters (or, in an investigation involving merchandise imported from a 
    nonmarket economy country, the two most recently completed fiscal 
    quarters) as of the month preceding the month in which the petition was 
    filed or in which the Secretary self-initiated an investigation. 
    However, the Secretary may examine merchandise sold during any 
    additional or alternate period that the Secretary concludes is 
    appropriate.
        (2) Countervailing duty investigation. In a countervailing duty 
    investigation, the Secretary normally will rely on information 
    pertaining to the most recently completed fiscal year for the 
    government and exporters or producers in question. If the exporters or 
    producers have different fiscal years, the Secretary normally will rely 
    on information pertaining to the most recently completed calendar year. 
    If the investigation is conducted on an aggregate basis under section 
    777A(e)(2)(B) of the Act, the Secretary normally will rely on 
    information pertaining to the most recently completed fiscal year for 
    the government in question. However, the Secretary may rely on 
    information for
    
    [[Page 27386]]
    
    any additional or alternate period that the Secretary concludes is 
    appropriate.
        (c) Exporters and producers examined. (1) In general. In an 
    investigation, the Secretary will attempt to determine an individual 
    weighted-average dumping margin or individual countervailable subsidy 
    rate for each known exporter or producer of the subject merchandise. 
    However, the Secretary may decline to examine a particular exporter or 
    producer if that exporter or producer and the petitioner agree.
        (2) Limited investigation. Notwithstanding paragraph (c)(1) of this 
    section, the Secretary may limit the investigation by using a method 
    described in subsection (a), (c), or (e) of section 777A of the Act.
        (d) Voluntary respondents. (1) In general. If the Secretary limits 
    the number of exporters or producers to be individually examined under 
    section 777A(c)(2) or section 777A(e)(2)(A) of the Act, the Secretary 
    will examine voluntary respondents (exporters or producers, other than 
    those initially selected for individual examination) in accordance with 
    section 782(a) of the Act.
        (2) Acceptance of voluntary respondents. The Secretary will 
    determine, as soon as practicable, whether to examine a voluntary 
    respondent individually. A voluntary respondent accepted for individual 
    examination under subparagraph (d)(1) of this section will be subject 
    to the same requirements as an exporter or producer initially selected 
    by the Secretary for individual examination under section 777A(c)(2) or 
    section 777A(e)(2)(A) of the Act, including the requirements of section 
    782(a) of the Act and, where applicable, the use of the facts available 
    under section 776 of the Act and Sec. 351.308.
        (3) Exclusion of voluntary respondents' rates from all-others rate. 
    In calculating an all-others rate under section 705(c)(5) or section 
    735(c)(5) of the Act, the Secretary will exclude weighted-average 
    dumping margins or countervailable subsidy rates calculated for 
    voluntary respondents.
        (e) Exclusions. (1) In general. The Secretary will exclude from an 
    affirmative final determination under section 705(a) or section 735(a) 
    of the Act or an order under section 706(a) or section 736(a) of the 
    Act, any exporter or producer for which the Secretary determines an 
    individual weighted-average dumping margin or individual net 
    countervailable subsidy rate of zero or de minimis.
        (2) Preliminary determinations. In an affirmative preliminary 
    determination under section 703(b) or section 733(b) of the Act, an 
    exporter or producer for which the Secretary preliminarily determines 
    an individual weighted-average dumping margin or individual net 
    countervailable subsidy of zero or de minimis will not be excluded from 
    the preliminary determination or the investigation. However, the 
    exporter or producer will not be subject to provisional measures under 
    section 703(d) or section 733(d) of the Act.
        (3) Exclusion of nonproducing exporter. (i) In general. In the case 
    of an exporter that is not the producer of subject merchandise, the 
    Secretary normally will limit an exclusion of the exporter to subject 
    merchandise of those producers that supplied the exporter during the 
    period of investigation.
        (ii) Example. During the period of investigation, Exporter A 
    exports to the United States subject merchandise produced by Producer 
    X. Based on an examination of Exporter A, the Secretary determines that 
    the dumping margins with respect to these exports are de minimis, and 
    the Secretary excludes Exporter A. Normally, the exclusion of Exporter 
    A would be limited to subject merchandise produced by Producer X. If 
    Exporter A began to export subject merchandise produced by Producer Y, 
    this merchandise would be subject to the antidumping duty order, if 
    any.
        (4) Countervailing duty investigations conducted on an aggregate 
    basis and requests for exclusion from countervailing duty order. Where 
    the Secretary conducts a countervailing duty investigation on an 
    aggregate basis under section 777A(e)(2)(B) of the Act, the Secretary 
    will consider and investigate requests for exclusion to the extent 
    practicable. An exporter or producer that desires exclusion from an 
    order must submit:
        (i) A certification by the exporter or producer that it received 
    zero or de minimis net countervailable subsidies during the period of 
    investigation;
        (ii) If the exporter or producer received a countervailable 
    subsidy, calculations demonstrating that the amount of net 
    countervailable subsidies received was de minimis during the period of 
    investigation;
        (iii) If the exporter is not the producer of the subject 
    merchandise, certifications from the suppliers and producers of the 
    subject merchandise that those persons received zero or de minimis net 
    countervailable subsidies during the period of the investigation; and
        (iv) A certification from the government of the affected country 
    that the government did not provide the exporter (or the exporter's 
    supplier) or producer with more than de minimis net countervailable 
    subsidies during the period of investigation.
    
    
    Sec. 351.205  Preliminary determination.
    
        (a) Introduction. A preliminary determination in an antidumping or 
    countervailing duty investigation constitutes the first point at which 
    the Secretary may provide a remedy if the Secretary preliminarily finds 
    that dumping or countervailable subsidization has occurred. The remedy 
    (sometimes referred to as ``provisional measures'') usually takes the 
    form of a bonding requirement to ensure payment if antidumping or 
    countervailing duties ultimately are imposed. Whether the Secretary's 
    preliminary determination is affirmative or negative, the investigation 
    continues. This section contains rules regarding deadlines for 
    preliminary determinations, postponement of preliminary determinations, 
    notices of preliminary determinations, and the effects of affirmative 
    preliminary determinations.
        (b) Deadline for preliminary determination. The deadline for a 
    preliminary determination under section 703(b) or section 733(b) of the 
    Act will be:
        (1) Normally not later than 140 days in an antidumping 
    investigation (65 days in a countervailing duty investigation) after 
    the date on which the Secretary initiated the investigation (see 
    section 703(b)(1) or section 733(b)(1)(A) of the Act);
        (2) Not later than 190 days in an antidumping investigation (130 
    days in a countervailing duty investigation) after the date on which 
    the Secretary initiated the investigation if the Secretary postpones 
    the preliminary determination at petitioner's request or because the 
    Secretary determines that the investigation is extraordinarily 
    complicated (see section 703(c)(1) or section 733(c)(1) of the Act);
        (3) In a countervailing duty investigation, not later than 250 days 
    after the date on which the proceeding began if the Secretary postpones 
    the preliminary determination due to an upstream subsidy allegation (up 
    to 310 days if the Secretary also postponed the preliminary 
    determination at the request of the petitioner or because the Secretary 
    determined that the investigation is extraordinarily complicated) (see 
    section 703(c)(1) and section 703(g)(1) of the Act);
        (4) Within 90 days after initiation in an antidumping 
    investigation, and on an expedited basis in a countervailing duty 
    investigation, where verification has
    
    [[Page 27387]]
    
    been waived (see section 703(b)(3) or section 733(b)(2) of the Act);
        (5) In a countervailing duty investigation, on an expedited basis 
    and within 65 days after the date on which the Secretary initiated the 
    investigation if the sole subsidy alleged in the petition was the 
    derogation of an international undertaking on official export credits 
    (see section 702(b)(3) and section 703(b)(2) of the Act);
        (6) In a countervailing duty investigation, not later than 60 days 
    after the date on which the Secretary initiated the investigation if 
    the only subsidy under investigation is a subsidy with respect to which 
    the Secretary received notice from the United States Trade 
    Representative of a violation of Article 8 of the Subsidies Agreement 
    (see section 703(b)(5) of the Act); and
        (7) In an antidumping investigation, within the deadlines set forth 
    in section 733(b)(1)(B) of the Act if the investigation involves short 
    life cycle merchandise (see section 733(b)(1)(B) and section 739 of the 
    Act).
        (c) Contents of preliminary determination and publication of 
    notice. A preliminary determination will include a preliminary finding 
    on critical circumstances, if appropriate, under section 703(e)(1) or 
    section 733(e)(1) of the Act (whichever is applicable). The Secretary 
    will publish in the Federal Register notice of ``Affirmative (Negative) 
    Preliminary Antidumping (Countervailing Duty) Determination,'' 
    including the rates, if any, and an invitation for argument consistent 
    with Sec. 351.309.
        (d) Effect of affirmative preliminary determination. If the 
    preliminary determination is affirmative, the Secretary will take the 
    actions described in section 703(d) or section 733(d) of the Act 
    (whichever is applicable). In making information available to the 
    Commission under section 703(d)(3) or section 733(d)(3) of the Act, the 
    Secretary will make available to the Commission and to employees of the 
    Commission directly involved in the proceeding the information upon 
    which the Secretary based the preliminary determination and which the 
    Commission may consider relevant to its injury determination.
        (e) Postponement at the request of the petitioner. A petitioner 
    must submit a request for postponement of the preliminary determination 
    (see section 703(c)(1)(A) or section 733(c)(1)(A) of the Act) 25 days 
    or more before the scheduled date of the preliminary determination, and 
    must state the reasons for the request. The Secretary will grant the 
    request, unless the Secretary finds compelling reasons to deny the 
    request.
        (f) Notice of postponement. (1) If the Secretary decides to 
    postpone the preliminary determination at the request of the petitioner 
    or because the investigation is extraordinarily complicated, the 
    Secretary will notify all parties to the proceeding not later than 20 
    days before the scheduled date of the preliminary determination, and 
    will publish in the Federal Register notice of ``Postponement of 
    Preliminary Antidumping (Countervailing Duty) Determination,'' stating 
    the reasons for the postponement (see section 703(c)(2) or section 
    733(c)(2) of the Act).
        (2) If the Secretary decides to postpone the preliminary 
    determination due to an allegation of upstream subsidies, the Secretary 
    will notify all parties to the proceeding not later than the scheduled 
    date of the preliminary determination and will publish in the Federal 
    Register notice of ``Postponement of Preliminary Countervailing Duty 
    Determination,'' stating the reasons for the postponement.
    
    
    Sec. 351.206  Critical circumstances.
    
        (a) Introduction. Generally, antidumping or countervailing duties 
    are imposed on entries of merchandise made on or after the date on 
    which the Secretary first imposes provisional measures (most often the 
    date on which notice of an affirmative preliminary determination is 
    published in the Federal Register). However, if the Secretary finds 
    that ``critical circumstances'' exist, duties may be imposed 
    retroactively on merchandise entered up to 90 days before the 
    imposition of provisional measures. This section contains procedural 
    and substantive rules regarding allegations and findings of critical 
    circumstances.
        (b) In general. If a petitioner submits to the Secretary a written 
    allegation of critical circumstances, with reasonably available factual 
    information supporting the allegation, 21 days or more before the 
    scheduled date of the Secretary's final determination, or on the 
    Secretary's own initiative in a self-initiated investigation, the 
    Secretary will make a finding whether critical circumstances exist, as 
    defined in section 705(a)(2) or section 735(a)(3) of the Act (whichever 
    is applicable).
        (c) Preliminary finding. (1) If the petitioner submits an 
    allegation of critical circumstances 30 days or more before the 
    scheduled date of the Secretary's final determination, the Secretary, 
    based on the available information, will make a preliminary finding 
    whether there is a reasonable basis to believe or suspect that critical 
    circumstances exist, as defined in section 703(e)(1) or section 
    733(e)(1) of the Act (whichever is applicable).
        (2) The Secretary will issue the preliminary finding:
        (i) Not later than the preliminary determination, if the allegation 
    is submitted 20 days or more before the scheduled date of the 
    preliminary determination; or
        (ii) Within 30 days after the petitioner submits the allegation, if 
    the allegation is submitted later than 20 days before the scheduled 
    date of the preliminary determination. The Secretary will notify the 
    Commission and publish in the Federal Register notice of the 
    preliminary finding.
        (d) Suspension of liquidation. If the Secretary makes an 
    affirmative preliminary finding of critical circumstances, the 
    provisions of section 703(e)(2) or section 733(e)(2) of the Act 
    (whichever is applicable) regarding the retroactive suspension of 
    liquidation will apply.
        (e) Final finding. For any allegation of critical circumstances 
    submitted 21 days or more before the scheduled date of the Secretary's 
    final determination, the Secretary will make a final finding on 
    critical circumstances, and will take appropriate action under section 
    705(c)(4) or section 735(c)(4) of the Act (whichever is applicable).
        (f) Findings in self-initiated investigations. In a self-initiated 
    investigation, the Secretary will make preliminary and final findings 
    on critical circumstances without regard to the time limits in 
    paragraphs (c) and (e) of this section.
        (g) Information regarding critical circumstances. The Secretary may 
    request the Commissioner of Customs to compile information on an 
    expedited basis regarding entries of the subject merchandise if, at any 
    time after the initiation of an investigation, the Secretary makes the 
    findings described in section 702(e) or section 732(e) of the Act 
    (whichever is applicable) regarding the possible existence of critical 
    circumstances.
        (h) Massive imports. (1) In determining whether imports of the 
    subject merchandise have been massive under section 705(a)(2)(B) or 
    section 735(a)(3)(B) of the Act, the Secretary normally will examine:
        (i) The volume and value of the imports;
        (ii) Seasonal trends; and
        (iii) The share of domestic consumption accounted for by the 
    imports.
        (2) In general, unless the imports during the ``relatively short 
    period'' (see
    
    [[Page 27388]]
    
    paragraph (i) of this section) have increased by at least 15 percent 
    over the imports during an immediately preceding period of comparable 
    duration, the Secretary will not consider the imports massive.
        (i) Relatively short period. Under section 705(a)(2)(B) or section 
    735(a)(3)(B) of the Act, the Secretary normally will consider a 
    ``relatively short period'' as the period beginning on the date the 
    proceeding begins and ending at least three months later. However, if 
    the Secretary finds that importers, or exporters or producers, had 
    reason to believe, at some time prior to the beginning of the 
    proceeding, that a proceeding was likely, then the Secretary may 
    consider a period of not less than three months from that earlier time.
    
    
    Sec. 351.207  Termination of investigation.
    
        (a) Introduction. ``Termination'' is a term of art that refers to 
    the end of an antidumping or countervailing duty proceeding in which an 
    order has not yet been issued. The Act establishes a variety of 
    mechanisms by which an investigation may be terminated, most of which 
    are dealt with in this section. For rules regarding the termination of 
    a suspended investigation following a review under section 751 of the 
    Act, see Sec. 351.222.
        (b) Withdrawal of petition; self-initiated investigations. (1) In 
    general. The Secretary may terminate an investigation under section 
    704(a)(1)(A) or section 734(a)(1)(A) (withdrawal of petition) or under 
    section 704(k) or section 734(k) (self-initiated investigation) of the 
    Act, provided that the Secretary concludes that termination is in the 
    public interest. If the Secretary terminates an investigation, the 
    Secretary will publish in the Federal Register notice of ``Termination 
    of Antidumping (Countervailing Duty) Investigation,'' together with, 
    when appropriate, a copy of any correspondence with the petitioner 
    forming the basis of the withdrawal and the termination. (For the 
    treatment in a subsequent investigation of records compiled in an 
    investigation in which the petition was withdrawn, see section 
    704(a)(1)(B) or section 734(a)(1)(B) of the Act.)
        (2) Withdrawal of petition based on acceptance of quantitative 
    restriction agreements. In addition to the requirements of paragraph 
    (b)(1) of this section, if a termination is based on the acceptance of 
    an understanding or other kind of agreement to limit the volume of 
    imports into the United States of the subject merchandise, the 
    Secretary will apply the provisions of section 704(a)(2) or section 
    734(a)(2) of the Act (whichever is applicable) regarding public 
    interest and consultations with consuming industries and producers and 
    workers.
        (c) Lack of interest. The Secretary may terminate an investigation 
    based upon lack of interest (see section 782(h)(1) of the Act). Where 
    the Secretary terminates an investigation under this paragraph, the 
    Secretary will publish the notice described in paragraph (b)(1) of this 
    section.
        (d) Negative determination. An investigation terminates 
    automatically upon publication in the Federal Register of the 
    Secretary's negative final determination or the Commission's negative 
    preliminary or final determination.
        (e) End of suspension of liquidation. When an investigation 
    terminates, if the Secretary previously ordered suspension of 
    liquidation, the Secretary will order the suspension ended on the date 
    of publication of the notice of termination referred to in paragraph 
    (b) of this section or on the date of publication of a negative 
    determination referred to in paragraph (d) of this section, and will 
    instruct the Customs Service to release any cash deposit or bond.
    
    
    Sec. 351.208  Suspension of investigation.
    
        (a) Introduction. In addition to the imposition of duties, the Act 
    also permits the Secretary to suspend an antidumping or countervailing 
    duty investigation by accepting a suspension agreement (referred to in 
    the WTO Agreements as an ``undertaking''). Briefly, in a suspension 
    agreement, the exporters and producers or the foreign government agree 
    to modify their behavior so as to eliminate dumping or subsidization or 
    the injury caused thereby. If the Secretary accepts a suspension 
    agreement, the Secretary will ``suspend'' the investigation and 
    thereafter will monitor compliance with the agreement. This section 
    contains rules for entering into suspension agreements and procedures 
    for suspending an investigation.
        (b) In general. The Secretary may suspend an investigation under 
    section 704 or section 734 of the Act and this section.
        (c) Definition of ``substantially all.'' Under section 704 and 
    section 734 of the Act, exporters that account for ``substantially 
    all'' of the merchandise means exporters and producers that have 
    accounted for not less than 85 percent by value or volume of the 
    subject merchandise during the period for which the Secretary is 
    measuring dumping or countervailable subsidization in the investigation 
    or such other period that the Secretary considers representative.
        (d) Monitoring. In monitoring a suspension agreement under section 
    704(c), section 734(c), or section 734(l) of the Act (agreements to 
    eliminate injurious effects or to restrict the volume of imports), the 
    Secretary will not be obliged to ascertain on a continuing basis the 
    prices in the United States of the subject merchandise or of domestic 
    like products.
        (e) Exports not to increase during interim period. The Secretary 
    will not accept a suspension agreement under section 704(b)(2) or 
    section 734(b)(1) of the Act (the cessation of exports) unless the 
    agreement ensures that the quantity of the subject merchandise exported 
    during the interim period set forth in the agreement does not exceed 
    the quantity of the merchandise exported during a period of comparable 
    duration that the Secretary considers representative.
        (f) Procedure for suspension of investigation. (1) Submission of 
    proposed suspension agreement. (i) In general. As appropriate, the 
    exporters and producers or, in an antidumping investigation involving a 
    nonmarket economy country or a countervailing duty investigation, the 
    government, must submit to the Secretary a proposed suspension 
    agreement within:
        (A) In an antidumping investigation, 15 days after the date of 
    issuance of the preliminary determination, or
        (B) In a countervailing duty investigation, 7 days after the date 
    of issuance of the preliminary determination.
        (ii) Postponement of final determination. Where a proposed 
    suspension agreement is submitted in an antidumping investigation, an 
    exporter or producer or, in an investigation involving a nonmarket 
    economy country, the government, may request postponement of the final 
    determination under section 735(a)(2) of the Act (see Sec. 351.210(e)). 
    Where the final determination in a countervailing duty investigation is 
    postponed under section 703(g)(2) or section 705(a)(1) of the Act (see 
    Sec. 351.210(b)(3) and Sec. 351.210(i)), the time limits in paragraphs 
    (f)(1)(i), (f)(2)(i), (f)(3), and (g)(1) of this section applicable to 
    countervailing duty investigations will be extended to coincide with 
    the time limits in such paragraphs applicable to antidumping 
    investigations.
        (iii) Special rule for regional industry determination. If the 
    Commission makes a regional industry determination in its final 
    affirmative determination under
    
    [[Page 27389]]
    
    section 705(b) or section 735(b) of the Act but not in its preliminary 
    affirmative determination under section 703(a) or section 733(a) of the 
    Act, the exporters and producers or, in an antidumping investigation 
    involving a nonmarket economy country or a countervailing duty 
    investigation, the government, must submit to the Secretary any 
    proposed suspension agreement within 15 days of the publication in the 
    Federal Register of the antidumping or countervailing duty order.
        (2) Notification and consultation. In fulfilling the requirements 
    of section 704 or section 734 of the Act (whichever is applicable), the 
    Secretary will take the following actions:
        (i) In general. The Secretary will notify all parties to the 
    proceeding of the proposed suspension of an investigation and provide 
    to the petitioner a copy of the suspension agreement preliminarily 
    accepted by the Secretary (the agreement must contain the procedures 
    for monitoring compliance and a statement of the compatibility of the 
    agreement with the requirements of section 704 or section 734 of the 
    Act) within:
        (A) In an antidumping investigation, 30 days after the date of 
    issuance of the preliminary determination, or
        (B) In a countervailing duty investigation, 15 days after the date 
    of issuance of the preliminary determination; or
        (ii) Special rule for regional industry determination. If the 
    Commission makes a regional industry determination in its final 
    affirmative determination under section 705(b) or section 735(b) of the 
    Act but not in its preliminary affirmative determination under section 
    703(a) or section 733(a) of the Act, the Secretary, within 15 days of 
    the submission of a proposed suspension agreement under paragraph 
    (f)(1)(iii) of this section, will notify all parties to the proceeding 
    of the proposed suspension agreement and provide to the petitioner a 
    copy of the agreement preliminarily accepted by the Secretary (such 
    agreement must contain the procedures for monitoring compliance and a 
    statement of the compatibility of the agreement with the requirements 
    of section 704 or section 734 of the Act); and
        (iii) Consultation. The Secretary will consult with the petitioner 
    concerning the proposed suspension of the investigation.
        (3) Opportunity for comment. The Secretary will provide all 
    interested parties, an industrial user of the subject merchandise or a 
    representative consumer organization, as described in section 777(h) of 
    the Act, and United States government agencies an opportunity to submit 
    written argument and factual information concerning the proposed 
    suspension of the investigation within:
        (i) In an antidumping investigation, 50 days after the date of 
    issuance of the preliminary determination,
        (ii) In a countervailing duty investigation, 35 days after the date 
    of issuance of the preliminary determination, or
        (iii) In a regional industry case described in paragraph 
    (f)(1)(iii) of this section, 35 days after the date of issuance of an 
    order.
        (g) Acceptance of suspension agreement. (1) The Secretary may 
    accept an agreement to suspend an investigation within:
        (i) In an antidumping investigation, 60 days after the date of 
    issuance of the preliminary determination,
        (ii) In a countervailing duty investigation, 45 days after the date 
    of issuance of the preliminary determination, or
        (iii) In a regional industry case described in paragraph 
    (f)(1)(iii) of this section, 45 days after the date of issuance of an 
    order.
        (2) If the Secretary accepts an agreement to suspend an 
    investigation, the Secretary will take the actions described in section 
    704(f), section 704(m)(3), section 734(f), or section 734(l)(3) of the 
    Act (whichever is applicable), and will publish in the Federal Register 
    notice of ``Suspension of Antidumping (Countervailing Duty) 
    Investigation,'' including the text of the agreement. If the Secretary 
    has not already published notice of an affirmative preliminary 
    determination, the Secretary will include that notice. In accepting an 
    agreement, the Secretary may rely on factual or legal conclusions the 
    Secretary reached in or after the affirmative preliminary 
    determination.
        (h) Continuation of investigation. (1) A request to the Secretary 
    under section 704(g) or section 734(g) of the Act for the continuation 
    of the investigation must be made in writing. In addition, the request 
    must be simultaneously filed with the Commission, and the requester 
    must so certify in submitting the request to the Secretary.
        (2) If the Secretary and the Commission make affirmative final 
    determinations in an investigation that has been continued, the 
    suspension agreement will remain in effect in accordance with the 
    factual and legal conclusions in the Secretary's final determination. 
    If either the Secretary or the Commission makes a negative final 
    determination, the agreement will have no force or effect.
        (i) Merchandise imported in excess of allowed quantity. (1) The 
    Secretary may instruct the Customs Service not to accept entries, or 
    withdrawals from warehouse, for consumption of subject merchandise in 
    excess of any quantity allowed by a suspension agreement under section 
    704 or section 734 of the Act, including any quantity allowed during 
    the interim period (see paragraph (e) of this section).
        (2) Imports in excess of the quantity allowed by a suspension 
    agreement, including any quantity allowed during the interim period 
    (see paragraph (e) of this section), may be exported or destroyed under 
    Customs Service supervision, except that if the agreement is under 
    section 704(c)(3) or section 734(l) of the Act (restrictions on the 
    volume of imports), the excess merchandise, with the approval of the 
    Secretary, may be held for future opening under the agreement by 
    placing it in a foreign trade zone or by entering it for warehouse.
    
    
    Sec. 351.209  Violation of suspension agreement.
    
        (a) Introduction. A suspension agreement remains in effect until 
    the underlying investigation is terminated (see Secs. 351.207 and 
    351.222). However, if the Secretary finds that a suspension agreement 
    has been violated or no longer meets the requirements of the Act, the 
    Secretary may either cancel or revise the agreement. This section 
    contains rules regarding cancellation and revision of suspension 
    agreements.
        (b) Immediate determination. If the Secretary determines that a 
    signatory has violated a suspension agreement, the Secretary, without 
    providing interested parties an opportunity to comment, will:
        (1) Order the suspension of liquidation in accordance with section 
    704(i)(1)(A) or section 734(i)(1)(A) of the Act (whichever is 
    applicable) of all entries of the subject merchandise entered, or 
    withdrawn from warehouse, for consumption on or after the later of:
        (i) 90 days before the date of publication of the notice of 
    cancellation of the agreement; or
        (ii) The date of first entry, or withdrawal from warehouse, for 
    consumption of the merchandise the sale or export of which was in 
    violation of the agreement;
        (2) If the investigation was not completed under section 704(g) or 
    section 734(g) of the Act, resume the investigation as if the Secretary 
    had made an affirmative preliminary determination on the date of 
    publication
    
    [[Page 27390]]
    
    of the notice of cancellation and impose provisional measures by 
    instructing the Customs Service to require for each entry of the 
    subject merchandise suspended under paragraph (b)(1) of this section a 
    cash deposit or bond at the rates determined in the affirmative 
    preliminary determination;
        (3) If the investigation was completed under section 704(g) or 
    section 734(g) of the Act, issue an antidumping order or countervailing 
    duty order (whichever is applicable) and, for all entries subject to 
    suspension of liquidation under paragraph (b)(1) of this section, 
    instruct the Customs Service to require for each entry of the 
    merchandise suspended under this paragraph a cash deposit at the rates 
    determined in the affirmative final determination;
        (4) Notify all persons who are or were parties to the proceeding, 
    the Commission, and, if the Secretary determines that the violation was 
    intentional, the Commissioner of Customs; and
        (5) Publish in the Federal Register notice of ``Antidumping 
    (Countervailing Duty) Order (Resumption of Antidumping (Countervailing 
    Duty) Investigation); Cancellation of Suspension Agreement.''
        (c) Determination after notice and comment. (1) If the Secretary 
    has reason to believe that a signatory has violated a suspension 
    agreement, or that an agreement no longer meets the requirements of 
    section 704(d)(1) or section 734(d) of the Act, but the Secretary does 
    not have sufficient information to determine that a signatory has 
    violated the agreement (see paragraph (b) of this section), the 
    Secretary will publish in the Federal Register notice of ``Invitation 
    for Comment on Antidumping (Countervailing Duty) Suspension 
    Agreement.''
        (2) After publication of the notice inviting comment and after 
    consideration of comments received the Secretary will:
        (i) Determine whether any signatory has violated the suspension 
    agreement; or
        (ii) Determine whether the suspension agreement no longer meets the 
    requirements of section 704(d)(1) or section 734(d) of the Act.
        (3) If the Secretary determines that a signatory has violated the 
    suspension agreement, the Secretary will take appropriate action as 
    described in paragraphs (b)(1) through (b)(5) of this section.
        (4) If the Secretary determines that a suspension agreement no 
    longer meets the requirements of section 704(d)(1) or section 734(d) of 
    the Act, the Secretary will:
        (i) Take appropriate action as described in paragraphs (b)(1) 
    through (b)(5) of this section; except that, under paragraph (b)(1)(ii) 
    of this section, the Secretary will order the suspension of liquidation 
    of all entries of the subject merchandise entered, or withdrawn from 
    warehouse, for consumption on or after the later of:
        (A) 90 days before the date of publication of the notice of 
    suspension of liquidation; or
        (B) The date of first entry, or withdrawal from warehouse, for 
    consumption of the merchandise the sale or export of which does not 
    meet the requirements of section 704(d)(1) of the Act;
        (ii) Continue the suspension of investigation by accepting a 
    revised suspension agreement under section 704(b) or section 734(b) of 
    the Act (whether or not the Secretary accepted the original agreement 
    under such section) that, at the time the Secretary accepts the revised 
    agreement, meets the applicable requirements of section 704(d)(1) or 
    section 734(d) of the Act, and publish in the Federal Register notice 
    of ``Revision of Agreement Suspending Antidumping (Countervailing Duty) 
    Investigation''; or
        (iii) Continue the suspension of investigation by accepting a 
    revised suspension agreement under section 704(c), section 734(c), or 
    section 734(l) of the Act (whether or not the Secretary accepted the 
    original agreement under such section) that, at the time the Secretary 
    accepts the revised agreement, meets the applicable requirements of 
    section 704(d)(1) or section 734(d) of the Act, and publish in the 
    Federal Register notice of ``Revision of Agreement Suspending 
    Antidumping (Countervailing Duty) Investigation.'' If the Secretary 
    continues to suspend an investigation based on a revised agreement 
    accepted under section 704(c), section 734(c), or section 734(l) of the 
    Act, the Secretary will order suspension of liquidation to begin. The 
    suspension will not end until the Commission completes any requested 
    review of the revised agreement under section 704(h) or section 734(h) 
    of the Act. If the Commission receives no request for review within 20 
    days after the date of publication of the notice of the revision, the 
    Secretary will order the suspension of liquidation ended on the 21st 
    day after the date of publication, and will instruct the Customs 
    Service to release any cash deposit or bond. If the Commission 
    undertakes a review under section 704(h) or section 734(h) of the Act, 
    the provisions of sections 704(h)(2) and (3) and sections 734(h)(2) and 
    (3) of the Act will apply.
        (5) If the Secretary decides neither to consider the suspension 
    agreement violated nor to revise the agreement, the Secretary will 
    publish in the Federal Register notice of the Secretary's decision 
    under paragraph (c)(2) of this section, including a statement of the 
    factual and legal conclusions on which the decision is based.
        (d) Additional signatories. If the Secretary decides that a 
    suspension agreement no longer will completely eliminate the injurious 
    effect of exports to the United States of subject merchandise under 
    section 704(c)(1) or section 734(c)(1) of the Act, or that the 
    signatory exporters no longer account for substantially all of the 
    subject merchandise, the Secretary may revise the agreement to include 
    additional signatory exporters.
        (e) Definition of ``violation.'' Under this section, ``violation'' 
    means noncompliance with the terms of a suspension agreement caused by 
    an act or omission of a signatory, except, at the discretion of the 
    Secretary, an act or omission which is inadvertent or inconsequential.
    
    
    Sec. 351.210  Final determination.
    
        (a) Introduction. A ``final determination'' in an antidumping or 
    countervailing duty investigation constitutes a final decision by the 
    Secretary as to whether dumping or countervailable subsidization is 
    occurring. If the Secretary's final determination is affirmative, in 
    most instances the Commission will issue a final injury determination 
    (except in certain countervailing duty investigations). Also, if the 
    Secretary's preliminary determination was negative but the final 
    determination is affirmative, the Secretary will impose provisional 
    measures. If the Secretary's final determination is negative, the 
    proceeding, including the injury investigation conducted by the 
    Commission, terminates. This section contains rules regarding deadlines 
    for, and postponement of, final determinations, contents of final 
    determinations, and the effects of final determinations.
        (b) Deadline for final determination. The deadline for a final 
    determination under section 705(a)(1) or section 735(a)(1) of the Act 
    will be:
        (1) Normally, not later than 75 days after the date of the 
    Secretary's preliminary determination (see section 705(a)(1) or section 
    735(a)(1) of the Act);
        (2) In an antidumping investigation, not later than 135 days after 
    the date of publication of the preliminary
    
    [[Page 27391]]
    
    determination if the Secretary postpones the final determination at the 
    request of:
        (i) The petitioner, if the preliminary determination was negative 
    (see section 735(a)(2)(B) of the Act); or
        (ii) Exporters or producers who account for a significant 
    proportion of exports of the subject merchandise, if the preliminary 
    determination was affirmative (see section 735(a)(2)(A) of the Act);
        (3) In a countervailing duty investigation, not later than 165 days 
    after the preliminary determination, if, after the preliminary 
    determination, the Secretary decides to investigate an upstream subsidy 
    allegation and concludes that additional time is needed to investigate 
    the allegation (see section 703(g)(2) of the Act); or
        (4) In a countervailing duty investigation, the same date as the 
    date of the final antidumping determination, if:
        (i) In a situation where the Secretary simultaneously initiated 
    antidumping and countervailing duty investigations on the subject 
    merchandise (from the same or other countries), the petitioner requests 
    that the final countervailing duty determination be postponed to the 
    date of the final antidumping determination; and
        (ii) If the final countervailing duty determination is not due on a 
    later date because of postponement due to an allegation of upstream 
    subsidies under section 703(g) of the Act (see section 705(a)(1) of the 
    Act).
        (c) Contents of final determination and publication of notice. The 
    final determination will include, if appropriate, a final finding on 
    critical circumstances under section 705(a)(2) or section 735(a)(3) of 
    the Act (whichever is applicable). The Secretary will publish in the 
    Federal Register notice of ``Affirmative (Negative) Final Antidumping 
    (Countervailing Duty) Determination,'' including the rates, if any.
        (d) Effect of affirmative final determination. If the final 
    determination is affirmative, the Secretary will take the actions 
    described in section 705(c)(1) or section 735(c)(1) of the Act 
    (whichever is applicable). In addition, in the case of a countervailing 
    duty investigation involving subject merchandise from a country that is 
    not a Subsidies Agreement country, the Secretary will instruct the 
    Customs Service to require a cash deposit, as provided in section 
    706(a)(3) of the Act, for each entry of the subject merchandise 
    entered, or withdrawn from warehouse, for consumption on or after the 
    date of publication of the order under section 706(a) of the Act.
        (e) Request for postponement of final antidumping determination. 
    (1) In general. A request to postpone a final antidumping determination 
    under section 735(a)(2) of the Act (see paragraph (b)(2) of this 
    section) must be submitted in writing within the scheduled date of the 
    final determination. The Secretary may grant the request, unless the 
    Secretary finds compelling reasons to deny the request.
        (2) Requests by exporters. In the case of a request submitted under 
    paragraph (e)(1) of this section by exporters who account for a 
    significant proportion of exports of subject merchandise (see section 
    735(a)(2)(A) of the Act), the Secretary will not grant the request 
    unless those exporters also submit a request described in the last 
    sentence of section 733(d) of the Act (extension of provisional 
    measures from a 4-month period to not more than 6 months).
        (f) Deferral of decision concerning upstream subsidization to 
    review. Notwithstanding paragraph (b)(3) of this section, if the 
    petitioner so requests in writing and the preliminary countervailing 
    duty determination was affirmative, the Secretary, instead of 
    postponing the final determination, may defer a decision concerning 
    upstream subsidization until the conclusion of the first administrative 
    review of a countervailing duty order, if any (see section 
    703(g)(2)(B)(i) of the Act).
        (g) Notification of postponement. If the Secretary postpones a 
    final determination under paragraph (b)(2), (b)(3), or (b)(4) of this 
    section, the Secretary will notify promptly all parties to the 
    proceeding of the postponement, and will publish in the Federal 
    Register notice of ``Postponement of Final Antidumping (Countervailing 
    Duty) Determination,'' stating the reasons for the postponement.
        (h) Termination of suspension of liquidation in a countervailing 
    duty investigation. If the Secretary postpones a final countervailing 
    duty determination, the Secretary will end any suspension of 
    liquidation ordered in the preliminary determination not later than 120 
    days after the date of publication of the preliminary determination, 
    and will not resume it unless and until the Secretary publishes a 
    countervailing duty order.
        (i) Postponement of final countervailing duty determination for 
    simultaneous investigations. A request by the petitioner to postpone a 
    final countervailing duty determination to the date of the final 
    antidumping determination must be submitted in writing within five days 
    of the date of publication of the preliminary countervailing duty 
    determination (see section 705(a)(1) and paragraph (b)(4) of this 
    section).
        (j) Commission access to information. If the final determination is 
    affirmative, the Secretary will make available to the Commission and to 
    employees of the Commission directly involved in the proceeding the 
    information upon which the Secretary based the final determination and 
    that the Commission may consider relevant to its injury determination 
    (see section 705(c)(1)(A) or section 735(c)(1)(A) of the Act).
        (k) Effect of negative final determination. An investigation 
    terminates upon publication in the Federal Register of the Secretary's 
    or the Commission's negative final determination, and the Secretary 
    will take the relevant actions described in section 705(c)(2) or 
    section 735(c)(2) of the Act (whichever is applicable).
    
    
    Sec. 351.211  Antidumping order and countervailing duty order.
    
        (a) Introduction. The Secretary issues an order when both the 
    Secretary and the Commission (except in certain countervailing duty 
    investigations) have made final affirmative determinations. The 
    issuance of an order ends the investigative phase of a proceeding. 
    Generally, upon the issuance of an order, importers no longer may post 
    bonds as security for antidumping or countervailing duties, but instead 
    must make a cash deposit of estimated duties. An order remains in 
    effect until it is revoked. This section contains rules regarding the 
    issuance of orders in general, as well as special rules for orders 
    where the Commission has found a regional industry to exist.
        (b) In general. Not later than seven days after receipt of notice 
    of an affirmative final injury determination by the Commission under 
    section 705(b) or section 735(b) of the Act, or, in a countervailing 
    duty proceeding involving subject merchandise from a country not 
    entitled to an injury test (see Sec. 351.101(b)), simultaneously with 
    publication of an affirmative final countervailing duty determination 
    by the Secretary, the Secretary will publish in the Federal Register an 
    ``Antidumping Order'' or ``Countervailing Duty Order'' that:
        (1) Instructs the Customs Service to assess antidumping duties or 
    countervailing duties (whichever is applicable) on the subject 
    merchandise, in accordance with the Secretary's instructions at the 
    completion of each review requested under Sec. 351.213(b) 
    (administrative review), Sec. 351.214(b) (new shipper review), or 
    Sec. 351.215(b) (expedited antidumping review), or if a
    
    [[Page 27392]]
    
    review is not requested, in accordance with the Secretary's assessment 
    instructions under Sec. 351.212(c);
        (2) Instructs the Customs Service to require a cash deposit of 
    estimated antidumping or countervailing duties at the rates included in 
    the Secretary's final determination; and
        (3) Orders the suspension of liquidation ended for all entries of 
    the subject merchandise entered, or withdrawn from warehouse, for 
    consumption before the date of publication of the Commission's final 
    determination, and instructs the Customs Service to release the cash 
    deposit or bond on those entries, if in its final determination, the 
    Commission found a threat of material injury or material retardation of 
    the establishment of an industry, unless the Commission in its final 
    determination also found that, absent the suspension of liquidation 
    ordered under section 703(d)(2) or section 733(d)(2) of the Act, it 
    would have found material injury (see section 706(b) or section 736(b) 
    of the Act).
    
    
    Sec. 351.212  Assessment of antidumping and countervailing duties; 
    provisional measures deposit cap; interest on certain overpayments and 
    underpayments.
    
        (a) Introduction. Unlike the systems of some other countries, the 
    United States uses a ``retrospective'' assessment system under which 
    final liability for antidumping and countervailing duties is determined 
    after merchandise is imported. Generally, the amount of duties to be 
    assessed is determined in a review of the order covering a discrete 
    period of time. If a review is not requested, duties are assessed at 
    the rate established in the completed review covering the most recent 
    prior period or, if no review has been completed, the cash deposit rate 
    applicable at the time merchandise was entered. This section contains 
    rules regarding the assessment of duties, the provisional measures 
    deposit cap, and interest on over- or undercollections of estimated 
    duties.
        (b) Assessment of antidumping and countervailing duties as the 
    result of a review. (1) Antidumping duties. If the Secretary has 
    conducted a review of an antidumping order under Sec. 351.213 
    (administrative review), Sec. 351.214 (new shipper review), or 
    Sec. 351.215 (expedited antidumping review), the Secretary normally 
    will calculate an assessment rate for each importer of subject 
    merchandise covered by the review. The Secretary normally will 
    calculate the assessment rate by dividing the dumping margin found on 
    the subject merchandise examined by the entered value of such 
    merchandise for normal customs duty purposes. The Secretary then will 
    instruct the Customs Service to assess antidumping duties by applying 
    the assessment rate to the entered value of the merchandise.
        (2) Countervailing duties. If the Secretary has conducted a review 
    of a countervailing duty order under Sec. 351.213 (administrative 
    review) or Sec. 351.214 (new shipper review), the Secretary normally 
    will instruct the Customs Service to assess countervailing duties by 
    applying the rates included in the final results of the review to the 
    entered value of the merchandise.
        (c) Automatic assessment of antidumping and countervailing duties 
    if no review is requested. (1) If the Secretary does not receive a 
    timely request for an administrative review of an order (see paragraph 
    (b)(1), (b)(2), or (b)(3) of Sec. 351.213), the Secretary, without 
    additional notice, will instruct the Customs Service to:
        (i) Assess antidumping duties or countervailing duties, as the case 
    may be, on the subject merchandise described in Sec. 351.213(e) at 
    rates equal to the cash deposit of, or bond for, estimated antidumping 
    duties or countervailing duties required on that merchandise at the 
    time of entry, or withdrawal from warehouse, for consumption; and
        (ii) To continue to collect the cash deposits previously ordered.
        (2) If the Secretary receives a timely request for an 
    administrative review of an order (see paragraph (b)(1), (b)(2), or 
    (b)(3) of Sec. 351.213), the Secretary will instruct the Customs 
    Service to assess antidumping duties or countervailing duties, and to 
    continue to collect cash deposits, on the merchandise not covered by 
    the request in accordance with paragraph (c)(1) of this section.
        (3) The automatic assessment provisions of paragraphs (c)(1) and 
    (c)(2) of this section will not apply to subject merchandise that is 
    the subject of a new shipper review (see Sec. 351.214) or an expedited 
    antidumping review (see Sec. 351.215).
        (d) Provisional measures deposit cap. This paragraph applies to 
    subject merchandise entered, or withdrawn from warehouse, for 
    consumption before the date of publication of the Commission's notice 
    of an affirmative final injury determination or, in a countervailing 
    duty proceeding that involves merchandise from a country that is not 
    entitled to an injury test, the date of the Secretary's notice of an 
    affirmative final countervailing duty determination. If the amount of 
    duties that would be assessed by applying the rates included in the 
    Secretary's affirmative preliminary or affirmative final antidumping or 
    countervailing duty determination (``provisional duties'') is different 
    from the amount of duties that would be assessed by applying the 
    assessment rate under paragraphs (b)(1) and (b)(2) of this section 
    (``final duties''), the Secretary will instruct the Customs Service to 
    disregard the difference to the extent that the provisional duties are 
    less than the final duties, and to assess antidumping or countervailing 
    duties at the assessment rate if the provisional duties exceed the 
    final duties.
        (e) Interest on certain overpayments and underpayments. Under 
    section 778 of the Act, the Secretary will instruct the Customs Service 
    to calculate interest for each entry on or after the publication of the 
    order from the date that a cash deposit is required to be deposited for 
    the entry through the date of liquidation of the entry.
        (f) Special rule for regional industry cases. (1) In general. If 
    the Commission, in its final injury determination, found a regional 
    industry under section 771(4)(C) of the Act, the Secretary may direct 
    that duties not be assessed on subject merchandise of a particular 
    exporter or producer if the Secretary determines that:
        (i) The exporter or producer did not export subject merchandise for 
    sale in the region concerned during or after the Department's period of 
    investigation;
        (ii) The exporter or producer has certified that it will not export 
    subject merchandise for sale in the region concerned in the future so 
    long as the antidumping or countervailing duty order is in effect; and
        (iii) No subject merchandise of the exporter or producer was 
    entered into the United States outside of the region and then sold into 
    the region during or after the Department's period of investigation.
        (2) Procedures for obtaining an exception from the assessment of 
    duties. (i) Request for exception. An exporter or producer seeking an 
    exception from the assessment of duties under paragraph (f)(1) of this 
    section must request, subject to the provisions of Sec. 351.213 or 
    Sec. 351.214, an administrative review or a new shipper review to 
    determine whether subject merchandise of the exporter or producer in 
    question should be excepted from the assessment of duties under 
    paragraph (f)(1) of this section. The exporter or producer making the 
    request may request that the review be limited to a determination as to 
    whether the requirements of paragraph (f)(1) of this section are 
    satisfied. The request for a review must be accompanied by:
    
    [[Page 27393]]
    
        (A) A certification by the exporter or producer that it did not 
    export subject merchandise for sale in the region concerned during or 
    after the Department's period of investigation, and that it will not do 
    so in the future so long as the antidumping or countervailing duty 
    order is in effect; and
        (B) A certification from each of the exporter's or producer's U.S. 
    importers of the subject merchandise that no subject merchandise of 
    that exporter or producer was entered into the United States outside 
    such region and then sold into the region during or after the 
    Department's period of investigation.
        (ii) Limited review. If the Secretary initiates an administrative 
    review or a new shipper review based on a request for review that 
    includes a request for an exception from the assessment of duties under 
    paragraph (f)(2)(i) of this section, the Secretary, if requested, may 
    limit the review to a determination as to whether an exception from the 
    assessment of duties should be granted under paragraph (f)(1) of this 
    section.
        (3) Exception granted. If, in the final results of the 
    administrative review or the new shipper review, the Secretary 
    determines that the requirements of paragraph (f)(1) of this section 
    are satisfied, the Secretary will instruct the Customs Service to 
    liquidate, without regard to antidumping or countervailing duties 
    (whichever is appropriate), entries of subject merchandise of the 
    exporter or producer concerned.
        (4) Exception not granted. If, in the final results of the 
    administrative review or the new shipper review, the Secretary 
    determines that the requirements of paragraph (f)(1) are not satisfied, 
    the Secretary:
        (i) Will issue assessment instructions to the Customs Service in 
    accordance with paragraph (b) of this section; or
        (ii) If the review was limited to a determination as to whether an 
    exception from the assessment of duties should be granted, the 
    Secretary will instruct the Customs Service to assess duties in 
    accordance with paragraph (f)(1) or (f)(2) of this section, whichever 
    is appropriate (automatic assessment if no review is requested).
    
    
    Sec. 351.213  Administrative review of orders and suspension agreements 
    under section 751(a)(1) of the Act.
    
        (a) Introduction. As noted in Sec. 351.212(a), the United States 
    has a ``retrospective'' assessment system under which final liability 
    for antidumping and countervailing duties is determined after 
    merchandise is imported. Although duty liability may be determined in 
    the context of other types of reviews, the most frequently used 
    procedure for determining final duty liability is the administrative 
    review procedure under section 751(a)(1) of the Act. This section 
    contains rules regarding requests for administrative reviews and the 
    conduct of such reviews.
        (b) Request for administrative review. (1) Each year during the 
    anniversary month of the publication of an antidumping or 
    countervailing duty order, a domestic interested party or an interested 
    party described in section 771(9)(B) of the Act (foreign government) 
    may request in writing that the Secretary conduct an administrative 
    review under section 751(a)(1) of the Act of specified individual 
    exporters or producers covered by an order (except for a countervailing 
    duty order in which the investigation or prior administrative review 
    was conducted on an aggregate basis), if the requesting person states 
    why the person desires the Secretary to review those particular 
    exporters or producers.
        (2) During the same month, an exporter or producer covered by an 
    order (except for a countervailing duty order in which the 
    investigation or prior administrative review was conducted on an 
    aggregate basis) may request in writing that the Secretary conduct an 
    administrative review of only that person.
        (3) During the same month, an importer of the merchandise may 
    request in writing that the Secretary conduct an administrative review 
    of only an exporter or producer (except for a countervailing duty order 
    in which the investigation or prior administrative review was conducted 
    on an aggregate basis) of the subject merchandise imported by that 
    importer.
        (4) Each year during the anniversary month of the publication of a 
    suspension of investigation, an interested party may request in writing 
    that the Secretary conduct an administrative review of all producers or 
    exporters covered by an agreement on which the suspension of 
    investigation was based.
        (c) Deferral of administrative review. (1) In general. The 
    Secretary may defer the initiation of an administrative review, in 
    whole or in part, for one year if:
        (i) The request for administrative review is accompanied by a 
    request that the Secretary defer the review, in whole or in part; and
        (ii) None of the following persons objects to the deferral: the 
    exporter or producer for which deferral is requested, an importer of 
    subject merchandise of that exporter or producer, a domestic interested 
    party and, in a countervailing duty proceeding, the foreign government.
        (2) Timeliness of objection to deferral. An objection to a deferral 
    of the initiation of administrative review under paragraph (c)(1)(ii) 
    of this section must be submitted within 15 days after the end of the 
    anniversary month in which the administrative review is requested.
        (3) Procedures and deadlines. If the Secretary defers the 
    initiation of an administrative review, the Secretary will publish 
    notice of the deferral in the Federal Register. The Secretary will 
    initiate the administrative review in the month immediately following 
    the next anniversary month, and the deadline for issuing preliminary 
    results of review (see paragraph (h)(1) of this section) and submitting 
    factual information (see Sec. 351.302(b)(2)) will run from the last day 
    of the next anniversary month.
        (d) Rescission of administrative review. (1) Withdrawal of request 
    for review. The Secretary will rescind an administrative review under 
    this section, in whole or in part, if a party that requested a review 
    withdraws the request within 90 days of the date of publication of 
    notice of initiation of the requested review. The Secretary may extend 
    this time limit if the Secretary decides that it is reasonable to do 
    so.
        (2) Self-initiated review. The Secretary may rescind an 
    administrative review that was self-initiated by the Secretary.
        (3) No shipments. The Secretary may rescind an administrative 
    review, in whole or only with respect to a particular exporter or 
    producer, if the Secretary concludes that, during the period covered by 
    the review, there were no entries, exports, or sales of the subject 
    merchandise, as the case may be.
        (4) Notice of rescission. If the Secretary rescinds an 
    administrative review (in whole or in part), the Secretary will publish 
    in the Federal Register notice of ``Rescission of Antidumping 
    (Countervailing Duty) Administrative Review'' or, if appropriate, 
    ``Partial Rescission of Antidumping (Countervailing Duty) 
    Administrative Review.''
        (e) Period of review. (1) Antidumping proceedings. (i) Except as 
    provided in paragraph (e)(1)(ii) of this section, an administrative 
    review under this section normally will cover, as appropriate, entries, 
    exports, or sales of the subject merchandise during the 12 months 
    immediately preceding the most recent anniversary month.
        (ii) For requests received during the first anniversary month after 
    publication of an order or suspension of investigation, an 
    administrative review
    
    [[Page 27394]]
    
    under this section will cover, as appropriate, entries, exports, or 
    sales during the period from the date of suspension of liquidation 
    under this part or suspension of investigation to the end of the month 
    immediately preceding the first anniversary month.
        (2) Countervailing duty proceedings. (i) Except as provided in 
    paragraph (e)(2)(ii) of this section, an administrative review under 
    this section normally will cover entries or exports of the subject 
    merchandise during the most recently completed calendar year. If the 
    review is conducted on an aggregate basis, the Secretary normally will 
    cover entries or exports of the subject merchandise during the most 
    recently completed fiscal year for the government in question.
        (ii) For requests received during the first anniversary month after 
    publication of an order or suspension of investigation, an 
    administrative review under this section will cover entries or exports, 
    as appropriate, during the period from the date of suspension of 
    liquidation under this part or suspension of investigation to the end 
    of the most recently completed calendar or fiscal year as described in 
    paragraph (e)(2)(i) of this section.
        (f) Voluntary respondents. In an administrative review, the 
    Secretary will examine voluntary respondents in accordance with section 
    782(a) of the Act and Sec. 351.204(d).
        (g) Procedures. The Secretary will conduct an administrative review 
    under this section in accordance with Sec. 351.221.
        (h) Time limits. (1) In general. The Secretary will issue 
    preliminary results of review (see Sec. 351.221(b)(4)) within 245 days 
    after the last day of the anniversary month of the order or suspension 
    agreement for which the administrative review was requested, and final 
    results of review (see Sec. 351.221(b)(5)) within 120 days after the 
    date on which notice of the preliminary results was published in the 
    Federal Register.
        (2) Exception. If the Secretary determines that it is not 
    practicable to complete the review within the time specified in 
    paragraph (h)(1) of this section, the Secretary may extend the 245-day 
    period to 365 days and may extend the 120-day period to 180 days. If 
    the Secretary does not extend the time for issuing preliminary results, 
    the Secretary may extend the time for issuing final results from 120 
    days to 300 days.
        (i) Possible cancellation or revision of suspension agreement. If 
    during an administrative review the Secretary determines or has reason 
    to believe that a signatory has violated a suspension agreement or that 
    the agreement no longer meets the requirements of section 704 or 
    section 734 of the Act (whichever is applicable), the Secretary will 
    take appropriate action under section 704(i) or section 734(i) of the 
    Act and Sec. 351.209. The Secretary may suspend the time limit in 
    paragraph (h) of this section while taking action under Sec. 351.209.
        (j) Absorption of antidumping duties. (1) During any administrative 
    review covering all or part of a period falling between the first and 
    second or third and fourth anniversary of the publication of an 
    antidumping order under Sec. 351.211, or a determination under 
    Sec. 351.218(d) (sunset review), the Secretary, if requested by a 
    domestic interested party within 30 days of the date of publication of 
    the notice of initiation of the review, will determine whether 
    antidumping duties have been absorbed by an exporter or producer 
    subject to the review if the subject merchandise is sold in the United 
    States through an importer that is affiliated with such exporter or 
    producer. The request must include the name(s) of the exporter or 
    producer for which the inquiry is requested.
        (2) For transition orders defined in section 751(c)(6) of the Act, 
    the Secretary will apply paragraph (j)(1) of this section to any 
    administrative review initiated in 1996 or 1998.
        (3) In determining under paragraph (j)(1) of this section whether 
    antidumping duties have been absorbed, the Secretary will examine the 
    antidumping duties calculated in the administrative review in which the 
    absorption inquiry is requested.
        (4) The Secretary will notify the Commission of the Secretary's 
    determination if:
        (i) In the case of an administrative review other than one to which 
    paragraph (j)(2) of this section applies, the administrative review 
    covers all or part of a time period falling between the third and 
    fourth anniversary month of an order; or
        (ii) In the case of an administrative review to which paragraph 
    (j)(2) of this section applies, the Secretary initiated the 
    administrative review in 1998.
        (k) Administrative reviews of countervailing duty orders conducted 
    on an aggregate basis. (1) Request for zero rate. Where the Secretary 
    conducts an administrative review of a countervailing duty on an 
    aggregate basis under section 777A(e)(2)(B) of the Act, the Secretary 
    will consider and review requests for individual assessment and cash 
    deposit rates of zero to the extent practicable. An exporter or 
    producer that desires a zero rate must submit:
        (i) A certification by the exporter or producer that it received 
    zero or de minimis net countervailable subsidies during the period of 
    review;
        (ii) If the exporter or producer received a countervailable 
    subsidy, calculations demonstrating that the amount of net 
    countervailable subsidies received was de minimis during the period of 
    review;
        (iii) If the exporter is not the producer of the subject 
    merchandise, certifications from the suppliers and producers of the 
    subject merchandise that those persons received zero or de minimis net 
    countervailable subsidies during the period of the review; and
        (iv) A certification from the government of the affected country 
    that the government did not provide the exporter (or the exporter's 
    supplier) or producer with more than de minimis net countervailable 
    subsidies during the period of review.
        (2) Application of country-wide subsidy rate. With the exception of 
    assessment and cash deposit rates of zero determined under paragraph 
    (k)(1) of this section, if, in the final results of an administrative 
    review under this section of a countervailing duty order, the Secretary 
    calculates a single country-wide subsidy rate under section 
    777A(e)(2)(B) of the Act, that rate will supersede, for cash deposit 
    purposes, all rates previously determined in the countervailing duty 
    proceeding in question.
        (l) Exception from assessment in regional industry cases. For 
    procedures relating to a request for the exception from the assessment 
    of antidumping or countervailing duties in a regional industry case, 
    see Sec. 351.212(f).
    
    
    Sec. 351.214  New shipper reviews under section 751(a)(2)(B) of the 
    Act.
    
        (a) Introduction. The URAA established a new procedure by which so-
    called ``new shippers'' can obtain their own individual dumping margin 
    or countervailable subsidy rate on an expedited basis. In general, a 
    new shipper is an exporter or producer that did not export, and is not 
    affiliated with an exporter or producer that did export, to the United 
    States during the period of investigation. This section contains rules 
    regarding requests for new shipper reviews and procedures for 
    conducting such reviews. In addition, this section contains rules 
    regarding requests for expedited reviews by noninvestigated exporters 
    in certain countervailing duty proceedings and procedures for 
    conducting such reviews.
    
    [[Page 27395]]
    
        (b) Request for new shipper review. (1) Requirement of sale or 
    export. Subject to the requirements of section 751(a)(2)(B) of the Act 
    and this section, an exporter or producer may request a new shipper 
    review if it has exported, or sold for export, subject merchandise to 
    the United States.
        (2) Contents of request. A request for a new shipper review must 
    contain the following:
        (i) If the person requesting the review is both the exporter and 
    producer of the merchandise, a certification that the person requesting 
    the review did not export subject merchandise to the United States (or, 
    in the case of a regional industry, did not export the subject 
    merchandise for sale in the region concerned) during the period of 
    investigation;
        (ii) If the person requesting the review is the exporter, but not 
    the producer, of the subject merchandise:
        (A) The certification described in paragraph (b)(2)(i) of this 
    section; and
        (B) A certification from the person that produced or supplied the 
    subject merchandise to the person requesting the review that that 
    producer or supplier did not export the subject merchandise to the 
    United States (or, in the case of a regional industry, did not export 
    the subject merchandise for sale in the region concerned) during the 
    period of investigation;
        (iii)(A) A certification that, since the investigation was 
    initiated, such exporter or producer has never been affiliated with any 
    exporter or producer who exported the subject merchandise to the United 
    States (or in the case of a regional industry, who exported the subject 
    merchandise for sale in the region concerned) during the period of 
    investigation, including those not individually examined during the 
    investigation;
        (B) In an antidumping proceeding involving imports from a nonmarket 
    economy country, a certification that the export activities of such 
    exporter or producer are not controlled by the central government;
        (iv) Documentation establishing:
        (A) The date on which subject merchandise of the exporter or 
    producer making the request was first entered, or withdrawn from 
    warehouse, for consumption, or, if the exporter or producer cannot 
    establish the date of first entry, the date on which the exporter or 
    producer first shipped the subject merchandise for export to the United 
    States;
        (B) The volume of that and subsequent shipments; and
        (C) The date of the first sale to an unaffiliated customer in the 
    United States; and
        (v) In the case of a review of a countervailing duty order, a 
    certification that the exporter or producer has informed the government 
    of the exporting country that the government will be required to 
    provide a full response to the Department's questionnaire.
        (c) Deadline for requesting review. An exporter or producer may 
    request a new shipper review within one year of the date referred to in 
    paragraph (b)(2)(iv)(A) of this section.
        (d) Time for new shipper review. (1) In general. The Secretary will 
    initiate a new shipper review under this section in the calendar month 
    immediately following the anniversary month or the semiannual 
    anniversary month if the request for the review is made during the 6-
    month period ending with the end of the anniversary month or the 
    semiannual anniversary month (whichever is applicable).
        (2) Semiannual anniversary month. The semiannual anniversary month 
    is the calendar month which is 6 months after the anniversary month.
        (3) Example. An order is published in January. The anniversary 
    month would be January, and the semiannual anniversary month would be 
    July. If the Secretary received a request for a new shipper review at 
    any time during the period February-July, the Secretary would initiate 
    a new shipper review in August. If the Secretary received a request for 
    a new shipper review at any time during the period August-January, the 
    Secretary would initiate a new shipper review in February.
        (e) Suspension of liquidation; posting bond or security. When the 
    Secretary initiates a new shipper review under this section, the 
    Secretary will direct the Customs Service to suspend liquidation of any 
    unliquidated entries of the subject merchandise from the relevant 
    exporter or producer, and to allow, at the option of the importer, the 
    posting, until the completion of the review, of a bond or security in 
    lieu of a cash deposit for each entry of the subject merchandise.
        (f) Rescission of new shipper review. (1) Withdrawal of request for 
    review. The Secretary may rescind a new shipper review under this 
    section, in whole or in part, if a party that requested a review 
    withdraws its request not later than 60 days after the date of 
    publication of notice of initiation of the requested review.
        (2) Absence of entry and sale to an unaffiliated customer. The 
    Secretary may rescind a new shipper review, in whole or in part, if the 
    Secretary concludes that:
        (i) As of the end of the normal period of review referred to in 
    paragraph (g) of this section, there has not been an entry and sale to 
    an unaffiliated customer in the United States of subject merchandise; 
    and
        (ii) An expansion of the normal period of review to include an 
    entry and sale to an unaffiliated customer in the United States of 
    subject merchandise would be likely to prevent the completion of the 
    review within the time limits set forth in paragraph (i) of this 
    section.
        (3) Notice of Rescission. If the Secretary rescinds a new shipper 
    review (in whole or in part), the Secretary will publish in the Federal 
    Register notice of ``Rescission of Antidumping (Countervailing Duty) 
    New Shipper Review'' or, if appropriate, ``Partial Rescission of 
    Antidumping (Countervailing Duty) New Shipper Review.''
        (g) Period of review. (1) Antidumping proceeding. (i) In general. 
    Except as provided in paragraph (g)(1)(ii) of this section, in an 
    antidumping proceeding, a new shipper review under this section 
    normally will cover, as appropriate, entries, exports, or sales during 
    the following time periods:
        (A) If the new shipper review was initiated in the month 
    immediately following the anniversary month, the twelve-month period 
    immediately preceding the anniversary month; or
        (B) If the new shipper review was initiated in the month 
    immediately following the semiannual anniversary month, the period of 
    review will be the six-month period immediately preceding the 
    semiannual anniversary month.
        (ii) Exceptions. (A) If the Secretary initiates a new shipper 
    review under this section in the month immediately following the first 
    anniversary month, the review normally will cover, as appropriate, 
    entries, exports, or sales during the period from the date of 
    suspension of liquidation under this part to the end of the month 
    immediately preceding the first anniversary month.
        (B) If the Secretary initiates a new shipper review under this 
    section in the month immediately following the first semiannual 
    anniversary month, the review normally will cover, as appropriate, 
    entries, exports, or sales during the period from the date of 
    suspension of liquidation under this part to the end of the month 
    immediately preceding the first semiannual anniversary month.
    
    [[Page 27396]]
    
        (2) Countervailing duty proceeding. In a countervailing duty 
    proceeding, the period of review for a new shipper review under this 
    section will be the same period as that specified in Sec. 351.213(e)(2) 
    for an administrative review.
        (h) Procedures. The Secretary will conduct a new shipper review 
    under this section in accordance with Sec. 351.221.
        (i) Time limits. (1) In general. Unless the time limit is waived 
    under paragraph (j)(3) of this section, the Secretary will issue 
    preliminary results of review (see Sec. 351.221(b)(4)) within 180 days 
    after the date on which the new shipper review was initiated, and final 
    results of review (see Sec. 351.221(b)(5)) within 90 days after the 
    date on which the preliminary results were issued.
        (2) Exception. If the Secretary concludes that a new shipper review 
    is extraordinarily complicated, the Secretary may extend the 180-day 
    period to 300 days, and may extend the 90-day period to 150 days.
        (j) Multiple reviews. Notwithstanding any other provision of this 
    subpart, if a review (or a request for a review) under Sec. 351.213 
    (administrative review), Sec. 351.214 (new shipper review), 
    Sec. 351.215 (expedited antidumping review), or Sec. 351.216 (changed 
    circumstances review) covers merchandise of an exporter or producer 
    subject to a review (or to a request for a review) under this section, 
    the Secretary may, after consulting with the exporter or producer:
        (1) Rescind, in whole or in part, a review in progress under this 
    subpart;
        (2) Decline to initiate, in whole or in part, a review under this 
    subpart; or
        (3) Where the requesting party agrees in writing to waive the time 
    limits of paragraph (i) of this section, conduct concurrent reviews, in 
    which case all other provisions of this section will continue to apply 
    with respect to the exporter or producer.
        (k) Expedited reviews in countervailing duty proceedings for 
    noninvestigated exporters. (1) Request for review. If, in a 
    countervailing duty investigation, the Secretary limited the number of 
    exporters or producers to be individually examined under section 
    777A(e)(2)(A) of the Act, an exporter that the Secretary did not select 
    for individual examination or that the Secretary did not accept as a 
    voluntary respondent (see Sec. 351.204(d)) may request a review under 
    this paragraph (k). An exporter must submit a request for review within 
    30 days of the date of publication in the Federal Register of the 
    countervailing duty order. A request must be accompanied by a 
    certification that:
        (i) The requester exported the subject merchandise to the United 
    States during the period of investigation;
        (ii) The requester is not affiliated with an exporter or producer 
    that the Secretary individually examined in the investigation; and
        (iii) The requester has informed the government of the exporting 
    country that the government will be required to provide a full response 
    to the Department's questionnaire.
        (2) Initiation of review. (i) In general. The Secretary will 
    initiate a review in the month following the month in which a request 
    for review is due under paragraph (k)(1) of this section.
        (ii) Example. The Secretary publishes a countervailing duty order 
    on January 15. An exporter would have to submit a request for a review 
    by February 14. The Secretary would initiate a review in March.
        (3) Conduct of review. The Secretary will conduct a review under 
    this paragraph (k) in accordance with the provisions of this section 
    applicable to new shipper reviews, subject to the following exceptions:
        (i) The period of review will be the period of investigation used 
    by the Secretary in the investigation that resulted in the publication 
    of the countervailing duty order (see Sec. 351.204(b)(2));
        (ii) The Secretary will not permit the posting of a bond or 
    security in lieu of a cash deposit under paragraph (e) of this section;
        (iii) The final results of a review under this paragraph (k) will 
    not be the basis for the assessment of countervailing duties; and
        (iv) The Secretary may exclude from the countervailing duty order 
    in question any exporter for which the Secretary determines an 
    individual net countervailable subsidy rate of zero or de minimis (see 
    Sec. 351.204(e)(1)), provided that the Secretary has verified the 
    information on which the exclusion is based.
        (l) Exception from assessment in regional industry cases. For 
    procedures relating to a request for the exception from the assessment 
    of antidumping or countervailing duties in a regional industry case, 
    see Sec. 351.212(f).
    
    
    Sec. 351.215  Expedited antidumping review and security in lieu of 
    estimated duty under section 736(c) of the Act.
    
        (a) Introduction. Exporters and producers individually examined in 
    an investigation normally cannot obtain a review of entries until an 
    administrative review is requested. In addition, when an antidumping 
    order is published, importers normally must begin to make a cash 
    deposit of estimated antidumping duties upon the entry of subject 
    merchandise. Section 736(c), however, establishes a special procedure 
    under which exporters or producers may request an expedited review, and 
    bonds, rather than cash deposits, may continue to be posted for a 
    limited period of time if several criteria are satisfied. This section 
    contains rules regarding requests for expedited antidumping reviews and 
    the procedures applicable to such reviews.
        (b) In general. If the Secretary determines that the criteria of 
    section 736(c)(1) of the Act are satisfied, the Secretary:
        (1) May permit, for not more than 90 days after the date of 
    publication of an antidumping order, the posting of a bond or other 
    security instead of the deposit of estimated antidumping duties 
    required under section 736(a)(3) of the Act; and
        (2) Will initiate an expedited antidumping review. Before making 
    such a determination, the Secretary will make business proprietary 
    information available, and will provide interested parties with an 
    opportunity to file written comments, in accordance with section 
    736(c)(4) of the Act.
        (c) Procedures. The Secretary will conduct an expedited antidumping 
    review under this section in accordance with Sec. 351.221.
    
    
    Sec. 351.216  Changed circumstances review under section 751(b) of the 
    Act.
    
        (a) Introduction. Section 751(b) of the Act provides for what is 
    known as a ``changed circumstances'' review. This section contains 
    rules regarding requests for changed circumstances reviews and 
    procedures for conducting such reviews.
        (b) Requests for changed circumstances review. At any time, an 
    interested party may request a changed circumstances review, under 
    section 751(b) of the Act, of an order or a suspended investigation. 
    Within 45 days after the date on which a request is filed, the 
    Secretary will determine whether to initiate a changed circumstances 
    review.
        (c) Limitation on changed circumstances review. Unless the 
    Secretary finds that good cause exists, the Secretary will not review a 
    final determination in an investigation (see section 705(a) or section 
    735(a) of the Act) or a suspended investigation (see section 704 or 
    section 734 of the Act) less than 24 months after the date of 
    publication of notice of the final determination or the suspension of 
    the investigation.
    
    [[Page 27397]]
    
        (d) Procedures. If the Secretary decides that changed circumstances 
    sufficient to warrant a review exist, the Secretary will conduct a 
    changed circumstances review in accordance with Sec. 351.221.
        (e) Time limits. The Secretary will issue final results of review 
    (see Sec. 351.221(b)(5)) within 270 days after the date on which the 
    changed circumstances review is initiated, or within 45 days if all 
    parties to the proceeding agree to the outcome of the review.
    
    
    Sec. 351.217  Reviews to implement results of subsidies enforcement 
    proceeding under section 751(g) of the Act.
    
        (a) Introduction. Section 751(g) provides a mechanism for 
    incorporating into an ongoing countervailing duty proceeding the 
    results of certain subsidy-related disputes under the WTO Subsidies 
    Agreement. Where the United States, in the WTO, has successfully 
    challenged the ``nonactionable'' (e.g., noncountervailable) status of a 
    foreign subsidy, or where the United States has successfully challenged 
    a prohibited or actionable subsidy, the Secretary may conduct a review 
    to determine the effect, if any, of the successful outcome on an 
    existing countervailing duty order or suspended investigation. This 
    section contains rules regarding the initiation and conduct of reviews 
    under section 751(g).
        (b) Violations of Article 8 of the Subsidies Agreement. If:
        (1) The Secretary receives notice from the Trade Representative of 
    a violation of Article 8 of the Subsidies Agreement;
        (2) The Secretary has reason to believe that merchandise subject to 
    an existing countervailing duty order or suspended investigation is 
    benefiting from the subsidy or subsidy program found to have been in 
    violation of Article 8; and
        (3) No administrative review is in progress, the Secretary will 
    initiate an Article 8 violation review of the order or suspended 
    investigation to determine whether the subject merchandise benefits 
    from the subsidy or subsidy program found to have been in violation of 
    Article 8 of the Subsidies Agreement.
        (c) Withdrawal of subsidy or imposition of countermeasures. If the 
    Trade Representative notifies the Secretary that, under Article 4 or 
    Article 7 of the Subsidies Agreement:
        (1)(i)(A) The United States has imposed countermeasures; and
        (B) Such countermeasures are based on the effects in the United 
    States of imports of merchandise that is the subject of a 
    countervailing duty order; or
        (ii) A WTO member country has withdrawn a countervailable subsidy 
    provided with respect to merchandise subject to a countervailing duty 
    order, then
        (2) The Secretary will initiate an Article 4/Article 7 review of 
    the order to determine if the amount of estimated duty to be deposited 
    should be adjusted or the order should be revoked.
        (d) Procedures. The Secretary will conduct an Article 8 violation 
    review or an Article 4/Article 7 review under this section in 
    accordance with Sec. 351.221.
        (e) Expedited reviews. The Secretary will conduct reviews under 
    this section on an expedited basis.
    
    
    Sec. 351.218  Sunset reviews under section 751(c) of the Act.
    
        (a) Introduction. The URAA added a new procedure, commonly referred 
    to as ``sunset reviews,'' in section 751(c) of the Act. In general, no 
    later than once every five years, the Secretary must determine whether 
    dumping or countervailable subsidies would be likely to continue or 
    resume if an order were revoked or a suspended investigation were 
    terminated. The Commission must conduct a similar review to determine 
    whether injury would be likely to continue or resume in the absence of 
    an order or suspended investigation. If the determinations under 
    section 751(c) of both the Secretary and the Commission are 
    affirmative, the order (or suspended investigation) remains in place. 
    If either determination is negative, the order will be revoked (or the 
    suspended investigation will be terminated). This section contains 
    rules regarding the procedures for sunset reviews.
        (b) In general. The Secretary will conduct a sunset review, under 
    section 751(c) of the Act, of each antidumping and countervailing duty 
    order and suspended investigation, and, under section 752(b) or section 
    752(c) (whichever is applicable), will determine whether revocation of 
    an antidumping or countervailing duty order or termination of a 
    suspended investigation would be likely to lead to continuation or 
    recurrence of dumping or a countervailable subsidy.
        (c) Notice of initiation of review; early initiation. (1) Initial 
    sunset review. No later than 30 days before the fifth anniversary date 
    of an order or suspension of an investigation (see section 751(c)(1) of 
    the Act), the Secretary will publish a notice of initiation of a sunset 
    review (see section 751(c)(2) of the Act).
        (2) Subsequent sunset reviews. In the case of an order or suspended 
    investigation that is continued following a sunset review initiated 
    under paragraph (c)(1) of this section, no later than 30 days before 
    the fifth anniversary of the date of the last determination by the 
    Commission to continue the order or suspended investigation, the 
    Secretary will publish a notice of initiation of a sunset review (see 
    section 751(c)(2) of the Act).
        (3) Early initiation. The Secretary may publish a notice of 
    initiation at an earlier date than the dates described in paragraph (c) 
    (1) and (2) of this section if a domestic interested party demonstrates 
    to the Secretary's satisfaction that an early initiation would promote 
    administrative efficiency. However, if the Secretary determines that 
    the domestic interested party that requested early initiation is a 
    related party or an importer under section 771(4)(B) of the Act and 
    Sec. 351.203(e)(4), the Secretary may decline the request for early 
    initiation.
        (4) Transition orders. The Secretary will initiate sunset reviews 
    of transition orders, as defined in section 751(c)(6)(C) of the Act, in 
    accordance with section 751(c)(6) of the Act.
        (d) Conduct of review. Upon receipt of responses to the notice of 
    initiation that the Secretary deems adequate to conduct a sunset 
    review, the Secretary will conduct a sunset review in accordance with 
    Sec. 351.221.
        (e) Time limits. (1) In general. Unless the review has been 
    completed under section 751(c)(3) of the Act (no or inadequate 
    response) or, under section 751(c)(4)(B) of the Act, all respondent 
    interested parties waived their participation in the Secretary's sunset 
    review, the Secretary will issue final results of review within 240 
    days after the date on which the review was initiated. If the Secretary 
    concludes that the sunset review is extraordinarily complicated (see 
    section 751(c)(5)(C) of the Act), the Secretary may extend the period 
    for issuing final results by not more than 90 days.
        (2) Transition orders. The time limits described in paragraph 
    (e)(1) of this section will not apply to a sunset review of a 
    transition order (see section 751(c)(6) of the Act).
    
    
    Sec. 351.219  Reviews of countervailing duty orders in connection with 
    an investigation under section 753 of the Act.
    
        (a) Introduction. Section 753 of the Act is a transition provision 
    for countervailing duty orders that were issued under section 303 of 
    the Act without an injury determination by the Commission. Under the 
    Subsidies Agreement, one country may not impose countervailing duties 
    on imports from another WTO Member without first
    
    [[Page 27398]]
    
    making a determination that such imports have caused injury to a 
    domestic industry. Section 753 provides a mechanism for providing an 
    injury test with respect to those ``no-injury'' orders under section 
    303 that apply to merchandise from WTO Members. This section contains 
    rules regarding requests for section 753 investigations by a domestic 
    interested party; and the procedures that the Department will follow in 
    reviewing a countervailing duty order and providing the Commission with 
    advice regarding the amount and nature of a countervailable subsidy.
        (b) Notification of domestic interested parties. The Secretary will 
    notify directly domestic interested parties as soon as possible after 
    the opportunity arises for requesting an investigation by the 
    Commission under section 753 of the Act.
        (c) Initiation and conduct of section 753 review. Where the 
    Secretary deems it necessary in order to provide to the Commission 
    information on the amount or nature of a countervailable subsidy (see 
    section 753(b)(2) of the Act), the Secretary may initiate a section 753 
    review of the countervailing duty order in question. The Secretary will 
    conduct a section 753 review in accordance with Sec. 351.221.
    
    
    Sec. 351.220  Countervailing duty review at the direction of the 
    President under section 762 of the Act.
    
        At the direction of the President or a designee, the Secretary will 
    conduct a review under section 762(a)(1) of the Act to determine if a 
    countervailable subsidy is being provided with respect to merchandise 
    subject to an understanding or other kind of quantitative restriction 
    agreement accepted under section 704(a)(2) or section 704(c)(3) of the 
    Act. The Secretary will conduct a review under this section in 
    accordance with Sec. 351.221. If the Secretary's final results of 
    review under this section and the Commission's final results of review 
    under section 762(a)(2) of the Act are both affirmative, the Secretary 
    will issue a countervailing duty order and order suspension of 
    liquidation in accordance with section 762(b) of the Act.
    
    
    Sec. 351.221  Review procedures.
    
        (a) Introduction. The procedures for reviews are similar to those 
    followed in investigations. This section details the procedures 
    applicable to reviews in general, as well as procedures that are unique 
    to certain types of reviews.
        (b) In general. After receipt of a timely request for a review, or 
    on the Secretary's own initiative when appropriate, the Secretary will:
        (1) Promptly publish in the Federal Register notice of initiation 
    of the review;
        (2) Before or after publication of notice of initiation of the 
    review, send to appropriate interested parties or other persons (or, if 
    appropriate, a sample of interested parties or other persons) 
    questionnaires requesting factual information for the review;
        (3) Conduct, if appropriate, a verification under Sec. 351.307;
        (4) Issue preliminary results of review, based on the available 
    information, and publish in the Federal Register notice of the 
    preliminary results of review that include:
        (i) the rates determined, if the review involved the determination 
    of rates; and
        (ii) an invitation for argument consistent with Sec. 351.309;
        (5) Issue final results of review and publish in the Federal 
    Register notice of the final results of review that include the rates 
    determined, if the review involved the determination of rates;
        (6) If the type of review in question involves a determination as 
    to the amount of duties to be assessed, promptly after publication of 
    the notice of final results instruct the Customs Service to assess 
    antidumping duties or countervailing duties (whichever is applicable) 
    on the subject merchandise covered by the review, except as otherwise 
    provided in Sec. 351.106(c) with respect to de minimis duties; and
        (7) If the review involves a revision to the cash deposit rates for 
    estimated antidumping duties or countervailing duties, instruct the 
    Customs Service to collect cash deposits at the revised rates on future 
    entries.
        (c) Special rules. (1) Administrative reviews and new shipper 
    reviews. In an administrative review under section 751(a)(1) of the Act 
    and Sec. 351.213 and a new shipper review under section 751(a)(2)(B) of 
    the Act and Sec. 351.214 the Secretary:
        (i) Will publish the notice of initiation of the review no later 
    than the last day of the month following the anniversary month or the 
    semiannual anniversary month (as the case may be); and
        (ii) Normally will send questionnaires no later than 30 days after 
    the date of publication of the notice of initiation.
        (2) Expedited antidumping review. In an expedited antidumping 
    review under section 736(c) of the Act and Sec. 351.215, the Secretary:
        (i) Will include in the notice of initiation of the review an 
    invitation for argument consistent with Sec. 351.309, and a statement 
    that the Secretary is permitting the posting of a bond or other 
    security instead of a cash deposit of estimated antidumping duties;
        (ii) Will instruct the Customs Service to accept, instead of the 
    cash deposit of estimated antidumping duties under section 736(a)(3) of 
    the Act, a bond for each entry of the subject merchandise entered, or 
    withdrawn from warehouse, for consumption on or after the date of 
    publication of the notice of initiation of the investigation and 
    through the date not later than 90 days after the date of publication 
    of the order; and
        (iii) Will not issue preliminary results of review.
        (3) Changed circumstances review. In a changed circumstances review 
    under section 751(b) of the Act and Sec. 351.216, the Secretary:
        (i) Will include in the preliminary results of review and the final 
    results of review a description of any action the Secretary proposed 
    based on the preliminary or final results;
        (ii) May combine the notice of initiation of the review and the 
    preliminary results of review in a single notice if the Secretary 
    concludes that expedited action is warranted; and
        (iii) May refrain from issuing questionnaires under paragraph 
    (b)(2) of this section.
        (4) Article 8 Violation review and Article 4/Article 7 review. In 
    an Article 8 Violation review or an Article 4/Article 7 review under 
    section 751(g) of the Act and Sec. 351.217, the Secretary:
        (i) Will include in the notice of initiation of the review an 
    invitation for argument consistent with Sec. 351.309 and will notify 
    all parties to the proceeding at the time the Secretary initiates the 
    review;
        (ii) Will not issue preliminary results of review; and
        (iii) In the final results of review will indicate the amount, if 
    any, by which the estimated duty to be deposited should be adjusted, 
    and, in an Article 4/Article 7 review, any action, including 
    revocation, that the Secretary will take based on the final results.
        (5) Sunset review. In a sunset review under section 751(c) of the 
    Act and Sec. 351.218:
        (i) The notice of initiation of the review will contain a request 
    for the information described in section 751(c)(2) of the Act; and
        (ii) The Secretary, without issuing preliminary results of review, 
    may issue final results of review under paragraphs (3) or (4) of 
    subsection 751(c) of the Act if the conditions of those paragraphs are 
    satisfied.
        (6) Section 753 review. In a section 753 review under section 753 
    of the Act and Sec. 351.219, the Secretary:
    
    [[Page 27399]]
    
        (i) Will include in the notice of initiation of the review an 
    invitation for argument consistent with Sec. 351.309, and will notify 
    all parties to the proceeding at the time the Secretary initiates the 
    review; and
        (ii) May decline to issue preliminary results of review.
        (7) Countervailing duty review at the direction of the President. 
    In a countervailing duty review at the direction of the President under 
    section 762 of the Act and Sec. 351.220, the Secretary will:
        (i) Include in the notice of initiation of the review a description 
    of the merchandise, the period under review, and a summary of the 
    available information which, if accurate, would support the imposition 
    of countervailing duties;
        (ii) Notify the Commission of the initiation of the review and the 
    preliminary results of review;
        (iii) Include in the preliminary results of review the 
    countervailable subsidy, if any, during the period of review and a 
    description of official changes in the subsidy programs made by the 
    government of the affected country that affect the estimated 
    countervailable subsidy; and
        (iv) Include in the final results of review the countervailable 
    subsidy, if any, during the period of review and a description of 
    official changes in the subsidy programs, made by the government of the 
    affected country not later than the date of publication of the notice 
    of preliminary results, that affect the estimated countervailable 
    subsidy.
    
    
    Sec. 351.222  Revocation of orders; termination of suspended 
    investigations.
    
        (a) Introduction. ``Revocation'' is a term of art that refers to 
    the end of an antidumping or countervailing proceeding in which an 
    order has been issued. ``Termination'' is the companion term for the 
    end of a proceeding in which the investigation was suspended due to the 
    acceptance of a suspension agreement. Generally, a revocation or 
    termination may occur only after the Department or the Commission have 
    conducted one or more reviews under section 751 of the Act. This 
    section contains rules regarding requirements for a revocation or 
    termination; and procedures that the Department will follow in 
    determining whether to revoke an order or terminate a suspended 
    investigation.
        (b) Revocation or termination based on absence of dumping. (1) The 
    Secretary may revoke an antidumping order or terminate a suspended 
    antidumping investigation if the Secretary concludes that:
        (i) All exporters and producers covered at the time of revocation 
    by the order or the suspension agreement have sold the subject 
    merchandise at not less than normal value for a period of at least 
    three consecutive years; and
        (ii) It is not likely that those persons will in the future sell 
    the subject merchandise at less than normal value.
        (2) The Secretary may revoke an antidumping order in part if the 
    Secretary concludes that:
        (i) One or more exporters or producers covered by the order have 
    sold the merchandise at not less than normal value for a period of at 
    least three consecutive years;
        (ii) It is not likely that those persons will in the future sell 
    the subject merchandise at less than normal value; and
        (iii) For any exporter or producer that the Secretary previously 
    has determined to have sold the subject merchandise at less than normal 
    value, the exporter or producer agrees in writing to its immediate 
    reinstatement in the order, as long as any exporter or producer is 
    subject to the order, if the Secretary concludes that the exporter or 
    producer, subsequent to the revocation, sold the subject merchandise at 
    less than normal value.
        (3) Revocation of nonproducing exporter. In the case of an exporter 
    that is not the producer of subject merchandise, the Secretary normally 
    will revoke an order in part under paragraph (b)(2) of this section 
    only with respect to subject merchandise produced or supplied by those 
    companies that supplied the exporter during the time period that formed 
    the basis for the revocation.
        (c) Revocation or termination based on absence of countervailable 
    subsidy. (1) The Secretary may revoke a countervailing duty order or 
    terminate a suspended countervailing duty investigation if the 
    Secretary concludes that:
        (i) The government of the affected country has eliminated all 
    countervailable subsidies on the subject merchandise by abolishing for 
    the subject merchandise, for a period of at least three consecutive 
    years, all programs that the Secretary has found countervailable;
        (ii) It is not likely that the government of the affected country 
    will in the future reinstate for the subject merchandise those programs 
    or substitute other countervailable programs; and
        (iii) Exporters and producers of the subject merchandise are not 
    continuing to receive any net countervailable subsidy from an abolished 
    program referred to in paragraph (c)(1)(i) of this section.
        (2) The Secretary may revoke a countervailing duty order or 
    terminate a suspended countervailing duty investigation if the 
    Secretary concludes that:
        (i) All exporters and producers covered at the time of revocation 
    by the order or the suspension agreement have not applied for or 
    received any net countervailable subsidy on the subject merchandise for 
    a period of at least five consecutive years; and
        (ii) It is not likely that those persons will in the future apply 
    for or receive any net countervailable subsidy on the subject 
    merchandise from those programs the Secretary has found countervailable 
    in any proceeding involving the affected country or from other 
    countervailable programs.
        (3) The Secretary may revoke a countervailing duty order in part if 
    the Secretary concludes that:
        (i) One or more exporters or producers covered by the order have 
    not applied for or received any net countervailable subsidy on the 
    subject merchandise for a period of at least five consecutive years;
        (ii) It is not likely that those persons will in the future apply 
    for or receive any net countervailable subsidy on the subject 
    merchandise from those programs the Secretary has found countervailable 
    in any proceeding involving the affected country or from other 
    countervailable programs; and
        (iii) Except for exporters or producers that the Secretary 
    previously has determined have not received any net countervailable 
    subsidy on the subject merchandise, the exporters or producers agree in 
    writing to their immediate reinstatement in the order, as long as any 
    exporter or producer is subject to the order, if the Secretary 
    concludes that the exporter or producer, subsequent to the revocation, 
    has received any net countervailable subsidy on the subject 
    merchandise.
        (4) Revocation of nonproducing exporter. In the case of an exporter 
    that is not the producer of subject merchandise, the Secretary normally 
    will revoke an order in part under paragraph (c)(3) of this section 
    only with respect to subject merchandise produced or supplied by those 
    companies that supplied the exporter during the time period that formed 
    the basis for the revocation.
        (d) Treatment of unreviewed intervening years. (1) In general. The 
    Secretary will not revoke an order or terminate a suspended 
    investigation under paragraphs (b) or (c) of this section unless the 
    Secretary has
    
    [[Page 27400]]
    
    conducted a review under this subpart of the first and third (or fifth) 
    years of the three-and five-year consecutive time periods referred to 
    in those paragraphs. The Secretary need not have conducted a review of 
    an intervening year (see paragraph (d)(2) of this section). However, 
    except in the case of a revocation or termination under paragraph 
    (c)(1) of this section (government abolition of countervailable subsidy 
    programs), before revoking an order or terminating a suspended 
    investigation, the Secretary must be satisfied that, during each of the 
    three (or five) years, there were exports to the United States in 
    commercial quantities of the subject merchandise to which a revocation 
    or termination will apply.
        (2) Intervening year. ``Intervening year'' means any year between 
    the first and final year of the consecutive period on which revocation 
    or termination is conditioned.
        (e) Request for revocation or termination. (1) Antidumping 
    proceeding. During the third and subsequent annual anniversary months 
    of the publication of an antidumping order or suspension of an 
    antidumping investigation, an exporter or producer may request in 
    writing that the Secretary revoke an order or terminate a suspended 
    investigation under paragraph (b) of this section with regard to that 
    person if the person submits with the request:
        (i) The person's certification that the person sold the subject 
    merchandise at not less than normal value during the period of review 
    described in Sec. 351.213(e)(1), and that in the future the person will 
    not sell the merchandise at less than normal value;
        (ii) the person's certification that, during each of the 
    consecutive years referred to in paragraph (b) of this section, the 
    person sold the subject merchandise to the United States in commercial 
    quantities; and
        (iii) If applicable, the agreement regarding reinstatement in the 
    order or suspended investigation described in paragraph (b)(2)(iii) of 
    this section.
        (2) Countervailing duty proceeding. (i) During the third and 
    subsequent annual anniversary months of the publication of a 
    countervailing duty order or suspension of a countervailing duty 
    investigation, the government of the affected country may request in 
    writing that the Secretary revoke an order or terminate a suspended 
    investigation under paragraph (c)(1) of this section if the government 
    submits with the request its certification that it has satisfied, 
    during the period of review described in Sec. 351.213(e)(2), the 
    requirements of paragraph (c)(1)(i) of this section regarding the 
    abolition of countervailable subsidy programs, and that it will not 
    reinstate for the subject merchandise those programs or substitute 
    other countervailable subsidy programs;
        (ii) During the fifth and subsequent annual anniversary months of 
    the publication of a countervailing duty order or suspended 
    countervailing duty investigation, the government of the affected 
    country may request in writing that the Secretary revoke an order or 
    terminate a suspended investigation under paragraph (c)(2) of this 
    section if the government submits with the request:
        (A) Certifications for all exporters and producers covered by the 
    order or suspension agreement that they have not applied for or 
    received any net countervailable subsidy on the subject merchandise for 
    a period of at least five consecutive years (see paragraph (c)(2)(i) of 
    this section);
        (B) Those exporters' and producers' certifications that they will 
    not apply for or receive any net countervailable subsidy on the subject 
    merchandise from any program the Secretary has found countervailable in 
    any proceeding involving the affected country or from other 
    countervailable programs (see paragraph (c)(2)(ii) of this section); 
    and
        (C) A certification from each exporter or producer that, during 
    each of the consecutive years referred to in paragraph (c)(2) of this 
    section, that person sold the subject merchandise to the United States 
    in commercial quantities; or
        (iii) During the fifth and subsequent annual anniversary months of 
    the publication of a countervailing duty order, an exporter or producer 
    may request in writing that the Secretary revoke the order with regard 
    to that person if the person submits with the request:
        (A) A certification that the person has not applied for or received 
    any net countervailable subsidy on the subject merchandise for a period 
    of at least five consecutive years (see paragraph (c)(3)(i) of this 
    section), including calculations demonstrating the basis for the 
    conclusion that the person received zero or de minimis net 
    countervailable subsidies during the review period of the 
    administrative review in connection with which the person has submitted 
    the request for revocation;
        (B) A certification that the person will not apply for or receive 
    any net countervailable subsidy on the subject merchandise from any 
    program the Secretary has found countervailable in any proceeding 
    involving the affected country or from other countervailable programs 
    (see paragraph (c)(3)(ii) of this section);
        (C) The person's certification that, during each of the consecutive 
    years referred to in paragraph (c)(3) of this section, the person sold 
    the subject merchandise to the United States in commercial quantities; 
    and
        (D) The agreement described in paragraph (c)(3)(iii) of this 
    section (reinstatement in order).
        (f) Procedures. (1) Upon receipt of a timely request for revocation 
    or termination under paragraph (e) of this section, the Secretary will 
    consider the request as including a request for an administrative 
    review and will initiate and conduct a review under Sec. 351.213.
        (2) In addition to the requirements of Sec. 351.221 regarding the 
    conduct of an administrative review, the Secretary will:
        (i) Publish with the notice of initiation under Sec. 351.221(b)(1), 
    notice of ``Request for Revocation of Order (in part)'' or ``Request 
    for Termination of Suspended Investigation'' (whichever is applicable);
        (ii) Conduct a verification under Sec. 351.307;
        (iii) Include in the preliminary results of review under 
    Sec. 351.221(b)(4) the Secretary's decision whether there is a 
    reasonable basis to believe that the requirements for revocation or 
    termination are met;
        (iv) If the Secretary decides that there is a reasonable basis to 
    believe that the requirements for revocation or termination are met, 
    publish with the notice of preliminary results of review under 
    Sec. 351.221(b)(4) notice of ``Intent to Revoke Order (in Part)'' or 
    ``Intent to Terminate Suspended Investigation'' (whichever is 
    applicable);
        (v) Include in the final results of review under Sec. 351.221(b)(5) 
    the Secretary's final decision whether the requirements for revocation 
    or termination are met; and
        (vi) If the Secretary determines that the requirements for 
    revocation or termination are met, publish with the notice of final 
    results of review under Sec. 351.221(b)(5) notice of ``Revocation of 
    Order (in Part)'' or ``Termination of Suspended Investigation'' 
    (whichever is applicable).
        (3) If the Secretary revokes an order in whole or in part, the 
    Secretary will order the suspension of liquidation terminated for the 
    merchandise covered by the revocation on the first day after the period 
    under review, and will instruct the Customs Service to release any cash 
    deposit or bond.
        (g) Revocation or termination based on changed circumstances. (1) 
    The
    
    [[Page 27401]]
    
    Secretary may revoke an order, in whole or in part, or terminate a 
    suspended investigation if the Secretary concludes that:
        (i) Producers accounting for substantially all of the production of 
    the domestic like product to which the order (or the part of the order 
    to be revoked) or suspended investigation pertains have expressed a 
    lack of interest in the order, in whole or in part, or suspended 
    investigation (see section 782(h) of the Act); or
        (ii) Other changed circumstances sufficient to warrant revocation 
    or termination exist.
        (2) If at any time the Secretary concludes from the available 
    information that changed circumstances sufficient to warrant revocation 
    or termination may exist, the Secretary will conduct a changed 
    circumstances review under Sec. 351.216.
        (3) In addition to the requirements of Sec. 351.221, the Secretary 
    will:
        (i) Publish with the notice of initiation (see Sec. 353.221(b)(1), 
    notice of ``Consideration of Revocation of Order (in Part)'' or 
    ``Consideration of Termination of Suspended Investigation'' (whichever 
    is applicable);
        (ii) If the Secretary's conclusion regarding the possible existence 
    of changed circumstances (see paragraph (g)(2) of this section), is not 
    based on a request, the Secretary, not later than the date of 
    publication of the notice of ``Consideration of Revocation of Order (in 
    Part)'' or ``Consideration of Termination of Suspended Investigation'' 
    (whichever is applicable) (see paragraph (g)(3)(i) of this section), 
    will serve written notice of the consideration of revocation or 
    termination on each interested party listed on the Department's service 
    list and on any other person that the Secretary has reason to believe 
    is a domestic interested party;
        (iii) Conduct a verification, if appropriate, under Sec. 351.307;
        (iv) Include in the preliminary results of review, under 
    Sec. 351.221(b)(4), the Secretary's decision whether there is a 
    reasonable basis to believe that changed circumstances warrant 
    revocation or termination;
        (v) If the Secretary's preliminary decision is that changed 
    circumstances warrant revocation or termination, publish with the 
    notice of preliminary results of review, under Sec. 351.221(b)(4), 
    notice of ``Intent to Revoke Order (in Part)'' or ``Intent to Terminate 
    Suspended Investigation'' (whichever is applicable);
        (vi) Include in the final results of review, under 
    Sec. 351.221(b)(5), the Secretary's final decision whether changed 
    circumstances warrant revocation or termination; and
        (vii) If the Secretary's determines that changed circumstances 
    warrant revocation or termination, publish with the notice of final 
    results of review, under Sec. 351.221(b)(5), notice of ``Revocation of 
    Order (in Part)'' or ``Termination of Suspended Investigation'' 
    (whichever is applicable).
        (4) If the Secretary revokes an order, in whole or in part, under 
    paragraph (g) of this section, the Secretary will order the suspension 
    of liquidation ended for the merchandise covered by the revocation on 
    the effective date of the notice of revocation, and will instruct the 
    Customs Service to release any cash deposit or bond.
        (h) Revocation or termination based on injury reconsideration. If 
    the Commission determines in a changed circumstances review under 
    section 751(b)(2) of the Act that the revocation of an order or 
    termination of a suspended investigation is not likely to lead to 
    continuation or recurrence of material injury, the Secretary will 
    revoke, in whole or in part, the order or terminate the suspended 
    investigation, and will publish in the Federal Register notice of 
    ``Revocation of Order (in Part)'' or ``Termination of Suspended 
    Investigation'' (whichever is applicable).
        (i) Revocation or termination based on sunset review. (1) In 
    general. In the case of a sunset review under Sec. 351.218, the 
    Secretary will revoke an order or terminate a suspended investigation, 
    unless:
        (i) The Secretary makes a determination that revocation or 
    termination would be likely to lead to continuation or recurrence of a 
    countervailable subsidy or dumping (see section 752(b) and section 
    752(c) of the Act); and
        (ii) The Commission makes a determination that revocation or 
    termination would be likely to lead to continuation or recurrence of 
    material injury (see section 752(a) of the Act).
        (2) Exception for transition orders. Before January 1, 2000, the 
    Secretary will not revoke a transition order (see section 751(c)(6) of 
    the Act) as the result of a sunset review under Sec. 351.218.
        (j) Revocation of countervailing duty order based on Commission 
    negative determination under section 753 of the Act. The Secretary will 
    revoke a countervailing duty order, and will order the refund, with 
    interest, of any estimated countervailing duties collected during the 
    period liquidation was suspended under section 753(a)(4) of the Act 
    upon being notified by the Commission that:
        (1) The Commission has determined that an industry in the United 
    States is not likely to be materially injured if the countervailing 
    duty order in question is revoked (see section 753(a)(1) of the Act); 
    or
        (2) A domestic interested party did not make a timely request for 
    an investigation under section 753(a) of the Act (see section 753(a)(3) 
    of the Act).
        (k) Revocation based on Article 4/Article 7 review.
        (1) In general. The Secretary may revoke a countervailing duty 
    order, in whole or in part, following an Article 4/Article 7 review 
    under Sec. 351.217(c), due to the imposition of countermeasures by the 
    United States or the withdrawal of a countervailable subsidy by a WTO 
    member country (see section 751(g)(2) of the Act).
        (2) Additional Requirements. In addition to the requirements of 
    Sec. 351.221, if the Secretary determines to revoke an order as the 
    result of an Article 4/Article 7 review, the Secretary will:
        (i) Conduct a verification, if appropriate, under Sec. 351.307;
        (ii) Include in the final results of review, under 
    Sec. 351.221(b)(5), the Secretary's final decision whether the order 
    should be revoked;
        (iii) If the Secretary's final decision is that the order should be 
    revoked:
        (A) Determine the effective date of the revocation;
        (B) Publish with the notice of final results of review, under 
    Sec. 351.221(b)(5), a notice of ``Revocation of Order (in Part),'' that 
    will include the effective date of the revocation; and
        (C) Order any suspension of liquidation ended for merchandise 
    covered by the revocation that was entered on or after the effective 
    date of the revocation, and instruct the Customs Service to release any 
    cash deposit or bond.
        (l) Revocation under section 129. The Secretary may revoke an order 
    under section 129 of the URAA (implementation of WTO dispute 
    settlement).
        (m) Transition rule. In the case of time periods that, under 
    section 291(a)(2) of the URAA, are subject to review under the 
    provisions of the Act prior to its amendment by the URAA, and for 
    purposes of determining whether the three-or five-year requirements of 
    paragraphs (b) and (c) of this section are satisfied, the following 
    rules will apply:
        (1) Antidumping proceedings. The Secretary will consider sales at 
    not less than foreign market value to be equivalent to sales at not 
    less than normal value.
    
    [[Page 27402]]
    
        (2) Countervailing duty proceedings. The Secretary will consider 
    the absence of a subsidy, as defined in section 771(5) of the Act prior 
    to its amendment by the URAA, to be equivalent to the absence of a 
    countervailable subsidy, as defined in section 771(5) of the Act, as 
    amended by the URAA.
        (n) Cross-reference. For the treatment in a subsequent 
    investigation of business proprietary information submitted to the 
    Secretary in connection with a changed circumstances review under 
    Sec. 351.216 or a sunset review under Sec. 351.218 that results in the 
    revocation of an order (or termination of a suspended investigation), 
    see section 777(b)(3) of the Act.
    
    
    Sec. 351.223  Procedures for initiation of downstream product 
    monitoring.
    
        (a) Introduction. Section 780 of the Act establishes a mechanism 
    for monitoring imports of ``downstream products.'' In general, section 
    780 is aimed at situations where, following the issuance of an 
    antidumping or countervailing duty order on a product that is used as a 
    component in another product, exports to the United States of that 
    other (or ``downstream'') product increase. Although the Department is 
    responsible for determining whether trade in the downstream product 
    should be monitored, the Commission is responsible for conducting the 
    actual monitoring. The Commission must report the results of its 
    monitoring to the Department, and the Department must consider the 
    reports in determining whether to self-initiate an antidumping or 
    countervailing duty investigation on the downstream product. This 
    section contains rules regarding applications for the initiation of 
    downstream product monitoring and decisions regarding such 
    applications.
        (b) Contents of application. An application to designate a 
    downstream product for monitoring under section 780 of the Act must 
    contain the following information, to the extent reasonably available 
    to the applicant:
        (1) The name and address of the person requesting the monitoring 
    and a description of the article it produces which is the basis for 
    filing its application;
        (2) A detailed description of the downstream product in question;
        (3) A detailed description of the component product that is 
    incorporated into the downstream product, including the value of the 
    component part in relation to the value of the downstream product, and 
    the extent to which the component part has been substantially 
    transformed as a result of its incorporation into the downstream 
    product;
        (4) The name of the country of production of both the downstream 
    and component products and the name of any intermediate country from 
    which the merchandise is imported;
        (5) The name and address of all known producers of component parts 
    and downstream products in the relevant countries and a detailed 
    description of any relationship between such producers;
        (6) Whether the component part is already subject to monitoring to 
    aid in the enforcement of a bilateral arrangement within the meaning of 
    section 804 of the Trade and Tariff Act of 1984;
        (7) A list of all antidumping or countervailing duty investigations 
    that have been suspended, or antidumping or countervailing duty orders 
    that have been issued, on merchandise that is related to the component 
    part and that is manufactured in the same foreign country in which the 
    component part is manufactured;
        (8) A list of all antidumping or countervailing duty investigations 
    that have been suspended, or antidumping or countervailing duty orders 
    that have been issued, on merchandise that is manufactured or exported 
    by the manufacturer or exporter of the component part and that is 
    similar in description and use to the component part; and
        (9) The reasons for suspecting that the imposition of antidumping 
    or countervailing duties has resulted in a diversion of exports of the 
    component part into increased production and exportation to the United 
    States of the downstream product.
        (c) Determination of sufficiency of application. Within 14 days 
    after an application is filed under paragraph (b) of this section, the 
    Secretary will rule on the sufficiency of the application by making the 
    determinations described in section 780(a)(2) of the Act.
        (d) Notice of Determination. The Secretary will publish in the 
    Federal Register notice of each affirmative or negative ``monitoring'' 
    determination made under section 780(a)(2) of the Act, and if the 
    determination under section 780(a)(2)(A) of the Act and a determination 
    made under any clause of section 780(a)(2)(B) of the Act are 
    affirmative, will transmit to the Commission a copy of the 
    determination and the application. The Secretary will make available to 
    the Commission, and to its employees directly involved in the 
    monitoring, the information upon which the Secretary based the 
    initiation.
    
    
    Sec. 351.224  Disclosure of calculations and procedures for the 
    correction of ministerial errors.
    
        (a) Introduction. In the interests of transparency, the Department 
    has long had a practice of providing parties with the details of its 
    antidumping and countervailing duty calculations. This practice has 
    come to be referred to as a ``disclosure.'' This section contains rules 
    relating to requests for disclosure and procedures for correcting 
    ministerial errors.
        (b) Disclosure. The Secretary will disclose to a party to the 
    proceeding calculations performed, if any, in connection with a 
    preliminary determination under section 703(b) or section 733(b) of the 
    Act, a final determination under section 705(a) or section 735(a) of 
    the Act, and a final results of a review under section 736(c), section 
    751, or section 753 of the Act, normally within five days after the 
    date of any public announcement or, if there is no public announcement 
    of, within five days after the date of publication of, the preliminary 
    determination, final determination, or final results of review 
    (whichever is applicable). The Secretary will disclose to a party to 
    the proceeding calculations performed, if any, in connection with a 
    preliminary results of review under section 751 or section 753 of the 
    Act, normally not later than ten days after the date of the public 
    announcement of, or, if there is no public announcement, within five 
    days after the date of publication of, the preliminary results of 
    review.
        (c) Comments regarding ministerial errors. (1) In general. A party 
    to the proceeding to whom the Secretary has disclosed calculations 
    performed in connection with a preliminary determination may submit 
    comments concerning a significant ministerial error in such 
    calculations. A party to the proceeding to whom the Secretary has 
    disclosed calculations performed in connection with a final 
    determination or the final results of a review may submit comments 
    concerning any ministerial error in such calculations. Comments 
    concerning ministerial errors made in the preliminary results of a 
    review should be included in a party's case brief.
        (2) Time limits for submitting comments. A party to the proceeding 
    must file comments concerning ministerial errors within five days after 
    the earlier of:
        (i) The date on which the Secretary released disclosure documents 
    to that party; or
        (ii) The date on which the Secretary held a disclosure meeting with 
    that party.
    
    [[Page 27403]]
    
        (3) Replies to comments. Replies to comments submitted under 
    paragraph (c)(1) of this section must be filed within five days after 
    the date on which the comments were filed with the Secretary. The 
    Secretary will not consider replies to comments submitted in connection 
    with a preliminary determination.
        (4) Extensions. A party to the proceeding may request an extension 
    of the time limit for filing comments concerning a ministerial error in 
    a final determination or final results of review under Sec. 351.302(c) 
    within three days after the date of any public announcement, or, if 
    there is no public announcement, within five days after the date of 
    publication of the final determination or final results of review, as 
    applicable. The Secretary will not extend the time limit for filing 
    comments concerning a significant ministerial error in a preliminary 
    determination.
        (d) Contents of comments and replies. Comments filed under 
    paragraph (c)(1) of this section must explain the alleged ministerial 
    error by reference to applicable evidence in the official record, and 
    must present what, in the party's view, is the appropriate correction. 
    In addition, comments concerning a preliminary determination must 
    demonstrate how the alleged ministerial error is significant (see 
    paragraph (g) of this section) by illustrating the effect on individual 
    weighted-average dumping margin or countervailable subsidy rate, the 
    all-others rate, or the country-wide subsidy rate (whichever is 
    applicable). Replies to any comments must be limited to issues raised 
    in such comments.
        (e) Corrections. The Secretary will analyze any comments received 
    and, if appropriate, correct any significant ministerial error by 
    amending the preliminary determination, or correct any ministerial 
    error by amending the final determination or the final results of 
    review (whichever is applicable). Where practicable, the Secretary will 
    announce publicly the issuance of a correction notice, and normally 
    will do so within 30 days after the date of public announcement, or, if 
    there is no public announcement, within 30 days after the date of 
    publication, of the preliminary determination, final determination, or 
    final results of review (whichever is applicable). In addition, the 
    Secretary will publish notice of such corrections in the Federal 
    Register. A correction notice will not alter the anniversary month of 
    an order or suspended investigation for purposes of requesting an 
    administrative review (see Sec. 351.213) or a new shipper review (see 
    Sec. 351.214) or initiating a sunset review (see Sec. 351.218).
        (f) Definition of ``ministerial error.'' Under this section, 
    ministerial error means an error in addition, subtraction, or other 
    arithmetic function, clerical error resulting from inaccurate copying, 
    duplication, or the like, and any other similar type of unintentional 
    error which the Secretary considers ministerial.
        (g) Definition of ``significant ministerial error.'' Under this 
    section, significant ministerial error means a ministerial error (see 
    paragraph (f) of this section), the correction of which, either singly 
    or in combination with other errors:
        (1) Would result in a change of at least five absolute percentage 
    points in, but not less than 25 percent of, the weighted-average 
    dumping margin or the countervailable subsidy rate (whichever is 
    applicable) calculated in the original (erroneous) preliminary 
    determination; or
        (2) Would result in a difference between a weighted-average dumping 
    margin or countervailable subsidy rate (whichever is applicable) of 
    zero (or de minimis) and a weighted-average dumping margin or 
    countervailable subsidy rate of greater than de minimis, or vice versa.
    
    
    Sec. 351.225  Scope rulings.
    
        (a) Introduction. Issues arise as to whether a particular product 
    is included within the scope of an antidumping or countervailing duty 
    order or a suspended investigation. Such issues can arise because the 
    descriptions of subject merchandise contained in the Department's 
    determinations must be written in general terms. At other times, a 
    domestic interested party may allege that changes to an imported 
    product or the place where the imported product is assembled 
    constitutes circumvention under section 781 of the Act. When such 
    issues arise, the Department issues ``scope rulings'' that clarify the 
    scope of an order or suspended investigation with respect to particular 
    products. This section contains rules regarding scope rulings, requests 
    for scope rulings, procedures for scope inquiries, and standards used 
    in determining whether a product is within the scope of an order or 
    suspended investigation.
        (b) Self-initiation. If the Secretary determines from available 
    information that an inquiry is warranted to determine whether a product 
    is included within the scope of an antidumping or countervailing duty 
    order or a suspended investigation, the Secretary will initiate an 
    inquiry, and will notify all parties on the Department's scope service 
    list of its initiation of a scope inquiry.
        (c) By application. (1) Contents and service of application. Any 
    interested party may apply for a ruling as to whether a particular 
    product is within the scope of an order or a suspended investigation. 
    The application must be served upon all parties on the scope service 
    list described in paragraph (n) of this section, and must contain the 
    following, to the extent reasonably available to the interested party:
        (i) A detailed description of the product, including its technical 
    characteristics and uses, and its current U.S. Tariff Classification 
    number;
        (ii) A statement of the interested party's position as to whether 
    the product is within the scope of an order or a suspended 
    investigation, including:
        (A) A summary of the reasons for this conclusion,
        (B) Citations to any applicable statutory authority, and
        (C) Any factual information supporting this position, including 
    excerpts from portions of the Secretary's or the Commission's 
    investigation, and relevant prior scope rulings.
        (2) Deadline for action on application. Within 45 days of the date 
    of receipt of an application for a scope ruling, the Secretary will 
    issue a final ruling under paragraph (d) of this section or will 
    initiate a scope inquiry under paragraph (e) of this section.
        (d) Ruling based upon the application. If the Secretary can 
    determine, based solely upon the application and the descriptions of 
    the merchandise referred to in paragraph (k)(1) of this section, 
    whether a product is included within the scope of an order or a 
    suspended investigation, the Secretary will issue a final ruling as to 
    whether the product is included within the order or suspended 
    investigation. The Secretary will notify all persons on the 
    Department's scope service list (see paragraph (n) of this section) of 
    the final ruling.
        (e) Ruling where further inquiry is warranted. If the Secretary 
    finds that the issue of whether a product is included within the scope 
    of an order or a suspended investigation cannot be determined based 
    solely upon the application and the descriptions of the merchandise 
    referred to in paragraph (k)(1) of this section, the Secretary will 
    notify by mail all parties on the Department's scope service list of 
    the initiation of a scope inquiry.
        (f) Notice and procedure. (1) Notice of the initiation of a scope 
    inquiry issued under paragraph (b) or (e) of this section will include:
    
    [[Page 27404]]
    
        (i) A description of the product that is the subject of the scope 
    inquiry; and
        (ii) An explanation of the reasons for the Secretary's decision to 
    initiate a scope inquiry;
        (iii) A schedule for submission of comments that normally will 
    allow interested parties 20 days in which to provide comments on, and 
    supporting factual information relating to, the inquiry, and 10 days in 
    which to provide any rebuttal to such comments.
        (2) The Secretary may issue questionnaires and verify submissions 
    received, where appropriate.
        (3) Whenever the Secretary finds that a scope inquiry presents an 
    issue of significant difficulty, the Secretary will issue a preliminary 
    scope ruling, based upon the available information at the time, as to 
    whether there is a reasonable basis to believe or suspect that the 
    product subject to a scope inquiry is included within the order or 
    suspended investigation. The Secretary will notify all parties on the 
    Department's scope service list (see paragraph (n) of this section) of 
    the preliminary scope ruling, and will invite comment. Unless otherwise 
    specified, interested parties will have within twenty days from the 
    date of receipt of the notification in which to submit comments, and 
    ten days thereafter in which to submit rebuttal comments.
        (4) The Secretary will issue a final ruling as to whether the 
    product which is the subject of the scope inquiry is included within 
    the order or suspended investigation, including an explanation of the 
    factual and legal conclusions on which the final ruling is based. The 
    Secretary will notify all parties on the Department's scope service 
    list (see paragraph (n) of this section) of the final scope ruling.
        (5) The Secretary will issue a final ruling under paragraph (k) of 
    this section (other scope rulings) normally within 120 days of the 
    initiation of the inquiry under this section. The Secretary will issue 
    a final ruling under paragraph (g), (h), (i), or (j) of this section 
    (circumvention rulings under section 781 of the Act) normally within 
    300 days from the date of the initiation of the scope inquiry.
        (6) When an administrative review under Sec. 351.213, a new shipper 
    review under Sec. 351.214, or an expedited antidumping review under 
    Sec. 351.215 is in progress at the time the Secretary provides notice 
    of the initiation of a scope inquiry (see paragraph (e)(1) of this 
    section), the Secretary may conduct the scope inquiry in conjunction 
    with that review.
        (7)(i) The Secretary will notify the Commission in writing of the 
    proposed inclusion of products in an order prior to issuing a final 
    ruling under paragraph (f)(4) of this section based on a determination 
    under:
        (A) Section 781(a) of the Act with respect to merchandise completed 
    or assembled in the United States (other than minor completion or 
    assembly);
        (B) Section 781(b) of the Act with respect to merchandise completed 
    or assembled in other foreign countries; or
        (C) Section 781(d) of the Act with respect to later-developed 
    products which incorporate a significant technological advance or 
    significant alteration of an earlier product.
        (ii) If the Secretary notifies the Commission under paragraph 
    (f)(7)(i) of this section, upon the written request of the Commission, 
    the Secretary will consult with the Commission regarding the proposed 
    inclusion, and any such consultation will be completed within 15 days 
    after the date of such request. If, after consultation, the Commission 
    believes that a significant injury issue is presented by the proposed 
    inclusion of a product within an order, the Commission may provide 
    written advice to the Secretary as to whether the inclusion would be 
    inconsistent with the affirmative injury determination of the 
    Commission on which the order is based.
        (g) Products completed or assembled in the United States. Under 
    section 781(a) of the Act, the Secretary may include within the scope 
    of an antidumping or countervailing duty order imported parts or 
    components referred to in section 781(a)(1)(B) of the Act that are used 
    in the completion or assembly of the merchandise in the United States 
    at any time such order is in effect. In making this determination, the 
    Secretary will not consider any single factor of section 781(a)(2) of 
    the Act to be controlling. In determining the value of parts or 
    components purchased from an affiliated person under section 
    781(a)(1)(D) of the Act, or of processing performed by an affiliated 
    person under section 781(a)(2)(E) of the Act, the Secretary may 
    determine the value of the part or component on the basis of the cost 
    of producing the part or component under section 773(f)(3) of the Act.
        (h) Products completed or assembled in other foreign countries. 
    Under section 781(b) of the Act, the Secretary may include within the 
    scope of an antidumping or countervailing duty order, at any time such 
    order is in effect, imported merchandise completed or assembled in a 
    foreign country other than the country to which the order applies. In 
    making this determination, the Secretary will not consider any single 
    factor of section 781(b)(2) of the Act to be controlling. In 
    determining the value of parts or components purchased from an 
    affiliated person under section 781(b)(1)(D) of the Act, or of 
    processing performed by an affiliated person under section 781(b)(2)(E) 
    of the Act, the Secretary may determine the value of the part or 
    component on the basis of the cost of producing the part or component 
    under section 773(f)(3) of the Act.
        (i) Minor alterations of merchandise. Under section 781(c) of the 
    Act, the Secretary may include within the scope of an antidumping or 
    countervailing duty order articles altered in form or appearance in 
    minor respects.
        (j) Later-developed merchandise. In determining whether later-
    developed merchandise is within the scope of an antidumping or 
    countervailing duty order, the Secretary will apply section 781(d) of 
    the Act.
        (k) Other scope determinations. With respect to those scope 
    determinations that are not covered under paragraphs (g) through (j) of 
    this section, in considering whether a particular product is included 
    within the scope of an order or a suspended investigation, the 
    Secretary will take into account the following:
        (1) The descriptions of the merchandise contained in the petition, 
    the initial investigation, and the determinations of the Secretary 
    (including prior scope determinations) and the Commission.
        (2) When the above criteria are not dispositive, the Secretary will 
    further consider:
        (i) The physical characteristics of the product;
        (ii) The expectations of the ultimate purchasers;
        (iii) The ultimate use of the product;
        (iv) The channels of trade in which the product is sold; and
        (v) The manner in which the product is advertised and displayed.
        (l) Suspension of liquidation. (1) When the Secretary conducts a 
    scope inquiry under paragraph (b) or (e) of this section, and the 
    product in question is already subject to suspension of liquidation, 
    that suspension of liquidation will be continued, pending a preliminary 
    or a final scope ruling, at the cash deposit rate that would apply if 
    the product were ruled to be included within the scope of the order.
        (2) If the Secretary issues a preliminary scope ruling under 
    paragraph (f)(3) of this section to the effect that the product in 
    question is included within the scope of the order, any suspension of 
    liquidation described in paragraph (l)(1) of this section will
    
    [[Page 27405]]
    
    continue. If liquidation has not been suspended, the Secretary will 
    instruct the Customs Service to suspend liquidation and to require a 
    cash deposit of estimated duties, at the applicable rate, for each 
    unliquidated entry of the product entered, or withdrawn from warehouse, 
    for consumption on or after the date of initiation of the scope 
    inquiry. If the Secretary issues a preliminary scope ruling to the 
    effect that the product in question is not included within the scope of 
    the order, the Secretary will order any suspension of liquidation on 
    the product ended, and will instruct the Customs Service to refund any 
    cash deposits or release any bonds relating to that product.
        (3) If the Secretary issues a final scope ruling, under either 
    paragraph (d) or (f)(4) of this section, to the effect that the product 
    in question is included within the scope of the order, any suspension 
    of liquidation under paragraph (l)(1) or (l)(2) of this section will 
    continue. Where there has been no suspension of liquidation, the 
    Secretary will instruct the Customs Service to suspend liquidation and 
    to require a cash deposit of estimated duties, at the applicable rate, 
    for each unliquidated entry of the product entered, or withdrawn from 
    warehouse, for consumption on or after the date of initiation of the 
    scope inquiry. If the Secretary's final scope ruling is to the effect 
    that the product in question is not included within the scope of the 
    order, the Secretary will order any suspension of liquidation on the 
    subject product ended and will instruct the Customs Service to refund 
    any cash deposits or release any bonds relating to this product.
        (4) If, within 90 days of the initiation of a review of an order or 
    a suspended investigation under this subpart, the Secretary issues a 
    final ruling that a product is included within the scope of the order 
    or suspended investigation that is the subject of the review, the 
    Secretary, where practicable, will include sales of that product for 
    purposes of the review and will seek information regarding such sales. 
    If the Secretary issues a final ruling after 90 days of the initiation 
    of the review, the Secretary may consider sales of the product for 
    purposes of the review on the basis of non-adverse facts available. 
    However, notwithstanding the pendency of a scope inquiry, if the 
    Secretary considers it appropriate, the Secretary may request 
    information concerning the product that is the subject of the scope 
    inquiry for purposes of a review under this subpart.
        (m) Orders covering identical products. Except for a scope inquiry 
    and a scope ruling that involves section 781(a) or section 781(b) of 
    the Act (assembly of parts or components in the United States or in a 
    third country), if more than one order or suspended investigation cover 
    the same subject merchandise, and if the Secretary considers it 
    appropriate, the Secretary may conduct a single inquiry and issue a 
    single scope ruling that applies to all such orders or suspended 
    investigations.
        (n) Service of applications; scope service list. The requirements 
    of Sec. 351.303(f) apply to this section, except that an application 
    for a scope ruling must be served on all persons on the Department's 
    scope service list. For purposes of this section, the ``scope service 
    list'' will include all persons that have participated in any segment 
    of the proceeding. If an application for a scope ruling in one 
    proceeding results in a single inquiry that will apply to another 
    proceeding (see paragraph (m) of this section), the Secretary will 
    notify persons on the scope service list of the other proceeding of the 
    application for a scope ruling.
        (o) Publication of list of scope rulings. On a quarterly basis, the 
    Secretary will publish in the Federal Register a list of scope rulings 
    issued within the last three months. This list will include the case 
    name, reference number, and a brief description of the ruling.
    
    Subpart C--Information and Argument
    
    
    Sec. 351.301  Time limits for submission of factual information.
    
        (a) Introduction. The Department obtains most of its factual 
    information in antidumping and countervailing duty proceedings from 
    submissions made by interested parties during the course of the 
    proceeding. This section sets forth the time limits for submitting such 
    factual information, including information in questionnaire responses, 
    publicly available information to value factors in nonmarket economy 
    cases, allegations concerning market viability, allegations of sales at 
    prices below the cost of production, countervailable subsidy 
    allegations, and upstream subsidy allegations. Section 351.302 sets 
    forth the procedures for requesting an extension of such time limits. 
    Section 351.303 contains the procedural rules regarding filing, format, 
    translation, service, and certification of documents.
        (b) Time limits in general. Except as provided in paragraphs (c) 
    and (d) of this section and Sec. 351.302, a submission of factual 
    information is due no later than:
        (1) For a final determination in a countervailing duty 
    investigation or an antidumping investigation, seven days before the 
    date on which the verification of any person is scheduled to commence, 
    except that factual information requested by the verifying officials 
    from a person normally will be due no later than seven days after the 
    date on which the verification of that person is completed;
        (2) For the final results of an administrative review, 140 days 
    after the last day of the anniversary month, except that factual 
    information requested by the verifying officials from a person normally 
    will be due no later than seven days after the date on which the 
    verification of that person is completed;
        (3) For the final results of a changed circumstances review, sunset 
    review, or section 762 review, 140 days after the date of publication 
    of notice of initiation of the review, except that factual information 
    requested by the verifying officials from a person normally will be due 
    no later than seven days after the date on which the verification of 
    that person is completed;
        (4) For the final results of a new shipper review, 100 days after 
    the date of publication of notice of initiation of the review, except 
    that factual information requested by the verifying officials from a 
    person normally will be due no later than seven days after the date on 
    which the verification of that person is completed; and
        (5) For the final results of an expedited antidumping review, 
    Article 8 violation review, Article 4/Article 7 review, or section 753 
    review, a date specified by the Secretary.
        (c) Time limits for certain submissions. (1) Rebuttal, 
    clarification, or correction of factual information. Any interested 
    party may submit factual information to rebut, clarify, or correct 
    factual information submitted by any other interested party at any time 
    prior to the deadline provided in this section for submission of such 
    factual information. If factual information is submitted less than 10 
    days before, on, or after (normally only with the Department's 
    permission) the applicable deadline for submission of such factual 
    information, an interested party may submit factual information to 
    rebut, clarify, or correct the factual information no later than 10 
    days after the date such factual information is served on the 
    interested party or, if appropriate, made available under APO to the 
    authorized applicant.
        (2) Questionnaire responses and other submissions on request. (i) 
    Notwithstanding paragraph (b) of this section, the Secretary may 
    request any person to submit factual information at any time during a 
    proceeding.
    
    [[Page 27406]]
    
        (ii) In the Secretary's written request to an interested party for 
    a response to a questionnaire or for other factual information, the 
    Secretary will specify the following: the time limit for the response; 
    the information to be provided; the form and manner in which the 
    interested party must submit the information; and that failure to 
    submit requested information in the requested form and manner by the 
    date specified may result in use of the facts available under section 
    776 of the Act and Sec. 351.308.
        (iii) Interested parties will have at least 30 days from the date 
    of receipt to respond to the full initial questionnaire. The time limit 
    for response to individual sections of the questionnaire, if the 
    Secretary requests a separate response to such sections, may be less 
    than the 30 days allotted for response to the full questionnaire. The 
    date of receipt will be seven days from the date on which the initial 
    questionnaire was transmitted.
        (iv) A notification by an interested party, under section 782(c)(1) 
    of the Act, of difficulties in submitting information in response to a 
    questionnaire issued by the Secretary is to be submitted in writing 
    within 14 days after the date of receipt of the initial questionnaire.
        (v) A respondent interested party may request in writing that the 
    Secretary conduct a questionnaire presentation. The Secretary may 
    conduct a questionnaire presentation if the Secretary notifies the 
    government of the affected country and that government does not object.
        (3) Submission of publicly available information to value factors 
    under Sec. 351.408(c). Notwithstanding paragraph (b) of this section, 
    interested parties may submit publicly available information to value 
    factors under Sec. 351.408(c) within:
        (i) For a final determination in an antidumping investigation, 40 
    days after the date of publication of the preliminary determination;
        (ii) For the final results of an administrative review, new shipper 
    review, or changed circumstances review, 20 days after the date of 
    publication of the preliminary results of review; and
        (iii) For the final results of an expedited antidumping review, a 
    date specified by the Secretary.
        (d) Time limits for certain allegations. (1) Market viability and 
    the basis for determining a price-based normal value. In an antidumping 
    investigation or administrative review, allegations regarding market 
    viability, including the exceptions in Sec. 351.404(c)(2), are due, 
    with all supporting factual information, within 40 days after the date 
    on which the initial questionnaire was transmitted, unless the 
    Secretary alters this time limit.
        (2) Sales at prices below the cost of production. An allegation of 
    sales at prices below the cost of production made by the petitioner or 
    other domestic interested party is due within:
        (i) In an antidumping investigation,
        (A) On a country-wide basis, 20 days after the date on which the 
    initial questionnaire was transmitted to any person, unless the 
    Secretary alters this time limit; or
        (B) On a company-specific basis, 20 days after a respondent 
    interested party files the response to the relevant section of the 
    questionnaire, unless the relevant questionnaire response is, in the 
    Secretary's view, incomplete, in which case the Secretary will 
    determine the time limit;
        (ii) In an administrative review, new shipper review, or changed 
    circumstances review, on a company-specific basis, 20 days after a 
    respondent interested party files the response to the relevant section 
    of the questionnaire, unless the relevant questionnaire response is, in 
    the Secretary's view, incomplete, in which case the Secretary will 
    determine the time limit; or
        (iii) In an expedited antidumping review, on a company-specific 
    basis, 10 days after the date of publication of the notice of 
    initiation of the review.
        (3) Purchases of major inputs from an affiliated party at prices 
    below the affiliated party's cost of production. An allegation of 
    purchases of major inputs from an affiliated party at prices below the 
    affiliated party's cost of production made by the petitioner or other 
    domestic interested party is due within 20 days after a respondent 
    interested party files the response to the relevant section of the 
    questionnaire, unless the relevant questionnaire response is, in the 
    Secretary's view, incomplete, in which case the Secretary will 
    determine the time limits.
        (4) Countervailable subsidy; upstream subsidy. (i) In general. A 
    countervailable subsidy allegation made by the petitioner or other 
    domestic interested party is due no later than:
        (A) In a countervailing duty investigation, 40 days before the 
    scheduled date of the preliminary determination; or
        (B) In an administrative review, new shipper review, or changed 
    circumstances review, 20 days after all responses to the initial 
    questionnaire are filed with the Department, unless the Secretary 
    alters this time limit.
        (ii) Exception for upstream subsidy allegation in an investigation. 
    In a countervailing duty investigation, an allegation of upstream 
    subsidies made by the petitioner or other domestic interested party is 
    due no later than:
        (A) 10 days before the scheduled date of the preliminary 
    determination; or
        (B) 15 days before the scheduled date of the final determination.
        (5) Targeted dumping. In an antidumping investigation, an 
    allegation of targeted dumping made by the petitioner or other domestic 
    interested party under Sec. 351.414(f)(3) is due no later than 30 days 
    before the scheduled date of the preliminary determination.
    
    
    Sec. 351.302  Extension of time limits; return of untimely filed or 
    unsolicited material.
    
        (a) Introduction. This section sets forth the procedures for 
    requesting an extension of a time limit. In addition, this section 
    explains that certain untimely filed or unsolicited material will be 
    returned to the submitter together with an explanation of the reasons 
    for the return of such material.
        (b) Extension of time limits. Unless expressly precluded by 
    statute, the Secretary may, for good cause, extend any time limit 
    established by this part.
        (c) Requests for extension of specific time limit. Before the 
    applicable time limit specified under Sec. 351.301 expires, a party may 
    request an extension pursuant to paragraph (b) of this section. The 
    request must be in writing and state the reasons for the request. An 
    extension granted to a party must be approved in writing.
        (d) Return of untimely filed or unsolicited material. (1) Unless 
    the Secretary extends a time limit under paragraph (b) of this section, 
    the Secretary will not consider or retain in the official record of the 
    proceeding:
        (i) Untimely filed factual information, written argument, or other 
    material that the Secretary returns to the submitter, except as 
    provided under Sec. 351.104(a)(2); or
        (ii) Unsolicited questionnaire responses, except as provided under 
    Sec. 351.204(d)(2).
        (2) The Secretary will return such information, argument, or other 
    material, or unsolicited questionnaire response with, to the extent 
    practicable, written notice stating the reasons for return.
    
    
    Sec. 351.303  Filing, format, translation, service, and certification 
    of documents.
    
        (a) Introduction. This section contains the procedural rules 
    regarding filing, format, service, translation, and certification of 
    documents and applies to all persons submitting documents to the 
    Department for consideration in an antidumping or countervailing duty 
    proceeding.
    
    [[Page 27407]]
    
        (b) Where to file; time of filing. Persons must address and submit 
    all documents to the Secretary of Commerce, Attention: Import 
    Administration, Central Records Unit, Room 1870, U.S. Department of 
    Commerce, 14th Street and Constitution Avenue, NW, Washington, DC 
    20230, between the hours of 8:30 a.m. and 5:00 p.m. on business days 
    (see Sec. 351.103(b)). If the applicable time limit expires on a non-
    business day, the Secretary will accept documents that are filed on the 
    next business day.
        (c) Number of copies; filing of business proprietary and public 
    versions under the one-day lag rule; information in double brackets. 
    (1) In general. Except as provided in paragraphs (c)(2) and (c)(3) of 
    this section, a person must file six copies of each submission with the 
    Department.
        (2) Application of the one-day lag rule. (i) Filing the business 
    proprietary version. A person must file one copy of the business 
    proprietary version of any document with the Department within the 
    applicable time limit. Business proprietary version means the version 
    of a document containing information for which a person claims business 
    proprietary treatment under Sec. 351.304.
        (ii) Filing the final business proprietary version; bracketing 
    corrections. By the close of business one business day after the date 
    the business proprietary version is filed under paragraph (c)(2)(i) of 
    this section, a person must file six copies of the final business 
    proprietary version of the document with the Department. The final 
    business proprietary version must be identical to the business 
    proprietary version filed on the previous day except for any bracketing 
    corrections. Although a person must file six copies of the complete 
    final business proprietary version with the Department, the person may 
    serve other persons with only those pages containing bracketing 
    corrections.
        (iii) Filing the public version. Simultaneously with the filing of 
    the final business proprietary version under paragraph (c)(2)(ii) of 
    this section, a person also must file three copies of the public 
    version of such document (see Sec. 351.304(c)) with the Department.
        (iv) Information in double brackets. If a person serves authorized 
    applicants with a business proprietary version of a document that 
    excludes information in double brackets pursuant to Sec. 351.304(b)(2), 
    the person simultaneously must file with the Department one copy of 
    those pages in which information in double brackets has been excluded.
        (3) Computer media and printouts. The Secretary may require 
    submission of factual information on computer media unless the 
    Secretary modifies such requirements under section 782(c) of the Act 
    (see Sec. 351.301(c)(2)(iv)). The computer medium must be accompanied 
    by the number of copies of any computer printout specified by the 
    Secretary. All information on computer media must be releasable under 
    APO (see Sec. 351.305).
        (d) Format of copies. (1) In general. Unless the Secretary alters 
    the requirements of this section, documents filed with the Department 
    must conform to the specification and marking requirements under 
    paragraph (d)(2) of this section or the Secretary may refuse to accept 
    such documents for the official record of the proceeding.
        (2) Specifications and markings. A person must submit documents on 
    letter-size paper, single-sided and double-spaced, and must securely 
    bind each copy as a single document with any letter of transmittal as 
    the first page of the document. A submitter must mark the first page of 
    each document in the upper right-hand corner with the following 
    information in the following format:
        (i) On the first line, except for a petition, indicate the 
    Department case number;
        (ii) On the second line, indicate the total number of pages in the 
    document including cover pages, appendices, and any unnumbered pages;
        (iii) On the third line, indicate whether the document is for an 
    investigation, scope inquiry, circumvention inquiry, downstream product 
    monitoring application, or review and, if the latter, indicate the 
    inclusive dates of the review, the type of review, and the section 
    number of the Act corresponding to the type of review;
        (iv) On the fourth line, indicate the Department office conducting 
    the proceeding;
        (v) On the fifth and subsequent lines, indicate whether any portion 
    of the document contains business proprietary information and, if so, 
    list the applicable page numbers and state either ``Document May be 
    Released Under APO'' or ``Document May Not be Released Under APO.'' 
    Indicate ``Business Proprietary Treatment Requested'' on the top of 
    each page containing business proprietary information. In addition, 
    include the warning ``Bracketing of Business Proprietary Information is 
    Not Final for One Business Day After Date of Filing'' on the top of 
    each page containing business proprietary information in the copy of 
    the business proprietary version filed under Sec. 351.303(c)(2)(i) 
    (one-day lag rule). Do not include this warning in the copies of the 
    final business proprietary version filed on the next business day under 
    Sec. 351.303(c)(2)(ii) (see Sec. 351.303(c)(2) and Sec. 351.304(c)); 
    and
        (vi) For public versions of business proprietary documents required 
    under Sec. 351.304(c), complete the marking as required in paragraphs 
    (d)(2)(i)-(v) of this section for the business proprietary document, 
    but conspicuously mark the first page ``Public Version.''
        (e) Translation to English. A document submitted in a foreign 
    language must be accompanied by an English translation of the entire 
    document or of only pertinent portions, where appropriate, unless the 
    Secretary waives this requirement for an individual document. A party 
    must obtain the Department's approval for submission of an English 
    translation of only portions of a document prior to submission to the 
    Department.
        (f) Service of copies on other persons. (1)(i) In general. Except 
    as provided in Sec. 351.202(c) (filing of petition), Sec. 351.207(f)(1) 
    (submission of proposed suspension agreement), and paragraph (f)(3) of 
    this section, a person filing a document with the Department 
    simultaneously must serve a copy of the document on all other persons 
    on the service list by personal service or first class mail.
        (ii) Service of public versions or a party's own business 
    proprietary information. Notwithstanding paragraphs (f)(1)(i) and 
    (f)(3) of this section, service of the public version of a document or 
    of the business proprietary version of a document containing only the 
    server's own business proprietary information, on persons on the 
    service list, may be made by facsimile transmission or other electronic 
    transmission process, with the consent of the person to be served.
        (2) Certificate of service. Each document filed with the Department 
    must include a certificate of service listing each person served 
    (including agents), the type of document served, and the date and 
    method of service on each person. The Secretary may refuse to accept 
    any document that is not accompanied by a certificate of service.
        (3) Service requirements for certain documents. (i) Briefs. In 
    addition to the certificate of service requirements contained in 
    paragraph (f)(2) of this section, a person filing a case or rebuttal 
    brief with the Department simultaneously must serve a copy of that 
    brief on all persons on the service list and on any U.S. Government 
    agency that has submitted a case or rebuttal brief in the segment of 
    the proceeding. If, under Sec. 351.103(c), a person has
    
    [[Page 27408]]
    
    designated an agent to receive service that is located in the United 
    States, service on that person must be either by personal service on 
    the same day the brief is filed or by overnight mail or courier on the 
    next day. If the person has designated an agent to receive service that 
    is located outside the United States, service on that person must be by 
    first class airmail.
        (ii) Request for review. In addition to the certificate of service 
    requirements under paragraph (f)(2) of this section, an interested 
    party that files with the Department a request for an expedited 
    antidumping review, an administrative review, a new shipper review, or 
    a changed circumstances review must serve a copy of the request by 
    personal service or first class mail on each exporter or producer 
    specified in the request and on the petitioner by the end of the 
    anniversary month or within ten days of filing the request for review, 
    whichever is later. If the interested party that files the request is 
    unable to locate a particular exporter or producer, or the petitioner, 
    the Secretary may accept the request for review if the Secretary is 
    satisfied that the party made a reasonable attempt to serve a copy of 
    the request on such person.
        (g) Certifications. A person must file with each submission 
    containing factual information the certification in paragraph (g)(1) of 
    this section and, in addition, if the person has legal counsel or 
    another representative, the certification in paragraph (g)(2) of this 
    section:
        (1) For the person's officially responsible for presentation of the 
    factual information:
    
        I, (name and title), currently employed by (person), certify 
    that (1) I have read the attached submission, and (2) the 
    information contained in this submission is, to the best of my 
    knowledge, complete and accurate.
    
        (2) For the person's legal counsel or other representative:
    
        I, (name), of (law or other firm), counsel or representative to 
    (person), certify that (1) I have read the attached submission, and 
    (2) based on the information made available to me by (person), I 
    have no reason to believe that this submission contains any material 
    misrepresentation or omission of fact.
    
    
    Sec. 351.304  Establishing business proprietary treatment of 
    information [Reserved].
    
    
    Sec. 351.305  Access to business proprietary information [Reserved].
    
    
    Sec. 351.306  Use of business proprietary information [Reserved].
    
    
    Sec. 351.307  Verification of information.
    
        (a) Introduction. Prior to making a final determination in an 
    investigation or issuing final results of review, the Secretary may 
    verify relevant factual information. This section clarifies when 
    verification will occur, the contents of a verification report, and the 
    procedures for verification.
        (b) In general. (1) Subject to paragraph (b)(4) of this section, 
    the Secretary will verify factual information upon which the Secretary 
    relies in:
        (i) A final determination in a continuation of a previously 
    suspended countervailing duty investigation (section 704(g) of the 
    Act), countervailing duty investigation, continuation of a previously 
    suspended antidumping investigation (section 705(a) of the Act), or 
    antidumping investigation;
        (ii) The final results of an expedited antidumping review;
        (iii) A revocation under section 751(d) of the Act;
        (iv) The final results of an administrative review, new shipper 
    review, or changed circumstances review, if the Secretary decides that 
    good cause for verification exists; and
        (v) The final results of an administrative review if:
        (A) A domestic interested party, not later than 100 days after the 
    date of publication of the notice of initiation of review, submits a 
    written request for verification; and
        (B) The Secretary conducted no verification under this paragraph 
    during either of the two immediately preceding administrative reviews.
        (2) The Secretary may verify factual information upon which the 
    Secretary relies in a proceeding or a segment of a proceeding not 
    specifically provided for in paragraph (b)(1) of this section.
        (3) If the Secretary decides that, because of the large number of 
    exporters or producers included in an investigation or administrative 
    review, it is impractical to verify relevant factual information for 
    each person, the Secretary may select and verify a sample.
        (4) The Secretary may conduct verification of a person if that 
    person agrees to verification and the Secretary notifies the government 
    of the affected country and that government does not object. If the 
    person or the government objects to verification, the Secretary will 
    not conduct verification and may disregard any or all information 
    submitted by the person in favor of use of the facts available under 
    section 776 of the Act and Sec. 351.308.
        (c) Verification report. The Secretary will report the methods, 
    procedures, and results of a verification under this section prior to 
    making a final determination in an investigation or issuing final 
    results in a review.
        (d) Procedures for verification. The Secretary will notify the 
    government of the affected country that employees of the Department 
    will visit with the persons listed below in order to verify the 
    accuracy and completeness of submitted factual information. The 
    notification will, where practicable, identify any member of the 
    verification team who is not an officer of the U.S. Government. As part 
    of the verification, employees of the Department will request access to 
    all files, records, and personnel which the Secretary considers 
    relevant to factual information submitted of:
        (1) Producers, exporters, or importers;
        (2) Persons affiliated with the persons listed in paragraph (d)(1) 
    of this section, where applicable;
        (3) Unaffiliated purchasers, or
        (4) The government of the affected country as part of verification 
    in a countervailing duty proceeding.
    
    
    Sec. 351.308  Determinations on the basis of the facts available.
    
        (a) Introduction. The Secretary may make determinations on the 
    basis of the facts available whenever necessary information is not 
    available on the record, an interested party or any other person 
    withholds or fails to provide information requested in a timely manner 
    and in the form required or significantly impedes a proceeding, or the 
    Secretary is unable to verify submitted information. If the Secretary 
    finds that an interested party ``has failed to cooperate by not acting 
    to the best of its ability to comply with a request for information,'' 
    the Secretary may use an inference that is adverse to the interests of 
    that party in selecting from among the facts otherwise available. This 
    section lists some of the sources of information upon which the 
    Secretary may base an adverse inference and explains the actions the 
    Secretary will take with respect to corroboration of information.
        (b) In general. The Secretary may make a determination under the 
    Act and this part based on the facts otherwise available in accordance 
    with section 776(a) of the Act.
        (c) Adverse Inferences. For purposes of section 776(b) of the Act, 
    an adverse inference may include reliance on:
        (1) Secondary information, such as information derived from:
        (i) The petition;
        (ii) A final determination in a countervailing duty investigation 
    or an antidumping investigation;
        (iii) Any previous administrative review, new shipper review, 
    expedited antidumping review, section 753 review, or section 762 
    review; or
    
    [[Page 27409]]
    
        (2) Any other information placed on the record.
        (d) Corroboration of secondary information. Under section 776(c) of 
    the Act, when the Secretary relies on secondary information, the 
    Secretary will, to the extent practicable, corroborate that information 
    from independent sources that are reasonably at the Secretary's 
    disposal. Independent sources may include, but are not limited to, 
    published price lists, official import statistics and customs data, and 
    information obtained from interested parties during the instant 
    investigation or review. Corroborate means that the Secretary will 
    examine whether the secondary information to be used has probative 
    value. The fact that corroboration may not be practicable in a given 
    circumstance will not prevent the Secretary from applying an adverse 
    inference as appropriate and using the secondary information in 
    question.
        (e) Use of certain information. In reaching a determination under 
    the Act and this part, the Secretary will not decline to consider 
    information that is submitted by an interested party and is necessary 
    to the determination but does not meet all the applicable requirements 
    established by the Secretary if the conditions listed under section 
    782(e) of the Act are met.
    
    
    Sec. 351.309  Written argument.
    
        (a) Introduction. Written argument may be submitted during the 
    course of an antidumping or countervailing duty proceeding. This 
    section sets forth the time limits for submission of case and rebuttal 
    briefs and provides guidance on what should be contained in these 
    documents.
        (b) Written argument. (1) In general. In making the final 
    determination in a countervailing duty investigation or antidumping 
    investigation or the final results of an administrative review, new 
    shipper review, expedited antidumping review, section 753 review, or 
    section 762 review, the Secretary will consider written arguments in 
    case or rebuttal briefs filed within the time limits in this section.
        (2) Written argument on request. Notwithstanding paragraph (b)(1) 
    of this section, the Secretary may request written argument on any 
    issue from any person or U.S. Government agency at any time during a 
    proceeding.
        (c) Case brief. (1) Any interested party or U.S. Government agency 
    may submit a ``case brief'' within:
        (i) For a final determination in a countervailing duty 
    investigation or antidumping investigation, 50 days after the date of 
    publication of the preliminary determination, unless the Secretary 
    alters this time limit;
        (ii) For the final results of an administrative review, new shipper 
    review, changed circumstances review, or section 762 review, 30 days 
    after the date of publication of the preliminary results of review, 
    unless the Secretary alters the time limit; or
        (iii) For the final results of an expedited antidumping review, 
    sunset review, Article 8 violation review, Article 4/Article 7 review, 
    or section 753 review, a date specified by the Secretary.
        (2) The case brief must present all arguments that continue in the 
    submitter's view to be relevant to the Secretary's final determination 
    or final results, including any arguments presented before the date of 
    publication of the preliminary determination or preliminary results. As 
    part of the case brief, parties are encouraged to provide a summary of 
    the arguments not to exceed five pages and a table of statutes, 
    regulations, and cases cited.
        (d) Rebuttal brief. (1) Any interested party or U.S. Government 
    agency may submit a ``rebuttal brief'' within five days after the time 
    limit for filing the case brief, unless the Secretary alters this time 
    limit.
        (2) The rebuttal brief may respond only to arguments raised in case 
    briefs and should identify the arguments to which it is responding. As 
    part of the rebuttal brief, parties are encouraged to provide a summary 
    of the arguments not to exceed five pages and a table of statutes, 
    regulations, and cases cited.
    
    
    Sec. 351.310  Hearings.
    
        (a) Introduction. This section sets forth the procedures for 
    requesting a hearing, indicates that the Secretary may consolidate 
    hearings, and explains when the Secretary may hold closed hearing 
    sessions.
        (b) Pre-hearing conference. The Secretary may conduct a telephone 
    pre-hearing conference with representatives of interested parties to 
    facilitate the conduct of the hearing.
        (c) Request for hearing. Any interested party may request that the 
    Secretary hold a public hearing on arguments to be raised in case or 
    rebuttal briefs within 30 days after the date of publication of the 
    preliminary determination or preliminary results of review, unless the 
    Secretary alters this time limit, or in a proceeding where the 
    Secretary will not issue a preliminary determination, not later than a 
    date specified by the Secretary. To the extent practicable, a party 
    requesting a hearing must identify arguments to be raised at the 
    hearing. At the hearing, an interested party may make an affirmative 
    presentation only on arguments included in that party's case brief and 
    may make a rebuttal presentation only on arguments included in that 
    party's rebuttal brief.
        (d) Hearings in general. (1) If an interested party submits a 
    request under paragraph (c) of this section, the Secretary will hold a 
    public hearing on the date stated in the notice of the Secretary's 
    preliminary determination or preliminary results of administrative 
    review (or otherwise specified by the Secretary in an expedited 
    antidumping review), unless the Secretary alters the date. Ordinarily, 
    the hearing will be held two days after the scheduled date for 
    submission of rebuttal briefs.
        (2) The hearing is not subject to 5 U.S.C. Secs. 551-559, and 
    Sec. 702 (Administrative Procedure Act). Witness testimony, if any, 
    will not be under oath or subject to cross-examination by another 
    interested party or witness. During the hearing, the chair may question 
    any person or witness and may request persons to present additional 
    written argument.
        (e) Consolidated hearings. At the Secretary's discretion, the 
    Secretary may consolidate hearings in two or more cases.
        (f) Closed hearing sessions. An interested party may request a 
    closed session of the hearing no later than the date the case briefs 
    are due in order to address limited issues during the course of the 
    hearing. The requesting party must identify the subjects to be 
    discussed, specify the amount of time requested, and justify the need 
    for a closed session with respect to each subject. If the Secretary 
    approves the request for a closed session, only authorized applicants 
    and other persons authorized by the regulations may be present for the 
    closed session (see Sec. 351.305).
        (g) Transcript of hearing. The Secretary will place a verbatim 
    transcript of the hearing in the public and official records of the 
    proceeding and will announce at the hearing how interested parties may 
    obtain copies of the transcript.
    
    
    Sec. 351.311  Countervailable subsidy practice discovered during 
    investigation or review.
    
        (a) Introduction. During the course of a countervailing duty 
    investigation or review, Department officials may discover or receive 
    notice of a practice that appears to provide a countervailable subsidy. 
    This section explains when the Secretary will examine such a practice.
        (b) Inclusion in proceeding. If during a countervailing duty 
    investigation or a
    
    [[Page 27410]]
    
    countervailing duty administrative review the Secretary discovers a 
    practice that appears to provide a countervailable subsidy with respect 
    to the subject merchandise and the practice was not alleged or examined 
    in the proceeding, or if, pursuant to section 775 of the Act, the 
    Secretary receives notice from the United States Trade Representative 
    that a subsidy or subsidy program is in violation of Article 8 of the 
    Subsidies Agreement, the Secretary will examine the practice, subsidy, 
    or subsidy program if the Secretary concludes that sufficient time 
    remains before the scheduled date for the final determination or final 
    results of review.
        (c) Deferral of examination. If the Secretary concludes that 
    insufficient time remains before the scheduled date for the final 
    determination or final results of review to examine the practice, 
    subsidy, or subsidy program described in paragraph (b) of this section, 
    the Secretary will:
        (1) During an investigation, allow the petitioner to withdraw the 
    petition without prejudice and resubmit it with an allegation with 
    regard to the newly discovered practice, subsidy, or subsidy program; 
    or
        (2) During an investigation or review, defer consideration of the 
    newly discovered practice, subsidy, or subsidy program until a 
    subsequent administrative review, if any.
        (d) Notice. The Secretary will notify the parties to the proceeding 
    of any practice the Secretary discovers, or any subsidy or subsidy 
    program with respect to which the Secretary receives notice from the 
    United States Trade Representative, and whether or not it will be 
    included in the then ongoing proceeding.
    
    
    Sec. 351.312  Industrial users and consumer organizations.
    
        (a) Introduction. The URAA provides for opportunity for comment by 
    consumer organizations and industrial users on matters relevant to a 
    particular determination of dumping, subsidization, or injury. This 
    section indicates under what circumstances such persons may submit 
    relevant information and argument.
        (b) Opportunity to submit relevant information and argument. In an 
    antidumping or countervailing duty proceeding under title VII of the 
    Act and this part, an industrial user of the subject merchandise or a 
    representative consumer organization, as described in section 777(h) of 
    the Act, may submit relevant factual information and written argument 
    to the Department under paragraphs (b), (c)(1), and (c)(3) of 
    Sec. 351.301 and paragraphs (c) and (d) of Sec. 351.309 concerning 
    dumping or a countervailable subsidy. All such submissions must be 
    filed in accordance with Sec. 351.303.
        (c) Business proprietary information. Persons described in 
    paragraph (b) of this section may request business proprietary 
    treatment of information under Sec. 351.304, but will not be granted 
    access under Sec. 351.305 to business proprietary information submitted 
    by other persons.
    
    Subpart D--Calculation of Export Price, Constructed Export Price, 
    Fair Value, and Normal Value
    
    
    Sec. 351.401  In general.
    
        (a) Introduction. In general terms, an antidumping analysis 
    involves a comparison of export price or constructed export price in 
    the United States with normal value in the foreign market. This section 
    establishes certain general rules that apply to the calculation of 
    export price, constructed export price and normal value. (See section 
    772, section 773, and section 773A of the Act.)
        (b) Adjustments in general. In making adjustments to export price, 
    constructed export price, or normal value, the Secretary will adhere to 
    the following principles:
        (1) The interested party that is in possession of the relevant 
    information has the burden of establishing to the satisfaction of the 
    Secretary the amount and nature of a particular adjustment; and
        (2) The Secretary will not double-count adjustments.
        (c) Use of price net of price adjustments. In calculating export 
    price, constructed export price, and normal value (where normal value 
    is based on price), the Secretary will use a price that is net of any 
    price adjustment, as defined in Sec. 351.102(b), that is reasonably 
    attributable to the subject merchandise or the foreign like product 
    (whichever is applicable).
        (d) Delayed payment or pre-payment of expenses. Where cost is the 
    basis for determining the amount of an adjustment to export price, 
    constructed export price, or normal value, the Secretary will not 
    factor in any delayed payment or pre-payment of expenses by the 
    exporter or producer.
        (e) Adjustments for movement expenses. (1) Original place of 
    shipment. In making adjustments for movement expenses to establish 
    export price or constructed export price under section 772(c)(2)(A) of 
    the Act, or normal value under section 773(a)(6)(B)(ii) of the Act, the 
    Secretary normally will consider the production facility as being the 
    ``original place of shipment. However, where the Secretary bases export 
    price, constructed export price, or normal value on a sale by an 
    unaffiliated reseller, the Secretary may treat the original place from 
    which the reseller shipped the merchandise as the ``original place of 
    shipment.''
        (2) Warehousing. The Secretary will consider warehousing expenses 
    that are incurred after the subject merchandise or foreign like product 
    leaves the original place of shipment as movement expenses.
        (f) Treatment of affiliated producers in antidumping proceedings. 
    (1) In general. In an antidumping proceeding under this part, the 
    Secretary will treat two or more affiliated producers as a single 
    entity where those producers have production facilities for similar or 
    identical products that would not require substantial retooling of 
    either facility in order to restructure manufacturing priorities and 
    the Secretary concludes that there is a significant potential for the 
    manipulation of price or production.
        (2) Significant potential for manipulation. In identifying a 
    significant potential for the manipulation of price or production, the 
    factors the Secretary may consider include:
        (i) The level of common ownership;
        (ii) The extent to which managerial employees or board members of 
    one firm sit on the board of directors of an affiliated firm; and
        (iii) Whether operations are intertwined, such as through the 
    sharing of sales information, involvement in production and pricing 
    decisions, the sharing of facilities or employees, or significant 
    transactions between the affiliated producers.
        (g) Allocation of expenses and price adjustments. (1) In general. 
    The Secretary may consider allocated expenses and price adjustments 
    when transaction-specific reporting is not feasible, provided the 
    Secretary is satisfied that the allocation method used does not cause 
    inaccuracies or distortions.
        (2) Reporting allocated expenses and price adjustments. Any party 
    seeking to report an expense or a price adjustment on an allocated 
    basis must demonstrate to the Secretary's satisfaction that the 
    allocation is calculated on as specific a basis as is feasible, and 
    must explain why the allocation methodology used does not cause 
    inaccuracies or distortions.
        (3) Feasibility. In determining the feasibility of transaction-
    specific reporting or whether an allocation is calculated on as 
    specific a basis as is
    
    [[Page 27411]]
    
    feasible, the Secretary will take into account the records maintained 
    by the party in question in the ordinary course of its business, as 
    well as such factors as the normal accounting practices in the country 
    and industry in question and the number of sales made by the party 
    during the period of investigation or review.
        (4) Expenses and price adjustments relating to merchandise not 
    subject to the proceeding. The Secretary will not reject an allocation 
    method solely because the method includes expenses incurred, or price 
    adjustments made, with respect to sales of merchandise that does not 
    constitute subject merchandise or a foreign like product (whichever is 
    applicable).
        (h) Treatment of subcontractors (``tolling'' operations). The 
    Secretary will not consider a toller or subcontractor to be a 
    manufacturer or producer where the toller or subcontractor does not 
    acquire ownership, and does not control the relevant sale, of the 
    subject merchandise or foreign like product.
        (i) Date of sale. In identifying the date of sale of the subject 
    merchandise or foreign like product, the Secretary normally will use 
    the date of invoice, as recorded in the exporter or producer's records 
    kept in the ordinary course of business. However, the Secretary may use 
    a date other than the date of invoice if the Secretary is satisfied 
    that a different date better reflects the date on which the exporter or 
    producer establishes the material terms of sale.
    
    
    Sec. 351.402  Calculation of export price and constructed export price; 
    reimbursement of antidumping and countervailing duties.
    
        (a) Introduction. In order to establish export price, constructed 
    export price, and normal value, the Secretary must make certain 
    adjustments to the price to the unaffiliated purchaser (often called 
    the ``starting price'') in both the United States and foreign markets. 
    This regulation clarifies how the Secretary will make certain of the 
    adjustments to the starting price in the United States that are 
    required by section 772 of the Act.
        (b) Additional adjustments to constructed export price. In 
    establishing constructed export price under section 772(d) of the Act, 
    the Secretary will make adjustments for expenses associated with 
    commercial activities in the United States that relate to the sale to 
    an unaffiliated purchaser, no matter where or when paid. The Secretary 
    will not make an adjustment for any expense that is related solely to 
    the sale to an affiliated importer in the United States, although the 
    Secretary may make an adjustment to normal value for such expenses 
    under section 773(a)(6)(C)(iii) of the Act.
        (c) Special rule for merchandise with value added after 
    importation. (1) Merchandise imported by affiliated persons. In 
    applying section 772(e) of the Act, merchandise imported by and value 
    added by a person affiliated with the exporter or producer includes 
    merchandise imported and value added for the account of such an 
    affiliated person.
        (2) Estimation of value added. The Secretary normally will 
    determine that the value added in the United States by the affiliated 
    person is likely to exceed substantially the value of the subject 
    merchandise if the Secretary estimates the value added to be at least 
    65 percent of the price charged to the first unaffiliated purchaser for 
    the merchandise as sold in the United States. The Secretary normally 
    will estimate the value added based on the difference between the price 
    charged to the first unaffiliated purchaser for the merchandise as sold 
    in the United States and the price paid for the subject merchandise by 
    the affiliated person. The Secretary normally will base this 
    determination on averages of the prices and the value added to the 
    subject merchandise.
        (3) Determining dumping margins. For purposes of determining 
    dumping margins under paragraphs (1) and (2) of section 772(e) of the 
    Act, the Secretary may use the weighted-average dumping margins 
    calculated on sales of identical or other subject merchandise sold to 
    unaffiliated persons.
        (d) Special rule for determining profit. This paragraph sets forth 
    rules for calculating profit in establishing constructed export price 
    under section 772(f) of the Act.
        (1) Basis for total expenses and total actual profit. In 
    calculating total expenses and total actual profit, the Secretary 
    normally will use the aggregate of expenses and profit for all subject 
    merchandise sold in the United States and all foreign like products 
    sold in the exporting country, including sales that have been 
    disregarded as being below the cost of production. (See section 773(b) 
    of the Act (sales at less than cost of production).)
        (2) Use of financial reports. For purposes of determining profit 
    under section 772(d)(3) of the Act, the Secretary may rely on any 
    appropriate financial reports, including public, audited financial 
    statements, or equivalent financial reports, and internal financial 
    reports prepared in the ordinary course of business.
        (3) Voluntary reporting of costs of production. The Secretary will 
    not require the reporting of costs of production solely for purposes of 
    determining the amount of profit to be deducted from the constructed 
    export price. The Secretary will base the calculation of profit on 
    costs of production if such costs are reported voluntarily by the date 
    established by the Secretary, and provided that it is practicable to do 
    so and the costs of production are verifiable.
        (e) Treatment of payments between affiliated persons. Where a 
    person affiliated with the exporter or producer incurs any of the 
    expenses deducted from constructed export price under section 772(d) of 
    the Act and is reimbursed for such expenses by the exporter, producer 
    or other affiliate, the Secretary normally will make an adjustment 
    based on the actual cost to the affiliated person. If the Secretary is 
    satisfied that information regarding the actual cost to the affiliated 
    person is unavailable to the exporter or producer, the Secretary may 
    determine the amount of the adjustment on any other reasonable basis, 
    including the amount of the reimbursement to the affiliated person if 
    the Secretary is satisfied that such amount reflects the amount usually 
    paid in the market under consideration.
        (f) Reimbursement of antidumping duties and countervailing duties. 
    (1) In general. (i) In calculating the export price (or the constructed 
    export price), the Secretary will deduct the amount of any antidumping 
    duty or countervailing duty which the exporter or producer:
        (A) Paid directly on behalf of the importer; or
        (B) Reimbursed to the importer.
        (ii) The Secretary will not deduct the amount of any antidumping 
    duty or countervailing duty paid or reimbursed if the exporter or 
    producer granted to the importer before initiation of the antidumping 
    investigation in question a warranty of nonapplicability of antidumping 
    duties or countervailing duties with respect to subject merchandise 
    which was:
        (A) Sold before the date of publication of the Secretary's order 
    applicable to the merchandise in question; and
        (B) Exported before the date of publication of the Secretary's 
    final antidumping determination.
        (iii) Ordinarily, under paragraph (f)(1)(i) of this section, the 
    Secretary will deduct the amount reimbursed only once in the 
    calculation of the export price (or constructed export price).
        (2) Certificate. The importer must file prior to liquidation a 
    certificate in the
    
    [[Page 27412]]
    
    following form with the appropriate District Director of Customs:
    
        I hereby certify that I (have) (have not) entered into any 
    agreement or understanding for the payment or for the refunding to 
    me, by the manufacturer, producer, seller, or exporter, of all or 
    any part of the antidumping duties or countervailing duties assessed 
    upon the following importations of (commodity) from (country): (List 
    entry numbers) which have been purchased on or after (date of 
    publication of antidumping notice suspending liquidation in the 
    Federal Register) or purchased before (same date) but exported on or 
    after (date of final determination of sales at less than fair 
    value).
    
        (3) Presumption. The Secretary may presume from an importer's 
    failure to file the certificate required in paragraph (f)(2) of this 
    section that the exporter or producer paid or reimbursed the 
    antidumping duties or countervailing duties.
    
    
    Sec. 351.403  Sales used in calculating normal value; transactions 
    between affiliated parties.
    
        (a) Introduction. This section clarifies when the Secretary may use 
    offers for sale in determining normal value. Additionally, this section 
    clarifies the authority of the Secretary to use sales to or through an 
    affiliated party as a basis for normal value. (See section 773(a)(5) of 
    the Act (indirect sales or offers for sale).)
        (b) Sales and offers for sale. In calculating normal value, the 
    Secretary normally will consider offers for sale only in the absence of 
    sales and only if the Secretary concludes that acceptance of the offer 
    can be reasonably expected.
        (c) Sales to an affiliated party. If an exporter or producer sold 
    the foreign like product to an affiliated party, the Secretary may 
    calculate normal value based on that sale only if satisfied that the 
    price is comparable to the price at which the exporter or producer sold 
    the foreign like product to a person who is not affiliated with the 
    seller.
        (d) Sales through an affiliated party. If an exporter or producer 
    sold the foreign like product through an affiliated party, the 
    Secretary may calculate normal value based on the sale by such 
    affiliated party. However, the Secretary normally will not calculate 
    normal value based on the sale by an affiliated party if sales of the 
    foreign like product by an exporter or producer to affiliated parties 
    account for less than five percent of the total value (or quantity) of 
    the exporter's or producer's sales of the foreign like product in the 
    market in question or if sales to the affiliated party are comparable, 
    as defined in paragraph (c) of this section.
    
    
    Sec. 351.404  Selection of the market to be used as the basis for 
    normal value.
    
        (a) Introduction. Although in most circumstances sales of the 
    foreign like product in the home market are the most appropriate basis 
    for determining normal value, section 773 of the Act also permits use 
    of sales to a third country or constructed value as the basis for 
    normal value. This section clarifies the rules for determining the 
    basis for normal value.
        (b) Determination of viable market. (1) In general. The Secretary 
    will consider the exporting country or a third country as constituting 
    a viable market if the Secretary is satisfied that sales of the foreign 
    like product in that country are of sufficient quantity to form the 
    basis of normal value.
        (2) Sufficient quantity. ``Sufficient quantity'' normally means 
    that the aggregate quantity (or, if quantity is not appropriate, value) 
    of the foreign like product sold by an exporter or producer in a 
    country is 5 percent or more of the aggregate quantity (or value) of 
    its sales of the subject merchandise to the United States.
        (c) Calculation of price-based normal value in viable market. (1) 
    In general. Subject to paragraph (c)(2) of this section:
        (i) If the exporting country constitutes a viable market, the 
    Secretary will calculate normal value on the basis of price in the 
    exporting country (see section 773(a)(1)(B)(i) of the Act (price used 
    for determining normal value)); or
        (ii) If the exporting country does not constitute a viable market, 
    but a third country does constitute a viable market, the Secretary may 
    calculate normal value on the basis of price to a third country (see 
    section 773(a)(1)(B)(ii) of the Act (use of third country prices in 
    determining normal value)).
        (2) Exception. The Secretary may decline to calculate normal value 
    in a particular market under paragraph (c)(1) of this section if it is 
    established to the satisfaction of the Secretary that:
        (i) In the case of the exporting country or a third country, a 
    particular market situation exists that does not permit a proper 
    comparison with the export price or constructed export price (see 
    section 773(a)(1)(B)(ii)(III) or section 773(a)(1)(C)(iii) of the Act); 
    or
        (ii) In the case of a third country, the price is not 
    representative (see section 773(a)(1)(B)(ii)(I) of the Act).
        (d) Allegations concerning market viability and the basis for 
    determining a price-based normal value. In an antidumping investigation 
    or review, allegations regarding market viability or the exceptions in 
    paragraph (c)(2) of this section, must be filed, with all supporting 
    factual information, in accordance with Sec. 351.301(d)(1).
        (e) Selection of third country. For purposes of calculating normal 
    value based on prices in a third country, where prices in more than one 
    third country satisfy the criteria of section 773(a)(1)(B)(ii) of the 
    Act and this section, the Secretary generally will select the third 
    country based on the following criteria:
        (1) The foreign like product exported to a particular third country 
    is more similar to the subject merchandise exported to the United 
    States than is the foreign like product exported to other third 
    countries;
        (2) The volume of sales to a particular third country is larger 
    than the volume of sales to other third countries;
        (3) Such other factors as the Secretary considers appropriate.
        (f) Third country sales and constructed value. The Secretary 
    normally will calculate normal value based on sales to a third country 
    rather than on constructed value if adequate information is available 
    and verifiable (see section 773(a)(4) of the Act (use of constructed 
    value)).
    
    
    Sec. 351.405  Calculation of normal value based on constructed value.
    
        (a) Introduction. In certain circumstances, the Secretary may 
    determine normal value by constructing a value based on the cost of 
    manufacture, selling general and administrative expenses, and profit. 
    The Secretary may use constructed value as the basis for normal value 
    where: neither the home market nor a third country market is viable; 
    sales below the cost of production are disregarded; sales outside the 
    ordinary course of trade, or sales the prices of which are otherwise 
    unrepresentative, are disregarded; sales used to establish a fictitious 
    market are disregarded; no contemporaneous sales of comparable 
    merchandise are available; or in other circumstances where the 
    Secretary determines that home market or third country prices are 
    inappropriate. (See section 773(e) and section 773(f) of the Act.) This 
    section clarifies the meaning of certain terms relating to constructed 
    value.
        (b) Profit and selling, general, and administrative expenses. In 
    determining the amount to be added to constructed value for profit and 
    for selling, general, and administrative expenses, the following rules 
    will apply:
        (1) Under section 773(e)(2)(A) of the Act, ``foreign country'' 
    means the country in which the merchandise is produced or a third 
    country selected by the Secretary under Sec. 351.404(e), as 
    appropriate.
    
    [[Page 27413]]
    
        (2) Under section 773(e)(2)(B) of the Act, ``foreign country'' 
    means the country in which the merchandise is produced.
    
    
    Sec. 351.406  Calculation of normal value if sales are made at less 
    than cost of production.
    
        (a) Introduction. In determining normal value, the Secretary may 
    disregard sales of the foreign like product made at prices that are 
    less than the cost of production of that product. However, such sales 
    will be disregarded only if they are made within an extended period of 
    time, in substantial quantities, and are not at prices which permit 
    recovery of costs within a reasonable period of time. (See section 
    773(b) of the Act.) This section clarifies the meaning of the term 
    ``extended period of time'' as used in the Act.
        (b) Extended period of time. The ``extended period of time'' under 
    section 773(b)(1)(A) of the Act normally will coincide with the period 
    in which the sales under consideration for the determination of normal 
    value were made.
    
    
    Sec. 351.407  Calculation of constructed value and cost of production.
    
        (a) Introduction. This section sets forth certain rules that are 
    common to the calculation of constructed value and the cost of 
    production. (See section 773(f) of the Act.)
        (b) Determination of value under the major input rule. For purposes 
    of section 773(f)(3) of the Act, the Secretary normally will determine 
    the value of a major input purchased from an affiliated person based on 
    the higher of:
        (1) The price paid by the exporter or producer to the affiliated 
    person for the major input;
        (2) The amount usually reflected in sales of the major input in the 
    market under consideration; or
        (3) The cost to the affiliated person of producing the major input.
        (c) Allocation of costs. In determining the appropriate method for 
    allocating costs among products, the Secretary may take into account 
    production quantities, relative sales values, and other quantitative 
    and qualitative factors associated with the manufacture and sale of the 
    subject merchandise and the foreign like product.
        (d) Startup costs. (1) In identifying startup operations under 
    section 773(f)(1)(C)(ii) of the Act:
        (i) ``New production facilities'' includes the substantially 
    complete retooling of an existing plant. Substantially complete 
    retooling involves the replacement of nearly all production machinery 
    or the equivalent rebuilding of existing machinery.
        (ii) A ``new product'' is one requiring substantial additional 
    investment, including products which, though sold under an existing 
    nameplate, involve the complete revamping or redesign of the product. 
    Routine model year changes will not be considered a new product.
        (iii) Mere improvements to existing products or ongoing 
    improvements to existing facilities will not be considered startup 
    operations.
        (iv) An expansion of the capacity of an existing production line 
    will not qualify as a startup operation unless the expansion 
    constitutes such a major undertaking that it requires the construction 
    of a new facility and results in a depression of production levels due 
    to technical factors associated with the initial phase of commercial 
    production of the expanded facilities.
        (2) In identifying the end of the startup period under clauses (ii) 
    and (iii) of section 773(f)(1)(C) of the Act:
        (i) The attainment of peak production levels will not be the 
    standard for identifying the end of the startup period, because the 
    startup period may end well before a company achieves optimum capacity 
    utilization.
        (ii) The startup period will not be extended to cover improvements 
    and cost reductions that may occur over the entire life cycle of a 
    product.
        (3) In determining when a producer reaches commercial production 
    levels under section 773(f)(1)(C)(ii) of the Act:
        (i) The Secretary will consider the actual production experience of 
    the merchandise in question, measuring production on the basis of units 
    processed.
        (ii) To the extent necessary, the Secretary will examine factors in 
    addition to those specified in section 773(f)(1)(C)(ii) of the Act, 
    including historical data reflecting the same producer's or other 
    producers' experiences in producing the same or similar products. A 
    producer's projections of future volume or cost will be accorded little 
    weight.
        (4) In making an adjustment for startup operations under section 
    773(f)(1)(C)(iii) of the Act:
        (i) The Secretary will determine the duration of the startup period 
    on a case-by-case basis.
        (ii) The difference between actual costs and the costs of 
    production calculated for startup costs will be amortized over a 
    reasonable period of time subsequent to the startup period over the 
    life of the product or machinery, as appropriate.
        (iii) The Secretary will consider unit production costs to be items 
    such as depreciation of equipment and plant, labor costs, insurance, 
    rent and lease expenses, material costs, and factory overhead. The 
    Secretary will not consider sales expenses, such as advertising costs, 
    or other general and administrative or non-production costs (such as 
    general research and development costs), as startup costs.
    
    
    Sec. 351.408  Calculation of normal value of merchandise from nonmarket 
    economy countries.
    
        (a) Introduction. In identifying dumping from a nonmarket economy 
    country, the Secretary normally will calculate normal value by valuing 
    the nonmarket economy producers' factors of production in a market 
    economy country. (See section 773(c) of the Act.) This section 
    clarifies when and how this special methodology for nonmarket economies 
    will be applied.
        (b) Economic Comparability. In determining whether a country is at 
    a level of economic development comparable to the nonmarket economy 
    under section 773(c)(2)(B) or section 773(c)(4)(A) of the Act, the 
    Secretary will place primary emphasis on per capita GDP as the measure 
    of economic comparability.
        (c) Valuation of Factors of Production. For purposes of valuing the 
    factors of production, general expenses, profit, and the cost of 
    containers, coverings, and other expenses (referred to collectively as 
    ``factors'') under section 773(c)(1) of the Act the following rules 
    will apply:
        (1) Information used to value factors. The Secretary normally will 
    use publicly available information to value factors. However, where a 
    factor is purchased from a market economy supplier and paid for in a 
    market economy currency, the Secretary normally will use the price paid 
    to the market economy supplier. In those instances where a portion of 
    the factor is purchased from a market economy supplier and the 
    remainder from a nonmarket economy supplier, the Secretary normally 
    will value the factor using the price paid to the market economy 
    supplier.
        (2) Valuation in a single country. Except for labor, as provided in 
    paragraph (d)(3) of this section, the Secretary normally will value all 
    factors in a single surrogate country.
        (3) Labor. For labor, the Secretary will use regression-based wage 
    rates reflective of the observed relationship between wages and 
    national income in market economy countries. The Secretary will 
    calculate the wage rate to
    
    [[Page 27414]]
    
    be applied in nonmarket economy proceedings each year. The calculation 
    will be based on current data, and will be made available to the 
    public.
        (4) Manufacturing overhead, general expenses, and profit. For 
    manufacturing overhead, general expenses, and profit, the Secretary 
    normally will use non-proprietary information gathered from producers 
    of identical or comparable merchandise in the surrogate country.
    
    
    Sec. 351.409  Differences in quantities.
    
        (a) Introduction. Because the quantity of merchandise sold may 
    affect the price, in comparing export price or constructed export price 
    with normal value, the Secretary will make a reasonable allowance for 
    any difference in quantities to the extent the Secretary is satisfied 
    that the amount of any price differential (or lack thereof) is wholly 
    or partly due to that difference in quantities. (See section 
    773(a)(6)(C)(i) of the Act.)
        (b) Sales with quantity discounts in calculating normal value. The 
    Secretary normally will calculate normal value based on sales with 
    quantity discounts only if:
        (1) During the period examined, or during a more representative 
    period, the exporter or producer granted quantity discounts of at least 
    the same magnitude on 20 percent or more of sales of the foreign like 
    product for the relevant country; or
        (2) The exporter or producer demonstrates to the Secretary's 
    satisfaction that the discounts reflect savings specifically 
    attributable to the production of the different quantities.
        (c) Sales with quantity discounts in calculating weighted-average 
    normal value. If the exporter or producer does not satisfy the 
    conditions of paragraph (b) of this section, the Secretary will 
    calculate normal value based on weighted-average prices that include 
    sales at a discount.
        (d) Price lists. In determining whether a discount has been 
    granted, the existence or lack of a published price list reflecting 
    such a discount will not be controlling. Ordinarily, the Secretary will 
    give weight to a price list only if, in the line of trade and market 
    under consideration, the exporter or producer demonstrates that it has 
    adhered to its price list.
        (e) Relationship to level of trade adjustment. If adjustments are 
    claimed for both differences in quantities and differences in level of 
    trade, the Secretary will not make an adjustment for differences in 
    quantities unless the Secretary is satisfied that the effect on price 
    comparability of differences in quantities has been identified and 
    established separately from the effect on price comparability of 
    differences in the levels of trade.
    
    
    Sec. 351.410  Differences in circumstances of sale
    
        (a) Introduction. In calculating normal value the Secretary may 
    make adjustments to account for certain differences in the 
    circumstances of sales in the United States and foreign markets. (See 
    section 773(a)(6)(C)(iii) of the Act.) This section clarifies certain 
    terms used in the statute regarding circumstances of sale adjustments 
    and describes the adjustment when commissions are paid only in one 
    market.
        (b) In general. With the exception of the allowance described in 
    paragraph (e) of this section concerning commissions paid in only one 
    market, the Secretary will make circumstances of sale adjustments under 
    section 773(a)(6)(C)(iii) of the Act only for direct selling expenses 
    and assumed expenses.
        (c) Direct selling expenses. ``Direct selling expenses'' are 
    expenses, such as commissions, credit expenses, guarantees, and 
    warranties, that result from, and bear a direct relationship to, the 
    particular sale in question.
        (d) Assumed expenses. Assumed expenses are selling expenses that 
    are assumed by the seller on behalf of the buyer, such as advertising 
    expenses.
        (e) Commissions paid in one market. The Secretary normally will 
    make a reasonable allowance for other selling expenses if the Secretary 
    makes a reasonable allowance for commissions in one of the markets 
    under considerations, and no commission is paid in the other market 
    under consideration. The Secretary will limit the amount of such 
    allowance to the amount of the other selling expenses incurred in the 
    one market or the commissions allowed in the other market, whichever is 
    less.
        (f) Reasonable allowance. In deciding what is a reasonable 
    allowance for any difference in circumstances of sale, the Secretary 
    normally will consider the cost of such difference to the exporter or 
    producer but, if appropriate, may also consider the effect of such 
    difference on the market value of the merchandise.
    
    
    Sec. 351.411  Differences in physical characteristics.
    
        (a) Introduction. In comparing United States sales with foreign 
    market sales, the Secretary may determine that the merchandise sold in 
    the United States does not have the same physical characteristics as 
    the merchandise sold in the foreign market, and that the difference has 
    an effect on prices. In calculating normal value, the Secretary will 
    make a reasonable allowance for such differences. (See section 
    773(a)(6)(C)(ii) of the Act.)
        (b) Reasonable allowance. In deciding what is a reasonable 
    allowance for differences in physical characteristics, the Secretary 
    will consider only differences in variable costs associated with the 
    physical differences. Where appropriate, the Secretary may also 
    consider differences in the market value. The Secretary will not 
    consider differences in cost of production when compared merchandise 
    has identical physical characteristics.
    
    
    Sec. 351.412  Levels of trade; adjustment for difference in level of 
    trade; constructed export price offset.
    
        (a) Introduction. In comparing United States sales with foreign 
    market sales, the Secretary may determine that sales in the two markets 
    were not made at the same level of trade, and that the difference has 
    an effect on the comparability of the prices. The Secretary is 
    authorized to adjust normal value to account for such a difference. 
    (See section 773(a)(7) of the Act.)
        (b) Adjustment for difference in level of trade. The Secretary will 
    adjust normal value for a difference in level of trade if:
        (1) The Secretary calculates normal value at a different level of 
    trade from the level of trade of the export price or the constructed 
    export price (whichever is applicable); and
        (2) The Secretary determines that the difference in level of trade 
    has an effect on price comparability.
        (c) Identifying levels of trade and differences in levels of trade. 
    (1) Basis for identifying levels of trade. The Secretary will identify 
    the level of trade based on:
        (i) In the case of export price, the starting price;
        (ii) In the case of constructed export price, the starting price, 
    as adjusted under section 772(d) of the Act; and
        (iii) In the case of normal value, the starting price or 
    constructed value.
        (2) Differences in levels of trade. The Secretary will determine 
    that sales are made at different levels of trade if they are made at 
    different marketing stages (or their equivalent). Substantial 
    differences in selling activities are a necessary, but not sufficient, 
    condition for determining that there is a difference in the stage of 
    marketing. Some overlap in selling activities will not preclude a 
    determination that two sales are at different stages of marketing.
        (d) Effect on price comparability. (1) In general. The Secretary 
    will determine that a difference in level of trade has an
    
    [[Page 27415]]
    
    effect on price comparability only if it is established to the 
    satisfaction of the Secretary that there is a pattern of consistent 
    price differences between sales in the market in which normal value is 
    determined:
        (i) At the level of trade of the export price or constructed export 
    price (whichever is appropriate); and
        (ii) At the level of trade at which normal value is determined.
        (2) Relevant sales. Where possible, the Secretary will make the 
    determination under paragraph (d)(1) of this section on the basis of 
    sales of the foreign like product by the producer or exporter. Where 
    this is not possible, the Secretary may use sales of different or 
    broader product lines, sales by other companies, or any other 
    reasonable basis.
        (e) Amount of adjustment. The Secretary normally will calculate the 
    amount of a level of trade adjustment by:
        (1) Calculating the weighted-averages of the prices of sales at the 
    two levels of trade identified in paragraph (d), after making any other 
    adjustments to those prices appropriate under section 773(a)(6) of the 
    Act and this subpart;
        (2) Calculating the average of the percentage differences between 
    those weighted-average prices; and
        (3) Applying the percentage difference to normal value, where it is 
    at a different level of trade from the export price or constructed 
    export price (whichever is applicable), after making any other 
    adjustments to normal value appropriate under section 773(a)(6) of the 
    Act and this subpart.
        (f) Constructed export price offset. (1) In general. The Secretary 
    will grant a constructed export price offset only where:
        (i) Normal value is compared to constructed export price;
        (ii) Normal value is determined at a more advanced level of trade 
    than the level of trade of the constructed export price; and
        (iii) Despite the fact that a person has cooperated to the best of 
    its ability, the data available do not provide an appropriate basis to 
    determine under paragraph (d) of this section whether the difference in 
    level of trade affects price comparability.
        (2) Amount of the offset. The amount of the constructed export 
    price offset will be the amount of indirect selling expenses included 
    in normal value, up to the amount of indirect selling expenses deducted 
    in determining constructed export price. In making the constructed 
    export price offset, ``indirect selling expenses'' means selling 
    expenses, other than direct selling expenses or assumed selling 
    expenses (see Sec. 351.410), that the seller would incur regardless of 
    whether particular sales were made, but that reasonably may be 
    attributed, in whole or in part, to such sales.
        (3) Where data permit determination of affect on price 
    comparability. Where available data permit the Secretary to determine 
    under paragraph (d) of this section whether the difference in level of 
    trade affects price comparability, the Secretary will not grant a 
    constructed export price offset. In such cases, if the Secretary 
    determines that price comparability has been affected, the Secretary 
    will make a level of trade adjustment. If the Secretary determines that 
    price comparability has not been affected, the Secretary will not grant 
    either a level of trade adjustment or a constructed export price 
    offset.
    
    
    Sec. 351.413  Disregarding insignificant adjustments.
    
        Ordinarily, under section 777A(a)(2) of the Act, an ``insignificant 
    adjustment'' is any individual adjustment having an ad valorem effect 
    of less than 0.33 percent, or any group of adjustments having an ad 
    valorem effect of less than 1.0 percent, of the export price, 
    constructed export price, or normal value, as the case may be. Groups 
    of adjustments are adjustments for differences in circumstances of sale 
    under Sec. 351.410, adjustments for differences in the physical 
    characteristics of the merchandise under Sec. 351.411, and adjustments 
    for differences in the levels of trade under Sec. 351.412.
    
    
    Sec. 351.414  Comparison of normal value with export price (constructed 
    export price).
    
        (a) Introduction. The Secretary normally will average prices used 
    as the basis for normal value and, in an investigation, prices used as 
    the basis for export price or constructed export price as well. This 
    section explains when and how the Secretary will average prices in 
    making comparisons of export price or constructed export price with 
    normal value. (See section 777A(d) of the Act.)
        (b) Description of methods of comparison. (1) Average-to-average 
    method. The ``average-to-average'' method involves a comparison of the 
    weighted average of the normal values with the weighted average of the 
    export prices (and constructed export prices) for comparable 
    merchandise.
        (2) Transaction-to-transaction method. The ``transaction-to-
    transaction'' method involves a comparison of the normal values of 
    individual transactions with the export prices (or constructed export 
    prices) of individual transactions for comparable merchandise.
        (3) Average-to-transaction method. The ``average-to-transaction'' 
    method involves a comparison of the weighted average of the normal 
    values to the export prices (or constructed export prices) of 
    individual transactions for comparable merchandise.
        (c) Preferences. (1) In an investigation, the Secretary normally 
    will use the average-to-average method. The Secretary will use the 
    transaction-to-transaction method only in unusual situations, such as 
    when there are very few sales of subject merchandise and the 
    merchandise sold in each market is identical or very similar or is 
    custom-made.
        (2) In a review, the Secretary normally will use the average-to-
    transaction method.
        (d) Application of the average-to-average method. (1) In general. 
    In applying the average-to-average method, the Secretary will identify 
    those sales of the subject merchandise to the United States that are 
    comparable, and will include such sales in an ``averaging group.'' The 
    Secretary will calculate a weighted average of the export prices and 
    the constructed export prices of the sales included in the averaging 
    group, and will compare this weighted average to the weighted average 
    of the normal values of such sales.
        (2) Identification of the averaging group. An averaging group will 
    consist of subject merchandise that is identical or virtually identical 
    in all physical characteristics and that is sold to the United States 
    at the same level of trade. In identifying sales to be included in an 
    averaging group, the Secretary also will take into account, where 
    appropriate, the region of the United States in which the merchandise 
    is sold, and such other factors as the Secretary considers relevant.
        (3) Time period over which weighted average is calculated. When 
    applying the average-to-average method, the Secretary normally will 
    calculate weighted averages for the entire period of investigation or 
    review, as the case may be. However, when normal values, export prices, 
    or constructed export prices differ significantly over the course of 
    the period of investigation or review, the Secretary may calculate 
    weighted averages for such shorter period as the Secretary deems 
    appropriate.
        (e) Application of the average-to-transaction method. (1) In 
    general. In applying the average-to-transaction method in a review, 
    when normal value is based on the weighted average of sales of the 
    foreign like product, the
    
    [[Page 27416]]
    
    Secretary will limit the averaging of such prices to sales incurred 
    during the contemporaneous month.
        (2) Contemporaneous month. Normally, the Secretary will select as 
    the contemporaneous month the first of the following which applies:
        (i) The month during which the particular U.S. sale under 
    consideration was made;
        (ii) If there are no sales of the foreign like product during this 
    month, the most recent of the three months prior to the month of the 
    U.S. sale in which there was a sale of the foreign like product.
        (iii) If there are no sales of the foreign like product during any 
    of these months, the earlier of the two months following the month of 
    the U.S. sale in which there was a sale of the foreign like product.
        (f) Targeted dumping. (1) In general. Notwithstanding paragraph 
    (c)(1) of this section, the Secretary may apply the average-to-
    transaction method, as described in paragraph (e) of this section, in 
    an antidumping investigation if:
        (i) As determined through the use of, among other things, standard 
    and appropriate statistical techniques, there is targeted dumping in 
    the form of a pattern of export prices (or constructed export prices) 
    for comparable merchandise that differ significantly among purchasers, 
    regions, or periods of time; and
        (ii) The Secretary determines that such differences cannot be taken 
    into account using the average-to-average method or the transaction-to-
    transaction method and explains the basis for that determination.
        (2) Limitation of average-to-transaction method to targeted 
    dumping. Where the criteria for identifying targeted dumping under 
    paragraph (f)(1) of this section are satisfied, the Secretary normally 
    will limit the application of the average-to-transaction method to 
    those sales that constitute targeted dumping under paragraph (f)(1)(i) 
    of this section.
        (3) Allegations concerning targeted dumping. The Secretary normally 
    will examine only targeted dumping described in an allegation, filed 
    within the time indicated in Sec. 351.301(d)(5). Allegations must 
    include all supporting factual information, and an explanation as to 
    why the average-to-average or transaction-to-transaction method could 
    not take into account any alleged price differences.
        (g) Requests for information. In an investigation, the Secretary 
    will request information relevant to the identification of averaging 
    groups under paragraph (d)(2) of this section and to the analysis of 
    possible targeted dumping under paragraph (f) of this section. If a 
    response to a request for such information is such as to warrant the 
    application of the facts otherwise available, within the meaning of 
    section 776 of the Act and Sec. 351.308, the Secretary may apply the 
    average-to-transaction method to all the sales of the producer or 
    exporter concerned.
    
    
    Sec. 351.415  Conversion of currency.
    
        (a) In general. In an antidumping proceeding, the Secretary will 
    convert foreign currencies into United States dollars using the rate of 
    exchange on the date of sale of the subject merchandise.
        (b) Exception. If the Secretary establishes that a currency 
    transaction on forward markets is directly linked to an export sale 
    under consideration, the Secretary will use the exchange rate specified 
    with respect to such foreign currency in the forward sale agreement to 
    convert the foreign currency.
        (c) Exchange rate fluctuations. The Secretary will ignore 
    fluctuations in exchange rates.
        (d) Sustained movement in foreign currency value. In an antidumping 
    investigation, if there is a sustained movement increasing the value of 
    the foreign currency relative to the United States dollar, the 
    Secretary will allow exporters 60 days to adjust their prices to 
    reflect such sustained movement.
    
    Subpart E--[Reserved]
    
    Subpart F--Subsidy Determinations Regarding Cheese Subject to an 
    In-Quota Rate of Duty
    
    
    Sec. 351.601  Annual list and quarterly update of subsidies.
    
        The Secretary will make the determinations called for by section 
    702(a) of the Trade Agreements Act of 1979, as amended (19 U.S.C. 1202 
    note) based on the available information, and will publish the annual 
    list and quarterly updates described in such section in the Federal 
    Register.
    
    
    Sec. 351.602  Determination upon request.
    
        (a) Request for determination. (1) Any person, including the 
    Secretary of Agriculture, who has reason to believe there have been 
    changes in or additions to the latest annual list published under 
    Sec. 351.601 may request in writing that the Secretary determine under 
    section 702(a)(3) of the Trade Agreements Act of 1979 whether there are 
    any changes or additions. The person must file the request with the 
    Central Records Unit (see Sec. 351.103). The request must allege either 
    a change in the type or amount of any subsidy included in the latest 
    annual list or quarterly update or an additional subsidy not included 
    in that list or update provided by a foreign government, and must 
    contain the following, to the extent reasonably available to the 
    requesting person:
        (i) The name and address of the person;
        (ii) The article of cheese subject to an in-quota rate of duty 
    allegedly benefitting from the changed or additional subsidy;
        (iii) The country of origin of the article of cheese subject to an 
    in-quota rate of duty; and
        (iv) The alleged subsidy or changed subsidy and relevant factual 
    information (particularly documentary evidence) regarding the alleged 
    changed or additional subsidy including the authority under which it is 
    provided, the manner in which it is paid, and the value of the subsidy 
    to producers or exporters of the article.
        (2) The requirements of Sec. 351.303 (c) and (d) apply to this 
    section.
        (b) Determination. Not later than 30 days after receiving an 
    acceptable request, the Secretary will:
        (1) In consultation with the Secretary of Agriculture, determine 
    based on the available information whether there has been any change in 
    the type or amount of any subsidy included in the latest annual list or 
    quarterly update or an additional subsidy not included in that list or 
    update is being provided by a foreign government;
        (2) Notify the Secretary of Agriculture and the person making the 
    request of the determination; and
        (3) Promptly publish in the Federal Register notice of any changes 
    or additions.
    
    
    Sec. 351.603  Complaint of price-undercutting by subsidized imports.
    
        Upon receipt of a complaint filed with the Secretary of Agriculture 
    under section 702(b) of the Trade Agreements Act concerning price-
    undercutting by subsidized imports, the Secretary will promptly 
    determine, under section 702(a)(3) of the Trade Agreements Act of 1979, 
    whether or not the alleged subsidies are included in or should be added 
    to the latest annual list or quarterly update.
    
    
    Sec. 351.604  Access to information.
    
        Subpart C of this part applies to factual information submitted in 
    connection with this subpart.
    
    Subpart G--Applicability Dates
    
    
    Sec. 351.701  Applicability dates.
    
        The regulations contained in this part 351 apply to all 
    administrative reviews initiated on the basis of requests made
    
    [[Page 27417]]
    
    on or after the first day of July, 1997, to all investigations and 
    other segments of proceedings initiated on the basis of petitions filed 
    or requests made after June 18, 1997 and to segments of proceedings 
    self-initiated by the Department after June 18, 1997. Segments of 
    proceedings to which part 351 do not apply will continue to be governed 
    by the regulations in effect on the date the petitions were filed or 
    requests were made for those segments, to the extent that those 
    regulations were not invalidated by the URAA or replaced by the interim 
    final regulations published on May 11, 1995 (60 FR 25130 (1995)). For 
    segments of proceedings initiated on the basis of petitions filed or 
    requests made after January 1, 1995, but before part 351 applies, part 
    351 will serve as a restatement of the Department's interpretation of 
    the requirements of the Act as amended by the URAA.
    
        Annex I.--Deadlines for Parties in Countervailing Investigations    
    ------------------------------------------------------------------------
               Day \1\                    Event              Regulation     
    ------------------------------------------------------------------------
    0 days......................  Initiation..........  ....................
    31 days \2\.................  Notification of       351.301(c)(2)(iv)   
                                   difficulty in         (14 days after date
                                   responding to         of receipt of      
                                   questionnaire.        initial            
                                                         questionnaire).    
    37 days.....................  Application for an    351.305(b)(3).      
                                   administrative                           
                                   protective order.                        
    40 days.....................  Request for           351.205(e) (25 days 
                                   postponement by       or more before     
                                   petitioner.           preliminary        
                                                         determination).    
    45 days.....................  Allegation of         351.206(c)(2)(i) (20
                                   critical              days before        
                                   circumstances.        preliminary        
                                                         determination).    
    47 days.....................  Questionnaire         351.301(c)(2)(iii)  
                                   response.             (30 days from date 
                                                         of receipt of      
                                                         initial            
                                                         questionnaire).    
    55 days.....................  Allegation of         351.301(d)(4)(ii)(A)
                                   upstream subsidies.   (10 days before    
                                                         preliminary        
                                                         determination).    
    65 days (Can be extended)...  Preliminary           351.205(b)(1).      
                                   determination.                           
    72 days.....................  Submission of         351.208(f)(1)(B) (7 
                                   proposed suspension   days after         
                                   agreement.            preliminary        
                                                         determination).    
    75 days \3\.................  Submission of         351.301(b)(1) (7    
                                   factual information.  days before date on
                                                         which verification 
                                                         is to commence).   
    75 days.....................  Submission of         351.224(c)(2) (5    
                                   ministerial error     days after release 
                                   comments.             of disclosure      
                                                         documents).        
    77 days \4\.................  Request to align a    351.210(i) (5 days  
                                   CVD case with a       after date of      
                                   concurrent AD case.   publication of     
                                                         preliminary        
                                                         determination).    
    102 days....................  Request for a         351.310(c) (30 days 
                                   hearing.              after date of      
                                                         publication of     
                                                         preliminary        
                                                         determination).    
    119 days....................  Critical              351.206(e) (21 days 
                                   circumstances         or more before     
                                   allegation.           final              
                                                         determination).    
    122 days....................  Requests for closed   351.310(f) (No later
                                   hearing sessions.     than the date the  
                                                         case briefs are    
                                                         due).              
    122 days....................  Submission of briefs  351.309(c)(1)(i) (50
                                                         days after date of 
                                                         publication of     
                                                         preliminary        
                                                         determination).    
    125 days....................  Allegation of         351.301(d)(4)(ii)(B)
                                   upstream subsidies.   (15 days before    
                                                         final              
                                                         determination).    
    127 days....................  Submission of         351.309(d) (5 days  
                                   rebuttal briefs.      after dead-line for
                                                         filing case brief).
    129 days....................  Hearing.............  351.310(d)(1) (2    
                                                         days after         
                                                         submission of      
                                                         rebuttal briefs).  
    140 days (Can be extended)..  Final determination.  351.210(b)(1) (75   
                                                         days after         
                                                         preliminary        
                                                         determination).    
    150 days....................  Submission of         351.224(c)(2) (5    
                                   ministerial error     days after release 
                                   comments.             of disclosure      
                                                         documents).        
    155 days....................  Submission of         351.224(c)(3) (5    
                                   replies to            days after filing  
                                   ministerial error     of comments).      
                                   comments.                                
    192 days....................  Order issued........  351.211(b).         
    ------------------------------------------------------------------------
    \1\ Indicates the number of days from the date of initiation. Most of   
      the deadlines shown here are approximate. The actual deadline in any  
      particular segment of a proceeding may depend on the date of an       
      earlier event or be established by the Secretary.                     
    \2\ Assumes that the Department sends out the questionnaire within 10   
      days of the initiation and allows 7 days for receipt of the           
      questionnaire from the date on which it was transmitted.              
    \3\ Assumes about 17 days between the preliminary determination and     
      verification.                                                         
    \4\ Assumes that the preliminary determination is published 7 days after
      issuance (i.e., signature).                                           
    
    
        Annex II.--Deadlines for Parties in Countervailing Administrative   
                                     Reviews                                
    ------------------------------------------------------------------------
               Day \1\                    Event              Regulation     
    ------------------------------------------------------------------------
    0 days......................  Request for review..  351.213(b) (Last day
                                                         of the anniversary 
                                                         month).            
    30 days.....................  Publication of        351.221(c)(1)(i)    
                                   initiation notice.    (End of month      
                                                         following the      
                                                         anniversary month).
    66 days \2\.................  Notification of       351.301(c)(2)(iv)   
                                   difficulty in         (14 days after date
                                   responding to         of receipt of      
                                   questionnaire.        initial            
                                                         questionnaire).    
    75 days.....................  Application for an    351.305(b)(3).      
                                   administrative                           
                                   protective order.                        
    
    [[Page 27418]]
    
                                                                            
    90 days \3\.................  Questionnaire         351.301(c)(2)(iii)  
                                   response.             (At least 30 days  
                                                         after date of      
                                                         receipt of initial 
                                                         questionnaire).    
    120 days....................  Withdrawal of         351.213(d)(1) (90   
                                   request for review.   days after date of 
                                                         publication of     
                                                         initiation).       
    130 days....................  Request for           351.307(b)(1)(v)    
                                   verification.         (100 days after    
                                                         date of publication
                                                         of initiation).    
    140 days....................  Submission of         351.301(b)(2).      
                                   factual information.                     
    245 days (Can be extended)..  Preliminary results   351.213(h)(1).      
                                   of review.                               
    282 days \4\................  Request for a         351.310(c);         
                                   hearing and/or        351.310(f) (30 days
                                   closed hearing        after date of      
                                   session.              publication of     
                                                         preliminary        
                                                         results).          
    282 days....................  Submission of briefs  351.309(c)(1)(ii)   
                                                         (30 days after date
                                                         of publication of  
                                                         preliminary        
                                                         results).          
    287 days....................  Submission of         351.309(d)(1) (5    
                                   rebuttal briefs.      days after deadline
                                                         for filing case    
                                                         briefs).           
    289 days....................  Hearing.............  351.310(d)(1) (2    
                                                         days after         
                                                         submission of      
                                                         rebuttal briefs).  
    372 days (Can be extended)..  Final results of      351.213(h)(1) (120  
                                   review.               days after date of 
                                                         publication of     
                                                         preliminary        
                                                         results).          
    382 days....................  Submission of         351.224(c)(2) (5    
                                   ministerial error     days after release 
                                   comments.             of disclosure      
                                                         documents).        
    387 days....................  Replies to            351.224(c)(3) (5    
                                   ministerial error     days after filing  
                                   comments.             of comments).      
    ------------------------------------------------------------------------
    \1\ Indicates the number of days from the end of the anniversary month. 
      Most of the deadlines shown here are approximate. The actual deadline 
      in any particular segment of a proceeding may depend on the date of an
      earlier event or be established by the Secretary.                     
    \2\ Assumes that the Department sends out the questionnaire 45 days     
      after the last day of the anniversary month and allows 7 days for     
      receipt of the questionnaire from the date on which it was            
      transmitted.                                                          
    \3\ Assumes that the Department sends out the questionnaire on day 45   
      and the response is due 45 days later.                                
    \4\ Assumes that the preliminary results are published 7 days after     
      issuance (i.e., signature).                                           
    
    
         Annex III.--Deadlines for Parties in Antidumping Investigations    
    ------------------------------------------------------------------------
               Day \1\                    Event              Regulation     
    ------------------------------------------------------------------------
    0 days......................  Initiation..........  ....................
    37 days.....................  Application for an    351.305(b)(3).      
                                   administrative                           
                                   protective order.                        
    50 days.....................  Country-wide cost     351.301(d)(2)(i)(A) 
                                   allegation.           (20 days after date
                                                         on which initial   
                                                         questionnaire was  
                                                         transmitted).      
    51 days \2\.................  Notification of       351.301(c)(2)(iv)   
                                   difficulty in         (Within 14 days    
                                   responding to         after date of      
                                   questionnaire.        receipt of initial 
                                                         questionnaire).    
    51 days.....................  Section A response..  None.               
    67 days.....................  Sections B, C, D, E   351.301(c)(2)(iii)  
                                   responses.            (At least 30 days  
                                                         after date of      
                                                         receipt of initial 
                                                         questionnaire).    
    70 days.....................  Viability arguments.  351.301(d)(1) (40   
                                                         days after date on 
                                                         which initial      
                                                         questionnaire was  
                                                         transmitted).      
    87 days.....................  Company-specific      351.301(d)(2)(i)(B).
                                   cost allegations.                        
    87 days.....................  Major input cost      351.301(d)(3).      
                                   allegations.                             
    115 days....................  Request for           351.205(e) (25 days 
                                   postponement by       or more before     
                                   petitioner.           preliminary        
                                                         determination).    
    120 days....................  Allegation of         351.206(c)(2)(i) (20
                                   critical              days before        
                                   circumstances.        preliminary        
                                                         determination).    
    140 days (Can be extended)..  Preliminary           351.205(b)(1).      
                                   determination.                           
    150 days....................  Submission of         351.224(c)(2) (5    
                                   ministerial error     days after release 
                                   comments.             of disclosure      
                                                         documents).        
    155 days....................  Submission of         351.208(f)(1)(A) (15
                                   proposed suspension   days after         
                                   agreement.            preliminary        
                                                         determination).    
    161 days \3\................  Submission of         351.301(b)(1) (7    
                                   factual information.  days before date on
                                                         which verification 
                                                         is to commence).   
    177 days \4\................  Request for a         351.310(c) (30 days 
                                   hearing.              after date of      
                                                         publication of     
                                                         preliminary        
                                                         determination).    
    187 days....................  Submission of         351.301(c)(3)(i) (40
                                   publicly available    days after date of 
                                   information to        publication of     
                                   value factors         preliminary        
                                   (NME's).              determination).    
    194 days....................  Critical              351.206(e) (21 days 
                                   circumstance          before final       
                                   allegation.           determination).    
    197 days (Can be changed)...  Request for closed    351.310(f) (No later
                                   hearing sessions.     than the date the  
                                                         case briefs are    
                                                         due).              
    197 days (Can be changed)...  Submission of briefs  351.309(c)(1)(i) (50
                                                         days after date of 
                                                         publication of     
                                                         preliminary        
                                                         determination).    
    202 days....................  Submission of         351.309(d) (5 days  
                                   rebuttal briefs.      after dealine for  
                                                         filing case        
                                                         briefs).           
    204 days....................  Hearing.............  351.310(d)(1) (2    
                                                         days after         
                                                         submission of      
                                                         rebuttal briefs).  
    
    [[Page 27419]]
    
                                                                            
    215 days....................  Request for           351.210(e).         
                                   postponement of the                      
                                   final determination.                     
    215 days (Can be extended)..  Final determination.  351.210(b)(1) (75   
                                                         days after         
                                                         preliminary        
                                                         determination).    
    225 days....................  Submission            351.224(c)(2) (5    
                                   ministerial error     days after release 
                                   comments.             of disclosure      
                                                         documents).        
    230 days....................  Replies to            351.224(c)(3) (5    
                                   ministerial error     days after filing  
                                   comments.             of comments).      
    267 days....................  Order issued........  351.211(b).         
    ------------------------------------------------------------------------
    \1\ Indicates the number of days from the date of initiation. Most of   
      the deadlines shown here are approximate. The actual deadline in any  
      particular segment of a proceeding may depend on the date of an       
      earlier event or be established by the Secretary.                     
    \2\ Assumes that the Department sends out the questionnaire 5 days after
      the ITC vote and allows 7 days for receipt of the questionnaire from  
      the date on which it was transmitted.                                 
    \3\ Assumes about 28 days between the preliminary determination and     
      verification.                                                         
    \4\ Assumes that the preliminary determination is published 7 days after
      issuance (i.e., signature).                                           
    
    
      Annex IV.--Deadlines for Parties in Antidumping Administrative Reviews
    ------------------------------------------------------------------------
               Day\1\                     Event              Regulation     
    ------------------------------------------------------------------------
    0 days......................  Request for review..  351.213(b) (Last day
                                                         of the anniversary 
                                                         month).            
    30 days.....................  Publication of        351.221 (c)(1)(i)   
                                   initiation.           (End of month      
                                                         following the      
                                                         anniversary month).
    37 days.....................  Application for an    351.305(b)(3).      
                                   administrative                           
                                   protective order.                        
    60 days.....................  Request to examine    351.213(j) (30 days 
                                   absorption of         after date of      
                                   duties (AD).          publication of     
                                                         initiation).       
    66 days \2\.................  Notification of       351.301(c)(2)(iv)   
                                   difficulty in         (14 days after date
                                   responding to         of receipt of      
                                   questionnaire.        initial            
                                                         questionnaire).    
    66 days.....................  Section A response..  None.               
    85 days.....................  Viability arguments.  351.301(d)(1) (40   
                                                         days after date of 
                                                         transmittal of     
                                                         initial            
                                                         questionnaire).    
    90 days\3\..................  Sections B, C, D, E   351.301(c)(2)(iii)  
                                   response.             (At least 30 days  
                                                         after date of      
                                                         receipt of initial 
                                                         questionnaire).    
    110 days....................  Company-specific      351.301(d)(2)(i)(B) 
                                   cost allegations.     (20 days after     
                                                         relevant section is
                                                         filed).            
    110 days....................  Major input cost      351.301(d)(3) (20   
                                   allegations.          days after relevant
                                                         section is filed). 
    120 days....................  Withdrawal of         351.213(d)(1) (90   
                                   request for review.   days after date of 
                                                         publication of     
                                                         initiation)        
    130 days....................  Request for           351.307(b)(1)(v)    
                                   verification.         (100 days after    
                                                         date of publication
                                                         of initiation).    
    140 days....................  Submission of         351.301(b)(2).      
                                   factual information.                     
    245 days (Can be extended)..  Preliminary results   351.213(h)(1).      
                                   of review.                               
    272 days\4\.................  Submission of         351.301(c)(3)(ii)   
                                   publicly available    (20 days after date
                                   information to        of publication of  
                                   value factors         preliminary        
                                   (NME's).              results).          
    282 days....................  Request for a         351.310(c);         
                                   hearing and/or        351.310(f) (30 days
                                   closed hearing        after date of      
                                   session.              publication of     
                                                         preliminary        
                                                         results).          
    282 days....................  Submission of briefs  351.309(c)(1)(ii)   
                                                         (30 days after date
                                                         of publication of  
                                                         preliminary        
                                                         results).          
    287 days....................  Submission of         351.309(d)(1) (5    
                                   rebuttal briefs.      days after deadline
                                                         for filing case    
                                                         briefs).           
    289 days....................  Hearing; closed       351.310(d)(1) (2    
                                   hearing session.      days after         
                                                         submission of      
                                                         rebuttal briefs).  
    372 days (Can be extended)..  Final results of      351.213(h)(1) (120  
                                   review.               days after date of 
                                                         publication of     
                                                         preliminary        
                                                         results).          
    382 days....................  Ministerial error     351.224(c)(2) (5    
                                   comments.             days after release 
                                                         of disclosure      
                                                         documents).        
    387 days....................  Replies to            351.224(c)(3) (5    
                                   ministerial error     days after filing  
                                   comments.             of comments).      
    ------------------------------------------------------------------------
    \1\ Indicates the number of days from the end of the anniversary month. 
      Most of the deadlines shown here are approximate. The actual deadline 
      in any particular segment of a proceeding may depend on the date of an
      earlier event or be established by the Secretary.                     
    \2\ Assumes that the Department sends out the questionnaire 45 days     
      after the last day of the anniversary month and allows 7 days for     
      receipt of the questionnaire from the date on which it was            
      transmitted.                                                          
    \3\ Assumes that the Department sends out the questionnaire on day 45   
      and the response is due 45 days later.                                
    \4\ Assumes that the preliminary results are published 7 days after     
      issuance (i.e., signature).                                           
    
    
    [[Page 27420]]
    
    
                                    Annex V.--Comparison of Prior and New Regulations                               
    ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                      Prior                                       New                            Description        
    ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                              PART 353--ANTIDUMPING DUTIES                                          
    ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                            Subpart A--Scope and Definitions                                        
    ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
    353.1....................................  351.101.................................  Scope of regulations.      
    353.2....................................  351.102.................................  Definitions.               
    353.3....................................  351.104.................................  Record of proceedings.     
    353.4....................................  351.105.................................  Public, proprietary,       
                                                                                          privileged & classified.  
    353.5....................................  Removed.................................  Trade and Tariff Act of    
                                                                                          1984 amendments.          
    353.6....................................  351.106.................................  De minimis weighted-average
                                                                                          dumping margin.           
    ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                         Subpart B--Antidumping Duty Procedures                                     
    ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
    353.11...................................  351.201.................................  Self-initiation.           
    353.12...................................  351.202.................................  Petition requirements.     
    353.13...................................  351.203.................................  Determination of           
                                                                                          sufficiency of petition.  
    353.14...................................  351.204(e)..............................  Exclusion from antidumping 
                                                                                          duty order.               
    353.15...................................  351.205.................................  Preliminary determination. 
    353.16...................................  351.206.................................  Critical circumstances.    
    353.17...................................  351.207.................................  Termination of             
                                                                                          investigation.            
    353.18...................................  351.208.................................  Suspension of              
                                                                                          investigation.            
    353.19...................................  351.209.................................  Violation of suspension    
                                                                                          agreement.                
    353.20...................................  351.210.................................  Final determination.       
    353.21...................................  351.211.................................  Antidumping duty order.    
    353.21(c)................................  351.204(e)..............................  Exclusion from antidumping 
                                                                                          duty order.               
    1353.22 (a)-(d)..........................  351.213,................................  Administrative reviews     
                                               351.221.................................   under 751(a) of the Act.  
    353.22(e)................................  351.212(c)..............................  Automatic assessment of    
                                                                                          duties.                   
    353.22(f)................................  351.216,................................  Changed circumstances      
                                               351.221(c)(3)...........................   reviews.                  
    353.22(g)................................  351.215,................................  Expedited antidumping      
                                               351.221(c)(2)...........................   review.                   
    353.23...................................  351.212(d)..............................  Provisional measures       
                                                                                          deposit cap.              
    353.24...................................  351.212(e)..............................  Interest on overpayments   
                                                                                          and under-payments.       
    353.25...................................  351.222.................................  Revocation of orders;      
                                                                                          termination of suspended  
                                                                                          investigations.           
    353.26...................................  351.402(f)..............................  Reimbursement of duties.   
    353.27...................................  351.223.................................  Downstream product         
                                                                                          monitoring.               
    353.28...................................  351.224.................................  Correction of ministerial  
                                                                                          errors.                   
    353.29...................................  351.225.................................  Scope rulings.             
    ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                           Subpart C--Information and Argument                                      
    ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
    353.31 (a)-(c)...........................  351.301.................................  Time Limits for submission 
                                                                                          of factual information.   
    353.31(a)(3).............................  351.301(d),.............................  Return of untimely         
                                               351.104(a)(2)...........................   material.                 
    353.31(b)(3).............................  351.302(c)..............................  Request for extension of   
                                                                                          time.                     
    353.31 (d)-(i)...........................  351.303.................................  Filing, format,            
                                                                                          translation, service and  
                                                                                          certification.            
    353.32...................................  351.304.................................  Request for proprietary    
                                                                                          treatment of information. 
    353.33...................................  351.104, 351.304(a)(2)..................  Information exempt from    
                                                                                          disclosure.               
    353.34...................................  351.305, 351.306........................  Disclosure of information  
                                                                                          under protective order.   
    353.35...................................  Removed.................................  Ex parte meeting.          
    353.36...................................  351.307.................................  Verification.              
    353.37...................................  351.308.................................  Determination on the basis 
                                                                                          of the facts available.   
    353.38 (a)-(e)...........................  351.309.................................  Written argument.          
    353.38(f)................................  351.310.................................  Hearings.                  
    ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
              Subpart D--Calculation of Export Price, Constructed Export Price, Fair Value and Normal Value         
    ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
    353.41...................................  351.402.................................  Calculation of export      
                                                                                          price.                    
    353.42(a)................................  351.102.................................  Fair value (definition).   
    353.42(b)................................  351.104(c)..............................  Transaction and persons    
                                                                                          examined.                 
    353.43...................................  351.403(b)..............................  Sales used in calculating  
                                                                                          normal value.             
    353.44...................................  Removed.................................  Sales at varying prices.   
    353.45...................................  351.403.................................  Transactions between       
                                                                                          affiliated parties.       
    353.46...................................  351.404.................................  Selection of home market as
                                                                                          the basis for normal      
                                                                                          value.                    
    353.47...................................  Removed.................................  Intermediate countries.    
    353.48...................................  351.404.................................  Basis for normal value if  
                                                                                          home market sales are     
                                                                                          inadequate.               
    353.49...................................  351.404.................................  Sales to a third country.  
    353.50...................................  351.405, 351.407........................  Calculation of normal value
                                                                                          based on constructed      
                                                                                          value.                    
    353.51...................................  351.406, 351.407........................  Sales at less than the cost
                                                                                          of production.            
    353.52...................................  351.408.................................  Nonmarket economy          
                                                                                          countries.                
    353.53...................................  Removed.................................  Multinational corporations.
    
    [[Page 27421]]
    
                                                                                                                    
    353.54...................................  351.401(b)..............................  Claims for adjustments.    
    353.55...................................  351.409.................................  Differences in quantities. 
    353.56...................................  351.410.................................  Differences in             
                                                                                          circumstances of sale.    
    353.57...................................  351.411.................................  Differences in physical    
                                                                                          characteristics.          
    353.58...................................  351.412.................................  Levels of trade.           
    353.59(a)................................  351.413.................................  Insignificant adjustments. 
    353.59(b)................................  351.414.................................  Use of averaging.          
    353.60...................................  351.415.................................  Conversion of currency.    
    ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                             PART 355--COUNTERVAILING DUTIES                                        
    ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                            Subpart A--Scope and Definitions                                        
    ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
    355.1....................................  351.001.................................  Scope of regulations.      
    355.2....................................  351.002.................................  Definitions.               
    355.3....................................  351.004.................................  Record of proceeding.      
    355.4....................................  351.005.................................  Public, proprietary,       
                                                                                          privileged & classified.  
    355.5....................................  351.003(a)..............................  Subsidy library.           
    355.6....................................  Removed.................................  Trade and Tariff Act of    
                                                                                          1984 amendments.          
    355.7....................................  351.006.................................  De minimis net subsidies.  
    ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                        Subpart B--Countervailing Duty Procedures                                   
    ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
    355.11...................................  351.101.................................  Delf-initiation.           
    355.12...................................  351.102.................................  Petition requirements.     
    355.13...................................  351.103.................................  Determination of           
                                                                                          sufficiency of petition.  
    355.14...................................  351.104(e)..............................  Exclusion from             
                                                                                          countervailing duty order.
    355.15...................................  351.105.................................  Preliminary determination. 
    355.16...................................  351.106.................................  Critical circumstances.    
    355.17...................................  351.107.................................  Termination of             
                                                                                          investigation.            
    355.18...................................  351.108.................................  Suspension of              
                                                                                          investigation.            
    355.19...................................  351.109.................................  Violation of agreement.    
    355.20...................................  351.110.................................  Final determination.       
    355.21...................................  351.111.................................  Countervailing duty order. 
    355.21(c)................................  351.104(e)..............................  Exclusion from             
                                                                                          countervailing duty order.
    355.22 (a)-(c)...........................  351.113, 351.121........................  Administrative reviews     
                                                                                          under 751(a) of the Act.  
    355.22(d)................................  Removed.................................  Calculation of individual  
                                                                                          rates.                    
    355.22(e)................................  351.113(h)..............................  Possible cancellation or   
                                                                                          revision of suspension    
                                                                                          agreements.               
    355.22(f)................................  Removed.................................  Review of individual       
                                                                                          producer or exporter.     
    355.22(g)................................  351.112(c)..............................  Automatic assessment of    
                                                                                          duties                    
    355.22(h)................................  351.116,................................  Changed circumstances      
                                               351.121(c)(3)...........................   review                    
    355.22(i)................................  351.120,................................  Review at the direction of 
                                               351.221(c)(7)...........................   the President.            
    355.23...................................  351.112(d)..............................  Provisional measures       
                                                                                          deposit cap               
    355.24...................................  351.112(e)..............................  Interest on overpayments   
                                                                                          and underpayments.        
    355.25...................................  351.112.................................  Revocation of orders;      
                                                                                          termination of suspended  
                                                                                          investigations.           
    355.27...................................  351.123.................................  Downstream product         
                                                                                          monitoring.               
    355.28...................................  351.124.................................  Correction of ministerial  
                                                                                          errors.                   
    355.29...................................  351.125.................................  Scope determinations.      
    ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                           Subpart C--Information and Argument                                      
    ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
    355.31 (a)-(c)...........................  351.301.................................  Time limits for submission 
                                                                                          of factual information.   
    355.31(a)(3).............................  351.302(d),.............................  Return of untimely         
                                               351.104(a)(2)...........................   material.                 
    355.31(b)(3).............................  351.302(c)..............................  Request for extension of   
                                                                                          time.                     
    355.31 (d)-(i)...........................  351.303.................................  Filing, format,            
                                                                                          translation, service and  
                                                                                          certification.            
    355.32...................................  351.304.................................  Request for proprietary    
                                                                                          treatment of information. 
    355.33...................................  351.104,................................  Information exempt from    
                                               351.304(a)(2)...........................   disclosure.               
    355.34...................................  351.305,................................  Disclosure of information  
                                               351.306.................................   under protective order.   
    355.35...................................  Removed.................................  Ex parte meeting.          
    355.36...................................  351.307.................................  Verification.              
    355.37...................................  351.308.................................  Determinations on the basis
                                                                                          of the facts available.   
    355.38 (a)-(e)...........................  351.309.................................  Written argument.          
    355.38(f)................................  351.310.................................  Hearings.                  
    355.39...................................  351.311.................................  Subsidy practice discovered
                                                                                          during investigation or   
                                                                                          review.                   
    ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                     Subpart D--Quota Cheese Subsidy Determinations                                 
    ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
    355.41...................................  Removed.................................  Definition of subsidy.     
    
    [[Page 27422]]
    
                                                                                                                    
    355.42...................................  351.601.................................  Annual list and quarterly  
                                                                                          update.                   
    355.43...................................  351.602.................................  Determination upon request.
    355.44...................................  351.603.................................  Complaint of price-        
                                                                                          undercutting.             
    355.45...................................  351.604.................................  Access to information.     
    ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
    
    
    BILLING CODE 3510-DS-P
    
    [[Page 27423]]
    
    Annex VI--Countervailing Investigations Timeline
    [GRAPHIC] [TIFF OMITTED] TR19MY97.000
    
    
    [[Page 27424]]
    
    
    
    Annex VII--Antidumping Investigations Timeline
    [GRAPHIC] [TIFF OMITTED] TR19MY97.001
    
    [FR Doc. 97-12201 Filed 5-16-97; 8:45 am]
    BILLING CODE 3510-DS-C
    
    
    

Document Information

Effective Date:
6/18/1997
Published:
05/19/1997
Department:
International Trade Administration
Entry Type:
Rule
Action:
Final rule.
Document Number:
97-12201
Dates:
The effective date of this final rule is June 18, 1997. See Sec. 351.701 for applicability dates.
Pages:
27296-27424 (129 pages)
Docket Numbers:
Docket No. 950306068-6361-04
RINs:
0625-AA45: Antidumping Duties; Countervailing Duties
RIN Links:
https://www.federalregister.gov/regulations/0625-AA45/antidumping-duties-countervailing-duties
PDF File:
97-12201.pdf
CFR: (77)
19 CFR 351.214)
19 CFR 351.210(b)(3)
19 CFR 351.215(b)
19 CFR 351.221(b)(4)
19 CFR 351.221(b)(5)
More ...